Manual GE C30
Manual GE C30
Manual GE C30
Digital Energy
834718A2.CDR
E83849
GE Digital Energy
650 Markland Street
Markham, Ontario
Canada L6C 0M1
Tel: +1 905 927 7070 Fax: +1 905 927 5098
Internet: http://www.GEDigitalEnergy.com
*1601-0088-AA1*
LISTED
IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL
GE Multilin's Quality Management
System is registered to ISO
9001:2008
QMI # 005094
UL # A3775
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. GETTING STARTED
1.2 OVERVIEW
1.2.1
1.2.2
1.2.3
1.4 UR HARDWARE
1.4.1
1.4.2
1.4.3
2. PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2.1.1
2.1.2
2.1.3
OVERVIEW........................................................................................................ 2-1
SECURITY ......................................................................................................... 2-1
IEC 870-5-103 PROTOCOL............................................................................... 2-6
OVERVIEW........................................................................................................ 2-7
ORDER CODES WITH ENHANCED CT/VT MODULES ................................... 2-7
ORDER CODES WITH PROCESS BUS MODULES ........................................ 2-9
REPLACEMENT MODULES ........................................................................... 2-12
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2.3.1
2.3.2
2.3.3
2.3.4
2.3.5
2.3.6
2.3.7
2.3.8
2.3.9
2.3.10
2.3.11
2.3.12
3. HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3.1.1
3.1.2
3.2 WIRING
3.2.1
3.2.2
3.2.3
GE Multilin
iii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
3.2.4
3.2.5
3.2.6
3.2.7
3.2.8
3.2.9
4. HUMAN INTERFACES
DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................3-23
FIBER: LED AND ELED TRANSMITTERS ......................................................3-25
FIBER-LASER TRANSMITTERS .....................................................................3-25
G.703 INTERFACE...........................................................................................3-27
RS422 INTERFACE .........................................................................................3-30
RS422 AND FIBER INTERFACE .....................................................................3-32
G.703 AND FIBER INTERFACE ......................................................................3-32
IEEE C37.94 INTERFACE................................................................................3-33
C37.94SM INTERFACE ...................................................................................3-36
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................4-1
CREATING A SITE LIST ....................................................................................4-1
ENERVISTA UR SETUP OVERVIEW ................................................................4-1
ENERVISTA UR SETUP MAIN WINDOW..........................................................4-2
5. SETTINGS
FACEPLATE .....................................................................................................4-13
LED INDICATORS............................................................................................4-14
CUSTOM LABELING OF LEDS .......................................................................4-17
DISPLAY...........................................................................................................4-23
KEYPAD ...........................................................................................................4-23
BREAKER CONTROL ......................................................................................4-23
MENUS .............................................................................................................4-24
CHANGING SETTINGS ...................................................................................4-26
5.1 OVERVIEW
5.1.1
5.1.2
SECURITY..........................................................................................................5-5
DISPLAY PROPERTIES ..................................................................................5-20
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS ..............................................................................5-21
COMMUNICATIONS ........................................................................................5-22
MODBUS USER MAP ......................................................................................5-60
REAL TIME CLOCK .........................................................................................5-60
OSCILLOGRAPHY ...........................................................................................5-65
DATA LOGGER ................................................................................................5-67
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS .....................................................................5-68
USER-PROGRAMMABLE SELF TESTS .........................................................5-71
CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS ............................................................................5-73
USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS....................................................5-74
FLEX STATE PARAMETERS ..........................................................................5-79
USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS ........................................................................5-80
DIRECT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS....................................................................5-82
TELEPROTECTION .........................................................................................5-89
INSTALLATION ................................................................................................5-90
iv
GE Multilin
TABLE OF CONTENTS
5.4 SYSTEM SETUP
5.4.1
5.4.2
BREAKERS...................................................................................................... 5-92
DISCONNECT SWITCHES ............................................................................. 5-96
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5.5.1
5.5.2
5.5.3
5.5.4
5.5.5
5.5.6
5.5.7
5.5.8
OVERVIEW.................................................................................................... 5-119
SELECTOR SWITCH..................................................................................... 5-119
DIGITAL ELEMENTS..................................................................................... 5-125
DIGITAL COUNTERS .................................................................................... 5-128
8-BIT SWITCHES .......................................................................................... 5-130
PID REGULATOR.......................................................................................... 5-132
5.9 TESTING
5.9.1
5.9.2
5.9.3
6. ACTUAL VALUES
6.1 OVERVIEW
6.1.1
6.2 STATUS
6.2.1
6.2.2
6.2.3
6.2.4
6.2.5
6.2.6
6.2.7
6.2.8
6.2.9
6.2.10
6.2.11
6.2.12
6.2.13
6.2.14
6.2.15
6.2.16
GE Multilin
TABLE OF CONTENTS
6.2.17
6.2.18
6.2.19
6.2.20
6.3 METERING
6.3.1
6.3.2
6.3.3
FLEXELEMENTS .............................................................................................6-12
IEC 61580 GOOSE ANALOG VALUES ...........................................................6-12
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS.................................................................6-12
6.4 RECORDS
6.4.1
6.4.2
6.4.3
7. COMMANDS AND
TARGETS
7.1 COMMANDS
7.1.1
7.1.2
7.1.3
7.1.4
7.1.5
7.1.6
7.2 TARGETS
7.2.1
7.2.2
7.2.3
8. MAINTENANCE
8.1 MODULES
8.1.1
8.2 BATTERIES
8.2.1
8.2.2
A. FLEXANALOG AND
FLEXINTEGER
PARAMETERS
B. MODBUS
COMMUNICATIONS
A.1.1
A.1.2
B.1.1
B.1.2
B.1.3
B.1.4
vi
GE Multilin
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B.3.2
C. IEC 61850
COMMUNICATIONS
C.1 OVERVIEW
C.1.1
C.1.2
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................C-1
COMMUNICATION PROFILES .........................................................................C-1
OVERVIEW........................................................................................................C-2
GGIO1: DIGITAL STATUS VALUES .................................................................C-2
GGIO2: DIGITAL CONTROL VALUES ..............................................................C-2
GGIO3: DIGITAL STATUS AND ANALOG VALUES FROM GOOSE DATA ....C-2
GGIO4: GENERIC ANALOG MEASURED VALUES .........................................C-2
MMXU: ANALOG MEASURED VALUES...........................................................C-3
PROTECTION AND OTHER LOGICAL NODES ...............................................C-3
OVERVIEW........................................................................................................C-7
GSSE CONFIGURATION ..................................................................................C-7
FIXED GOOSE ..................................................................................................C-7
CONFIGURABLE GOOSE.................................................................................C-7
ETHERNET MAC ADDRESS FOR GSSE/GOOSE.........................................C-10
GSSE ID AND GOOSE ID SETTINGS ............................................................C-10
OVERVIEW......................................................................................................C-11
CONFIGURING IEC 61850 SETTINGS...........................................................C-12
ABOUT ICD FILES...........................................................................................C-13
CREATING AN ICD FILE WITH ENERVISTA UR SETUP ..............................C-17
ABOUT SCD FILES .........................................................................................C-17
IMPORTING AN SCD FILE WITH ENERVISTA UR SETUP ...........................C-20
D. IEC 60870-5-103
COMMUNICATIONS
E. IEC 60870-5-104
COMMUNICATIONS
GE Multilin
D.1.1
D.1.2
D.1.3
E.1.1
E.1.2
OVERVIEW........................................................................................................D-1
FACTOR AND OFFSET CALCULATION TO TRANSMIT MEASURAND .........D-1
INTEROPERABILITY DOCUMENT ...................................................................D-2
vii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
F. DNP COMMUNICATIONS
G. RADIUS SERVER
H. MISCELLANEOUS
H.2 ABBREVIATIONS
H.2.1
H.3 WARRANTY
H.3.1
INDEX
viii
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
Use this chapter for initial setup of your new C30 Controller System.
1.1.1 CAUTIONS AND WARNINGS
Before attempting to install or use the device, review all safety indicators in this document to help prevent injury, equipment
damage, or downtime.
The following safety and equipment symbols are used in this document.
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate
injury.
Indicates practices not related to personal injury.
a) GENERAL CAUTIONS AND WARNINGS
The following general safety precautions and warnings apply.
Ensure that all connections to the product are correct so as to avoid accidental risk of shock
and/or fire, for example such as can arise from high voltage connected to low voltage terminals.
Follow the requirements of this manual, including adequate wiring size and type, terminal torque settings, voltage,
current magnitudes applied, and adequate isolation/clearance in external wiring from high to low voltage circuits.
Use the device only for its intended purpose and application.
Ensure that all ground paths are uncompromised for safety purposes during device operation and service.
Ensure that the control power applied to the device, the AC current, and voltage input match the ratings specified
on the relay nameplate. Do not apply current or voltage in excess of the specified limits.
Only qualified personnel are to operate the device. Such personnel must be thoroughly familiar with all safety cautions and warnings in this manual and with applicable country, regional, utility, and plant safety regulations.
Hazardous voltages can exist in the power supply and at the device connection to current transformers, voltage
transformers, control, and test circuit terminals. Make sure all sources of such voltages are isolated prior to
attempting work on the device.
Hazardous voltages can exist when opening the secondary circuits of live current transformers. Make sure that
current transformer secondary circuits are shorted out before making or removing any connection to the current
transformer (CT) input terminals of the device.
For tests with secondary test equipment, ensure that no other sources of voltages or currents are connected to
such equipment and that trip and close commands to the circuit breakers or other switching apparatus are isolated, unless this is required by the test procedure and is specified by appropriate utility/plant procedure.
When the device is used to control primary equipment, such as circuit breakers, isolators, and other switching
apparatus, all control circuits from the device to the primary equipment must be isolated while personnel are
working on or around this primary equipment to prevent any inadvertent command from this device.
Use an external disconnect to isolate the mains voltage supply.
LED transmitters are classified as IEC 60825-1 Accessible Emission Limit (AEL) Class 1M.
Class 1M devices are considered safe to the unaided eye. Do not view directly with optical
instruments.
This product is rated to Class A emissions levels and is to be used in Utility, Substation Industrial
environments. Not to be used near electronic devices rated for Class B levels.
GE Multilin
1-1
1 GETTING STARTED
1.1.2 INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1.
Open the relay packaging and inspect the unit for physical damage.
2.
View the rear nameplate and verify that the correct model has been ordered and delivered. The model number is at the
top right.
4.
If there is any noticeable physical damage, or any of the contents listed are missing, contact GE Digital Energy as follows.
GE DIGITAL ENERGY CONTACT INFORMATION AND CALL CENTER FOR PRODUCT SUPPORT:
GE Digital Energy
650 Markland Street
Markham, Ontario
Canada L6C 0M1
TELEPHONE:
FAX:
E-MAIL:
HOME PAGE:
For updates to the instruction manual, firmware, and software, visit the GE Digital Energy website.
1-2
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
1.2 OVERVIEW
1.2OVERVIEW
The GE Universal Relay (UR) series is a new generation of digital, modular, and multifunction equipment that is easily
incorporated into automation systems, at both the station and enterprise levels.
1.2.2 HARDWARE ARCHITECTURE
a) UR BASIC DESIGN
The UR is a digital-based device containing a central processing unit (CPU) that handles multiple types of input and output
signals. The UR device can communicate over a local area network (LAN) with an operator interface, a programming
device, or another UR device.
GE Multilin
1-3
1.2 OVERVIEW
1 GETTING STARTED
The direct inputs and outputs provide a means of sharing digital point states between a number of UR-series intelligent
electronic devices (IEDs) over dedicated fiber, RS422, or G.703 interface. No switching equipment is required as the IEDs
are connected directly in a ring or redundant (dual) ring configuration. This feature is optimized for speed and intended for
pilot-aided schemes, distributed logic applications, or the extension of the input/output capabilities of a single relay chassis.
1.2.3 SOFTWARE ARCHITECTURE
Firmware is the software embedded in the relay in functional modules that can be installed in any relay as required. This is
achieved with object-oriented design and programming (OOD/OOP) techniques.
Object-oriented techniques involve the use of objects and classes. An object is defined as a logical entity that contains
both data and code that manipulates data. A class is the generalized form of similar objects. By using this approach, one
can create a protection class with the protection elements as objects of the class, such as time overcurrent, instantaneous
overcurrent, current differential, undervoltage, overvoltage, underfrequency, and distance. These objects represent completely self-contained software modules. The same object-class concept can be used for metering, input/output control,
software interface, communications, or any functional entity in the system.
Employing OOD/OOP in the software architecture of the C30 achieves the same features as the hardware architecture:
modularity, scalability, and flexibility. The application software for any UR-series device (for example, feeder protection,
transformer protection, distance protection) is constructed by combining objects from the various functional classes. This
results in a common interface across the UR series.
1-4
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
The relay front panel or the EnerVista UR Setup software can be used to communicate with the relay. The software interface is the preferred method to edit settings and view actual values because the computer monitor can display more information.
The minimum system requirements for the EnerVista UR Setup software are as follows:
Windows XP with Service Pack 2 (Service Pack 3 recommended), Windows 7, or Windows Server 2008 Release 2
64-bit
1 GB of RAM (2 GB recommended)
The following qualified modems have been tested to be compatible with the C30 and the EnerVista UR Setup software:
After ensuring that the requirements for using EnerVista UR Setup software are met, install the software from the GE
EnerVista DVD. Or download the UR EnerVista software from http://www.gedigitalenergy.com/multilin and install it.
If you are upgrading from version 7.0 or 7.1 to 7.2 or later, some CPU modules require a new boot version. Update this first
in EnerVista under Maintenance > Update Firmware.
To install the UR EnerVista software from the DVD:
1.
Insert the GE EnerVista DVD into the DVD drive of your computer.
2.
3.
4.
In the EnerVista Launch Pad window, click the Add Product button and select the appropriate product as follows.
Select the Web option to ensure the most recent software release, or select CD if you do not have an Internet connec-
GE Multilin
1-5
1 GETTING STARTED
tion, then click the Add Now button to list software items for the product. EnerVista Launchpad obtains the software
from the Internet or DVD and automatically starts the installation program.
Select the complete path, including the new directory name, where the EnerVista UR Setup software is to be installed.
7.
Click the Next button to begin the installation. The files are installed in the directory indicated, and the installation program automatically creates icons and adds an entry to the Windows start menu.
8.
Click Finish to complete the installation. The UR device is added to the list of installed intelligent electronic devices
(IEDs) in the EnerVista Launchpad window, as shown.
To configure the C30 for remote access via the rear RS485 port, see the Configuring Serial Communications section.
To configure the C30 for remote access via the rear Ethernet port, see the Configuring Ethernet Communications section. An Ethernet module must be specified at the time of ordering.
To configure the C30 for local access with a laptop through either the front RS232 port or rear Ethernet port, see the
Using the Quick Connect Feature section.
1-6
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
Connect a serial cable to the RS485 terminal on the back of the UR device.
2.
In the EnerVista Launchpad software on the computer, select the UR device to start the software.
3.
Click the Device Setup button to open the Device Setup window, and click the Add Site button to define a new site.
4.
Enter a site name in the Site Name field. Optionally add a short description of the site along with the display order of
devices defined for the site. This example uses Location 1 as the site name. When done, click the OK button. The
new site appears in the upper-left list in the EnerVista UR Setup window.
5.
Click the Device Setup button, then select the new site to re-open the Device Setup window.
6.
7.
Enter a name in the "Device Name field and a description (optional) of the site.
8.
Select Serial from the Interface drop-down list. This displays a number of interface parameters that must be entered
for serial communications.
Enter the relay slave address, COM port, baud rate, and parity settings from the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMmenu in their respective fields.
10. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the C30 device and upload the order code. If a communications error
occurs, ensure that the EnerVista UR Setup serial communications values entered in the previous step correspond to
the relay setting values.
11. Click the OK button when the relay order code has been received. The new device is added to the Site List window (or
Online window) located in the top left corner of the main EnerVista UR Setup window.
The device has now been configured for RS232 communications. Proceed to the Connecting to the C30 section to begin
communication.
GE Multilin
1-7
1 GETTING STARTED
1-8
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
Verify that the latest version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed (available from the GE EnerVista CD or
online from http://www.gedigitalenergy.com/multilin). See the Software Installation section if not already installed.
2.
Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
3.
Click the Quick Connect button to open the Quick Connect dialog box.
4.
Select the Serial interface and the correct COM Port, then click Connect.
5.
The EnerVista UR Setup software creates a site named Quick Connect with a corresponding device also named
Quick Connect and displays them at the upper-left of the screen. Expand the sections to view data directly from the
C30 device.
Each time that the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communications to the C30 device. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the C30 model
number.
b) USING QUICK CONNECT VIA THE REAR ETHERNET PORTS
To use the Quick Connect feature to access the C30 from a computer through Ethernet, first assign an IP address to the
relay from the front panel keyboard.
1.
2.
3.
Enter an IP address, for example 1.1.1.1, and select the ENTER key to save the value.
4.
5.
Enter a subnet IP address, for example 255.0.0.0, and press the ENTER key to save the value.
Next, use an Ethernet cross-over cable to connect the computer to the rear Ethernet port. In case you need it, the figure
shows the pinout for an Ethernet cross-over cable.
2
1
4 5 6
7
8
END 1
Pin
Wire color
1
White/orange
2
Orange
3
White/green
4
Blue
5
White/blue
6
Green
7
White/brown
8
Brown
Diagram
END 2
Pin
Wire color
1
White/green
2
Green
3
White/orange
4
Blue
5
White/blue
6
Orange
7
White/brown
8
Brown
Diagram
842799A1.CDR
GE Multilin
1-9
1 GETTING STARTED
1.
From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network connections window.
2.
3.
Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list, and click the Properties button.
4.
1-10
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
5.
Enter an IP address with the first three numbers the same as the IP address of the C30 relay and the last number different (in this example, 1.1.1.2).
6.
Enter a subnet mask equal to the one set in the C30 (in this example, 255.0.0.0).
7.
Open a Windows console window by selecting Start > Run from the Windows Start menu and typing cmd.
2.
Type the following command, substituting the IP address of 1.1.1.1 with yours:
C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1
3.
If the connection is successful, the system returns four replies similar to the following:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Reply
Reply
Reply
Reply
from
from
from
from
1.1.1.1:
1.1.1.1:
1.1.1.1:
1.1.1.1:
bytes=32
bytes=32
bytes=32
bytes=32
time<10ms
time<10ms
time<10ms
time<10ms
TTL=255
TTL=255
TTL=255
TTL=255
4.
Note that the values for time and TTL vary depending on local network configuration.
5.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Request
Request
Request
Request
timed
timed
timed
timed
out.
out.
out.
out.
verify the physical connection between the C30 and the laptop computer, and double-check the programmed IP
address in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2.
6.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Hardware
Hardware
Hardware
Hardware
error.
error.
error.
error.
verify the physical connection between the C30 and the laptop computer, and double-check the programmed IP
address in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2.
7.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
GE Multilin
1-11
1 GETTING STARTED
Destination
Destination
Destination
Destination
host
host
host
host
unreachable.
unreachable.
unreachable.
unreachable.
verify the IP address is programmed in the local computer by entering the ipconfig command in the command window.
C:\WINNT>ipconfig
Windows IP Configuration
Ethernet adapter <F4FE223E-5EB6-4BFB-9E34-1BD7BE7F59FF>:
Connection-specific
IP Address. . . . .
Subnet Mask . . . .
Default Gateway . .
DNS
. .
. .
. .
suffix.
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
.
.
.
.
:
: 0.0.0.0
: 0.0.0.0
:
.
.
.
.
:
: 1.1.1.2
: 255.0.0.0
:
DNS
. .
. .
. .
suffix
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
C:\WINNT>
Before using the Quick Connect feature through the Ethernet port, disable any configured proxy settings in Internet
Explorer.
1.
2.
Select the Tools > Internet Options menu item and click the Connections tab.
3.
4.
Ensure that the Use a proxy server for your LAN box is not checked.
If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the laptop has been disconnected from the C30 relay.
1.
2.
Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
1-12
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
3.
Click the Quick Connect button to open the Quick Connect dialog box.
4.
Select the Ethernet interface and enter the IP address assigned to the C30, then click the Connect button. The
EnerVista UR Setup software creates a site named Quick Connect with a corresponding device also named Quick
Connect and displays them at the upper-left of the screen.
5.
Expand the sections to view data directly from the C30 device.
Each time the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communications to the C30. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the C30 model number.
When direct communications with the C30 via Ethernet is complete, make the following changes:
1.
From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network connections window.
2.
Right-click the Local Area Connection icon and select the Properties item.
3.
Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list provided and click the Properties button.
4.
If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the computer has been disconnected from the C30 relay.
AUTOMATIC DISCOVERY OF ETHERNET DEVICES
The EnerVista UR Setup software can automatically discover and communicate to all UR-series IEDs located on an Ethernet network.
Using the Quick Connect feature, a single click of the mouse triggers the software to automatically detect any UR-series
relays located on the network. The EnerVista UR Setup software then proceeds to configure all settings and order code
options in the Device Setup menu. This feature allows the user to identify and interrogate all UR-series devices at a location.
GE Multilin
1-13
1 GETTING STARTED
1.3.5 CONNECTING TO THE C30 RELAY
1.
Open the Display Properties window through the Site List tree as shown. The Display Properties window opens with a
status indicator on the lower left of the EnerVista UR Setup window.
842743A3.CDR
2.
If the status indicator is red, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the
back of the relay and that the relay has been properly setup for communications (steps A and B earlier).
If a relay icon appears in place of the status indicator, than a report (such as an oscillography or event record) is open.
Close the report to re-display the green status indicator.
3.
NOTE
1-14
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
If and when first using CyberSentry security, use the following procedure for set up.
1.
Log in to the relay as Administrator by using the Value keys on the front panel or through EnerVista connected serially
(so that no IP address is required). If logging in through EnerVista choose Device authentication. Enter the default
password "ChangeMe1#". Note that the "Lock relay" setting needs to be disabled in the Security > Supervisory
menu. When this setting is disabled, configuration and firmware upgrade are possible. By default, this setting is disabled.
2.
3.
Make any required changes in configuration, such as setting a valid IP address for communication over Ethernet.
4.
Next, device or server authentication can be chosen on the login screen, but the choice is available only in EnerVista. Use
device authentication to log in using the five pre-configured roles (Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator,
Observer). When using a serial connection, only device authentication is supported. When server authentication is
required, characteristics for communication with a RADIUS server must be configured on the UR. This is possible only
through the EnerVista software. The RADIUS server itself also must be configured. The appendix called RADIUS Server
gives an example of how to setup a simple RADIUS server. Once both the RADIUS server and the parameters for connecting UR to the server have been configured, you can choose server authentication on the login screen of EnerVista.
Figure 19: LOGIN SCREEN FOR CYBERSENTRY
During the commissioning phase, you have the option to bypass the use of passwords. Do so by enabling the Bypass
Access setting under SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > SECURITY > SUPERVISORY. Be sure to disable this bypass setting after
commissioning the device.
You can change the password for any role either from the front panel or through EnerVista.
GE Multilin
1-15
1 GETTING STARTED
If using EnerVista, navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Security. Change the Local Administrator Password, for
example. It is strongly recommended that the password for the Administrator be changed from the default. Changing the
passwords for the other three roles is optional.
Figure 110: CHANGING THE DEFAULT PASSWORD
1-16
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
1.4 UR HARDWARE
1.4UR HARDWARE
GE Multilin
1-17
1 GETTING STARTED
Display messages are organized into pages under the following headings: actual values, settings, commands, and targets.
The MENU key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is divided further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys increment or decrement numerical setting values
when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit mode. Alternatively, values can be entered with the numeric keypad.
The decimal key initiates and advances to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point.
The HELP key can be pressed at any time for context-sensitive help messages.
The ENTER key stores altered setting values.
When entering an IP address on the front panel, key in the first sequence of the number, then press the key for the decimal place. For example, for 127.0.0.1, press 127, then , then 0, then , then 0, then , then 1. To save the address, press
the ENTER key.
1.5.2 MENU NAVIGATION
Press the MENU key to select a header display page (top-level menu). The header title appears momentarily followed by a
header display page menu item. Each press of the MENU key advances through the following main heading pages:
Actual values
Settings
Commands
Targets
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters (), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters (). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
UP and DOWN keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing
the MESSAGE RIGHT key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, continually pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
HIGHEST LEVEL
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC
1.5.4 RELAY ACTIVATION
The relay is in the default Not Programmed state when it leaves the factory. When powered up successfully, the Trouble
LED is on and the In Service LED off. The relay in the Not Programmed state blocks signaling of any output relay. These
conditions remain until the relay is explicitly put in the Programmed state.
1-18
GE Multilin
1 GETTING STARTED
Select the menu message SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
1.
To put the relay in the Programmed state, press either of the VALUE keys once and then press ENTER. The faceplate Trouble LED turns off and the In Service LED turns on.
The settings for the relay can be programmed manually (see Chapter 5) via the faceplate keypad or remotely via the
EnerVista UR Setup software (see the EnerVista UR Setup help file).
1.5.5 RELAY PASSWORDS
a) PASSWORD SECURITY
It is recommended that passwords be set for each security level and assigned to specific personnel. There are two user
security access levels, COMMAND and SETTING.
1. COMMAND
The COMMAND access level restricts the user from making any settings changes, but allows the user to perform the following operations:
2. SETTING
The SETTING access level allows the user to make any changes to any of the setting values.
See the Changing Settings section in Chapter 4 for complete instructions on setting security-level passwords.
NOTE
b) CYBERSENTRY
When the CyberSentry option is purchased, advanced security services are available, using either device authentication or
server authentication using RADIUS. When this option is purchased, the basic password security is disabled automatically.
For more information, see the CyberSentry content in the Security section of the next chapter.
1.5.6 FLEXLOGIC CUSTOMIZATION
FlexLogic equation editing is required for setting user-defined logic for customizing the relay operations. See the FlexLogic
section in Chapter 5.
GE Multilin
1-19
1 GETTING STARTED
1.5.7 COMMISSIONING
The C30 requires minimal maintenance after it is commissioned into service. Since the C30 is a microprocessor-based
relay, its characteristics do not change over time. As such, no further functional tests are required.
The C30 performs a number of continual self-tests and takes the necessary action in case of any major errors (see the
Relay Self-tests section in chapter 7). However, it is recommended that C30 maintenance be scheduled with other system
maintenance. This maintenance can involve in-service, out-of-service, or unscheduled maintenance.
In-service maintenance:
1.
Visual verification of the analog values integrity, such as voltage and current (in comparison to other devices on the
corresponding system).
2.
Visual verification of active alarms, relay display messages, and LED indications.
3.
LED test.
4.
5.
Out-of-service maintenance:
1.
2.
Analog values (currents, voltages, RTDs, analog inputs) injection test and metering accuracy verification. Calibrated
test equipment is required.
3.
Protection elements setting verification (analog values injection or visual verification of setting file entries against relay
settings schedule).
4.
Contact inputs and outputs verification. This test can be conducted by direct change of state forcing or as part of the
system functional testing.
5.
6.
7.
View the event recorder and oscillography or fault report for correct operation of inputs, outputs, and elements.
If it is concluded that the relay or one of its modules is of concern, contact GE Multilin for service.
1-20
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2.1.1 OVERVIEW
The C30 Controller System is a microprocessor-based device designed for power substation control and monitoring.
Diagnostic features include a sequence of records capable of storing 1024 time-tagged events. The internal clock used for
time-tagging can be synchronized with an IRIG-B signal or via the SNTP protocol over the Ethernet port. This precise time
stamping allows the sequence of events to be determined throughout the system. Events can also be programmed (via
FlexLogic equations) to trigger oscillography data capture which may be set to record the measured parameters before
and after the event for viewing on a personal computer (PC). These tools significantly reduce troubleshooting time and simplify report generation in the event of a system fault.
Several options are available for communication. A faceplate RS232 port can be used to connect to a computer for the programming of settings and the monitoring of actual values. The RS232 port has a fixed baud rate of 19.2 kbps. The rear
RS485 port allows independent access by operating and engineering staff. It can be connected to system computers with
baud rates up to 115.2 kbps. All serial ports use the Modbus RTU protocol. The IEC 60870-5-103 protocol is supported on
the RS485 interface. IEC 60870-5-103, DNP, and Modbus cannot be enabled simultaneously on this interface. Also only
one of the DNP, IEC 60870-5-103, and IEC 60870-5-104 protocols can be enabled at any time on the relay. When the IEC
60870-5-103 protocol is chosen, the RS485 port has a fixed even parity and the baud rate can be either 9.6 kbps or 19.2
kbps. The 100Base-FX Ethernet interface provides fast, reliable communications in noisy environments. The Ethernet port
supports IEC 61850, Modbus/TCP, and TFTP protocols, PTP (according to IEEE Std. 1588-2008 or IEC 61588), and allows
access to the relay via any standard web browser (C30 web pages). The IEC 60870-5-104 protocol is supported on the
Ethernet port, and DNP and IEC 60870-5-104 cannot be enabled at the same time. The Ethernet port also supports the
Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) of IEC 62439-3 (clause 4, 2012) when purchased as a CPU module option.
The C30 IEDs use flash memory technology which allows field upgrading as new features are added.
Table 21: DEVICE FUNCTIONS
FUNCTION
FUNCTION
Breaker Control
Modbus Communications
Control Pushbuttons
CyberSentry security
Non-Volatile Latches
Data Logger
Oscillography
Disconnect Switches
Event Recorder
FlexElements (8)
FlexLogic Equations
2.1.2 SECURITY
The following security features are available:
Password security Basic security present in the default offering of the product
EnerVista security Role-based access to various EnerVista software screens and configuration elements. The feature is available in the default offering of the product and only in the EnerVista software.
CyberSentry security Advanced security options available as a software option. When purchased, the options are
automatically enabled, and the default Password security and EnerVista security are disabled.
GE Multilin
2-1
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
a) ENERVISTA SECURITY
The EnerVista security management system is a role-based access control (RBAC) system that allows an administrator to
manage the privileges of multiple users. This allows for access control of UR devices by multiple personnel within a substation and conforms to the principles of RBAC as defined in ANSI INCITS 359-2004. The EnerVista security management
system is disabled by default to allow the administrator direct access to the EnerVista software after installation. It is recommended that security be enabled before placing the device in service.
The command and setting passwords are defaulted to 0 when the relay is shipped from the factory. When a password is
set to 0, the password security feature is disabled. As shown in the figures, the window indicates when the password is at
the default and when the password has been set.
Figure 21: WINDOW INDICATES DEFAULT PASSWORD (LEFT) AND PASSWORD SET (RIGHT)
The C30 supports password entry from a local or remote connection. Local access is defined as any access to settings or
commands via the faceplate interface. This includes both keypad entry and the through the faceplate RS232 port. Remote
access is defined as any access to settings or commands via any rear communications port. This includes both Ethernet
and RS485 connections. Any changes to the local or remote passwords enables this functionality.
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the C30, the remote password must be used. If the connection
is to the RS232 port of the faceplate, the local password applies.
Events are logged in the Event Recorder. The FlexLogic operands and events are updated every five seconds.
c) CYBERSENTRY SECURITY
CyberSentry Embedded Security is a software option that provides advanced security services. When this option is purchased, the basic password security is disabled automatically.
CyberSentry provides security through the following features:
2-2
An Authentication, Authorization, Accounting (AAA) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) client that
is centrally managed, enables user attribution, provides accounting of all user activities, and uses secure standardsbased strong cryptography for authentication and credential protection.
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1 INTRODUCTION
A Role-Based Access Control (RBAC) system that provides a permission model that allows access to UR device operations and configurations based on specific roles and individual user accounts configured on the AAA server (that is,
Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, Observer).
Security event reporting through the Syslog protocol for supporting Security Information Event Management (SIEM)
systems for centralized cybersecurity monitoring.
Strong encryption of all access and configuration network messages between the EnerVista software and UR devices
using the Secure Shell (SSH) protocol, the Advanced Encryption Standard (AES), and 128-bit keys in Galois Counter
Mode (GCM) as specified in the U.S. National Security Agency Suite B extension for SSH and approved by the
National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) FIPS-140-2 standards for cryptographic systems.
Example: Administrative functions can be segmented away from common operator functions, or engineering type access,
all of which are defined by separate roles, as shown in the following figure, so that access of UR devices by multiple personnel within a substation is allowed. Permission for each role are outlined in the next section.
Figure 22: CYBERSENTRY USER ROLES
There are two types of authentication supported by CyberSentry that can be used to access the UR device:
The EnerVista software allows access to functionality that is determined by the user role, which comes either from the local
UR device or RADIUS server.
The EnerVista software has a device authentication option on the login screen for accessing the UR device. When the
"Device" button is selected, the UR uses its local authentication database and not the RADIUS server to authenticate the
user. In this case, it uses its built-in roles (Administrator, Engineer, Supervisor, Observer, Operator) as login names and the
associated passwords are stored on the UR device. As such, when using the local accounts, access is not user-attributable.
In cases where user attributable access is required especially to facilitate auditable processes for compliance reasons, use
RADIUS authentication only.
When the "Server" Authentication Type option is selected, the UR uses the RADIUS server and not its local authentication
database to authenticate the user.
No password or security information are displayed in plain text by the EnerVista software or UR device, nor are they ever
transmitted without cryptographic protection.
CYBERSENTRY USER ROLES
CyberSentry user roles (Administrator, Engineer, Operator, Supervisor, Observer) limit the levels of access to various UR
device functions. This means that the EnerVista software allows for access to functionality based on the users logged in
role.
Example: Observer cannot write any settings.
The table lists the roles that are supported and their corresponding capabilities.
GE Multilin
2-3
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
Administrator
Complete access
Device Definition
Engineer
Complete access
except for
CyberSentry
Security
R
Operator
Command
menu
Supervisor
Authorizes
writing
Observer
Default role
Settings
|------------ Product Setup
|--------------- Security (CyberSentry)
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
|--------------- Communications
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
|--------------- Oscillography
RW
RW
RW
RW
|--------------- Demand
RW
RW
User Programmable
|--------------- LEDs
RW
RW
|--------------- Supervisory
User Programmable
|--------------- self test
RW
RW
RW
RW
User programmable
|--------------- Pushbuttons
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
|--------------- Tele-protection
RW
RW
|--------------- Installation
RW
RW
RW
RW
|------------ FlexLogic
RW
RW
R
R
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
2-4
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
|--------------- Resetting
RW
RW
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
Roles
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Administrator
Engineer
Operator
Supervisor
Observer
RW
RW
RW
RW
|--------------- Teleprotection
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
IEC61850 GOOSE
|--------------- Analogs
RW
RW
IEC61850 GOOSE
|--------------- Integers
RW
RW
RW
RW
|------------ Testing
RW
RW
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
Commands
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
User Displays
Targets
Actual Values
|------------ Status
|------------ Metereing
|------------ Records
RW
RW
R
NA
Maintenance
|------------ Modbus Analyzer
NA
NA
NA
NA
RW
RW
RW
Yes
No
No
No
No
Yes
No
No
No
No
Table Notes:
1.
2.
R = read access
3.
4.
GE Multilin
2-5
2.1 INTRODUCTION
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.1.3 IEC 870-5-103 PROTOCOL
IEC 870-5-103 is a companion standard to IEC 870-5 suit of standards for transmission protocols. It defines messages and
procedures for interoperability between protection equipment and devices of a control system in a substation for communicating on a serial line.
The IEC 60870-5-103 is an unbalanced (master-slave) protocol for coded-bit serial communication, exchanging information
with a control system. In the context of this protocol, the protection equipment is the slave and the control system is the
master. The communication is based on a point to point principle. The master must be able to interpret the IEC 60870-5103 communication messages.
The UR implementation of IEC 60870-5-103 consists of the following functions:
Commands
Time synchronization
2-6
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.2ORDER CODES
2.2.1 OVERVIEW
The C30 is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount or reduced-size () vertical unit and consists of the following modules: power supply, CPU, CT/VT, digital input and output, transducer input and output, and inter-relay communications.
Each of these modules can be supplied in a number of configurations specified at the time of ordering. The information
required to completely specify the relay is provided in the following tables (see chapter 3 for full details of relay modules).
Order codes are subject to change without notice. See the ordering page at
http://www.gedigitalenergy.com/multilin/order.htm for the latest ordering options.
NOTE
The order code structure is dependent on the mounting option (horizontal or vertical) and the type of CT/VT modules
(enhanced diagnostic CT/VT modules or HardFiberTM process bus modules). The order code options are described in the
following sub-sections.
2.2.2 ORDER CODES WITH ENHANCED CT/VT MODULES
The order codes for the horizontal mount units are shown below.
Table 23: C30 ORDER CODES (HORIZONTAL UNITS)
BASE UNIT
CPU
C30
C30
SOFTWARE
MOUNT/COATING
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY
GE Multilin
*
|
T
U
V
**
|
|
|
|
00
01
03
04
A0
A1
A3
A4
AW
B0
B1
B3
B4
BW
C0
C1
C3
C4
CW
D0
D1
D3
D4
DW
E0
E1
E3
E4
EW
F0
F1
F3
F4
FW
G0
G1
G3
G4
GW
J0
J1
J3
J4
K0
K1
K3
K4
L0
L1
L3
L4
- *
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
A
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
C
D
R
A
P
G
S
B
K
M
Q
U
L
N
T
V
W
Y
I
J
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- H
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- P
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- U
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
W/X
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2-7
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
**
- *
DIGITAL
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
* - F
H
H
L
L
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
(select a maximum of 3 per unit)
INTER-RELAY
COMMUNICATIONS
(select a maximum of 1 per unit)
**
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- H
**
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- M
**
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- P
**
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- U
**
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
W/X
**
|
RH
|
RL
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
2A
2B
2E
2F
2G
2H
2I
2J
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7N
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
The order codes for the reduced size vertical mount units are shown below.
Table 24: C30 ORDER CODES (REDUCED SIZE VERTICAL UNITS)
BASE UNIT
CPU
SOFTWARE
2-8
C30
C30
*
|
T
U
V
**
|
|
|
|
00
01
03
04
A0
A1
A3
A4
AW
B0
B1
B3
B4
BW
C0
C1
C3
C4
CW
D0
D1
D3
D4
DW
E0
E1
E3
E4
EW
F0
F1
F3
F4
FW
G0
G1
G3
G4
GW
J0
J1
J3
J4
K0
K1
K3
- *
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- H
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
P/R
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
Base Unit
RS485 with 3 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
RS485 with 1 100Base-T Ethernet, SFP RJ-45 + 2 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
RS485 with 3 100Base-T Ethernet, SFP with RJ-45
No software options
Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
IEC 61850
Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850
CyberSentry Lvl 1
CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data
CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588
IEEE 1588 and Ethernet Global Data
IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PID controller, and IEC 61850
Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
PRP and Ethernet Global Data
PRP and IEC 61850
PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588 and PRP
IEEE 1588, PRP, and Ethernet Global Dada
IEEE 1588, PRP, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
PRP and CyberSentry Lvl1
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl1, and Ethernet Global Data
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, and CyberSentry Lvl 1
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103
IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
MOUNT/COATING
**
K4
L0
L1
L3
L4
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY
- *
|
|
|
|
|
V
B
POWER SUPPLY
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F
K
M
Q
U
L
N
T
V
W
Y
I
J
DIGITAL
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
L
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
(select a maximum of 3 per unit)
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- H
INTER-RELAY
COMMUNICATIONS
(select a maximum of 1 per unit)
For the last module, slot P is used for digital and transducer
input/output modules; slot R is used for inter-relay
communications modules.
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
P/R
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
2A
2B
2E
2F
2G
2H
2I
2J
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7N
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
Vertical (3/4 rack)
Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh-environmental coating
English display
Enhanced front panel with English display
Enhanced front panel with French display
Enhanced front panel with Russian display
Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with German display
Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
No Module
4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
16 digital inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
8 Form-C outputs
16 digital inputs
4 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
8 Fast Form-C outputs
4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 digital inputs
2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 digital inputs
2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 digital inputs
4 dcmA inputs, 4 dcmA outputs (only one 5A module is allowed)
8 RTD inputs
4 RTD inputs, 4 dcmA outputs (only one 5D module is allowed)
4 RTD inputs, 4 dcmA inputs
8 dcmA inputs
C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
Bi-phase, single channel
Bi-phase, dual channel
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
G.703, 1 Channel
G.703, 2 Channels
RS422, 1 Channel
RS422, 2 Channels
GE Multilin
C30
C30
*
|
T
U
V
**
|
|
|
|
00
01
03
04
A0
A1
A3
A4
AW
B0
B1
B3
B4
BW
C0
C1
C3
C4
CW
D0
D1
D3
D4
- *
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- H
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- P
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- U
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
W/X
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2-9
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
Table 25: C30 ORDER CODES (HORIZONTAL UNITS WITH PROCESS BUS)
C30
MOUNT/COATING
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY
POWER SUPPLY
(redundant supply must
be same type as main supply)
PROCESS BUS MODULE
DIGITAL
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
INTER-RELAY
COMMUNICATIONS
(select a maximum of 1 per unit)
2-10
**
DW
E0
E1
E3
E4
EW
F0
F1
F3
F4
FW
G0
G1
G3
G4
GW
J0
J1
J3
J4
K0
K1
K3
K4
L0
L1
L3
L4
- *
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
A
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
C
D
R
A
P
G
S
B
K
M
Q
U
L
N
T
V
W
Y
I
J
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
H
L
L
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
|
- H
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
81
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
|
- P
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
- U
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
W/X
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RH
|
RL
|
|
XX
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2A
2B
2E
2F
2G
2H
2I
2J
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7N
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
The order codes for the reduced size vertical mount units with the process bus module are shown below.
Table 26: C30 ORDER CODES (REDUCED SIZE VERTICAL UNITS WITH PROCESS BUS)
BASE UNIT
CPU
C30
C30
SOFTWARE
MOUNT/COATING
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY
POWER SUPPLY
PROCESS BUS MODULE
DIGITAL
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
*
|
T
U
V
**
|
|
|
|
00
01
03
04
A0
A1
A3
A4
AW
B0
B1
B3
B4
BW
C0
C1
C3
C4
CW
D0
D1
D3
D4
DW
E0
E1
E3
E4
EW
F0
F1
F3
F4
FW
G0
G1
G3
G4
GW
J0
J1
J3
J4
K0
K1
K3
K4
L0
L1
L3
L4
- *
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
V
B
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F
K
M
Q
U
L
N
T
V
W
Y
I
J
* - F
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
H
L
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
|
INTER-RELAY
COMMUNICATIONS
(select a maximum of 1 per unit)
For the last module, slot P is used for digital and transducer
input/output modules; slot R is used for inter-relay
communications modules.
GE Multilin
- H
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
81
- M
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
|
P/R
**
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XX
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
2A
2B
2E
2F
2G
2H
2I
2J
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
Base Unit
RS485 with 3 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
RS485 with 1 100Base-T Ethernet, SFP RJ-45 + 2 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode, SFP with LC
RS485 with 3 100Base-T Ethernet, SFP with RJ-45
No software options
Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
IEC 61850
Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850
CyberSentry Lvl 1
CyberSentry Lvl 1 and Ethernet Global Data
CyberSentry Lvl 1 and IEC 61850
CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588
IEEE 1588 and Ethernet Global Data
IEEE 1588 and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PID controller, and IEC 61850
Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
PRP and Ethernet Global Data
PRP and IEC 61850
PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588 and CyberSentry Lvl 1
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and Ethernet Global Data
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588 and PRP
IEEE 1588, PRP, and Ethernet Global Dada
IEEE 1588, PRP, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, PID controller, and IEC 61850
PRP and CyberSentry Lvl1
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl1, and Ethernet Global Data
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, and CyberSentry Lvl 1
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, Ethernet Global Data, and IEC 61850
IEEE 1588, PRP, CyberSentry Lvl 1, PID controller, and IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103
IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
IEEE1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
Vertical (3/4 rack)
Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh environmental coating
English display
Enhanced front panel with English display
Enhanced front panel with French display
Enhanced front panel with Russian display
Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
Enhanced front panel with German display
Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
None
Eight-port digital process bus module
None
4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
16 digital inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
8 Form-C outputs
16 digital inputs
4 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
8 Fast Form-C outputs
4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 digital inputs
2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 digital inputs
2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 digital inputs
C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
Bi-phase, single channel
Bi-phase, dual channel
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode Laser
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
2-11
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
Table 26: C30 ORDER CODES (REDUCED SIZE VERTICAL UNITS WITH PROCESS BUS)
C30
**
- *
* - F
**
- H
**
- M
**
P/R
**
7K
7L
7M
7N
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multimode, LED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
G.703, 1 Channel
G.703, 2 Channels
RS422, 1 Channel
RS422, 2 Channels
Replacement modules can be ordered separately. When ordering a replacement CPU module or faceplate, provide the
serial number of your existing unit.
Not all replacement modules may be applicable to the C30 relay. Only the modules specified in the order codes are
available as replacement modules.
NOTE
Replacement module codes are subject to change without notice. See the ordering page at
http://www.gedigitalenergy.com/multilin/order.htm for the latest C30 ordering options.
NOTE
The replacement module order codes for the horizontal mount units are shown below.
Table 27: ORDER CODES FOR REPLACEMENT MODULES, HORIZONTAL UNITS
POWER SUPPLY (redundant supply only available in
horizontal units; must be same type as main supply)
CPU
FACEPLATE/DISPLAY
CT/VT MODULES
(NOT AVAILABLE FOR THE C30)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS
2-12
UR
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
RH
RL
T
U
V
3C
3D
3R
3A
3P
3G
3S
3B
3K
3M
3Q
3U
3L
3N
3T
3V
3I
3J
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
8L
8N
8M
8R
2A
2B
2E
2F
2G
2H
2I
2J
H
H
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
UR
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7N
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The replacement module order codes for the reduced-size vertical mount units are shown below.
Table 28: ORDER CODES FOR REPLACEMENT MODULES, VERTICAL UNITS
POWER SUPPLY
CPU
FACEPLATE/DISPLAY
DIGITAL
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
CT/VT MODULES
(NOT AVAILABLE FOR THE C30)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS
TRANSDUCER
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
GE Multilin
UR
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
**
RH
RL
T
U
V
3F
3D
3R
3A
3K
3M
3Q
3U
3L
3N
3T
3V
3I
3J
4A
4B
4C
4D
4L
67
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
6G
6H
6K
6L
6M
6N
6P
6R
6S
6T
6U
6V
8L
8N
8V
2A
2B
2E
2F
2G
2H
2I
2J
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
7N
7P
7Q
7R
7S
7T
7W
5A
5C
5D
5E
5F
V
V
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2-13
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
FLEXLOGIC
LED TEST
Initiation:
Lines of code:
512
Number of tests:
Internal variables:
64
approximately 3 minutes
Supported operations:
Test sequence 1:
all LEDs on
Test sequence 2:
Test sequence 3:
Inputs:
USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
Number of displays:
16
Number of timers:
32
Lines of display:
2 20 alphanumeric characters
Pickup delay:
Parameters:
Dropout delay:
Number:
4 (A through D)
CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS
Reset points:
40 (0 through 1 of pickup)
Operate points:
80 (1 through 20 of pickup)
FLEXCURVES
Time delay:
Number of pushbuttons: 7
Operation:
0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1
FLEX STATES
Number:
Programmability:
FLEXELEMENTS
Number of elements:
Operating signal:
self-reset, latched
Display message:
Drop-out timer:
Autoreset timer:
Hold timer:
SELECTOR SWITCH
Number of elements:
1 to 7 in steps of 1
Operating mode:
level, delta
Selecting mode:
time-out or acknowledge
Comparator direction:
over, under
Time-out timer:
Pickup Level:
Control inputs:
Hysteresis:
Power-up mode:
Delta dt:
20 ms to 60 days
8-BIT SWITCH
NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
Type:
set-dominant or reset-dominant
Number:
16 (individually programmed)
Output:
Execution sequence:
Input signals:
Control signal:
Response time:
DIGITAL ELEMENTS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDs
Number of elements:
Number:
Programmability:
Reset mode:
self-reset or latched
2-14
Number of elements:
48
Operating signal:
Pickup delay:
Dropout delay:
Timing accuracy:
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2.3.2 MONITORING
DATA LOGGER
OSCILLOGRAPHY
Maximum records:
64
Number of channels:
Sampling rate:
Parameters:
1 to 16
any available analog actual value
Triggers:
Sampling rate:
15 to 3600000 ms in steps of 1
Data:
Data storage:
in non-volatile memory
Trigger:
Mode:
continuous or triggered
Storage capacity:
1-second rate:
01 channel for NN days
16 channels for NN days
EVENT RECORDER
Capacity:
1024 events
Time-tag:
to 1 microsecond
Triggers:
Data storage:
in non-volatile memory
60-minute rate:
01 channel for NN days
16 channels for NN days
2.3.3 INPUTS
CFREQUENCY
Nominal frequency setting:25 to 60 Hz
Sampling frequency:
RTD INPUTS
Types (3-wire):
CONTACT INPUTS
Sensing current:
5 mA
Range:
50 to +250C
Accuracy:
2C
300 V DC maximum
Isolation:
36 V pk-pk
17 V, 33 V, 84 V, 166 V
IRIG-B INPUT
10%
Dry contacts:
1000 maximum
Wet contacts:
Selectable thresholds:
Tolerance:
Amplitude modulation:
1 to 10 V pk-pk
DC shift:
TTLCompatible
Recognition time:
< 1 ms
Input impedance:
50 k
Debounce time:
Isolation:
2 kV
Input points:
Dry contacts:
1000 maximum
Remote devices:
Wet contacts:
300 V DC maximum
Selectable thresholds:
17 V, 33 V, 84 V, 166 V
Tolerance:
10%
DIRECT INPUTS
Input points:
32
Recognition time:
< 1 ms
Remote devices:
16
Debounce time:
Ring configuration:
Data rate:
64 or 128 kbps
CRC:
32-bit
DCMA INPUTS
CRC alarm:
Responding to:
Rate of messages failing the CRC
Monitoring message count: 10 to 10000 in steps of 1
Alarm threshold:
1 to 1000 in steps of 1
Input impedance:
379 10%
Conversion range:
1 to + 20 mA DC
Accuracy:
Type:
Passive
GE Multilin
Yes, No
2-15
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
TELEPROTECTION
Input points:
16
Remote devices:
No
Data rate:
64 or 128 kbps
CRC:
32-bit
ALL RANGES
Nominal DC voltage:
24 to 48 V
Volt withstand:
Minimum DC voltage:
20 V
Power consumption:
Maximum DC voltage:
20 ms duration at nominal
typical = 15 to 20 W/VA
maximum = 50 W/VA
contact factory for exact order code consumption
INTERNAL FUSE
RATINGS
HIGH RANGE
Nominal DC voltage:
125 to 250 V
Minimum DC voltage:
88 V
Maximum DC voltage:
Nominal AC voltage:
Minimum AC voltage:
88 V at 25 to 100 Hz
Maximum AC voltage:
265 V at 25 to 100 Hz
INTERRUPTING CAPACITY
AC:
DC:
2.3.5 OUTPUTS
FORM-A RELAY
Applicable voltage:
approx. 15 to 250 V DC
Trickle current:
approx. 1 to 2.5 mA
Carry continuous:
6A
Threshold current:
CURRENT
approx. 80 to 100 mA
24 V
1A
48 V
0.5 A
125 V
0.3 A
Carry continuous:
250 V
0.2 A
Operate time:
< 4 ms
Contact material:
silver alloy
VOLTAGE
8A
CURRENT
24 V
1A
48 V
0.5 A
125 V
0.3 A
Carry continuous:
250 V
0.2 A
LATCHING RELAY
6 A as per IEEE C37.90
CURRENT
24 V
6A
48 V
1.6 A
125 V
0.4 A
250 V
0.2 A
Operate time:
< 4 ms
Contact material:
silver alloy
Control:
Control mode:
operate-dominant or reset-dominant
2-16
Operate time:
< 8 ms
Contact material:
silver alloy
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
IMPEDANCE
Capacity:
100 mA DC at 48 V DC
Isolation:
300 Vpk
2 W RESISTOR
1 W RESISTOR
250 V DC
20 K
50 K
120 V DC
5 K
2 K
48 V DC
2 K
2 K
DIRECT OUTPUTS
24 V DC
2 K
2 K
Output points:
Operate time:
Utility
application
(autoreclose
scheme)
5000 ops /
1 s-On, 9 s-Off
5 ops /
0.2 s-On,
0.2 s-Off
within 1
minute
10000 ops /
0.2 s-On,
30 s-Off
10 A
L/R = 40 ms
10 A
L/R = 40 ms
1000 ops /
0.5 s-On, 0.5 s-Off
Break
capability
(0 to 250 V
DC)
1 to 1 mA, 0 to 1 mA, 4 to 20 mA
12 k for 1 to 1 mA range
12 k for 0 to 1 mA range
600 for 4 to 20 mA range
Accuracy:
Breaking capacity:
Operations/
interval
32
Range:
265 V DC
32
DCMA OUTPUTS
< 0.6 ms
Maximum voltage:
Industrial
application
Isolation:
1.5 kV
Driving signal:
3.2 A
L/R = 10 ms
1.6 A
L/R = 20 ms
0.8 A
L/R = 40 ms
GE Multilin
2-17
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.3.6 COMMUNICATIONS
RS232
Front port:
RS485
1 rear port:
Typical distance:
1200 m
Isolation:
2 kV
FIBER TYPE
100MB MULTIMODE
Wavelength
ETHERNET (FIBER)
PARAMETER
2 and 3
Networks supported:
10/100 MB Ethernet
1310 nm
Connector
LC
Transmit power
20 dBm
Receiver sensitivity
30 dBm
Power budget
10 dB
Maximum input
power
14 dBm
Typical distance
2 km
Duplex
full/half
Redundancy
yes
Connector:
RJ45
TYPICAL DISTANCE
RS422
1200 m
G.703
100 m
NOTE
The power budgets for the 1300 nm ELED are calculated from the manufacturer's transmitter power and
receiver sensitivity at ambient temperature. At
extreme temperatures these values deviate based
on component tolerance. On average, the output
power decreases as the temperature is increased by
a factor 1dB / 5C.
EMITTER,
FIBER TYPE
TRANSMIT
POWER
RECEIVED
SENSITIVITY
POWER
BUDGET
MAX. OPTICAL
INPUT POWER
820 nm LED,
Multimode
20 dBm
30 dBm
10 dB
7.6 dBm
1300 nm LED,
Multimode
21 dBm
30 dBm
9 dB
1300 nm ELED,
Single mode
23 dBm
32 dBm
9 dB
1300 nm Laser,
Single mode
1 dBm
30 dBm
29 dB
1550 nm Laser,
Single mode
+5 dBm
30 dBm
35 dB
NOTE
2-18
11 dBm
14 dBm
14 dBm
14 dBm
These power budgets are calculated from the manufacturers worst-case transmitter power and worst
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
CABLE
TYPE
CONNECTOR
TYPE
TYPICAL
DISTANCE
820 nm LED,
multimode
62.5/125 m
ST
1.65 km
1300 nm LED,
multimode
62.5/125 m
ST
3.8 km
1300 nm ELED,
single mode
9/125 m
ST
11.4 km
1300 nm Laser,
single mode
9/125 m
ST
64 km
1550 nm Laser,
single mode
9/125 m
ST
105 km
NOTE
Typical distances listed are based on the following assumptions for system loss. As actual losses
vary from one installation to another, the distance
covered by your system may vary.
2 dB
FIBER LOSSES
820 nm multimode
3 dB/km
1300 nm multimode
1 dB/km
0.35 dB/km
0.25 dB/km
Splice losses:
SYSTEM MARGIN
3 dB additional loss added to calculations to compensate for
all other losses.
Compensated difference in transmitting and receiving (channel
asymmetry) channel delays using GPS satellite clock: 10 ms
GE Multilin
2-19
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.3.8 ENVIRONMENTAL
AMBIENT TEMPERATURES
OTHER
Storage temperature:
Altitude:
2000 m (maximum)
Pollution degree:
II
Overvoltage category:
II
Ingress protection:
40 to 85C
HUMIDITY
Humidity:
REFERENCE STANDARD
TEST LEVEL
EN60255-5
2.2 kV
EN60255-5
5 kV
Damped oscillatory
IEC61000-4-18 / IEC60255-22-1
2.5 kV CM, 1 kV DM
Electrostatic discharge
EN61000-4-2 / IEC60255-22-2
Level 3
RF immunity
EN61000-4-3 / IEC60255-22-3
Level 3
EN61000-4-4 / IEC60255-22-4
Class A and B
Surge immunity
EN61000-4-5 / IEC60255-22-5
Level 3 and 4
Conducted RF immunity
EN61000-4-6 / IEC60255-22-6
Level 3
EN61000-4-7 / IEC60255-22-7
Class A and B
IEC60255-11
Class A
Sinusoidal vibration
IEC60255-21-1
Class 1
IEC60255-21-2
Class 1
Seismic
IEC60255-21-3
Class 1
IEC61000-4-8
Level 5
IEC61000-4-9
Level 4
IEC61000-4-10
Level 4
IEC61000-4-11
Damped oscillatory
IEC61000-4-12
2.5 kV CM, 1 kV DM
IEC61000-4-16
Level 4
Voltage ripple
IEC61000-4-17
15% ripple
Ingress protection
IEC60529
Cold
IEC60068-2-1
Hot
IEC60068-2-2
Humidity
IEC60068-2-30
6 days, variant 1
Damped oscillatory
IEEE/ANSI C37.90.1
RF immunity
IEEE/ANSI C37.90.2
Safety
UL508
e83849 NKCR
Safety
UL C22.2-14
e83849 NKCR7
Safety
UL1053
e83849 NKCR
2-20
GE Multilin
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2.3.11 APPROVALS
APPROVALS
COMPLIANCE
APPLICABLE
COUNCIL DIRECTIVE
ACCORDING TO
CE
EN 60255-5
EMC directive
EN 60255-26 / EN 50263
EN 61000-6-5
C-UL-US
---
UL 508
UL 1053
C22.2 No. 14
2.3.12 MAINTENANCE
MOUNTING
CLEANING
GE Multilin
2-21
2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
2 PRODUCT DESCRIPTION
2-22
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE 3.1DESCRIPTION
a) HORIZONTAL UNITS
The C30 Controller System is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount unit with a removable faceplate. The faceplate
can be specified as either standard or enhanced at the time of ordering. The enhanced faceplate contains additional userprogrammable pushbuttons and LED indicators.
The modular design allows the relay to be easily upgraded or repaired by a qualified service person. The faceplate is
hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules, and is itself removable to allow mounting on doors with limited rear
depth.
The case dimensions are shown below, along with panel cutout details for panel mounting. When planning the location of
your panel cutout, ensure that provision is made for the faceplate to swing open without interference to or from adjacent
equipment.
The relay must be mounted such that the faceplate sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator
access to the keypad and the RS232 communications port. The relay is secured to the panel with the use of four screws
supplied with the relay.
11.016
[279,81 mm]
9.687
[246,05 mm]
17.56
[446,02 mm]
7.460
[189,48 mm]
6.995
[177,67 mm]
6.960
[176,78 mm]
19.040
[483,62 mm]
842807A1.CDR
GE Multilin
3-1
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE
18.370
[466,60 mm]
0.280
[7,11 mm]
Typ. x 4
CUT-OUT
4.000
[101,60 mm]
17.750
[450,85 mm]
842808A1.CDR
3-2
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
The relay must be mounted such that the faceplate sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator
access to the keypad and the RS232 communications port. The relay is secured to the panel with the use of four screws
supplied with the relay.
11.015
7.482
15.000
1.329
14.025
13.560
4.000
9.780
843809A1.CDR
GE Multilin
3-3
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE
GEK-113181: Connecting the side-mounted UR-V enhanced front panel to a vertical UR-series device.
GEK-113182: Connecting the side-mounted UR-V enhanced front panel to a vertically-mounted horizontal UR-series
device.
For details on side mounting C30 devices with the standard front panel, refer to the figures below.
3-4
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
GE Multilin
3-5
3.1 DESCRIPTION
3 HARDWARE
Figure 37: C30 VERTICAL SIDE MOUNTING REAR DIMENSIONS (STANDARD PANEL)
3.1.2 REAR TERMINAL LAYOUT
3-6
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.1 DESCRIPTION
Do not touch any rear terminals while the relay is energized.
The small form-factor pluggable ports (SFPs) are pluggable transceivers. Do not use non-validated
transceivers or install validated transceivers in the wrong Ethernet slot, else damage can occur.
The relay follows a convention with respect to terminal number assignments which are three characters long assigned in
order by module slot position, row number, and column letter. Two-slot wide modules take their slot designation from the
first slot position (nearest to CPU module) which is indicated by an arrow marker on the terminal block. See the following
figure for an example of rear terminal assignments.
GE Multilin
3-7
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3.2WIRING
3-8
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
3.2.2 DIELECTRIC STRENGTH
The dielectric strength of the UR-series module hardware is shown in the following table:
Table 31: DIELECTRIC STRENGTH OF UR-SERIES MODULE HARDWARE
MODULE
TYPE
MODULE FUNCTION
TERMINALS
DIELECTRIC STRENGTH
(AC)
FROM
TO
Power supply
Chassis
Power supply
48 V DC (+) and ()
Chassis
Power supply
Relay terminals
Chassis
Reserved
N/A
N/A
N/A
Reserved
N/A
N/A
N/A
Reserved
N/A
N/A
N/A
Analog inputs/outputs
All except 8b
Chassis
< 50 V DC
Digital inputs/outputs
All
Chassis
G.703
Chassis
RS422
Chassis
< 50 V DC
CPU
All
Chassis
7
9
Filter networks and transient protection clamps are used in the hardware to prevent damage caused
by high peak voltage transients, radio frequency interference (RFI), and electromagnetic interference
(EMI). These protective components can be damaged by application of the ANSI/IEEE C37.90 specified test voltage for a period longer than the specified one minute.
3.2.3 CONTROL POWER
Control power supplied to the relay must be connected to the matching power supply range of the
relay. If the voltage is applied to the wrong terminals, damage can occur.
The C30 relay, like almost all electronic relays, contains electrolytic capacitors. These capacitors are
well known to be subject to deterioration over time if voltage is not applied periodically. Deterioration
can be avoided by powering the relays up once a year.
The power supply module can be ordered for two possible voltage ranges, with or without a redundant power option. Each
range has a dedicated input connection for proper operation. The ranges are as shown below (see the Specifications section of chapter 2 for details):
The power supply module provides power to the relay and supplies power for dry contact input connections.
The power supply module provides 48 V DC power for dry contact input connections and a critical failure relay (see the
Typical wiring diagram earlier). The critical failure relay is a form-C device that is energized once control power is applied
and the relay has successfully booted up with no critical self-test failures. If on-going self-test diagnostic checks detect a
critical failure (see the Self-test Errors section in chapter 7) or control power is lost, the relay is de-energize.
For high reliability systems, the C30 has a redundant option in which two C30 power supplies are placed in parallel on the
bus. If one of the power supplies become faulted, the second power supply assumes the full load of the relay without any
interruptions. Each power supply has a green LED on the front of the module to indicate it is functional. The critical fail relay
of the module also indicates a faulted power supply.
An LED on the front of the control power module shows the status of the power supply:
LED INDICATION
POWER SUPPLY
CONTINUOUS ON
OK
ON / OFF CYCLING
Failure
OFF
Failure
GE Multilin
3-9
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
Reduces labor associated with design, installation, and testing of protection and control applications using the C30 by
reducing the number of individual copper terminations
Integrates seamlessly with existing C30 applications, since the IEC 61850 process bus interface module replaces the
traditional CT/VT modules
For additional details on the HardFiber system, see GE publication GEK-113658: HardFiber Process Bus System Instruction Manual.
3.2.5 CONTACT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
Every contact input/output module has 24 terminal connections. They are arranged as three terminals per row, with eight
rows in total. A given row of three terminals can be used for the outputs of one relay. For example, for form-C relay outputs,
the terminals connect to the normally open (NO), normally closed (NC), and common contacts of the relay. For a form-A
output, there are options of using current or voltage detection for feature supervision, depending on the module ordered.
The terminal configuration for contact inputs is different for the two applications.
The contact inputs are grouped with a common return. The C30 has two versions of grouping: four inputs per common
return and two inputs per common return. When a contact input/output module is ordered, four inputs per common is used.
The four inputs per common allows for high-density inputs in combination with outputs, with a compromise of four inputs
sharing one common. If the inputs must be isolated per row, then two inputs per common return should be selected (4D
module).
The tables and diagrams on the following pages illustrate the module types (6A, etc.) and contact arrangements that can be
ordered for the relay. Since an entire row is used for a single contact output, the name is assigned using the module slot
position and row number. However, since there are two contact inputs per row, these names are assigned by module slot
position, row number, and column position.
3-10
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
Some form-A / solid-state relay outputs include circuits to monitor the DC voltage across the output contact when it is open,
and the DC current through the output contact when it is closed. Each of the monitors contains a level detector whose output is set to logic On = 1 when the current in the circuit is above the threshold setting. The voltage monitor is set to On =
1 when the current is above about 1 to 2.5 mA, and the current monitor is set to On = 1 when the current exceeds about
80 to 100 mA. The voltage monitor is intended to check the health of the overall trip circuit, and the current monitor can be
used to seal-in the output contact until an external contact has interrupted current flow.
Block diagrams are shown as follows for form-A and solid-state relay outputs with optional voltage monitor, optional current
monitor, and with no monitoring. The actual values shown for contact output 1 are the same for all contact outputs.
aD
aD
aE
,I,GFP$&RQW2S 92Q
RWKHUZLVH&RQW2S 92II
aE
aF
9ROWDJHPRQLWRULQJRQO\
aD
,I,GFP$&RQW2S ,2Q
RWKHUZLVH&RQW2S ,2II
,I,GFP$&RQW2S ,2Q
RWKHUZLVH&RQW2S ,2II
,I,GFP$&RQW2S 92Q
RWKHUZLVH&RQW2S 92II
9
aE
%RWKYROWDJHDQGFXUUHQWPRQLWRULQJ
aD
/RDG
/RDG
aF
D9ROWDJHZLWKRSWLRQDO
FXUUHQWPRQLWRULQJ
,I,GFP$&RQW2S 92Q
RWKHUZLVH&RQW2S 92II
,I,GFP$&RQW2S ,2Q
RWKHUZLVH&RQW2S ,2II
aE
/RDG
aF
/RDG
aF
E&XUUHQWZLWKRSWLRQDO
YROWDJHPRQLWRULQJ
&XUUHQWPRQLWRULQJRQO\
%RWKYROWDJHDQGFXUUHQWPRQLWRULQJ
H[WHUQDOMXPSHUDELVUHTXLUHG
aD
aE
/RDG
aF
F1RPRQLWRULQJ
$&'5
Figure 312: FORM-A AND SOLID-STATE CONTACT OUTPUTS WITH VOLTAGE AND CURRENT MONITORING
The operation of voltage and current monitors is reflected with the corresponding FlexLogic operands (CONT OP # VON,
CONT OP # VOFF, and CONT OP # ION) which can be used in protection, control, and alarm logic. The typical application of
the voltage monitor is breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring; a typical application of the current monitor is seal-in of the
control command.
See the Digital Elements section of chapter 5 for an example of how form-A and solid-state relay contacts can be applied
for breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring.
Consider relay contacts unsafe to touch when the unit is energized. If the relay contacts need
to be used for low voltage accessible applications, ensure proper insulation levels.
USE OF FORM-A AND SOLID-STATE RELAY OUTPUTS IN HIGH IMPEDANCE CIRCUITS
NOTE
For form-A and solid-state relay output contacts internally equipped with a voltage measuring circuit across the contact, the circuit has an impedance that can cause a problem when used in conjunction with external high input
impedance monitoring equipment such as modern relay test set trigger circuits. These monitoring circuits may continue to read the form-A contact as being closed after it has closed and subsequently opened, when measured as
an impedance.
The solution is to use the voltage measuring trigger input of the relay test set, and connect the form-A contact
through a voltage-dropping resistor to a DC voltage source. If the 48 V DC output of the power supply is used as a
source, a 500 , 10 W resistor is appropriate. In this configuration, the voltage across either the form-A contact or
the resistor can be used to monitor the state of the output.
GE Multilin
3-11
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
Wherever a tilde ~ symbol appears, substitute with the slot position of the module; wherever a number sign #
appears, substitute the contact number
NOTE
When current monitoring is used to seal-in the form-A and solid-state relay contact outputs, the FlexLogic operand driving the contact output should be given a reset delay of 10 ms to prevent damage
of the output contact (in situations when the element initiating the contact output is bouncing, at values in the region of the pickup value).
Table 32: CONTACT INPUT AND OUTPUT MODULE ASSIGNMENTS
~6A MODULE
~6B MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~6C MODULE
~6D MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-C
~1a, ~1c
2 Inputs
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-C
~2a, ~2c
2 Inputs
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3a, ~3c
2 Inputs
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4a, ~4c
2 Inputs
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-C
~5
Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-C
~6
Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
Form-C
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Form-C
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~6E MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~6F MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~6G MODULE
~6H MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~1
Form-C
~1
Fast Form-C
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~2
Form-C
~2
Fast Form-C
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~3
Form-C
~3
Fast Form-C
~3
Form-A
~3
Form-A
~4
Form-C
~4
Fast Form-C
~4
Form-A
~4
Form-A
Form-A
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Fast Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Fast Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-A
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
Fast Form-C
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Fast Form-C
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~6K MODULE
~6L MODULE
~6M MODULE
~6N MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~1
Form-C
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~2
Form-C
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-A
3-12
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-A
~5
Fast Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~6
Fast Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~7
Fast Form-C
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8
Fast Form-C
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
~6P MODULE
~6R MODULE
~6S MODULE
~6T MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~3
Form-A
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-A
~4
Form-A
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-C
~4
Form-A
~5
Form-A
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-C
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-A
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-C
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
3
~6U MODULE
~6V MODULE
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
TERMINAL
OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT
INPUT
~67 MODULE
~4A MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Form-A
~1
Not Used
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Form-A
~2
Solid-State
~3
Form-A
~3
Form-C
~3
Form-A
~3
Not Used
~4
Form-A
~4
2 Outputs
~4
Form-A
~4
Solid-State
~5
Form-A
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
Form-A
~5
Not Used
~6
Form-A
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
Form-A
~6
Solid-State
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
Form-A
~7
Not Used
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Form-A
~8
Solid-State
~4B MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
~4C MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
~1
Not Used
~1
Not Used
~1a, ~1c
2 Inputs
~1
2 Outputs
~2
Solid-State
~2
Solid-State
~2a, ~2c
2 Inputs
~2
2 Outputs
~3
Not Used
~3
Not Used
~3a, ~3c
2 Inputs
~3
2 Outputs
~4
Solid-State
~4
Solid-State
~4a, ~4c
2 Inputs
~4
2 Outputs
~5
Not Used
~5
Not Used
~5a, ~5c
2 Inputs
~5
2 Outputs
~6
Solid-State
~6
Solid-State
~6a, ~6c
2 Inputs
~6
2 Outputs
~7
Not Used
~7
Not Used
~7a, ~7c
2 Inputs
~7
2 Outputs
~8
Solid-State
~8
Solid-State
~8a, ~8c
2 Inputs
~8
Not Used
OUTPUT
~4L MODULE
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
GE Multilin
OUTPUT
~4D MODULE
OUTPUT
TERMINAL
ASSIGNMENT
OUTPUT
3-13
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3-14
GE Multilin
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 5a
~ 5b
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6b
~ 6c
~ 7a
~ 7b
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8b
~ 8c
~1
3.2 WIRING
6K
3 HARDWARE
~2
~3
~4
~ 5a
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 5a DIGITAL I/O
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
~ 8b
SURGE
6L
~1
~2
~3
~4
V
I
V
I
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 8b
SURGE
~ 7a DIGITAL I/O
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
6M
~1
~2
~4
~6
~6
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 5a
~ 5b
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6b
~ 6c
DIGITAL I/O
~5
~8
V
I
~3
~5
~7
V
I
~ 5a
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 5a DIGITAL I/O
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
~ 8b
SURGE
6N
~1
~2
~3
~4
V
I
V
I
V
I
V
I
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 8b
SURGE
~ 7a DIGITAL I/O
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
6P
~1
~2
~3
~4
~5
~ 5a
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 5a DIGITAL I/O
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
~ 8b
SURGE
6R
~1
~2
~3
~4
~6
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 8b
SURGE
~ 7a DIGITAL I/O
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
6S
~1
~2
~3
~4
~ 5a
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 5a DIGITAL I/O
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6c
~ 5b
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
~ 8b
SURGE
6T
~1
~2
~3
~4
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~5
~6
~ 7a
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
CONTACT IN
COMMON
~ 8b
SURGE
~ 7a DIGITAL I/O
~ 7c
~ 8a
~ 8c
~ 7b
6U
~1
~2
~3
~4
~5
~6
V
I
V
I
V
I
V
I
V
I
V
I
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 5a
~ 5b
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6b
~ 6c
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 5a
~ 5b
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6b
~ 6c
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 1c
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 2c
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 3c
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 4c
~ 5a
~ 5b
~ 5c
~ 6a
~ 6b
~ 6c
842763A2.CDR
GE Multilin
3-15
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
CONTACT INPUTS
A dry contact has one side connected to terminal B3b. This is the positive 48 V DC voltage rail supplied by the power supply module. The other side of the dry contact is connected to the required contact input terminal. Each contact input group
has its own common (negative) terminal which must be connected to the DC negative terminal (B3a) of the power supply
module. When a dry contact closes, a current of 1 to 3 mA flows through the associated circuit.
A wet contact has one side connected to the positive terminal of an external DC power supply. The other side of this contact
is connected to the required contact input terminal. If a wet contact is used, then the negative side of the external source
must be connected to the relay common (negative) terminal of each contact group. The maximum external source voltage
for this arrangement is 300 V DC.
The voltage threshold at which each group of four contact inputs detects a closed contact input is programmable as
17 V DC for 24 V sources, 33 V DC for 48 V sources, 84 V DC for 110 to 125 V sources, and 166 V DC for 250 V sources.
Contact outputs can be ordered as form-A or form-C. The form-A contacts can be connected for external circuit supervision. These contacts are provided with voltage and current monitoring circuits used to detect the loss of DC voltage in the
circuit, and the presence of DC current flowing through the contacts when the form-A contact closes. If enabled, the current
monitoring can be used as a seal-in signal to ensure that the form-A contact does not attempt to break the energized inductive coil circuit and weld the output contacts.
There is no provision in the relay to detect a DC ground fault on 48 V DC control power external output. We recommend using an external DC supply.
NOTE
3-16
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
3 mA
time
25 to 50 ms
842749A1.CDR
GE Multilin
3-17
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3.2.6 TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS
Transducer input modules can receive input signals from external dcmA output transducers (dcmA In) or resistance temperature detectors (RTD). Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from these external transducers and convert these signals into a digital format for use as required.
Transducer output modules provide DC current outputs in several standard dcmA ranges. Software is provided to configure
virtually any analog quantity used in the relay to drive the analog outputs.
Every transducer input/output module has a total of 24 terminal connections. These connections are arranged as three terminals per row with a total of eight rows. A given row can be used for either inputs or outputs, with terminals in column "a"
having positive polarity and terminals in column "c" having negative polarity. Since an entire row is used for a single input/
output channel, the name of the channel is assigned using the module slot position and row number.
Each module also requires that a connection from an external ground bus be made to terminal 8b. The current outputs
require a twisted-pair shielded cable, where the shield is grounded at one end only. The figure below illustrates the transducer module types (5A, 5C, 5D, 5E, and 5F) and channel arrangements that can be ordered for the relay.
Wherever a tilde ~ symbol appears, substitute with the slot position of the module.
NOTE
3-18
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
GE Multilin
3-19
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3-20
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.2 WIRING
Lightning strikes and ground surge currents can cause large momentary voltage differences between remote ends of the
communication link. For this reason, surge protection devices are internally provided at both communication ports. An isolated power supply with an optocoupled data interface also acts to reduce noise coupling. To ensure maximum reliability, all
equipment should have similar transient protection devices installed.
Terminate both ends of the RS485 circuit with an impedance as shown below.
The fiber optic communication ports allow for fast and efficient communications between relays at 100 Mbps. Optical fiber
can be connected to the relay supporting a wavelength of 1310 nm in multi-mode.
The fiber optic port is designed such that the response times do not vary for any core that is 100 m or less in diameter,
62.5 m for 100 Mbps. For optical power budgeting, splices are required every 1 km for the transmitter/receiver pair. When
splicing optical fibers, the diameter and numerical aperture of each fiber must be the same.
GE Multilin
3-21
3.2 WIRING
3 HARDWARE
3.2.9 IRIG-B
IRIG-B is a standard time code format that allows stamping of events to be synchronized among connected devices within
1 millisecond. The IRIG time code formats are serial, width-modulated codes that can be either DC level shifted or amplitude modulated (AM). Third party equipment is available for generating the IRIG-B signal; this equipment can use a GPS
satellite system to obtain the time reference so that devices at different geographic locations can be synchronized.
3-22
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
3.3.1 DESCRIPTION
The C30 direct inputs and outputs feature makes use of the type 7 series of communications modules, which allow direct
messaging between devices.
The communications channels are normally connected in a ring configuration as shown in the following figure. The transmitter of one module is connected to the receiver of the next module. The transmitter of this second module is then connected to the receiver of the next module in the ring. This is continued to form a communications ring. The figure illustrates
a ring of four UR-series relays with the following connections: UR1-Tx to UR2-Rx, UR2-Tx to UR3-Rx, UR3-Tx to UR4-Rx,
and UR4-Tx to UR1-Rx. A maximum of sixteen (16) UR-series relays can be connected in a single ring
GE Multilin
3-23
3 HARDWARE
3
Figure 325: DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT SINGLE/DUAL CHANNEL COMBINATION CONNECTION
The interconnection requirements are described in further detail in this section for each specific variation of type 7 communications module. These modules are listed in the following table. All fiber modules use ST type connectors.
Not all the direct input and output communications modules are applicable to the C30 relay. See the order codes
tables in chapter 2 for the applicable options.
NOTE
SPECIFICATION
2A
2B
2E
Bi-phase, 1 channel
2F
Bi-phase, 2 channels
2G
2H
2I
Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94 MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode
2J
Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94 MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode
72
73
74
75
76
77
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
7G
7H
7I
7J
7K
7L
7M
3-24
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
SPECIFICATION
7N
7P
7Q
7R
G.703, 1 channel
7S
G.703, 2 channels
7T
RS422, 1 channel
7V
7W
RS422, 2 channels
GE Multilin
3-25
3 HARDWARE
When using a laser Interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed the
maximum optical input power to the receiver.
3-26
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
a) DESCRIPTION
The following figure shows the 64K ITU G.703 co-directional interface configuration.
The G.703 module is fixed at 64 kbps. The SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > DIRECT I/O > DIRECT I/O DATA
RATE setting is not applicable to this module.
NOTE
AWG 24 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external connections, with the shield grounded only at one end. Connecting the shield to pin X1a or X6a grounds the shield since these pins are internally connected to ground. Thus, if pin X1a
or X6a is used, do not ground at the other end. This interface module is protected by surge suppression devices.
NOTE
Pin nomenclature can differ from one manufacturer to another. Therefore, it is not uncommon to see pinouts numbered TxA, TxB, RxA and RxB. In such cases, it can be assumed that A is equivalent to + and B is equivalent
to .
With the power to the relay off, remove the G.703 module (7R or 7S) as follows. Record the original location of the
module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct slot.
2.
Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module in order to release the
module for removal.
3.
4.
Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5.
Set the timing selection switches (channel 1, channel 2) to the desired timing modes.
6.
GE Multilin
3-27
3 HARDWARE
Re-insert the G.703 module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot position.
The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as
the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage the
clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is fully inserted.
FUNCTION
S1
S5 and S6
Internal Timing Mode: The system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the G.703 timing selection should be in
the internal timing mode for back-to-back (UR-to-UR) connections. For back-to-back connections, set for octet timing
(S1 = OFF) and timing mode to internal timing (S5 = ON and S6 = OFF).
Loop Timing Mode: The system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the G.703 timing selection
should be in loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems. For connection to a higher order system (URto-multiplexer, factory defaults), set to octet timing (S1 = ON) and set timing mode to loop timing (S5 = OFF and S6 =
OFF).
3-28
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
The switch settings for the internal and loop timing modes are shown below:
DMR
G7X
DMX
G7R
842774A1.CDR
DMR
G7X
DMX
G7R
842775A1.CDR
GE Multilin
3-29
3 HARDWARE
3.3.5 RS422 INTERFACE
a) DESCRIPTION
There are two RS422 inter-relay communications modules available: single-channel RS422 (module 7T) and dual-channel
RS422 (module 7W). The modules can be configured to run at 64 kbps or 128 kbps. AWG 20-24 twisted shielded pair cable
is recommended for external connections. These modules are protected by optically-isolated surge suppression devices.
The shield pins (6a and 7b) are internally connected to the ground pin (8a). Proper shield termination is as follows:
Match the clock terminating impedance with the impedance of the line.
Single-channel RS422 module
Rx
Tx +
RS422
Rx +
Shield
Clock
COM
Surge
~ 3b
~ 3a
~ 2a
~ 4b
~ 6a
~ 5b
~ 5a
~ 4a
~ 6b
~ 7b
~ 7a
~ 8b
~ 2b
~ 8a
7W
RS422
channel 1
Shield
Tx
Rx
Tx +
Rx +
RS422
channel 2
Shield
Clock
COM
Surge
Inter-relay communications
Tx
7T
~ 3b
~ 3a
~ 2a
~ 4b
~ 6a
~ 7a
~ 8b
~ 2b
~ 8a
Inter-relay comms.
842776A3.CDR
3-30
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
Data module 1
Signal name
7W
Tx1(+)
Tx1(-)
RS422
CHANNEL 1
Rx1(+)
Rx1(-)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS
Shld.
CLOCK
Tx2(+)
Tx2(-)
RS422
CHANNEL 2
Rx2(+)
Rx2(-)
Shld.
com
SURGE
W 2a
W 3b
W 4b
W 3a
W 6a
W 7a
W 8b
W 4a
W 5b
W 6b
W 5a
W 7b
W 2b
W 8a
Data module 2
Signal name
TT(A) - Terminal timing
TT(B) - Terminal timing
SD(A) - Send data
SD(B) - Send data
RD(A) - Received data
RD(B) - Received data
RS(A) - Request to send (RTS)
RS(B) - Request to send (RTS)
CS(A) - Clear To send
CS(B) - Clear To send
Local loopback
Remote loopback
Signal ground
ST(A) - Send timing
ST(B) - Send timing
831022A3.CDR
Tx Clock
Tx Data
GE Multilin
3-31
3 HARDWARE
To recover the Rx clock from the data-stream, an integrated DPLL (digital phase lock loop) circuit is utilized. The DPLL is
driven by an internal clock, which is 16-times over-sampled, and uses this clock along with the data-stream to generate a
data clock that can be used as the SCC (serial communication controller) receive clock.
3.3.6 RS422 AND FIBER INTERFACE
The following figure shows the combined RS422 plus fiberoptic interface configuration at 64K baud. The 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P,
and 74 modules are used in two-terminal with a redundant channel or three-terminal configurations where channel 1 is
employed via the RS422 interface (possibly with a multiplexer) and channel 2 via direct fiber.
AWG 20-24 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external RS422 connections and ground the shield only at one end.
For the direct fiber channel, address power budget issues properly.
When using a LASER Interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed
maximum optical input power to the receiver.
3-32
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
The UR-series IEEE C37.94 communication modules (modules types 2G, 2H, 2I, 2J, 76, and 77) are designed to interface
with IEEE C37.94 compliant digital multiplexers or an IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converter for use with direct input
and output applications. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link for synchronous data between a
multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard provides for speeds up to 64n kbps,
where n = 1, 2,, 12. The UR-series C37.94 communication modules are either 64 kbps (with n fixed at 1) for 128 kbps
(with n fixed at 2). The frame is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T) recommended G.704 pattern from
the standpoint of framing and data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit
rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:.
IEEE standard: C37.94 for 1 128 kbps optical fiber interface (for 2G and 2H modules) or C37.94 for 2 64 kbps optical fiber interface (for 76 and 77 modules)
Wavelength: 830 40 nm
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that supports
the IEEE C37.94 standard shown as follows.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected to the electrical interface (G.703, RS422, or X.21) of a
non-compliant digital multiplexer via an optical-to-electrical interface converter that supports the IEEE C37.94 standard,
shown as follows.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module has six switches to set the clock configuration. The following figure shows
the functions of these control switches.
GE Multilin
3-33
3 HARDWARE
For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the timing switch selection should be
internal timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the timing selection
should be in loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems.
The IEEE C37.94 communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
1.
With power to the relay off, remove the IEEE C37.94 module (type 2G, 2H, 2I, 2J, 76 or 77 module) as follows. Record
the original location of the module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct slot.
2.
Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module in order to release the
module for removal.
3.
4.
Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5.
Set the timing selection switches (channel 1, channel 2) to the desired timing modes (see description above).
6.
7.
Re-insert the IEEE C37.94 module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is fully inserted.
3-34
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
Modules shipped since January 2012 have status LEDs that indicate the status of the DIP switches, as shown in the following figure.
Flashing green loop timing mode while receiving a valid data packet
Solid red (switch to) internal timing mode while not receiving a valid data packet
Solid yellow FPGA is receiving a "yellow bit" and remains yellow for each "yellow bit"
Solid red FPGA is not receiving a valid packet or the packet received is invalid
GE Multilin
3-35
3 HARDWARE
3.3.9 C37.94SM INTERFACE
The UR-series C37.94SM communication modules (2A and 2B) are designed to interface with modified IEEE C37.94 compliant digital multiplexers or IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converters that have been converted from 820 nm multi-mode
fiber optics to 1300 nm ELED single-mode fiber optics. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link for
synchronous data between a multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard provides for speeds up to 64n kbps, where n = 1, 2,, 12. The UR-series C37.94SM communication module is 64 kbps only
with n fixed at 1. The frame is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T) recommended G.704 pattern from
the standpoint of framing and data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit
rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:
Emulated IEEE standard: emulates C37.94 for 1 64 kbps optical fiber interface (modules set to n = 1 or 64 kbps)
Fiber optic mode: single-mode, ELED compatible with HP HFBR-1315T transmitter and HP HFBR-2316T receiver
Wavelength: 1300 40 nm
The UR-series C37.94SM communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that supports C37.94SM as shown below.
It can also can be connected directly to any other UR-series relay with a C37.94SM module as shown below.
The UR-series C37.94SM communication module has six switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The functions of these control switches are shown below.
For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the timing switch selection should be
internal timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
3-36
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE
For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the timing selection
should be in loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems.
The C37.94SM communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
1.
With power to the relay off, remove the C37.94SM module (modules 2A or 2B) as follows. Record the original location
of the module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct slot.
2.
Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module in order to release the
module for removal.
3.
4.
Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5.
Set the timing selection switches (channel 1, channel 2) to the desired timing modes (see description above).
6.
7.
Re-insert the C37.94SM module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is fully inserted.
GE Multilin
3-37
3 HARDWARE
Modules shipped since January 2012 have status LEDs that indicate the status of the DIP switches, as shown in the following figure.
Flashing green loop timing mode while receiving a valid data packet
Solid red (switch to) internal timing mode while not receiving a valid data packet
Solid yellow FPGA is receiving a "yellow bit" and remains yellow for each "yellow bit"
Solid red FPGA is not receiving a valid packet or the packet received is invalid
3-38
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a graphical user interface (GUI) as one of two human interfaces to a UR device.
The alternate human interface is implemented via the devices faceplate keypad and display (see the Faceplate Interface
section in this chapter).
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a single facility to configure, monitor, maintain, and troubleshoot the operation
of relay functions, connected over local or wide area communication networks. It can be used while disconnected (offline)
or connected (online) to a UR device. In offline mode, settings files can be created for eventual downloading to the device.
In online mode, you can communicate with the device in real-time.
The EnerVista UR Setup software is provided with every C30 relay and runs on Microsoft Windows XP, 7, and Server 2008.
This chapter provides a summary of the basic EnerVista UR Setup software interface features. The EnerVista UR Setup
Help File provides details for getting started and using the EnerVista UR Setup software interface.
4.1.2 CREATING A SITE LIST
To start using the EnerVista UR Setup software, site and device definition are required. See the EnerVista UR Setup Help
File or refer to the EnerVista UR Setup Software section in Chapter 1 for details.
4.1.3 ENERVISTA UR SETUP OVERVIEW
a) ENGAGING A DEVICE
The EnerVista UR Setup software can be used in online mode (relay connected) to directly communicate with the C30
relay. Communicating relays are organized and grouped by communication interfaces and into sites. Sites can contain any
number of relays selected from the UR-series of relays.
b) USING SETTINGS FILES
The EnerVista UR Setup software interface supports three ways of handling changes to relay settings:
In offline mode (relay disconnected) to create or edit relay settings files for later download to communicating relays
While connected to a communicating relay to directly modify any relay settings via relay data view windows, and then
save the settings to the relay
You can create/edit settings files and then write them to the relay while the interface is connected to the relay
Settings files are organized on the basis of file names assigned by the user. A settings file contains data pertaining to the
following types of relay settings:
Device definition
Product setup
FlexLogic
Control elements
Inputs/outputs
Testing
Factory default values are supplied and can be restored after any changes.
The following communications settings are not transferred to the C30 with settings files:
Modbus Slave Address
Modbus IP Port Number
RS485 COM2 Baud Rate
RS485 COM2 Parity
COM2 Minimum Response Time
COM2 Selection
RRTD Slave Address
RRTD Baud Rate
GE Multilin
4-1
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
IP Address
IP Subnet Mask
IEC61850 Config GOOSE ConfRev
IP Routing
When a settings file is loaded to a C30 that is in-service, the following sequence occurs:
1.
2.
3.
Event recorder
The event recorder captures contextual data associated with the last 1024 events, listed in chronological order from
most recent to oldest.
Oscillography
The oscillography waveform traces and digital states are used to provide a visual display of power system and relay
operation data captured during specific triggered events.
f) FILE SUPPORT
Execution: Any EnerVista UR Setup file that is opened launches the application or provides focus to the already
opened application. If the file was a settings file (has a URS extension) that had been removed from the Settings List
tree menu, it is added back to the Settings List tree menu.
Drag and Drop: The Site List and Settings List control bar windows are each mutually a drag source and a drop target
for device-order-code-compatible files or individual menu items. Also, the Settings List control bar window and any
Windows Explorer directory folder are each mutually a file drag source and drop target.
New files that are dropped into the Settings List window are added to the tree, which is automatically sorted alphabetically with respect to settings file names. Files or individual menu items that are dropped in the selected device menu in
the Site List window are automatically sent to the online communicating device.
g) FIRMWARE UPGRADES
The firmware of a C30 device can be upgraded, locally or remotely, via the EnerVista UR Setup software. The corresponding instructions are provided by the EnerVista UR Setup Help file under the topic Upgrading Firmware.
NOTE
Modbus addresses assigned to firmware modules, features, settings, and corresponding data items (that is, default
values, minimum/maximum values, data type, and item size) can change slightly from version to version of firmware. The addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are enhanced or modified.
The EEPROM DATA ERROR message displayed after upgrading/downgrading the firmware is a resettable, self-test
message intended to inform users that the Modbus addresses have changed with the upgraded firmware. This
message does not signal any problems when appearing after firmware upgrades.
4.1.4 ENERVISTA UR SETUP MAIN WINDOW
The EnerVista UR Setup software main window supports the following primary display components:
4-2
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
1.
Title bar that shows the pathname of the active data view
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Status bar
4
3
10
4
842786A2.CDR
GE Multilin
4-3
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.2.1 SETTINGS TEMPLATES
Setting file templates simplify the configuration and commissioning of multiple relays that protect similar assets. An example of this is a substation that has ten similar feeders protected by ten UR-series F60 relays.
In these situations, typically 90% or greater of the settings are identical between all devices. The templates feature allows
engineers to configure and test these common settings, then lock them so that they are not available to users. For example, these locked down settings can be hidden from view for field engineers, allowing them to quickly identify and concentrate on the specific settings.
The remaining settings (typically 10% or less) can be specified as editable and be made available to field engineers installing the devices. These are settings such as protection element pickup values and CT and VT ratios.
The settings template mode allows the user to define which settings are visible in EnerVista UR Setup. Settings templates
can be applied to both settings files (settings file templates) and online devices (online settings templates). The functionality
is identical for both purposes.
Settings files conversion from previous firmware versions is supported.
a) ENABLING THE SETTINGS TEMPLATE
The settings file template feature is disabled by default. The following procedure describes how to enable the settings template for UR-series settings files.
1.
Select a settings file from the offline window of the EnerVista UR Setup main screen.
2.
Right-click the selected device or settings file and select the Template Mode > Create Template option.
The settings file template is now enabled and the file tree displayed in light blue. The settings file is now in template editing
mode.
Alternatively, the settings template can also be applied to online settings. The following procedure describes this process.
1.
Select an installed device from the online window of the EnerVista UR Setup main screen.
2.
Right-click the selected device and select the Template Mode > Create Template option.
The software prompts for a template password. This password is required to use the template feature and must be at
least four characters in length.
3.
The online settings template is now enabled. The device is now in template editing mode.
b) EDITING THE SETTINGS TEMPLATE
The settings template editing feature allows the user to specify which settings are available for viewing and modification in
EnerVista UR Setup. By default, all settings except the FlexLogic equation editor settings are locked.
1.
Select an installed device or a settings file from the tree menu on the left of the EnerVista UR Setup main screen.
2.
Select the Template Mode > Edit Template option to place the device in template editing mode.
3.
4.
Open the relevant settings windows that contain settings to be specified as viewable.
4-4
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
By default, all settings are specified as locked and displayed against a grey background. The icon on the upper right of
the settings window also indicates that EnerVista UR Setup is in EDIT mode. The following example shows the phase
time overcurrent settings window in edit mode.
7.
Select a settings file from the offline window on the left of the EnerVista UR Setup main screen.
2.
GE Multilin
4-5
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
The software prompts for a template password. This password must be at least four characters in length.
3.
Once all necessary settings are specified for viewing, users are able to view the settings template on the online device or
settings file. There are two ways to specify the settings view with the settings template feature:
Display all settings, with settings not available for editing greyed-out
Use the following procedure to only display settings available for editing:
1.
Select an installed device or a settings file from the tree menu on the left of the EnerVista UR Setup main screen.
2.
Apply the template by selecting the Template Mode > View In Template Mode option.
3.
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to view and edit the settings specified by the template. The effect of
applying the template to the phase time overcurrent settings is shown below.
Figure 44: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW IN TEMPLATE MODE COMMAND
4-6
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Viewing the settings in template mode also modifies the settings tree, showing only the settings categories that contain
editable settings. The effect of applying the template to a typical settings tree view is shown below.
Figure 45: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW IN TEMPLATE MODE SETTINGS COMMAND
Use the following procedure to display settings available for editing and settings locked by the template.
1.
Select an installed device or a settings file from the tree menu on the left of the EnerVista UR Setup main screen.
2.
Apply the template by selecting the Template Mode > View All Settings option.
3.
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to edit the settings specified by the template, but all settings are
shown. The effect of applying the template to the phase time overcurrent settings is shown below.
Figure 46: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW ALL SETTINGS COMMAND
e) REMOVING THE SETTINGS TEMPLATE
It can be necessary at some point to remove a settings template. Once a template is removed, it cannot be reapplied and it
is necessary to define a new settings template.
1.
Select an installed device or settings file from the tree menu on the left of the EnerVista UR Setup main screen.
2.
3.
GE Multilin
4-7
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Verify one more time that you want to remove the template by clicking Yes.
The EnerVista software removes all template information and all settings are available.
4.2.2 SECURING AND LOCKING FLEXLOGIC EQUATIONS
The UR allows users to secure parts or all of a FlexLogic equation, preventing unauthorized viewing or modification of critical FlexLogic applications. This is accomplished using the settings template feature to lock individual entries within FlexLogic equations.
Secured FlexLogic equations remain secure when files are sent to and retrieved from any UR-series device.
Right-click the settings file or online device and select the Template Mode > Create Template item to enable the settings template feature.
2.
Select the FlexLogic > FlexLogic Equation Editor settings menu item.
By default, all FlexLogic entries are specified as viewable and displayed against a yellow background. The icon on the
upper right of the window also indicates that EnerVista UR Setup is in EDIT mode.
3.
5.
Select the Template Mode > View In Template Mode option to view the template.
6.
Apply a password to the template then click OK to secure the FlexLogic equation.
4-8
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to view and edit the FlexLogic entries not locked by the template.
The effect of applying the template to the FlexLogic entries in the above procedure is shown below.
2.
Right-click on the file and select the Edit Settings File Properties item.
GE Multilin
4-9
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
3.
Enter the serial number of the C30 device to lock to the settings file in the Serial # Lock field.
The settings file and corresponding secure FlexLogic equations are now locked to the C30 device specified by the serial
number.
4.2.3 SETTINGS FILE TRACEABILITY
A traceability feature for settings files allows the user to quickly determine if the settings in a C30 device have been
changed since the time of installation from a settings file. When a settings file is transferred to a C30 device, the date, time,
and serial number of the C30 are sent back to EnerVista UR Setup and added to the settings file on the local PC. This information can be compared with the C30 actual values at any later date to determine if security has been compromised.
The traceability information is only included in the settings file if a complete settings file is either transferred to the C30
device or obtained from the C30 device. Any partial settings transfers by way of drag and drop do not add the traceability
information to the settings file.
4-10
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
1.
The transfer date of a setting file written to a C30 is logged in the relay and can be viewed via EnerVista UR Setup or
the front panel display. Likewise, the transfer date of a setting file saved to a local PC is logged in EnerVista UR Setup.
2.
Comparing the dates stored in the relay and on the settings file at any time in the future indicates if any changes have
been made to the relay configuration since the settings file was saved.
4
842863A1.CDR
Traceability data
in settings report
842862A1.CDR
GE Multilin
4-11
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
842865A1.CDR
If the user changes any settings within the settings file in the offline window, then the traceability information is
removed from the settings file.
If the user creates a new settings file, then no traceability information is included in the settings file.
If the user converts an existing settings file to another revision, then any existing traceability information is removed
from the settings file.
If the user duplicates an existing settings file, then any traceability information is transferred to the duplicate settings
file.
4-12
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.3FACEPLATE INTERFACE
4.3.1 FACEPLATE
a) ENHANCED FACEPLATE
The front panel interface is one of two supported interfaces, the other interface being EnerVista UR Setup software. The
front panel interface consists of LED panels, an RS232 port, keypad, LCD display, control pushbuttons, and optional userprogrammable pushbuttons.
The faceplate is hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules.
Display
Keypad
4
Front panel
RS232 port
User-programmable pushbuttons 1 to 16
842810A1.CDR
LED panel 2
LED panel 3
Display
Front panel
RS232 port
Small user-programmable
(control) pushbuttons 1 to 7
User-programmable
pushbuttons 1 to 12
Keypad
827801A.DL
GE Multilin
4-13
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
The following figure shows the vertical arrangement of the faceplate panels for relays ordered with the vertical option.
842811A1.CDR
IN SERVICE: This LED indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs, outputs, and internal systems are
OK, and that the device has been programmed.
4-14
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
TROUBLE: This LED indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem.
TEST MODE: This LED indicates that the relay is in test mode.
TRIP: This LED indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as a trip switch has operated. This indicator always
latches; as such, a reset command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
ALARM: This LED indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm switch has operated. This indicator is
never latched.
PICKUP: This LED indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator is never latched.
The event cause indicators in the first column are described below.
Events cause LEDs are turned on or off by protection elements that have their respective target setting selected as either
Enabled or Latched. If a protection element target setting is Enabled, then the corresponding event cause LEDs
remain on as long as operate operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a protection element target setting
is Latched, then the corresponding event cause LEDs turn on when the operate operand associated with the element is
asserted and remain on until the RESET button on the front panel is pressed after the operand is reset.
All elements that are able to discriminate faulted phases can independently turn off or on the phase A, B or C LEDs. This
includes phase instantaneous overcurrent, phase undervoltage, etc. This means that the phase A, B, and C operate operands for individual protection elements are ORed to turn on or off the phase A, B or C LEDs.
In the C30 Controller System, only the OTHER indicator is applicable and indicates that a digital element was
involved.
NOTE
The user-programmable LEDs consist of 48 amber LED indicators in four columns. The operation of these LEDs is userdefined. Support for applying a customized label beside every LED is provided. Default labels are shipped in the label package of every C30, together with custom templates. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used to
communicate with operators. Refer to the User-programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
b) STANDARD FACEPLATE
The standard faceplate consists of three panels with LED indicators, keys, and a communications port. The RESET key is
used to reset any latched LED indicator or target message, once the condition has been cleared (these latched conditions
can also be reset via the SETTINGS INPUT/OUTPUTS RESETTING menu). The RS232 port is for connection to a computer.
The USER keys are not used in this unit.
GE Multilin
4-15
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
STATUS
EVENT CAUSE
IN SERVICE
VOLTAGE
TROUBLE
CURRENT
TEST MODE
FREQUENCY
TRIP
OTHER
ALARM
PHASE A
PICKUP
PHASE B
RESET
USER 1
USER 2
PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND
USER 3
842781A1.CDR
IN SERVICE: Indicates that control power is applied; all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are OK; the
relay has been programmed.
TRIP: Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a Trip switch has operated. This indicator always
latches; the reset command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
ALARM: Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as an Alarm switch has operated. This indicator is
never latched.
PICKUP: Indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator is never latched.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE INDICATORS:
The second and third provide 48 amber LED indicators whose operation is controlled by the user. Support for applying a
customized label beside every LED is provided.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used to
communicate with operators. Refer to the User-programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
4-16
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
842782A1.CDR
NOTE
Firmware revisions 2.9x and earlier support eight user setting groups; revisions 3.0x and higher support six setting
groups. For convenience of users using earlier firmware revisions, the relay panel shows eight setting groups.
Please note that the LEDs, despite their default labels, are fully user-programmable.
The relay is shipped with the default label for the LED panel 2. The LEDs, however, are not pre-programmed. To match the
pre-printed label, the LED settings must be entered as shown in the User-programmable LEDs section of chapter 5. The
LEDs are fully user-programmable. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels for both panels as explained
in the following section.
4.3.3 CUSTOM LABELING OF LEDS
a) ENHANCED FACEPLATE
The following procedure requires these pre-requisites:
The C30 front panel label cutout sheet (GE Multilin part number 1006-0047) has been downloaded from
http://www.gedigitalenergy.com/products/support/ur/URLEDenhanced.doc and printed
Small-bladed knife
To create custom LED labels for the enhanced front panel display:
1.
GE Multilin
4-17
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Select the Front Panel Report item at the bottom of the menu tree for the settings file. The front panel report window
displays.
4
Figure 421: FRONT PANEL REPORT WINDOW
3.
Enter the text to appear next to each LED and above each user-programmable pushbuttons in the fields provided.
4.
Feed the C30 front panel label cutout sheet into a printer and press the Print button in the front panel report window.
5.
When printing is complete, fold the sheet along the perforated lines and punch out the labels.
6.
Remove the C30 label insert tool from the package and bend the tabs as described in the following procedures. These
tabs are used for removal of the default and custom LED labels.
It is important that the tool be used EXACTLY as shown below, with the printed side containing the GE part number
facing the user.
NOTE
The label package shipped with every C30 contains the three default labels shown below, the custom label template sheet,
and the label removal tool.
If the default labels are suitable for your application, insert them in the appropriate slots and program the LEDs to match
them. If you require custom labels, follow the procedures below to remove the original labels and insert the new ones.
The following procedure describes how to setup and use the label removal tool.
1.
Bend the tabs at the left end of the tool upwards as shown below.
4-18
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
2.
Bend the tab at the center of the tool tail as shown below.
The following procedure describes how to remove the LED labels from the C30 enhanced front panel and insert the custom
labels.
1.
2.
Use the knife to lift the LED label and slide the label tool underneath. Make sure the bent tabs are pointing away from
the relay.
Slide the label tool under the LED label until the tabs snap out as shown below. This attaches the label tool to the LED
label.
GE Multilin
4-19
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
3.
4.
Slide the new LED label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the LEDs, as shown below.
The following procedure describes how to remove the user-programmable pushbutton labels from the C30 enhanced front
panel and insert the custom labels.
1.
Use the knife to lift the pushbutton label and slide the tail of the label tool underneath, as shown below. Make sure the
bent tab is pointing away from the relay.
4-20
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
2.
Slide the label tool under the user-programmable pushbutton label until the tabs snap out as shown below. This
attaches the label tool to the user-programmable pushbutton label.
3.
Remove the tool and attached user-programmable pushbutton label as shown below.
GE Multilin
4-21
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Slide the new user-programmable pushbutton label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the buttons,
as shown below.
4
b) STANDARD FACEPLATE
Custom labeling of an LED-only panel is facilitated through a Microsoft Word file available from the following URL:
http://www.gedigitalenergy.com/products/support/ur/GET-8494A.doc
This file provides templates and instructions for creating appropriate labeling for the LED panel. The following procedures
are contained in the downloadable file. The panel templates provide relative LED locations and located example text (x)
edit boxes. The following procedure demonstrates how to install/uninstall the custom panel labeling.
1.
Remove the clear Lexan Front Cover (GE Multilin part number: 1501-0014).
F60
Push in
and gently lift
up the cover.
842771A1.CDR
2.
Pop out the LED module and/or the blank module with a screwdriver as shown below. Be careful not to damage the
plastic covers.
( LED MODULE )
F60
( BLANK MODULE )
842722A1.CDR
3.
Place the left side of the customized module back to the front panel frame, then snap back the right side.
4.
4-22
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
The following items are required to customize the C30 display module:
1 each of: 8.5" x 11" white paper, exacto knife, ruler, custom display module (GE Multilin Part Number: 1516-0069),
and a custom module cover (GE Multilin Part Number: 1502-0015)
The following procedure describes how to customize the C30 display module:
1.
Open the LED panel customization template with Microsoft Word. Add text in places of the LED x text placeholders on
the template(s). Delete unused place holders as required.
2.
When complete, save the Word file to your computer for future use.
3.
4.
From the printout, cut-out the Background Template from the three windows, using the cropmarks as a guide.
5.
Put the Background Template on top of the custom display module (GE Multilin Part Number: 1513-0069) and snap the
clear custom module cover (GE Multilin Part Number: 1502-0015) over it and the templates.
4.3.4 DISPLAY
All messages are displayed on a backlit liquid crystal display (LCD) to make them visible under poor lighting conditions.
While the keypad and display are not actively being used, the display defaults to user-defined messages. Any high-priority
event-driven message automatically overrides the default message and appears on the display.
4.3.5 KEYPAD
Display messages are organized into pages under the following headings: actual values, settings, commands, and targets.
The MENU key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is divided further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys increment or decrement numerical setting values
when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit mode. Alternatively, values can be entered with the numeric keypad.
The decimal key initiates and advances to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point.
The HELP key can be pressed at any time for context-sensitive help messages.
The ENTER key stores altered setting values.
When entering an IP address on the front panel, key in the first sequence of the number, then press the key for the decimal place. For example, for 127.0.0.1, press 127, then , then 0, then , then 0, then , then 1. To save the address, press
the ENTER key.
4.3.6 BREAKER CONTROL
a) INTRODUCTION
The C30 can interface with associated circuit breakers. In many cases the application monitors the state of the breaker, that
can be presented on faceplate LEDs, along with a breaker trouble indication. Breaker operations can be manually initiated
from faceplate keypad or automatically initiated from a FlexLogic operand. A setting is provided to assign names to each
breaker; this user-assigned name is used for the display of related flash messages. These features are provided for two
breakers; the user can use only those portions of the design relevant to a single breaker, which must be breaker 1.
For the following discussion it is assumed the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP BREAKERS BREAKER 1(2) BREAKER
setting is "Enabled" for each breaker.
FUNCTION
GE Multilin
4-23
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
For the following discussion it is assumed the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP BREAKERS BREAKER 1(2) BREAKER
1(2) PUSH BUTTON CONTROL setting is Enabled for each breaker.
c) FACEPLATE (USER KEY) CONTROL
After the 30 minute interval during which command functions are permitted after a correct command password, the user
cannot open or close a breaker via the keypad. The following discussions begin from the not-permitted state.
d) CONTROL OF TWO BREAKERS
For the following example setup, the (Name) field represents the user-programmed variable name.
For this application (setup shown below), the relay is connected and programmed for both breaker 1 and breaker 2. The
USER 1 key performs the selection of which breaker is to be operated by the USER 2 and USER 3 keys. The USER 2 key
is used to manually close the breaker and the USER 3 key is used to manually open the breaker.
ENTER COMMAND
PASSWORD
This message appears when the USER 1, USER 2, or USER 3 key is pressed and a
is required; i.e. if COMMAND PASSWORD is enabled and no commands have been issued within the last 30 minutes.
COMMAND PASSWORD
Press USER 1
To Select Breaker
This message appears if the correct password is entered or if none is required. This message displays for 30 seconds or until the USER 1 key is pressed again.
BKR1-(Name) SELECTED
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP
This message is displayed after the USER 1 key is pressed for the second time. Three
possible actions can be performed from this state within 30 seconds as per items (1), (2)
and (3) below:
(1)
USER 2 OFF/ON
To Close BKR1-(Name)
If the USER 2 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 2 key is
pressed again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an
output relay to close breaker 1.
(2)
USER 3 OFF/ON
To Open BKR1-(Name)
If the USER 3 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 3 key is
pressed again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an
output relay to open breaker 1.
(3)
BKR2-(Name) SELECTED
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP
If the USER 1 key is pressed at this step, this message appears showing that a different
breaker is selected. Three possible actions can be performed from this state as per (1),
(2) and (3). Repeatedly pressing the USER 1 key alternates between available breakers.
Pressing keys other than USER 1, 2, or 3 at any time aborts the breaker control function.
Actual values
Settings
Commands
Targets
4-24
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
b) HIERARCHY
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters (), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters (). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
UP and DOWN keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing
the MESSAGE RIGHT key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, continually pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
HIGHEST LEVEL
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC
Press the MENU key until the header for the first Actual Values page appears. This
page contains system and relay status information. Repeatedly press the MESSAGE
keys to display the other actual value headers.
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
Press the MENU key until the header for the first page of Settings appears. This page
contains settings to configure the relay.
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC
Press the MESSAGE DOWN key to move to the next Settings page. This page contains settings for FlexLogic . Repeatedly press the MESSAGE UP and DOWN keys to
display the other setting headers and then back to the first Settings page header.
From the Settings page one header (Product Setup), press the MESSAGE RIGHT
key once to display the first sub-header (Password Security).
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key once more and this will display the first setting for
Password Security. Pressing the MESSAGE DOWN key repeatedly will display the
remaining setting messages for this sub-header.
Press the MESSAGE LEFT key once to move back to the first sub-header message.
PASSWORD
SECURITY
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
Pressing the MESSAGE DOWN key displays the second setting sub-header associated with the Product Setup header.
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME: 1.0 s
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key once more to display the first setting for Display
Properties.
DEFAULT MESSAGE
INTENSITY: 25%
GE Multilin
To view the remaining settings associated with the Display Properties subheader,
repeatedly press the MESSAGE DOWN key. The last message appears as shown.
4-25
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4.3.8 CHANGING SETTINGS
For example, select the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH
setting.
MESSAGE TIME
MINIMUM:
MAXIMUM:
0.5
10.0
Press the HELP key to view the minimum and maximum values. Press the HELP key
again to view the next context sensitive help message.
Two methods of editing and storing a numerical setting value are available.
0 to 9 and decimal point: The relay numeric keypad works the same as that of any electronic calculator. A number is
entered one digit at a time. The leftmost digit is entered first and the rightmost digit is entered last. Pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key or pressing the ESCAPE key, returns the original value to the display.
VALUE keys: The VALUE UP key increments the displayed value by the step value, up to the maximum value allowed.
While at the maximum value, pressing the VALUE UP key again allows the setting selection to continue upward from
the minimum value. The VALUE DOWN key decrements the displayed value by the step value, down to the minimum
value. While at the minimum value, pressing the VALUE DOWN key again allows the setting selection to continue
downward from the maximum value.
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME: 2.5 s
NEW SETTING
HAS BEEN STORED
As an example, set the flash message time setting to 2.5 seconds. Press the appropriate
numeric keys in the sequence 2 . 5". The display message changes as the digits are
being entered.
Until ENTER is pressed, editing changes are not registered by the relay. Therefore, press
ENTER to store the new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as
confirmation of the storing process. Numerical values which contain decimal places are
rounded-off if more decimal place digits are entered than specified by the step value.
For example, the selections available for ACCESS LEVEL are "Restricted", "Command",
"Setting", and "Factory Service".
Enumeration type values are changed using the VALUE keys. The VALUE UP key displays the next selection while the
VALUE DOWN key displays the previous selection.
ACCESS LEVEL:
Setting
If the ACCESS LEVEL needs to be "Setting", press the VALUE keys until the proper selection is displayed. Press HELP at any time for the context sensitive help messages.
NEW SETTING
HAS BEEN STORED
Changes are not registered by the relay until the ENTER key is pressed. Pressing
ENTER stores the new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as
confirmation of the storing process.
4-26
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
There are several places where text messages can be programmed to allow the relay to be customized for specific applications. One example is the Message Scratchpad. Use the following procedure to enter alphanumeric text messages.
For example: to enter the text, Breaker #1.
1.
2.
Press the VALUE keys until the character 'B' appears; press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
3.
4.
5.
If you have any problem, press HELP to view context sensitive help. Flash messages appear sequentially for several
seconds each. For the case of a text setting message, pressing HELP displays how to edit and store new values.
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
To change the RELAY SETTINGS: "Not Programmed" mode to "Programmed", proceed as follows:
1.
Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message appears on the
display.
2.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the PASSWORD SECURITY message appears on the display.
3.
Press the MESSAGE DOWN key until the INSTALLATION message appears on the display.
4.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message is displayed.
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
PASSWORD
SECURITY
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
INSTALLATION
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
5.
After the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message appears on the display, press the VALUE keys change the
selection to "Programmed".
6.
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
7.
RELAY SETTINGS:
Programmed
NEW SETTING
HAS BEEN STORED
When the "NEW SETTING HAS BEEN STORED" message appears, the relay is in "Programmed" state and the In
Service LED turns on.
GE Multilin
4-27
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message appears on the
display.
2.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the ACCESS LEVEL message appears on the display.
3.
Press the MESSAGE DOWN key until the CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS message appears on the display.
4.
Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the CHANGE SETTING PASSWORD or CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD message
appears on the display.
PASSWORD
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
CHANGE COMMAND
PASSWORD: No
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
ENCRYPTED COMMAND
PASSWORD: --------ENCRYPTED SETTING
PASSWORD: ---------
5.
After the CHANGE...PASSWORD message appears on the display, press the VALUE UP or DOWN key to change the
selection to Yes.
6.
Press the ENTER key and the display prompts you to ENTER NEW PASSWORD.
7.
Type in a numerical password (up to 10 characters) and press the ENTER key.
8.
When the VERIFY NEW PASSWORD is displayed, re-type in the same password and press ENTER.
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: Yes
ENTER NEW
PASSWORD: ##########
VERIFY NEW
PASSWORD: ##########
NEW PASSWORD
HAS BEEN STORED
9.
When the NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED message appears, your new Setting (or Command) Password will be
active.
4-28
GE Multilin
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
In the event that an incorrect Command or Setting password has been entered via the any external communications interface three times within a three-minute time span, the REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand is set to On and the
C30 does not allow Settings or Command access via the any external communications interface for the next ten minutes.
The REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operand is set to Off after the expiration of the ten-minute timeout.
GE Multilin
4-29
4 HUMAN INTERFACES
4-30
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.1 OVERVIEW
5 SETTINGS 5.1OVERVIEW
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC
GE Multilin
SECURITY
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
CLEAR RELAY
RECORDS
COMMUNICATIONS
REAL TIME
CLOCK
OSCILLOGRAPHY
DATA LOGGER
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
SELF TESTS
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
PUSHBUTTONS
FLEX STATE
PARAMETERS
USER-DEFINABLE
DISPLAYS
DIRECT I/O
TELEPROTECTION
INSTALLATION
BREAKERS
SWITCHES
FLEXLOGIC
EQUATION EDITOR
5-1
5.1 OVERVIEW
SETTINGS
CONTROL ELEMENTS
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC
TIMERS
FLEXELEMENTS
NON-VOLATILE
LATCHES
SELECTOR SWITCH
DIGITAL ELEMENTS
DIGITAL COUNTERS
8-BIT SWITCHES
PID REGULATOR
SETTINGS
INPUTS / OUTPUTS
5-2
CONTACT INPUTS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
CONTACT OUTPUTS
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE INPUTS
REMOTE OUTPUTS
DNA BIT PAIRS
REMOTE OUTPUTS
UserSt BIT PAIRS
RESETTING
DIRECT INPUTS
DIRECT OUTPUTS
TELEPROTECTION
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTINGS
TRANSDUCER I/O
SETTINGS
TESTING
GE Multilin
5.1 OVERVIEW
IEC 61850
GOOSE ANALOGS
IEC 61850
GOOSE UINTEGERS
DCMA INPUTS
RTD INPUTS
DCMA OUTPUTS
TEST MODE
FUNCTION: Disabled
FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS
FORCE CONTACT
OUTPUTS
5-3
5.1 OVERVIEW
5 SETTINGS
5.1.2 INTRODUCTION TO ELEMENTS
The main characteristics of an element are shown on the element logic diagram. This includes the inputs, settings, fixed
logic, and the output operands generated (abbreviations used on scheme logic diagrams are defined in Appendix F).
FUNCTION setting: This setting programs the element to be operational when selected as Enabled. The factory
default is Disabled. Once programmed to Enabled, any element associated with the function becomes active and all
options become available.
PICKUP DELAY setting: This setting sets a time-delay-on-pickup, or on-delay, for the duration between the pickup
and operate output states.
RESET DELAY setting: This setting is used to set a time-delay-on-dropout, or off-delay, for the duration between the
Operate output state and the return to logic 0 after the input transits outside the defined pickup range.
BLOCK setting: The default output operand state of all comparators is a logic 0 or flag not set. The comparator
remains in this default state until a logic 1 is asserted at the RUN input, allowing the test to be performed. If the RUN
input changes to logic 0 at any time, the comparator returns to the default state. The RUN input is used to supervise
the comparator. The BLOCK input is used as one of the inputs to RUN control.
TARGET setting: This setting is used to define the operation of an element target message. When set to Disabled,
no target message or illumination of a faceplate LED indicator is issued upon operation of the element. When set to
Self-Reset, the target message and LED indication follow the operate state of the element, and self-resets once the
operate element condition clears. When set to Latched, the target message and LED indication will remain visible
after the element output returns to logic 0 until a RESET command is received by the relay.
EVENTS setting: This setting is used to control whether the pickup, dropout or operate states are recorded by the
event recorder. When set to Disabled, element pickup, dropout or operate are not recorded as events. When set to
Enabled, events are created for:
(Element) PKP (pickup)
(Element) DPO (dropout)
(Element) OP (operate)
The DPO event is created when the measure and decide comparator output transits from the pickup state (logic 1) to
the dropout state (logic 0). This could happen when the element is in the operate state if the reset delay time is not 0.
5-4
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.2PRODUCT SETUP
5.2.1 SECURITY
a) SECURITY OVERVIEW
The following security features are available:
Password security Basic security present in the default offering of the product
EnerVista security Role-based access to various EnerVista software screens and configuration elements. The feature is available in the default offering of the product and only in the EnerVista software.
CyberSentry security Advanced security options available as a software option. When purchased, the options are
automatically enabled, and the default Password security and EnerVista security are disabled.
b) LOST PASSWORD
If all passwords are lost, recovery is possible by resetting the unit to default values.
To reset the unit after a lost password:
1.
Email GE customer service at [email protected] with the serial number and using a recognizable corporate email
account. Customer service provides a code to reset the relay to the factory defaults.
2.
Enter the reset code on the front panel, under Commands > Commands Relay Maintenance > Service Command.
3.
Change the default password of ChangeMe1# as outlined in the Setting Up CyberSentry and Changing Default Password section in the first chapter.
c) PASSWORD REQUIREMENTS
A user account requires an alpha-numeric password that meets the following requirements:
Password is case-sensitive
Password cannot contain the user account name or parts of the user account that exceed two consecutive characters
Password must contain characters from three of the following four categories:
- English uppercase characters (A through Z)
- English lowercase characters (a through z)
- Base 10 digits (0 through 9)
- Non-alphabetic characters (for example, ~, !, @, #, $,%, &)
d) PASSWORD SECURITY
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY
SECURITY
ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
MESSAGE
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
MESSAGE
ACCESS
SUPERVISION
MESSAGE
DUAL PERMISSION
SECURITY ACCESS
MESSAGE
PASSWORD ACCESS
EVENTS: Disabled
GE Multilin
5-5
5 SETTINGS
Local access is defined as any access to settings or commands via the faceplate interface. This includes both keypad entry
and the through the faceplate RS232 port. Remote access is defined as any access to settings or commands via any rear
communications port. This includes both Ethernet and RS485 connections. Any changes to the local or remote passwords
enables this functionality.
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the C30, the remote password must be used. If the connection
is to the RS232 port of the faceplate, the local password must be used.
The PASSWORD ACCESS EVENTS settings allows recording of password access events in the event recorder.
The local setting and command sessions are initiated by the user through the front panel display and are disabled either by
the user or by timeout (via the setting and command level access timeout settings). The remote setting and command sessions are initiated by the user through the EnerVista UR Setup software and are disabled either by the user or by timeout.
The state of the session (local or remote, setting or command) determines the state of the following FlexLogic operands.
ACCESS LOC SETG OFF: Asserted when local setting access is disabled
ACCESS LOC SETG ON: Asserted when local setting access is enabled
ACCESS LOC CMND OFF: Asserted when local command access is disabled
ACCESS LOC CMND ON: Asserted when local command access is enabled
ACCESS REM SETG OFF: Asserted when remote setting access is disabled
ACCESS REM SETG ON: Asserted when remote setting access is enabled
ACCESS REM CMND OFF: Asserted when remote command access is disabled
ACCESS REM CMND ON: Asserted when remote command access is enabled
A command or setting write operation is required to update the state of all the remote and local security operands
shown above.
NOTE
LOCAL PASSWORDS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS
CHANGE COMMAND
PASSWORD: No
MESSAGE
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
MESSAGE
ENCRYPTED COMMAND
PASSWORD: ----------
Range: 0 to 9999999999
Note: ---------- indicates no password
MESSAGE
ENCRYPTED SETTING
PASSWORD: ----------
Range: 0 to 9999999999
Note: ---------- indicates no password
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
Proper password codes are required to enable each access level. When a CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD or CHANGE SETTING PASSWORD setting is programmed to Yes via the front panel interface, the following message sequence is invoked:
1.
2.
3.
To gain write access to a Restricted setting, program the ACCESS LEVEL setting in the main security menu to Setting and
then change the setting, or attempt to change the setting and follow the prompt to enter the programmed password. If the
password is correctly entered, access is allowed. Access automatically reverts to the Restricted level according to the
access level timeout setting values.
If the setting and command passwords are identical, then this one password allows access to both commands and
settings.
NOTE
5-6
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
REMOTE PASSWORDS
The remote password settings are visible only from a remote connection via the EnerVista UR Setup software.
Proper passwords are required to enable each command or setting level access.
To set the command or setting password:
1.
In the EnerVista software, navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Security menu item to open the remote password
settings window.
2.
3.
Enter the new password in the New Password field. Requirements are outlined in the Password Requirements section
at the beginning of the chapter. When an original password has already been used, enter it in the Enter Password
field and click the Send Password to Device button.
4.
5.
Click the OK button. The password is checked to ensure that is meets requirements.
If you establish a local connection to the relay (serial), you cannot view remote passcodes.
NOTE
ACCESS SUPERVISION
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY ACCESS SUPERVISION
ACCESS
SUPERVISION
ACCESS LEVEL
TIMEOUTS
MESSAGE
INVALID ATTEMPTS
BEFORE LOCKOUT: 3
Range: 2 to 5 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PASSWORD LOCKOUT
DURATION: 5 min
INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT: This setting specifies the number of times an incorrect password can be
entered within a three-minute time span before lockout occurs. When lockout occurs, the LOCAL ACCESS DENIED or
REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic operands are set to On. These operands are returned to the Off state upon
expiration of the lockout.
PASSWORD LOCKOUT DURATION: This setting specifies the time that the C30 will lockout password access after
the number of invalid password entries specified by the INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT setting has occurred.
The C30 provides a means to raise an alarm upon failed password entry. Should password verification fail while accessing
a password-protected level of the relay (either settings or commands), the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS FlexLogic operand is
asserted. The operand can be programmed to raise an alarm via contact outputs or communications. This feature can be
used to protect against both unauthorized and accidental access attempts.
GE Multilin
5-7
5 SETTINGS
The UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand is reset with the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS RESET UNAUTHORIZED
ALARMS command. Therefore, to apply this feature with security, the command level should be password-protected. The
operand does not generate events or targets.
If events or targets are required, the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand can be assigned to a digital element programmed
with event logs or targets enabled.
The access level timeout settings are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY ACCESS SUPERVISION ACCESS LEVEL TIMEOUTS
ACCESS LEVEL
TIMEOUTS
MESSAGE
These settings allow the user to specify the length of inactivity required before returning to the restricted access level. Note
that the access level will set as restricted if control power is cycled.
COMMAND LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT: This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access)
required to return to restricted access from the command password level.
SETTING LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT: This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access)
required to return to restricted access from the command password level.
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
ACCESS AUTH
TIMEOUT: 30 min.
DUAL PERMISSION
SECURITY ACCESS
The dual permission security access feature provides a mechanism for customers to prevent unauthorized or unintended
upload of settings to a relay through the local or remote interfaces interface.
The following settings are available through the local (front panel) interface only.
LOCAL SETTING AUTH: This setting is used for local (front panel or RS232 interface) setting access supervision.
Valid values for the FlexLogic operands are either On (default) or any physical Contact Input ~~ On value.
If this setting is On, then local setting access functions as normal; that is, a local setting password is required. If this
setting is any contact input on FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to providing the
local setting password to gain setting access.
If setting access is not authorized for local operation (front panel or RS232 interface) and the user attempts to obtain
setting access, then the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS message is displayed on the front panel.
REMOTE SETTING AUTH: This setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interfaces) setting access supervision.
If this setting is On (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required). If this setting is Off, then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is
provided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to providing the remote setting password to gain setting access.
5-8
ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT: This setting represents the timeout delay for local setting access. This setting is applicable
when the LOCAL SETTING AUTH setting is programmed to any operand except On. The state of the FlexLogic operand
is continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, local access is permitted and the timer programmed with the ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT setting value is started. When this timer expires, local setting access is
immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic operand is detected, the timeout
is restarted. The status of this timer is updated every 5 seconds.
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The following settings are available through the remote (EnerVista UR Setup) interface only. Select the Settings > Product
Setup > Security menu item to display the security settings window.
The Remote Settings Authorized setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interfaces) setting access supervision. If
this setting is On (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required). If this setting is Off, then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is provided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to providing the
remote setting password to gain setting access.
The Access Authorized Timeout setting represents the timeout delay remote setting access. This setting is applicable
when the Remote Settings Authorized setting is programmed to any operand except On or Off. The state of the FlexLogic operand is continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, remote setting access is permitted
and the timer programmed with the Access Authorized Timeout setting value is started. When this timer expires, remote
setting access is immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic operand is detected,
the timeout is restarted. The status of this timer is updated every 5 seconds.
e) ENERVISTA SECURITY
ENABLING THE SECURITY MANAGEMENT SYSTEM
The EnerVista security system allows an administrator to manage access privileges of multiple users to the EnerVista application.
It is disabled by default to allow the administrator direct access to the EnerVista software immediately after installation.
When security is disabled, all users have administrator access. GE recommends enabling the EnerVista security before
placing the device in service.
To enable the security system and require password use:
GE Multilin
5-9
5 SETTINGS
1.
Select the Security > User Management menu item to open the user management window.
2.
Check the Enable Security box in the lower-left corner to enable the security management system.
Security is now enabled for the EnerVista UR Setup software. Upon starting the software, users are now required to enter a
username and password.
Select the Security > User Management menu item to open the user management window.
2.
Enter a username in the User field. The username must be 4 to 20 characters in length.
3.
Select the user access rights by enabling the check box of one or more of the fields.
5-10
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
4.
DESCRIPTION
Delete Entry
Deletes the user account when exiting the user management window
Actual Values
Settings
Commands
Event Recorder
FlexLogic
Update Info
Allows the user to write to any function to which they have read privileges. When any of the Settings, Event
Recorder, and FlexLogic check boxes are enabled by themselves, the user is granted read access. When
any of them are enabled in conjunction with the Update Info box, they are granted read and write access.
The user is not granted write access to functions that are not checked, even if the Update Info field is
checked.
Admin
The user is an EnerVista UR Setup administrator, therefore receiving all of the administrative rights.
Exercise caution when granting administrator rights.
Select the Security > User Management menu item to open the user management window.
2.
3.
Modify the user access rights by enabling or disabling one or more of the check boxes.
DESCRIPTION
Delete Entry
Deletes the user account when exiting the user management window
Actual Values
Settings
Commands
GE Multilin
5-11
5 SETTINGS
4.
DESCRIPTION
Event Recorder
FlexLogic
Update Info
Allows the user to write to any function to which they have read privileges. When any of the Settings, Event
Recorder, and FlexLogic check boxes are enabled by themselves, the user is granted read access. When
any of them are enabled in conjunction with the Update Info box, they are granted read and write access.
The user is not granted write access to functions that are not checked, even if the Update Info field is
checked.
Admin
The user is an EnerVista UR Setup administrator, therefore receiving all of the administrative rights.
Exercise caution when granting administrator rights.
f) CYBERSENTRY SECURITY
The EnerVista software provides the means to configure and authenticate UR using either server or device or authentication. Access to various functionality depends on user role.
The login screen of EnerVista has two options for access to the UR, server and device authentication.
Figure 51: LOGIN SCREEN FOR CYBERSENTRY
When the "Server" Authentication Type option is selected, the UR uses the RADIUS server and not its local authentication
database to authenticate the user.
When the "Device" button is selected, the UR uses its local authentication database and not the RADIUS server to authenticate the user. In this case, it uses built-in roles (Administrator, Engineer, Supervisor, Operator, Observer) as login
accounts and the associated passwords are stored on the UR device. In this case, access is not user-attributable. In cases
where user-attributable access is required, especially for auditable processes for compliance reasons, use server authentication (RADIUS) only.
No password or security information is displayed in plain text by the EnerVista software or UR device, nor are they ever
transmitted without cryptographic protection.
5-12
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
GE Multilin
5-13
5 SETTINGS
For the Device > Settings > Product Setup > Supervisory option, the panel looks like the following.
5
Figure 53: SUPERVISORY PANEL
For the Security panel, the following settings are available.
RADIUS Server Settings
SETTING NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
MAX
DEFAULT
UNITS MINIMUM
PERMISSION
Primary RADIUS IP
Address
0.0.0.0
223.255.255.254
0.0.0.0
Administrator
Primary
Authentication Port
65535
1812
Administrator
Primary Accounting
Port
65535
1813
Administrator
Vendor ID
RADIUS
Authentication
(Shared) Secret
See the
See the following N/A
Password
password section
Requirement for requirements
s section
Administrator
RADIUS
Authentication
Method
EAP-TTLS
EAP-TTLS
EAP-TTLS
Administrator
Timeout
9999
10
sec
Administrator
Retries
9999
Administrator
5-14
Value that
represents
General
Electric
Administrator
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Confirm RADIUS
Authentication
(Shared) Secret
See the
245 characters
Password
Requirement
s section
N/A
Administrator
DESCRIPTION
MIN
MAX
Session Lockout
0 (lockout
disabled)
99
Administrator
Session Lockout
Period
min
Administrator
Syslog Server IP
Address
0.0.0.0
223.255.
255.254
0.0.0.0
Administrator
65535
514
Administrator
Device
Authentication
Enabled
Enabled
Administrator
Firmware Locked
Yes
Yes
Administrator
Factory Service
Mode
Enabled
Disabled
Supervisor
(Administrator
when Supervisor
is disabled)
Yes
No
Administrator
Enabled
Enabled
Administrator to
enable and
Supervisor to
disable
Disabled
No
Supervisor role
RADIUS user
names
Administrator
Password
See the
Password
Requirement
s section
Text
GE Multilin
See the
Change
following
Me1#
password
section for
requireme
nts
5-15
5 SETTINGS
DESCRIPTION / DETAILS
Failed
Authentications
MIN
MAX
DEFAULT UNITS
MINIMUM
PERMISSIONS
Administrator
Firmware lock
Yes
Yes
Administrator
Settings lock
No
A Boolean value indicating if the device can
accept any settings changes. If Yes and a
settings change attempt is made, the device
alarm activates. If No, the device alarm does not
activate.
Yes
Yes
Supervisor
(Administrator if
Supervisor has
been disabled)
SECURITY
LOGIN:
None
MESSAGE
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
MESSAGE
SESSION
SETTINGS
MESSAGE
RESTORE DEFAULTS
MESSAGE
SUPERVISORY
MESSAGE
SYSLOG IP ADDRESS:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
Range: 1 to 65535
LOGIN: This setting is applicable for Device Authentication only. This setting allows a user to login with a specific role, see
descriptions below. For the Supervisor role, the Supervisor Role setting should be enabled.
Whenever a new role is logged in, the user is prompted with a display to enter a password. Passwords must obey the
requirements specified at the beginning of the chapter in the Password Requirements section.The UR device supports five
roles. All roles have their corresponding passwords. The Observer role is the only role that does not require a password.
The roles are defined as follows:
Administrator: Complete read and write access to all settings and commands. This role does not allow concurrent
access. This role has an operand to indicate when it is logged on.
Engineer: Complete read and write access to all settings and commands with the exception of configuring Security settings and Firmware upgrades. This role does not allow concurrent access.
Operator: The Operator has read/write access to all settings under the command menu/section. This role does not
exist offline.
Supervisor: This is only an approving role. This roles authentication commits setting changes submitted by Administrator or Engineer. The Supervisor role authenticates to unlock the UR relay for setting changes and not approve changes
after the fact. Only Supervisor can set the Settings and Firmware Lock in the Security Settings. This role also has the
ability to forcefully logoff any other role and clear the security event log. This role can also be disabled, but only
through a Supervisor authentication. When this role is disabled its permissions are assigned to the Administrator role.
5-16
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Observer: This role has read only access to all UR settings. This role allows unlimited concurrent access but it has no
download access to any files on the device. Observer is the default role if no authentication has been done to the
device. This role displays as "None" on the front panel.
The Factory service role is not available and is intended for factory use only.
NOTE
Local Passwords
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS
CHANGE LOCAL
PASSWORDS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
LOGIN:
None
NEW PASSWORD:
CONFIRM PASSWORD:
The Change Local Passwords menu is shown on the front panel and Enervista on a successful login of Administrator role.
The login setting in this menu is similar to the login setting described in PATH: SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > SECURITY except for the factory role.
Passwords are stored in text format. No encryption is applied.
Notes:
NOTE
In Device Authentication mode, the Observer role does not have a password associated with it. In Server Authentication mode the Observer role requires a password.
Once the passwords are set, the Administrator with Supervisor approval can change the role associated password.
Session Settings
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SESSION SETTINGS
SESSION
SETTINGS
MESSAGE
SESSION LOCKOUT:
3
Range: 0 to 99
SESSION LOCKOUT
PERIOD: 3 min
SESSION LOCKOUT: This setting specifies the number of failed authentications (the default is three and the maximum is 99) before the device blocks subsequent authentication attempts for the lockout period. A value of zero means
lockout is disabled.
SESSION LOCKOUT PERIOD: This setting specifies the period of time in minutes of a lockout period (the default is
three and the maximum is 9999). A value of 0 means that there is no lockout period.
Restore Defaults
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY RESTORE DEFAULTS
RESTORE DEFAULTS
LOAD FACTORY
DEFAULTS: No
Range: Yes, No
LOAD FACTORY DEFAULTS: This setting is used to reset all the settings, communication and security passwords. An
Administrator role is used to change this setting and a Supervisor role (if not disabled) approves it.
GE Multilin
5-17
5 SETTINGS
Supervisory
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SUPERVISORY
DEVICE
AUTHENTICATION:Yes
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
BYPASS ACCESS:
Disabled
MESSAGE
LOCK RELAY:
Disabled
MESSAGE
FACTORY SERVICE:
MODE: Disabled
MESSAGE
SELF TESTS
MESSAGE
SUPERVISOR ROLE:
Disabled
MESSAGE
SERIAL INACTIVITY
TIMEOUT: 1 min
SUPERVISORY
See below
The Supervisory menu settings are available for Supervisor role only or if the Supervisor role is disabled then for the
Administrator role only.
Device Authentication: This setting is enabled by default, meaning "Yes" is selected. When enabled, Device Authentication with roles is enabled. When this setting is disabled, the UR only authenticates to the AAA server (Radius). However,
the Administrator and Supervisor (when enabled) remain active even after device authentication is disabled and their only
permission is to re-enable device authentication. To re-enable device authentication, the Supervisor unlocks the device for
setting changes, then the Administrator re-enables device authentication.
Bypass Access: The bypass security feature provides an easier access, with no authentication and encryption for those
special situations when this is considered safe. Only the Supervisor, or the Administrator when the Supervisor role is disabled, can enable this feature.
MODE
ETHERNET
Normal mode
Local Bypasses authentication for push buttons, keypad, RS232, and RS485
Local and Remote Bypasses authentication for push buttons, keypad, RS232, RS485, and Ethernet
Lock Relay: This setting uses a Boolean value (Enable/Disable) to indicate if the device accepts setting changes and
whether the device can receive a firmware upgrade. This setting can be changed only by the Supervisor role, if it is enabled
or by the Administrator if the Supervisor role is disabled. The Supervisor role enables this setting for the relay to start
accepting setting changes or command changes or firmware upgrade. After all the setting changes are applied or commands executed, the Supervisor disables to lock setting changes.
Example: If this setting is "Yes" and an attempt is made to change settings or upgrade the firmware, the UR device denies
the setting changes and denies upgrading the firmware. If this setting is "No", the UR device accepts setting changes and
firmware upgrade.
This role is disabled by default.
Factory Service Mode: When enabled (meaning "Yes" is selected) the device can go into factory service mode. For this
setting to become enabled a Supervisor authentication is necessary. The default value is Disabled.
5-18
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Supervisor Role: When enabled (meaning "Yes" is selected) the Supervisor role is active. When "No" is selected this role
is disabled. To disabled this setting a Supervisor authentication is necessary. If disabled, the Supervisor role is not allowed
to log on. In this case the Administrator can change the settings under the Supervisory menu.
If enabled, Supervisor authentication is required to change the settings in the Supervisory menu. If the Supervisor disables
his role after authentication, the Supervisor session remains valid until he switches to another role using MMI or until he
ends the current Supervisor session if using communications.
This role is disabled by default.
Serial Inactivity Timeout: The role logged via a serial port is auto logged off after the Serial Inactivity timer times out. A
separate timer is maintained for RS232 and RS485 connections. The default value is 1 minute.
a) SELF TESTS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SUPERVISORY SELF TESTS
SELF TESTS
FAILED
AUTHENTICATE
See below
MESSAGE
FIRMWARE LOCK:
Enabled
MESSAGE
SETTINGS LOCK:
Enabled
Failed Authentications: If this setting is Enabled then the number of failed authentications is compared with the Session
lockout threshold. When the Session lockout threshold is exceeded, this minor alarm indication comes up.
Firmware Lock: If this setting is Enabled then any firmware upgrade operation attempt when the LOCK FIRMWARE
UPGRADE setting is set to Yes brings up this self test alarm.
Settings Lock: If this setting is Enabled then an unauthorized write attempt to a setting for a given role activates this self
test.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SUPERVISORY SELF TESTS FAILED AUTHENTICATE
FAILED
AUTHENTICATE
FAILED AUTHENTICATE:
Enabled
CYBERSENTRY SETUP
When first using CyberSentry security, use the following procedure for set up.
1.
Log in to the relay as Administrator by using the Value keys on the front panel to enter the default password
"ChangeMe1#". Note that the "Lock relay" setting needs to be disabled in the Security > Supervisory menu. When
this setting is disabled, configuration and firmware upgrade are possible. By default, this setting is disabled.
2.
3.
Make any required changes in configuration, such as setting a valid IP address for communication over Ethernet.
4.
Next, device or server authentication can be chosen on the login screen, but the choice is available only in EnerVista. Use
device authentication to log in using the five pre-configured roles (Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator,
Observer). When using a serial connection, only device authentication is supported. When server authentication is
required, characteristics for communication with a RADIUS server must be configured. This is possible only in the EnerVista software. The RADIUS server itself also must be configured. The appendix called RADIUS Server gives an example of
how to setup a simple RADIUS server. Once both the RADIUS server and the parameters for connecting UR to the server
have been configured, you can choose server authentication on the login screen of EnerVista.
The use of CyberSentry for devices communicating through an Ethernet-to-RS485 gateway is not
supported. Because these gateways do not support the secure protocols necessary to communicate
with such devices, the connection cannot be established. Use the device as a non-CyberSentry
device.
GE Multilin
5-19
5 SETTINGS
Users logged in through the front panel are not timed out and cannot be forcefully logged out by a
supervisor. Roles logged in through the front panel that do no allow multiple instances (Administrator,
Supervisor, Engineer, Operator) must switch to None (equivalent to a logout) when they are done in
order to log out.
For all user roles except Observer, only one instance can be logged in at one time, for both login by
front panel and software.
To configure server authentication:
1.
2.
Configure the following RADIUS server parameters: IP address, authentication port, shared secret, and vendor ID.
3.
On the RADIUS server, configure the user accounts. Do not use the five pre-defined roles as user names (Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, Observer) in the RADIUS server. If you do, the UR relay automatically provides the
authentication from the device.
4.
In the EnerVista software, choose server authentication and log in using the user name and password configured on
the RADIUS server for server authentication login.
5.
Pushbuttons (both user-control buttons and user-programmable buttons) located on the front panel can be pressed by an
Administrator or Engineer role. This also applies to the reset button, which resets targets, where targets are errors displayed on the front panel or the Targets panel of the EnerVista software. The reset button has special behavior in that it
allows these two roles to press it even when they are logged in through the RS232 port and not through the front panel.
To reset the security event log and self-test operands:
1.
Log in as Supervisor (if the role is enabled) or Administrator (if the Supervisor role is disabled) and execute a clear
security command under Commands > Security > Clear Security.
5.2.2 DISPLAY PROPERTIES
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
LANGUAGE:
English
MESSAGE
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME: 1.0 s
MESSAGE
DEFAULT MESSAGE
TIMEOUT: 300 s
MESSAGE
DEFAULT MESSAGE
INTENSITY: 25 %
MESSAGE
SCREEN SAVER
FEATURE: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CURRENT CUT-OFF
LEVEL: 0.020 pu
MESSAGE
VOLTAGE CUT-OFF
LEVEL: 1.0 V
Some relay messaging characteristics can be modified to suit different situations using the display properties settings.
5-20
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
LANGUAGE: This setting selects the language used to display settings, actual values, and targets. The range is
dependent on the order code of the relay.
FLASH MESSAGE TIME: Flash messages are status, warning, error, or information messages displayed for several
seconds in response to certain key presses during setting programming. These messages override any normal messages. The duration of a flash message on the display can be changed to accommodate different reading rates.
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT: If the keypad is inactive for a period of time, the relay automatically reverts to a
default message. The inactivity time is modified via this setting to ensure messages remain on the screen long enough
during programming or reading of actual values.
DEFAULT MESSAGE INTENSITY: To extend phosphor life in the vacuum fluorescent display, the brightness can be
attenuated during default message display. During keypad interrogation, the display always operates at full brightness.
SCREEN SAVER FEATURE and SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME: These settings are only visible if the C30 has a liquid
crystal display (LCD) and control its backlighting. When the SCREEN SAVER FEATURE is Enabled, the LCD backlighting
is turned off after the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT followed by the SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME, providing that no keys
have been pressed and no target messages are active. When a keypress occurs or a target becomes active, the LCD
backlighting is turned on.
CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the current cut-off threshold. Very low currents (1 to 2% of the
rated value) are very susceptible to noise. Some customers prefer very low currents to display as zero, while others
prefer the current be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The C30 applies a cutoff value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured currents. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This applies to phase and ground current phasors as well as true RMS values and symmetrical components. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by
communications protocols. Note that the cut-off level for the sensitive ground input is 10 times lower that the CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value. Raw current samples available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.
VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the voltage cut-off threshold. Very low secondary voltage measurements (at the fractional volt level) can be affected by noise. Some customers prefer these low voltages to be displayed
as zero, while others prefer the voltage to be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The C30 applies a cut-off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured voltages. If the magnitude is below
the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This operation applies to phase and auxiliary voltages, and symmetrical
components. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those
used by communications protocols. Raw samples of the voltages available via oscillography are not subject cut-off.
NOTE
Lower the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL and CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL with care as the relay accepts lower signals as valid measurements. Unless dictated otherwise by a specific application, the default settings of 0.02 pu for
CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and 1.0 V for VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are recommended.
5.2.3 CLEAR RELAY RECORDS
MESSAGE
CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY?
No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CLEAR RELAY
RECORDS
Selected records can be cleared from user-programmable conditions with FlexLogic operands. Assigning user-programmable pushbuttons to clear specific records are typical applications for these commands. Since the C30 responds to rising
edges of the configured FlexLogic operands, they must be asserted for at least 50 ms to take effect.
GE Multilin
5-21
5 SETTINGS
Clearing records with user-programmable operands is not protected by the command password. However, user-programmable pushbuttons are protected by the command password. Thus, if they are used to clear records, the user-programmable pushbuttons can provide extra security if required.
For example, to assign user-programmable pushbutton 1 to clear demand records, the following settings should be applied.
1.
Assign the clear demand function to pushbutton 1 by making the following change in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS menu:
CLEAR DEMAND: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
2.
Set the properties for user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS PRODUCT
menu:
5.2.4 COMMUNICATIONS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
COMMUNICATIONS
5-22
SERIAL PORTS
MESSAGE
NETWORK
MESSAGE
ROUTING
MESSAGE
MODBUS PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
PROTOCOL:
DNP 3.0
MESSAGE
DNP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
DNP / IEC104
POINT LISTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
WEB SERVER
HTTP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
TFTP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
IEC 60870-5-104
PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
EGD PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
IEC103
PROTOCOL
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
b) SERIAL PORTS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SERIAL PORTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SERIAL PORTS
RS485 COM2 BAUD RATE and PARITY: The C30 is equipped with up to two independent serial communication ports. The faceplate RS232 port is intended for local use and is fixed at 19200 bit/s baud and even parity. The rear COM2 port is RS485
and has settings for baud rate and parity. It is important that these parameters agree with the settings used on the computer
or other equipment that is connected to these ports. Any of these ports can be connected to a computer running EnerVista
UR Setup. This software can download and upload setting files, view measured parameters, and upgrade the relay firmware. A maximum of 32 relays can be daisy-chained and connected to a DCS, PLC, or computer using the RS485 ports. If
IEC 60870-103 is chosen as the protocol, valid baud rates are 9600 and 19200 bit/s, and valid parity is Even.
RS485 COM2 RESPONSE MIN TIME: This setting specifies the minimum time before the rear RS485 port transmits after receiving data from a host. This feature allows operation with hosts that hold the RS485 transmitter active for some time after
each transmission.
GE Multilin
5-23
5 SETTINGS
5
Multiple LANS, with Redundancy
The topology in the following figure provides local configuration/monitoring through EnerVista software and access to the
public network shared on LAN1, to which port 1 (P1) is connected. There is no redundancy provided on LAN1. Communications to SCADA is provided through LAN2 and LAN3, to which P2 and respectively P3 are connected and configured to
work in redundant mode. In this configuration, P3 uses the IP and MAC address of P2.
Figure 55: MULTIPLE LANS, WITH REDUNDANCY
5-24
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5
d) NETWORK
As outlined in the previous section, when using more than one Ethernet port, configure each to belong to a different network or subnet using the IP addresses and mask. Configure the network IP and subnet settings before configuring the routing settings.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK 1(3)
PRT1 IP ADDRESS:
127.0.0.1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PRT2 IP ADDRESS:
127.0.0.1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PRT2 REDUNDANCY:
None
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NETWORK PORT 1
NETWORK PORT 2
GE Multilin
5-25
5 SETTINGS
PRT3 IP ADDRESS:
127.0.0.1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
NETWORK PORT 3
The IP addresses are used with the DNP, Modbus/TCP, IEC 61580, IEC 60870-5-104, TFTP, HTTP, and PRP protocols.
The next section explains PRP.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
NOTE
sets the ports IPv4 address in standard IPV4 format. This setting is valid on port 3 if
This setting sets the ports IPv4 subnet mask in standard IPV4 format. This setting is valid on
is set to None.
PRT2 REDUNDANCY is available when the hardware has multiple ports (modules T, U, and V). It determines if ports 2 and 3
operate in redundant or independent mode. If a license for PRP was purchased, the options are None, Failover, and PRP.
If a license for PRP was not purchased, the available options are None and Failover. In non-redundant mode (REDUNDANCY
set to None), ports 2 and 3 operate independently with their own MAC, IP, and mask addresses. If REDUNDANCY is set to
Failover, the operation of ports 2 and 3 is as follows:
Ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask
The configuration fields for IP address and mask on port 3 are hidden
Port 3 is in standby mode and does not actively communicate on the Ethernet network but monitors its link to the Multilink switch. If port 2 detects a problem with the link, communications is switched to Port 3. Port 3 is, in effect, acting as
a redundant or backup link to the network for port 2. Once Port 2 detects that the link between port 2 and the switch is
good, communications automatically switch back to port 2 and port 3 goes back into standby mode.
Ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask
The configuration fields for IP address and mask on port 3 are overwritten with those from port 2. This is visible on the
front panel but not displayed in the EnerVista software.
The port 2 PTP function still uses only port 2 and the port 3 PTP function still uses only port 3. The relay still synchronizes to whichever port has the best master. When ports 2 and 3 see the same master, as is typically the case for PRP
networks, the port with the better connectivity is used.
The two ports must be connected to completely independent LANS with no single point of failure, such as common
power supplies that feed switches on both LANS.
NOTE
5-26
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PRP is designed to provide seamless recovery in case of a single failure in the network, by using a combination of LAN
duplication and frame duplication technique. Identical frames are sent on two completely independent networks that connect source and destination. Under normal circumstances both frames reach the destination and one of them is sent up the
OSI stack to the destination application, while the second one is discarded. If an error occurs in one of the networks and
traffic is prevented from flowing on that path, connectivity is still provided through the other network to ensure continuous
communication. Take care when designing the two LANs, so that no single point of failure (such as a common power supply) is encountered, as such scenarios can bring down both LANs simultaneously.
Figure 57: EXAMPLE OF PARALLEL REDUNDANT NETWORK
PRP uses specialized nodes called doubly attached nodes (DANPs) for handling the duplicated frames. DANPs devices
have an additional module, called Link Redundancy Entity (LRE). LRE is responsible for duplicating frames and adding the
specific PRP trailer when sending the frames out on the LAN, as well as making decisions on received frames as to which
one is sent up the OSI stack to the application layer and which one is discarded. LRE is responsible for making PRP transparent to the higher layers of the stack. There is a second type of specialized device used in PRP networks, called RedBox,
with the role of connecting Single Attached Nodes (SANs) to a redundant network.
UR relays implement only the DANP functionality. The RedBox functionality is not implemented.
The original standard IEC 62439-3 (2010) was amended to align PRP with the High-availability Seamless Redundancy
(HSR) protocol. To achieve this, the original PRP was modified at the cost of losing compatibility with the PRP 2010 version. The revised standard IEC 62439-3 (2012) is commonly referred to as PRP-1, while the original standard is PRP-0.
The UR relays support only PRP-1.
The relay implements PRP on two of its Ethernet ports, specifically Port 2 and 3 of the CPU module. Use the previous section (network port configuration) to configure PRP.
PRP is purchased as a separate option. If purchased (valid order code), PRP can be enabled in configuration through a
setting available on the network configuration menu, REDUNDANCY, which already has the capability of enabling failover
redundancy. The options on this setting must be changed to accommodate two types of redundancy: failover and PRP.
When REDUNDANCY is set to either failover or PRP, the ports dedicated for PRP (Port 2 and 3) operate in redundant
mode. In this mode, Port 3 uses the Mac, IP address, and mask of Port 2.
f) ROUTING
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS ROUTING 1(6)
IPV4 ROUTING
TABLE
MESSAGE
IPV4 STATIC
NETWORK ROUTE 1
MESSAGE
IPV4 STATIC
NETWORK ROUTE 6
A default route and a maximum number of six static routes can be configured.
The default route is used as the last choice when no other route towards a given destination is found.
GE Multilin
5-27
5 SETTINGS
GATEWAY ADDRESS
127.0.0.1
IPV4 STATIC
NETWORK ROUTE 1
RT1 DESTINATION:
127.0.0.1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
RT1 GATEWAY:
127.0.0.1
Configure the network IP and subnet settings before configuring the routing settings.
ADDING AND DELETING STATIC ROUTES
Host routes are not supported at present.
The routing table configuration is available on the serial port and front panel. This is a deliberate decision, to avoid loss of
connectivity when remotely configuring the UR.
By default the value of the destination field is 127.0.0.1 for all static routes (1 to 6). This is equivalent to saying that the
static routes are not configured. When the destination address is 127.0.0.1, the mask and gateway must be also kept on
default values.
By default, the value of the route gateway address is 127.0.0.1. This means the default route is not configured.
To add a route:
1.
Use any of the static network route entries numbered 1 to 6 to configure a static network route. Once a route destination is configured for any of the entries 1 to 6, that entry becomes a static route and it must meet all the rules listed in
the next section, General Conditions to be Satisfied by Static Routes.
2.
To configure the default route, enter a default gateway address. Once a default gateway address is configured, it must
be validated against condition 2 of the General Conditions to be Satisfied by Static Routes.
To delete a route:
1.
Replace the route destination with the default loopback address (127.0.0.1). When deleting a route, the mask and
gateway must be also brought back to default values.
2.
Delete the default route by replacing the default gateway with the default value 127.0.0.1.
The route gateway must be on a connected network. This rule applies to the gateway address of the default route as
well.
The route mask has IP mask format. In binary this is a set of contiguous bits of 1 from left to right, followed by one or
more contiguous bits of 0.
The route destination and mask must match. This means that the result of the "and" bitwise operation between the
RtDestination and RtMask must equal RtDestination.
Example of good configuration: RtDestination = 10.1.1.0; Rt Mask = 255.255.255.0
Example of bad configuration: RtDestination = 10.1.1.1; Rt Mask = 255.255.255.0
5-28
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Starting with UR 7.10, up to six static network routes can be configured in addition to a default route. The default route configuration was also moved from the network settings into the routing section.
The figure shows an example of topology that benefits from the addition of static routes.
Figure 58: USING STATIC ROUTES
In the figure, the UR connects through the following two Ethernet ports:
Port 1 (IP address 10.1.1.2) connects the UR to LAN 10.1.1.0/24 and to the Internet through Router1. Router 1 has an
interface on 10.1.1.0/24 and the IP address of this interface is 10.1.1.1.
Port 2 (IP address 10.1.2.2) connects the UR to LAN 10.1.2.0/24 and to the EnerVista software through Router 2.
Router 2 has an interface on 10.1.2.0/24 and the IP address of this interface is 10.1.2.1.
The behavior before release 7.10 was as follows. When sending packets to EnerVista, the UR noticed that the destination
was not on a connected network and it tried to find a route to destination. Since the default route was the only route it knew,
it used it. Yet EnerVista was on a private network, which was not reachable through Router 1. Hence a destination unreachable message was received from the router.
The configuration starting release 7.10 is as follows:
The behavior since release 7.10 is as follows. There is one added static network route to the destination 10.1.3.0/24, where
a laptop running EnerVista is located. This static route uses a different gateway (10.1.2.1) than the default route. This gateway is the address of Router 2, which has knowledge about 10.1.3.0 and is able to route packets coming from UR and destined to EnerVista.
SHOW ROUTES AND ARP TABLES
This feature is available on the Web interface, where the main menu contains an additional Communications menu and two
submenus:
GE Multilin
5-29
Routing Table
ARP Table
5 SETTINGS
The tables outline the information displayed when the two submenus are selected.
Table 53: ROUTING TABLE INFORMATION
FIELD
DESCRIPTION
Destination
Mask
Gateway
Interface
DESCRIPTION
IP Address
Age (min)
Age, in minutes, of the cache entry. A hyphen (-) means the address is local.
Hardware Address
Type
Dynamic or Static
Interface
g) MODBUS PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL
MODBUS PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
MODBUS SLAVE
ADDRESS: 254
The serial communication ports utilize the Modbus protocol, unless configured for DNP operation (see descriptions below).
This allows the EnerVista UR Setup software to be used. The UR operates as a Modbus slave device only. When using
Modbus protocol on the RS232 port, the C30 responds regardless of the MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS programmed. For the
RS485 port, each C30 must have a unique address from 1 to 254. Address 0 is the broadcast address which all Modbus
slave devices listen to. Addresses do not have to be sequential, but no two devices can have the same address or conflicts
resulting in errors will occur. Generally, each device added to the link should use the next higher address starting at 1. See
Appendix B for more information on the Modbus protocol.
A value of 0 closes the port. When the Modbus port is set to 0, communicate with the relay using the front panel or serial
port.
When a 0 value is involved in a change, the changes to the MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER setting take effect
when the C30 is restarted.
NOTE
h) PROTOCOL
Select among DNP3.0, IEC60870-104, and IEC60870-103, with DNP being the default. For any change to take effect,
restart the unit.
5-30
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PORT: CHANNEL
RS232
RS485
ETHERNET
DNP
Modbus
Modbus
Modbus
Modbus
Channel 1: none
Channel 2: Eth TCP
Modbus
Modbus
Modbus
Modbus
Modbus
DNP
DNP
Modbus
Modbus
DNP
DNP
Modbus
Channel 1: RS485
Channel 2: Eth TCP
Modbus
DNP
Channel 1: RS232
Channel 2: Eth TCP
DNP
Modbus
Channel 1: RS485
Channel 2: RS232
DNP
DNP
Channel 1: RS232
Channel 2: RS485
DNP
DNP
Channel 1: RS485
Channel 2: none
Modbus
DNP
IEC 104
Modbus
Modbus
IEC 103
Modbus
IEC 103
i) DNP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL
DNP CHANNELS
MESSAGE
DNP ADDRESS:
1
MESSAGE
DNP NETWORK
CLIENT ADDRESSES
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 60 s in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP PROTOCOL
GE Multilin
5-31
5-32
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP PF SCALE
FACTOR: 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP PF DEFAULT
DEADBAND: 30000
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 1
DEFAULT VARIATION: 2
Range: 1, 2
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 2
DEFAULT VARIATION: 2
Range: 1, 2, 3
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 20
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 5, 6
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 21
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 9, 10
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 22
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 5, 6
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 23
DEFAULT VARIATION: 2
Range: 1, 2, 5, 6
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 30
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
MESSAGE
DNP OBJECT 32
DEFAULT VARIATION: 1
Range: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 32 in steps of 1
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
The C30 supports the Distributed Network Protocol (DNP) version 3.0. The C30 can be used as a DNP slave device connected to multiple DNP masters (usually an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the C30 maintains two sets of DNP
data change buffers and connection information, two DNP masters can actively communicate with the C30 at one time.
NOTE
The IEC 60870-5-104 and DNP protocols cannot be used simultaneously. When the IEC 60870-5-104 FUNCTION
setting is set to Enabled, the DNP protocol is not operational. When this setting is changed it does not become
active until power to the relay has been cycled (off-to-on).
DNP CHANNELS
The DNP CHANNEL 1 PORT and DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT settings select the communications port assigned to the DNP protocol
for each channel. Once DNP is assigned to a serial port, DNP is the only protocol running on that port; Modbus or IEC
60870-5-103 are disabled. If DNP is assigned to RS485, the protocol must be set to DNP on the serial port configuration as
well, for the change to take effect. When this setting is set to Network - TCP, the DNP protocol can be used over TCP/IP
on channels 1 or 2. When this value is set to Network - UDP, the DNP protocol can be used over UDP/IP on channel 1
only. See the DNP appendix for information on the DNP protocol.
Changes to these settings take effect when power has been cycled to the relay.
NOTE
The DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS settings can force the C30 to respond to a maximum of five specific DNP masters. The
settings in this sub-menu are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESSES
CLIENT ADDRESS 1:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 2:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 3:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 4:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 5:
0.0.0.0
DNP NETWORK
CLIENT ADDRESSES
The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE FUNCTION should be Disabled for RS485 applications since there is no collision avoidance
mechanism. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE TIMEOUT sets the time the C30 waits for a DNP master to confirm an unsolicited
response. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE MAX RETRIES setting determines the number of times the C30 retransmits an unsolicited response without receiving confirmation from the master; a value of 255 allows infinite re-tries. The DNP UNSOL
RESPONSE DEST ADDRESS is the DNP address to which all unsolicited responses are sent. The IP address to which unsolicited responses are sent is determined by the C30 from the current TCP connection or the most recent UDP message.
The DNP scale factor settings are numbers used to scale analog input point values. These settings group the C30 analog
input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other. Each setting represents the
scale factor for all analog input points of that type. For example, if the DNP VOLTAGE SCALE FACTOR setting is set to 1000,
all DNP analog input points that are voltages will be returned with values 1000 times smaller (for example, a value of 72000
GE Multilin
5-33
5 SETTINGS
V on the C30 will be returned as 72). These settings are useful when analog input values must be adjusted to fit within certain ranges in DNP masters. Note that a scale factor of 0.1 is equivalent to a multiplier of 10 (that is, the value will be 10
times larger).
The DNP DEFAULT DEADBAND settings determine when to trigger unsolicited responses containing analog input data. These
settings group the C30 analog input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other.
Each setting represents the default deadband value for all analog input points of that type. For example, to trigger unsolicited responses from the C30 when any current values change by 15 A, the DNP CURRENT DEFAULT DEADBAND setting
should be set to 15. Note that these settings are the deadband default values. DNP object 34 points can be used to
change deadband values, from the default, for each individual DNP analog input point. Whenever power is removed and
re-applied to the C30, the default deadbands will be in effect.
The C30 relay does not support power metering. As such, the DNP POWER SCALE FACTOR and DNP POWER DEFAULT
settings are not applicable.
DEADBAND
NOTE
The C30 relay does not support energy metering. As such, the DNP ENERGY SCALE FACTOR and DNP ENERGY
DEFAULT DEADBAND settings are not applicable.
NOTE
The DNP TIME SYNC IIN PERIOD setting determines how often the Need Time Internal Indication (IIN) bit is set by the C30.
Changing this time allows the DNP master to send time synchronization commands more or less often, as required.
The DNP MESSAGE FRAGMENT SIZE setting determines the size, in bytes, at which message fragmentation occurs. Large
fragment sizes allow for more efficient throughput; smaller fragment sizes cause more application layer confirmations to be
necessary which can provide for more robust data transfer over noisy communication channels.
NOTE
When the DNP data points (analog inputs and/or binary inputs) are configured for Ethernet-enabled relays, check
the DNP Points Lists C30 web page to view the points lists. This page can be viewed with a web browser by entering the C30 IP address to access the C30 Main Menu, then by selecting the Device Information Menu > DNP
Points Lists menu item.
The DNP OBJECT 1 DEFAULT VARIATION to DNP OBJECT 32 DEFAULT VARIATION settings allow the user to select the DNP
default variation number for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32. The default variation refers to the variation
response when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. See the DNP Implementation section in the DNP
appendix.
The DNP binary outputs typically map one-to-one to IED data points. That is, each DNP binary output controls a single
physical or virtual control point in an IED. In the C30 relay, DNP binary outputs are mapped to virtual inputs. However, some
legacy DNP implementations use a mapping of one DNP binary output to two physical or virtual control points to support
the concept of trip/close (for circuit breakers) or raise/lower (for tap changers) using a single control point. That is, the DNP
master can operate a single point for both trip and close, or raise and lower, operations. The C30 can be configured to support paired control points, with each paired control point operating two virtual inputs. The DNP NUMBER OF PAIRED CONTROL
POINTS setting allows configuration of from 0 to 32 binary output paired controls. Points not configured as paired operate on
a one-to-one basis.
The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This number identifies the C30 on a DNP communications link. Each
DNP slave should be assigned a unique address.
The DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting specifies a time delay for the detection of dead network TCP connections. If
there is no data traffic on a DNP TCP connection for greater than the time specified by this setting, the connection will be
aborted by the C30. This frees up the connection to be re-used by a client.
Relay power must be re-cycled after changing the DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting for the changes to take
effect.
NOTE
DNP / IEC104
POINT LISTS
MESSAGE
5-34
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The binary and analog inputs points for the DNP protocol, or the MSP and MME points for IEC 60870-5-104 protocol, can
configured to a maximum of 256 points. The value for each point is user-programmable and can be configured by assigning
FlexLogic operands for binary inputs / MSP points or FlexAnalog parameters for analog inputs / MME points.
The menu for the binary input points (DNP) or MSP points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS
Point:
Off
Point:
Off
MESSAGE
Point:
Off
255
Up to 256 binary input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The points are configured by
assigning an appropriate FlexLogic operand. See the Introduction to FlexLogic section in this chapter for the full range of
assignable operands.
The menu for the analog input points (DNP) or MME points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS ANALOG INPUT / MME POINTS
Point:
Off
Point:
Off
MESSAGE
Point:
Off
255
Up to 256 analog input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The analog point list is configured by assigning an appropriate FlexAnalog parameter to each point. Refer to Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters for the
full range of assignable parameters.
The DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists always begin with point 0 and end at the first Off value. Since DNP / IEC
60870-5-104 point lists must be in one continuous block, any points assigned after the first Off point are ignored.
NOTE
Changes to the DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists will not take effect until the C30 is restarted.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-35
5 SETTINGS
GSSE / GOOSE
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
SERVER
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MMXU DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
GGIO1 STATUS
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
GGIO2 CONTROL
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
GGIO5 UINTEGER
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
REPORT CONTROL
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
XCBR
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
XSWI
CONFIGURATION
The C30 Controller System is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability. This feature is
specified as a software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for
details.
Use independent ports for IEC 61850 communication and take care when configuring the settings,
else loss of protection or misoperation of the relay can result.
The C30 supports the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) protocol as specified by IEC 61850. MMS is supported
over two protocol stacks: TCP/IP over Ethernet. The C30 operates as an IEC 61850 server. The Remote Inputs and Outputs section in this chapter describe the peer-to-peer GSSE/GOOSE message scheme.
The GSSE/GOOSE configuration main menu is divided into two areas: transmission and reception.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
GSSE / GOOSE
CONFIGURATION
TRANSMISSION
MESSAGE
RECEPTION
5-36
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION
GENERAL
MESSAGE
GSSE
MESSAGE
FIXED GOOSE
MESSAGE
CONFIGURABLE
GOOSE
GENERAL
DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE
UPDATE TIME: 60 s
Range: 1 to 60 s in steps of 1
The DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE UPDATE TIME sets the time between GSSE or GOOSE messages when there are no remote output state changes to be sent. When remote output data changes, GSSE or GOOSE messages are sent immediately. This
setting controls the steady-state heartbeat time interval.
The DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE UPDATE TIME setting is applicable to GSSE, fixed C30 GOOSE, and configurable GOOSE.
GSSE FUNCTION:
Enabled
MESSAGE
GSSE ID:
GSSEOut
MESSAGE
DESTINATION MAC:
000000000000
GSSE
These settings are applicable to GSSE only. If the fixed GOOSE function is enabled, GSSE messages are not transmitted.
The GSSE ID setting represents the IEC 61850 GSSE application ID name string sent as part of each GSSE message. This
string identifies the GSSE message to the receiving device. In C30 releases previous to 5.0x, this name string was represented by the RELAY NAME setting.
GE Multilin
5-37
5 SETTINGS
GOOSE FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
GOOSE ID:
GOOSEOut
MESSAGE
DESTINATION MAC:
000000000000
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 7 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
FIXED GOOSE
The DESTINATION MAC setting allows the destination Ethernet MAC address to be set. This address must be a multicast
address; the least significant bit of the first byte must be set. In C30 releases previous to 5.0x, the destination Ethernet
MAC address was determined automatically by taking the sending MAC address (that is, the unique, local MAC address of
the C30) and setting the multicast bit.
The GOOSE VLAN PRIORITY setting indicates the Ethernet priority of GOOSE messages. This allows GOOSE messages to
have higher priority than other Ethernet data. The GOOSE ETYPE APPID setting allows the selection of a specific application
ID for each GOOSE sending device. This value can be left at its default if the feature is not required. Both the GOOSE VLAN
PRIORITY and GOOSE ETYPE APPID settings are required by IEC 61850.
5-38
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CONFIG GSE 1
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
VLAN PRIORITY: 4
Range: 0 to 7 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
VLAN ID:
0
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
ETYPE APPID:
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
CONFREV:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CONFIG GSE 1
DATASET ITEMS
CONFIGURABLE
GOOSE 1
0
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
The configurable GOOSE settings allow the C30 to be configured to transmit a number of different datasets within IEC
61850 GOOSE messages. Up to eight different configurable datasets can be configured and transmitted. This is useful for
intercommunication between C30 IEDs and devices from other manufacturers that support IEC 61850.
The configurable GOOSE feature allows for the configuration of the datasets to be transmitted or received from the C30.
The C30 supports the configuration of eight (8) transmission and reception datasets, allowing for the optimization of data
transfer between devices.
Items programmed for dataset 1 and 2 will have changes in their status transmitted as soon as the change is detected.
Datasets 1 and 2 should be used for high-speed transmission of data that is required for applications such as transfer tripping, blocking, and breaker fail initiate. At least one digital status value needs to be configured in the required dataset to
enable transmission of configured data. Configuring analog data only to dataset 1 or 2 will not activate transmission.
Items programmed for datasets 3 through 8 will have changes in their status transmitted at a maximum rate of every
100 ms. Datasets 3 through 8 will regularly analyze each data item configured within them every 100 ms to identify if any
changes have been made. If any changes in the data items are detected, these changes will be transmitted through a
GOOSE message. If there are no changes detected during this 100 ms period, no GOOSE message will be sent.
For all datasets 1 through 8, the integrity GOOSE message will still continue to be sent at the pre-configured rate even if no
changes in the data items are detected.
The GOOSE functionality was enhanced to prevent the relay from flooding a communications network with GOOSE messages due to an oscillation being created that is triggering a message.
The C30 has the ability of detecting if a data item in one of the GOOSE datasets is erroneously oscillating. This can be
caused by events such as errors in logic programming, inputs improperly being asserted and de-asserted, or failed station
components. If erroneously oscillation is detected, the C30 will stop sending GOOSE messages from the dataset for a minimum period of one second. Should the oscillation persist after the one second time-out period, the C30 will continue to
block transmission of the dataset. The C30 will assert the MAINTENANCE ALERT: GGIO Ind XXX oscill self-test error message on the front panel display, where XXX denotes the data item detected as oscillating.
For versions 5.70 and higher, the C30 supports four retransmission schemes: aggressive, medium, relaxed, and heartbeat.
The aggressive scheme is only supported in fast type 1A GOOSE messages (GOOSEOut 1 and GOOSEOut 2). For slow
GOOSE messages (GOOSEOut 3 to GOOSEOut 8) the aggressive scheme is the same as the medium scheme.
GE Multilin
5-39
5 SETTINGS
The details about each scheme are shown in the following table.
Table 56: GOOSE RETRANSMISSION SCHEMES
SCHEME
SQ NUM
TIME BETWEEN
MESSAGES
COMMENT
Aggressive
0 ms
0 ms
Event
2000 ms
4 ms
4 ms
T1
2000 ms
8 ms
4 ms
T1
2000 ms
16 ms
8 ms
T2
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
0 ms
0 ms
Event
2000 ms
16 ms
16 ms
T1
2000 ms
32 ms
16 ms
T1
2000 ms
64 ms
32 ms
T2
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
0 ms
0 ms
Event
2000 ms
100 ms
100 ms
T1
2000 ms
200 ms
100 ms
T1
2000 ms
700 ms
500 ms
T2
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
0 ms
0 ms
Event
2000 ms
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T1
2000 ms
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T1
2000 ms
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T2
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
Medium
Relaxed
Heartbeat
The configurable GOOSE feature is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers. Fixed GOOSE is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data
transfer between UR-series IEDs.
IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging contains a number of configurable parameters, all of which must be correct to achieve the
successful transfer of data. It is critical that the configured datasets at the transmission and reception devices are an exact
match in terms of data structure, and that the GOOSE addresses and name strings match exactly. Manual configuration is
possible, but third-party substation configuration software may be used to automate the process. The EnerVista UR Setup
software can produce IEC 61850 ICD files and import IEC 61850 SCD files produced by a substation configurator (as outlined in the IEC 61850 appendix).
The following example illustrates the configuration required to transfer IEC 61850 data items between two devices. The
general steps required for transmission configuration are:
1.
2.
3.
2.
3.
5-40
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
This example shows how to configure the transmission and reception of three IEC 61850 data items: a single point status
value, its associated quality flags, and a floating point analog value.
The following procedure illustrates the transmission configuration.
1.
Configure the transmission dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO1 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO1 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 3 to MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f to indicate the analog frequency magnitude for MMXU1 (the metered frequency for SRC1).
The transmission dataset now contains a quality flag, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point analog
value. The reception dataset on the receiving device must exactly match this structure.
2.
3.
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1 settings menu:
Set CONFIG GSE 1 ID to an appropriate descriptive string (the default value is GOOSEOut_1).
Set CONFIG GSE 1 DST MAC to a multicast address (for example, 01 00 00 12 34 56).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN PRIORITY; the default value of 4 is OK for this example.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN ID value; the default value is 0, but some switches may require this value to be 1.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 ETYPE APPID value. This setting represents the ETHERTYPE application ID and must match
the configuration on the receiver (the default value is 0).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 CONFREV value. This value changes automatically as described in IEC 61850 part 7-2. For
this example it can be left at its default value.
Configure the data by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC 61850 PROTOsettings menu:
4.
Set GGIO1 INDICATION 1 to a FlexLogic operand used to provide the status of GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal (for example, a
contact input, virtual input, a protection element status, etc.).
Configure the MMXU1 Hz Deadband by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
settings menu:
Set MMXU1 HZ DEADBAND to 0.050%. This will result in an update to the MMXU1.MX.mag.f analog value with a
change greater than 45 mHz, from the previous MMXU1.MX.mag.f value, in the source frequency.
The C30 must be rebooted (control power removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The following procedure illustrates the reception configuration.
1.
Configure the reception dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC
61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE
1 CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS settings menu:
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO3 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO3 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 3 to GGIO3.MX.AnIn1.mag.f to indicate the analog magnitude for GGIO3 analog input 1.
The reception dataset now contains a quality flag, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point analog
value. This matches the transmission dataset configuration above.
2.
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE DEVICE 1 settings menu:
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ID to match the GOOSE ID string for the transmitting device. Enter GOOSEOut_1.
GE Multilin
5-41
3.
5 SETTINGS
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID to match the ETHERTYPE application ID from the transmitting device. This is
0 in the example above.
Set the REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET value. This value represents the dataset number in use. Since we are using
configurable GOOSE 1 in this example, program this value as GOOSEIn 1.
Configure the Boolean data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE INPUTS REMOTE
settings menu:
INPUT 1
4.
Set REMOTE IN 1 ITEM to Dataset Item 2. This assigns the value of the GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal single point status
item to remote input 1.
Configure the analog data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS IEC 61850 GOOSE ANALOG
settings menu:
INPUTS
The GOOSE analog input 1 can now be used as a FlexAnalog value in a FlexElement or in other settings. The C30 must be
rebooted (control power removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of GOOSE analog input 1 in the receiving device will be determined by the MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f value in the
sending device. This MMXU value is determined by the source 1 frequency value and the MMXU Hz deadband setting of
the sending device.
Remote input 1 can now be used in FlexLogic equations or other settings. The C30 must be rebooted (control power
removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of remote input 1 (Boolean on or off) in the receiving device will be determined by the GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal value
in the sending device. The above settings will be automatically populated by the EnerVista UR Setup software when a complete SCD file is created by third party substation configurator software.
For intercommunication between C30 IEDs, the fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset can be used. The DNA/UserSt dataset contains the same DNA and UserSt bit pairs that are included in GSSE messages. All GOOSE messages transmitted by the
C30 (DNA/UserSt dataset and configurable datasets) use the IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging services (for example, VLAN
support).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 FUNCTION function to Disabled when configuration changes are required. Once changes are
entered, return the CONFIG GSE 1 FUNCTION to Enabled and restart the unit for changes to take effect.
NOTE
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(8) CONFIG GSE 1(64) DATA ITEMS
ITEM 1:
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal
MESSAGE
ITEM 2:
GGIO1.ST.IndPos1.stV
MESSAGE
ITEM
None
CONFIG GSE 1
DATASET ITEMS
3:
MESSAGE
ITEM 64:
None
To create a configurable GOOSE dataset that contains an IEC 61850 Single Point Status indication and its associated quality flags, the following dataset items can be selected: GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal and GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q. The C30 will then create a dataset containing these two data items. The status value for GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal is determined by the FlexLogic
operand assigned to GGIO1 indication 1. Changes to this operand will result in the transmission of GOOSE messages containing the defined dataset.
5-42
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The main reception menu is applicable to configurable GOOSE only and contains the configurable GOOSE dataset items
for reception:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(16) CONFIG GSE 1(32) DATA ITEMS
ITEM 1:
GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal
MESSAGE
ITEM 2:
GGIO3.ST.IndPos1.stV
MESSAGE
ITEM
None
CONFIG GSE 1
DATASET ITEMS
3:
MESSAGE
ITEM 32:
None
The configurable GOOSE settings allow the C30 to be configured to receive a number of different datasets within IEC
61850 GOOSE messages. Up to sixteen different configurable datasets can be configured for reception. This is useful for
intercommunication between C30 IEDs and devices from other manufacturers that support IEC 61850.
For intercommunication between C30 IEDs, the fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset can be used. The DNA/UserSt dataset contains the same DNA and UserSt bit pairs that are included in GSSE messages.
To set up a C30 to receive a configurable GOOSE dataset that contains two IEC 61850 single point status indications, the
following dataset items can be selected (for example, for configurable GOOSE dataset 1): GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal and
GGIO3.ST.Ind2.stVal. The C30 will then create a dataset containing these two data items. The Boolean status values from
these data items can be utilized as remote input FlexLogic operands. First, the REMOTE DEVICE 1(16) DATASET setting must
be set to contain dataset GOOSEIn 1 (that is, the first configurable dataset). Then REMOTE IN 1(16) ITEM settings must be
set to Dataset Item 1 and Dataset Item 2. These remote input FlexLogic operands will then change state in accordance
with the status values of the data items in the configured dataset.
Double-point status values may be included in the GOOSE dataset. Received values are populated in the
GGIO3.ST.IndPos1.stVal and higher items.
Floating point analog values originating from MMXU logical nodes may be included in GOOSE datasets. Deadband (noninstantaneous) values can be transmitted. Received values are used to populate the GGIO3.MX.AnIn1 and higher items.
Received values are also available as FlexAnalog parameters (GOOSE analog In1 and up).
GGIO3.MX.AnIn1 to GGIO3.MX.AnIn32 can only be used once for all sixteen reception datasets.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-43
5 SETTINGS
The main menu for the IEC 61850 server configuration is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL SERVER CONFIGURATION
LD INST: LDInst
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
INCLUDE NON-IEC
DATA: Enabled
MESSAGE
SERVER SCANNING:
Disabled
MESSAGE
LATITUDE:
LONGITUDE:
ALTITUDE:
SERVER
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The IED NAME and LD INST settings represent the MMS domain name (IEC 61850 logical device) where all IEC/MMS logical
nodes are located. Valid characters for these values are upper and lowercase letters, numbers, and the underscore (_)
character, and the first character in the string must be a letter. This conforms to the IEC 61850 standard. The LOCATION is a
variable string and can be composed of ASCII characters. This string appears within the PhyName of the LPHD node.
The IEC/MMS TCP PORT NUMBER setting allows the user to change the TCP port number for MMS connections. The INCLUDE
NON-IEC DATA setting determines whether or not the UR MMS domain will be available. This domain contains a large number of UR-series specific data items that are not available in the IEC 61850 logical nodes. This data does not follow the IEC
61850 naming conventions. For communications schemes that strictly follow the IEC 61850 standard, this setting should be
Disabled.
When a 0 value is involved in a change, the changes to the IEC/MMS TCP PORT NUMBER setting take effect when the
C30 is restarted.
NOTE
The SERVER SCANNING feature should be set to Disabled when IEC 61850 client/server functionality is not required. IEC
61850 has two modes of functionality: GOOSE/GSSE inter-device communication and client/server communication. If the
GOOSE/GSSE functionality is required without the IEC 61850 client server feature, then server scanning can be disabled
to increase CPU resources. When server scanning is disabled, there is no updating of the IEC 61850 logical node status
values in the C30. Clients are still able to connect to the server (C30 relay), but most data values are not updated. This setting does not affect GOOSE/GSSE operation.
Changes to the IED NAME setting, LD INST setting, and GOOSE dataset take effect when the C30 is restarted.
NOTE
5-44
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The main menu for the IEC 61850 logical node name prefixes is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL
IEC 61850 LOGICAL NODE NAME PREFIXES
MESSAGE
The IEC 61850 logical node name prefix settings are used to create name prefixes to uniquely identify each logical node.
For example, the logical node PTOC1 may have the name prefix abc. The full logical node name will then be
abcMMXU1. Valid characters for the logical node name prefixes are upper and lowercase letters, numbers, and the
underscore (_) character, and the first character in the prefix must be a letter. This conforms to the IEC 61850 standard.
Changes to the logical node prefixes will not take effect until the C30 is restarted.
The main menu for the IEC 61850 MMXU deadbands is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL MMXU DEADBANDS
MMXU DEADBANDS
MMXU1 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU2 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU3 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU4 DEADBANDS
The MMXU deadband settings represent the deadband values used to determine when the update the MMXU mag and
cVal values from the associated instmag and instcVal values. The mag and cVal values are used for the IEC 61850
buffered and unbuffered reports. These settings correspond to the associated db data items in the CF functional constraint of the MMXU logical node, as per the IEC 61850 standard. According to IEC 61850-7-3, the db value shall represent the percentage of difference between the maximum and minimum in units of 0.001%. Thus, it is important to know the
maximum value for each MMXU measured quantity, since this represents the 100.00% value for the deadband.
The minimum value for all quantities is 0; the maximum values are as follows:
power (real, reactive, and apparent): 46 phase CT primary setting 275 VT ratio setting
frequency: 90 Hz
power factor: 2
GE Multilin
5-45
5 SETTINGS
GGIO1 STATUS
CONFIGURATION
NUMBER OF STATUS
POINTS IN GGIO1: 8
MESSAGE
GGIO1 INDICATION
Off
MESSAGE
GGIO1 INDICATION
Off
MESSAGE
GGIO1 INDICATION
Off
MESSAGE
The NUMBER OF STATUS POINTS IN GGIO1 setting specifies the number of Ind (single point status indications) that are
instantiated in the GGIO1 logical node. Changes to the NUMBER OF STATUS POINTS IN GGIO1 setting will not take effect until
the C30 is restarted.
The GGIO2 control configuration points are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GGIO2 CONTROL CONFIGURATION
GGIO2 CF SPSCO 1(64)
GGIO2 CF SPCSO 1
Range: 0, 1, or 2
GGIO2 CF SPCSO 1
CTLMODEL: 1
The GGIO2 control configuration settings are used to set the control model for each input. The available choices are 0
(status only), 1 (direct control), and 2 (SBO with normal security). The GGIO2 control points are used to control the C30
virtual inputs.
The GGIO4 analog configuration points are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GGIO4 ANALOG CONFIGURATION
GGIO4 ANALOG
CONFIGURATION
NUMBER OF ANALOG
POINTS IN GGIO4:
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG 1
MEASURED VALUE
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG 2
MEASURED VALUE
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG 3
MEASURED VALUE
Range: 4 to 32 in steps of 4
MESSAGE
GGIO4 ANALOG 32
MEASURED VALUE
The NUMBER OF ANALOG POINTS setting determines how many analog data points will exist in GGIO4. When this value is
changed, the C30 must be rebooted in order to allow the GGIO4 logical node to be re-instantiated and contain the newly
configured number of analog points.
5-46
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The measured value settings for each of the 32 analog values are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT... COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GGIO4 ANALOG CONFIGURATION
GGIO4 ANALOG 1(32) MEASURED VALUE
ANALOG IN
Off
1 VALUE:
MESSAGE
ANALOG IN
0.000
1 DB:
MESSAGE
ANALOG IN
0.000
1 MIN:
MESSAGE
ANALOG IN
0.000
1 MAX:
GGIO4 ANALOG 1
MEASURED VALUE
ANALOG IN 1 VALUE: This setting selects the FlexAnalog value to drive the instantaneous value of each GGIO4 analog status value (GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.instMag.f).
ANALOG IN 1 DB: This setting specifies the deadband for each analog value. Refer to IEC 61850-7-1 and 61850-7-3
for details. The deadband is used to determine when to update the deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous
magnitude. The deadband is a percentage of the difference between the maximum and minimum values.
ANALOG IN 1 MIN: This setting specifies the minimum value for each analog value. Refer to IEC 61850-7-1 and
61850-7-3 for details. This minimum value is used to determine the deadband. The deadband is used in the determination of the deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous magnitude.
ANALOG IN 1 MAX: This setting defines the maximum value for each analog value. Refer to IEC 61850-7-1 and
61850-7-3 for details. This maximum value is used to determine the deadband. The deadband is used in the determination of the deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous magnitude.
NOTE
Note that the ANALOG IN 1 MIN and ANALOG IN 1 MAX settings are stored as IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating point
numbers. Because of the large range of these settings, not all values can be stored. Some values may be rounded
to the closest possible floating point number.
GGIO5 UINT In
Off
1:
MESSAGE
GGIO5 UINT In
Off
2:
MESSAGE
GGIO5 UINT In
Off
3:
GGIO5 UINTEGER
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
The GGIO5 logical node allows IEC 61850 client access to integer data values. This allows access to as many as 16
unsigned integer value points, associated timestamps, and quality flags. The method of configuration is similar to that of
GGIO1 (binary status values). The settings allow the selection of FlexInteger values for each GGIO5 integer value point.
It is intended that clients use GGIO5 to access generic integer values from the C30. Additional settings are provided to
allow the selection of the number of integer values available in GGIO5 (1 to 16), and to assign FlexInteger values to the
GGIO5 integer inputs. The following setting is available for all GGIO5 configuration points.
GGIO5 UINT IN 1 VALUE: This setting selects the FlexInteger value to drive each GGIO5 integer status value
(GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1). This setting is stored as an 32-bit unsigned integer value.
GE Multilin
5-47
5 SETTINGS
REPORT 1
DATASET ITEMS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
ITEM
1:
ITEM
2:
ITEM
3:
MESSAGE
ITEM 64:
To create the dataset for logical node LN, program the ITEM 1 to ITEM 64 settings to a value from the list of IEC 61850 data
attributes supported by the C30. Changes to the dataset will only take effect when the C30 is restarted. It is recommended
to use reporting service from logical node LLN0 if a user needs some (but not all) data from already existing GGIO1,
GGIO4, and MMXU4 points and their quantity is not greater than 64 minus the number items in this dataset.
5-48
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The breaker configuration settings are shown below. Changes to these values take effect when the UR is restarted:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL XCBR CONFIGURATION
XCBR
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
XCBR1 Pos
sboTimeout: 30 s
Range: 2 to 60 seconds
MESSAGE
XCBR6 Pos
sboTimeout: 30 s
Range: 2 to 60 seconds
The XCBR1 ST.LOC OPERAND setting is used to inhibit 61850 control commands to close or open breaker through UR
Breaker Control element. See the Breaker Control element logic diagram for more information.
The CLEAR XCBR1 OpCnt setting allows clearing the breaker operating counter. As breakers operate by opening and
closing, the XCBR operating counter status attribute (OpCnt) increments with every operation. Frequent breaker operation
can result in very large OpCnt values over time. This setting allows the OpCnt to be reset to 0 for XCBR1.
GE Multilin
5-49
5 SETTINGS
The XCBR1 SYNCCHECK CLS setting is used to supervise a close command with a synchrocheck condition within XCBR
logical node. If a Close with SynchroCheck is requested (through a SelectWithValue service) and the SynchroCheck condition is not satisfied, a Negative Response (-Rsp) is issued with the REASON CODE of Blocked-by-synchrocheck.
The XCBR1 INTERLOCK OPN/CLS settings are used to assign an operand, which is linked into the EnaOpn or EnaCls
INTERLOCKED inputs respectively of the XCBR. When this operand is asserted, XCBR logical node inhibits execution of
the open and close commands respectively. If select before operate (SBO) with Extended Security is requested and Interlock condition exists, the UR responds with a Negative response (-Rsp) with the Reason Code Blocked-by-interlocking.
The XCBR1 Pos ctlModel setting is used to select control model per IEC 61850-7-3. The following control models are supported by URs:
0 Status only
1 Direct control with normal security (direct-operate)
2 SBO control with normal security (operate-once)
3 Direct control with enhanced security (direct-operate)
4 SBO control with enhanced security (operate-once)
See IEC 61850-7-2 for complete details on these control models.
The XCBR1 Pos sboTimeout setting is used to select SBO timeout value. To be successful, the IEC 61850 "operate" command must be executed after the "select" command within the XCBR1 Pos sboTimeout setting value.
The disconnect switch configuration settings are shown below. Changes to these values will not take effect until the UR is
restarted:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL XSWI CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
XSWI
CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The CLEAR XSWI1 OpCnt setting represents the disconnect switch operating counter. As disconnect switches operate by
opening and closing, the XSWI operating counter status attribute (OpCnt) increments with every operation. Frequent switch
operation may result in very large OpCnt values over time. This setting allows the OpCnt to be reset to 0 for XSWI1.
NOTE
5-50
Since GSSE/GOOSE messages are multicast Ethernet by specification, they are not usually be forwarded by network routers. However, GOOSE messages may be forwarded by routers if the router has been configured for VLAN
functionality.
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
WEB SERVER
HTTP PROTOCOL
The C30 contains an embedded web server and is capable of transferring web pages to a web browser such as Internet
Explorer or Firefox. The web pages are organized as a series of menus that can be accessed starting at the C30 Main
Menu. Web pages are available showing DNP and IEC 60870-5-104 points lists, Modbus registers, event records, fault
reports, and so on. First connect the UR and a computer to an Ethernet network, then enter the IP address of the C30 into
the Address box of the web browser.
When the port is set to 0, the change takes effect when the C30 is restarted.
NOTE
m) TFTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS TFTP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
TFTP PROTOCOL
The Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) can be used to transfer files from the C30 over a network. The C30 operates as a
TFTP server. TFTP client software is available from various sources, including Microsoft Windows NT. The dir.txt file
obtained from the C30 contains a list and description of all available files (event records, oscillography, etc.).
When the TFTP MAIN UDP PORT NUMBER is set to 0, the change takes effect when the C30 is restarted.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-51
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
IEC NETWORK
CLIENT ADDRESSES
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
IEC PF DEFAULT
THRESHOLD: 1.00
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
IEC REDUNDANCY
ENABLED: No
IEC 60870-5-104
PROTOCOL
The C30 supports the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol. The C30 can be used as an IEC 60870-5-104 slave device connected to
a maximum of two masters (usually either an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the C30 maintains two sets of IEC
60870-5-104 data change buffers, no more than two masters should actively communicate with the C30 at one time.
The IEC ------- DEFAULT THRESHOLD settings are used to determine when to trigger spontaneous responses containing
M_ME_NC_1 analog data. These settings group the C30 analog data into types: current, voltage, power, energy, and other.
Each setting represents the default threshold value for all M_ME_NC_1 analog points of that type. For example, to trigger
spontaneous responses from the C30 when any current values change by 15 A, the IEC CURRENT DEFAULT THRESHOLD setting should be set to 15. Note that these settings are the default values of the deadbands. P_ME_NC_1 (parameter of measured value, short floating point value) points can be used to change threshold values, from the default, for each individual
M_ME_NC_1 analog point. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the C30, the default thresholds are in effect.
The IEC REDUNDANCY setting decides whether multiple client connections are accepted or not. If redundancy is set to Yes,
two simultaneous connections can be active at any given time.
When the IEC port number is set to 0, the change takes effect when the C30 is restarted.
NOTE
The C30 relay does not support power metering. As such, the IEC POWER DEFAULT THRESHOLD setting is not applicable.
NOTE
The C30 relay does not support energy metering. As such, the IEC ENERGY DEFAULT THRESHOLD setting is not applicable.
NOTE
NOTE
5-52
The IEC 60870-5-104 and DNP protocols cannot be used simultaneously. When the IEC 60870-5-104 FUNCTION
setting is set to Enabled, the DNP protocol does not operate. When this setting is changed, it takes effect when
power to the relay is cycled (off-to-on).
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS
ADDRESSES
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 2:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 3:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 4:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESS 5:
0.0.0.0
IEC NETWORK
CLIENT ADDRESSES
The UR can specify a maximum of five clients for its IEC 104 connections. These are IP addresses for the controllers to
which the UR can connect.
A maximum of two simultaneous connections are supported at any given time.
o) EGD PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS EGD PROTOCOL
EGD PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
The C30 Controller System is provided with optional Ethernet Global Data (EGD) communications capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in
chapter 2 for details.
The relay supports one fast Ethernet Global Data (EGD) exchange and two slow EGD exchanges. There are 20 data items
in the fast-produced EGD exchange and 50 data items in each slow-produced exchange.
Ethernet Global Data (EGD) is a suite of protocols used for the real-time transfer of data for display and control purposes.
The relay can be configured to produce EGD data exchanges, and other devices can be configured to consume EGD
data exchanges. The number of produced exchanges (up to three), the data items in each exchange (up to 50), and the
exchange production rate can be configured.
EGD cannot be used to transfer data between UR-series relays. The relay supports EGD production only. An EGD
exchange will not be transmitted unless the destination address is non-zero, and at least the first data item address is set to
a valid Modbus register address. Note that the default setting value of 0 is considered invalid.
GE Multilin
5-53
5 SETTINGS
The settings menu for the fast EGD exchange is shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS EGD PROTOCOL FAST PROD EXCH 1 CONFIGURATION
EXCH 1 FUNCTION:
Disable
MESSAGE
EXCH 1 DESTINATION:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Fast exchanges (50 to 1000 ms) are generally used in control schemes. The C30 has one fast exchange (exchange 1) and
two slow exchanges (exchange 2 and 3).
The settings menu for the slow EGD exchanges is shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS EGD PROTOCOL SLOW PROD EXCH 1(2) CONFIGURATION
EXCH 1 FUNCTION:
Disable
MESSAGE
EXCH 1 DESTINATION:
0.0.0.0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
1:
MESSAGE
2:
MESSAGE
3:
MESSAGE
Slow EGD exchanges (500 to 1000 ms) are generally used for the transfer and display of data items. The settings for the
fast and slow exchanges are described below:
EXCH 1 DESTINATION: This setting specifies the destination IP address of the produced EGD exchange. This is usually unicast or broadcast.
EXCH 1 DATA RATE: This setting specifies the rate at which this EGD exchange is transmitted. If the setting is 50 ms,
the exchange data will be updated and sent once every 50 ms. If the setting is 1000 ms, the exchange data will be
updated and sent once per second. EGD exchange 1 has a setting range of 50 to 1000 ms. Exchanges 2 and 3 have a
setting range of 500 to 1000 ms.
5-54
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 1 to 20/50: These settings specify the data items that are part of this EGD exchange. Almost any
data from the C30 memory map can be configured to be included in an EGD exchange. The settings are the starting
Modbus register address for the data item in decimal format. Refer to Appendix B for the complete Modbus memory
map. Note that the Modbus memory map displays shows addresses in hexadecimal format. as such, it will be necessary to convert these values to decimal format before entering them as values for these setpoints.
To select a data item to be part of an exchange, it is only necessary to choose the starting Modbus address of the item.
That is, for items occupying more than one Modbus register (for example, 32 bit integers and floating point values),
only the first Modbus address is required. The EGD exchange configured with these settings contains the data items
up to the first setting that contains a Modbus address with no data, or 0. That is, if the first three settings contain valid
Modbus addresses and the fourth is 0, the produced EGD exchange will contain three data items.
IEC103 COMMON
ADDRESS OF ASDU: 0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
IEC103 INPUTS
BINARY
MESSAGE
IEC103 INPUTS
MEASURANDS
MESSAGE
IEC103 COMMANDS
IEC103
PROTOCOL
The C30 Controller System is provided with optional IEC 60870-5-103 communications capability. This
feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2
for details.
IEC103 COMMON ADDRESS OF ASDU: This setting uniquely defines this C30 on the serial line. Select an ID between 0 and
254. This ID does not need to be in sequential order for all stations that communicate with a controller, but it is recommended. Note that RS485 only allows a maximum of 32 slave stations on a communication line, so the entire range of 254
addresses is never exhausted.
IEC103 SYNC TIMEOUT:
This setting defines the time that the C30 waits for a synchronization message. The C30 synchronizes its clock using all available sources, with the source synching more frequently overwriting the time of the other
sources. Since the synchronization message received from the IEC 60870-5-103 master is less frequent than IRIG-B, PTP,
or SNTP, its time is overwritten by these three sources, if any of them is active. If the synchronization timeout occurs and
none of IRIG-B, PTP, or SNTP is active, the C30 sets the invalid bit in the time stamp of a time-tagged message.
The settings for the remaining menus are outlined as follows.
IEC103 INPUTS
BINARY
MESSAGE
POINT 0
POINT 1
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
POINT 95
5-55
5 SETTINGS
POINT 0 FUN
0
MESSAGE
POINT 0 INF
0
MESSAGE
POINT 0 Input
Off
POINT 0
POINT 95 FUN
0
MESSAGE
POINT 95 INF
0
MESSAGE
POINT 95 Input
Off
POINT 95
The binary input points are mapped using elements from a list of possible FlexLogic operands. A maximum of 96 binary
inputs (points) can be mapped this way.
The IEC60870-5-103 point list always starts with point 0 and ends at the first "Off" value. Since the IEC 60870-5-103 point
list must be in a continuous block, any points assigned after the first "Off" point are ignored.
For each defined point, set appropriate values for the Function Type (FUN) and Information Number (INF), which form the
Information Object Identifier field of the ASDU, as defined in IEC60870-5-103.
The binary input points are sent as Class 1 data. They are sent either as a response to a general interrogation received
from the controller or reported spontaneously. Spontaneous transmission occurs as a response to cyclic Class 2 requests.
If the C30 wants to transmit Class 1 data at that time, it demands access for Class 1 data transmission (ACD=1 in the control field of the response).
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC60870-5-103 IEC103 INPUTS MEASURANDS
ASDU 1
ASDU 2
MESSAGE
ASDU 3
MESSAGE
ASDU 4
MESSAGE
IEC103 INPUTS
MEASURANDS
5-56
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
ASDU 1 TYP:
9
Range: 3 or 9
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 FUN:
0
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 INF:
0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 ANALOG 1
Off
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 ANALOG 1
FACTOR: 1.000
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 ANALOG 1
OFFSET: 0
ASDU 1
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 ANALOG 9
Off
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 ANALOG 9
FACTOR: 1.000
MESSAGE
ASDU 1 ANALOG 9
OFFSET: 0
ASDU 4 TYP:
9
Range: 3 or 9
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 FUN:
0
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 INF:
0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 ANALOG 1
Off
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 ANALOG 1
FACTOR: 1.000
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 ANALOG 1
OFFSET: 0
ASDU 4
GE Multilin
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 ANALOG 9
Off
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 ANALOG 9
FACTOR: 1.000
MESSAGE
ASDU 4 ANALOG 9
OFFSET: 0
5-57
5 SETTINGS
These two fields form the Information Object Identifier of the ASDU
as defined in IEC60870-103.
SCAN TIMEOUT (SCAN TOUT): This is the cyclic period used by the C30 to decide when a measurand ASDU is included in a
response. The measurand is sent as response to a Class 2 request when the corresponding timeout expires. The default
value 0 means 500 ms.
ANALOG #:
This field contains the actual measurand to be sent in the response to the master. The measurands can be
mapped using elements from a list of FlexAnalog operands. The measurands sent are voltage, current, power, power factor, and frequency. If any other FlexAnalog is chosen, the C30 sends 0 instead of its value. Note that the power is transmitted in KW, not W. Measurands are transmitted as ASDU 3 or ASDU 9 (type identification value set to measurands I,
respectively measurands II).
Each IEC60870-5-103 measurands list ends at the first unconfigured ("Off") value. Any measurand assigned after the first
"Off" value is ignored.
At least one measurand per ASDU must be configured in order to configure the following ASDU. For example, the user can
configure only one measurand for each ASDU, but the user is not allowed to skip ASDU2 and configure measurands in
ASDU3.
ANALOG # FACTOR AND OFFSET: For each measurand included in the ASDU, a factor and offset can also be configured. The
factor and offset allow for scaling to be performed on measurands. The final measurement sent to the IEC60870-103 master is then "a*x + b", where x is the measurand, a is the multiplying factor and b is the offset. The master has to perform the
reversed operation in order to retrieve the actual value if such scaling is done. By default a = 1 and b = 0, so no scaling is
done if these values are left at their defaults. Examples of when scaling is appropriate are as follows:
If the measured value contains decimals and it is important to preserve the resolution. Since the format for transmitting
the measurand does not permit decimals, a factor a>1 can be applied before transmission. For example, a frequency
F=59.9Hz can be transmitted as Ft = 10 * F = 10 * 59.9 = 599. In this case a = 10, b = 0. The master receives 599 and
has to divide by 10 to retrieve the real value 59.9.
If the measured value is larger than what fits in the format defined in IEC103. The format defined in the standard allows
for signed integers up to 4095. By offsetting, unsigned integers up to 4096 + 4095 = 8191 are supported. Scaling using
factors <1 can be required in such cases. The calculation is outlined in the IEC60870-5-103 appendix. Two examples
follow, where you decide factors a and b.
Example 1: Nominal power Pn = 100MW = 100000KW (power is transmitted in KW)
Since P can be both positive and negative:
Transmitted power Pt = (4095/(Pn*2.4)) * P = (4095/(100000 * 2.4) ) * P
= 0.017 * P
a = 0.017
b=0
Pt = 0.017 * P
For a max power 100000KW * 2.4 = 240000KW, we transmit
Pt = 0.017 * 240000 = 4080
A value above 240 MW is indicated by overflow.
Example 2: Nominal voltage Vn = 500000V
Since RMS voltage V can be only positive:
Transmitted voltage Vt = (8191/(Vn*2.4)) * V - 4096 =
= (8191/(500000 * 2.4) ) * V - 4096 = 0.0068 * V - 4096
5-58
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a = 0.0068
Since the step is in increments of 0.001, we round it at:
a = 0.006
b = -4096
Vt = 0.006 * V - 4096
For max voltage 500000V * 2.4 = 1200000V, we transmit
Vt = 0.006 * 1200000 - 4096 = 7200 - 4096 = 3104
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC60870-5-103 IEC103 COMMANDS
IEC103 COMMANDS
MESSAGE
COMMAND 0
COMMAND 1
COMMAND 31
COMMAND 0 FUN:
0
MESSAGE
COMMAND 0 INF:
0
COMMAND 0 ON:
Off
MESSAGE
COMMAND 0 OFF:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
COMMAND 0
COMMAND 31 FUN:
0
COMMAND 31 INF:
0
MESSAGE
COMMAND 31 ON:
Off
MESSAGE
COMMAND 31 OFF:
Off
MESSAGE
COMMAND 31
Commands are received as General Command (Type Identification 20). The user can configure which action to perform
when an ASDU command comes.
A list of available mappings is provided on the C30. This includes 64 virtual inputs (see the following table). The ON and
OFF for the same ASDU command can be mapped to different virtual inputs.
Each command is identified by the unique combination made by the function type (FUN), and information number (INF). If
the master sends an ASDU command that does not have the FUN and INF of any configured command, the relay rejects it.
Table 57: COMMANDS MAPPING TABLE
DESCRIPTION
Off
GE Multilin
VALUE
0
5-59
5 SETTINGS
VALUE
1
2
64
ADDRESS
VALUE:
1:
0
MESSAGE
ADDRESS
VALUE:
2:
0
MESSAGE
ADDRESS
VALUE:
3:
0
MESSAGE
ADDRESS 256:
VALUE:
0
The Modbus user map provides read-only access for up to 256 registers. To obtain a memory map value, enter the desired
address in the ADDRESS line (converted from hex to decimal format). The corresponding value displays in the VALUE line. A
value of 0 in subsequent register ADDRESS lines automatically returns values for the previous ADDRESS lines incremented
by 1. An address value of 0 in the initial register means none and values of 0 display for all registers. Different
ADDRESS values can be entered as required in any of the register positions.
5.2.6 REAL TIME CLOCK
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP REAL TIME CLOCK
SYNCRONIZING SOURCE:
None
MESSAGE
Range:Enabled, Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PRECISION TIME
PROTOCOL (1588)
See below
MESSAGE
SNTP PROTOCOL
See below
MESSAGE
LOCAL TIME
See below
REAL TIME
CLOCK
The relay contains a real time clock (RTC) to create timestamps for communications protocols as well as for historical data,
such as event records and oscillography. When the relay restarts, the RTC initializes from an onboard battery-backed
clock, which has the same accuracy as an electronic watch, approximately 1 minute per month (~23 ppm). Once the RTC
is synchronized with the Precision Time Protocol (PTP), IRIG-B, or SNTP, its accuracy approaches that of the synchronizing time delivered to the relay.
The SYNCHRONIZING SOURCE setting configures the priority sequence of the time synchronization source, to determine
which of the available external time sources to use for time synchronization. A setting of None causes the RTC and the synchrophasor clock to free-run. A setting of PP/IRIG-B/PTP/SNTP, IRIG-B/PP/PTP/SNTP, or PP/PTP/IRIG-B/SNTP causes
the relay to track the first source named that is enabled and operational, or free-run if none of these are available. Here, PP
5-60
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
means a time source that is strictly compliant with PP, and PTP means a time source that is not strictly compliant with PP.
When a time source fails or recovers, the relay automatically transfers synchronization as required by this setting.
SCADA protocols, such as IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104, Modbus, and DNP, are low accuracy time synchronization
methods. If none of the higher accuracy methods (IRIG-B, PTP, SNTP) is active, the C30 updates its clock when one of the
SCADA time synchronizations is done.
The UR clock is updated by all sources active in the device, including IEC 60870-5-103. This means that whenever a time
synchronization message is received through any of the active protocols, the UR clock updates. However, given that IEC
60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104, Modbus, and DNP are low accuracy time synchronization methods, their impact is insignificant when better accuracy time protocols, such as IRIG-B, PTP, and SNTP, are active in the system.
See the COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME menu section of this manual to manually set the RTC.
The REAL TIME CLOCK EVENTS setting allows changes to the date and/or time to be captured in the event record. The event
records the RTC time before the adjustment.
To enable IRIG-B synchronization, the input IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE must be set to DC Shift or Amplitude Modulated. IRIG-B
synchronization can be disabled by making this setting None.
To configure and enable PTP and/or SNTP, or to set local time parameters (for example time zone, daylight savings), use
the following sections.
b) PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (1588)
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP REAL TIME CLOCK PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (1588)
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 255
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 7
PTP VLAN ID
0
Range: 0 to 4095
PRECISION TIME
PROTOCOL (1588)
MESSAGE
PTP PORT 1
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP REAL TIME CLOCK PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (1588) PTP PORT 1(3)
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The UR supports the Precision Time Protocol (PTP) specified in IEEE Std 1588 2008 using the Power Profile (PP) specified
in IEEE Std C37.238 2011. This enables the relay to synchronize to the international time standard over an Ethernet network that implements PP.
The relay can be configured to operate on some PTP networks that are not strictly PP. Time accuracy can be less than
specified for a PP network. Tolerated deviations from strict PP include 1) missing declaration of PP compliance in the messages, 2) connection to a network device that does not support the PTP peer delay mechanism, 3) jitter substantially
greater than 1 s in received event messages, and 4) certain non-compliant announce and sync message update rates.
The relay implements PTP according to IEEE Std 1588 2008 and the equivalent IEC 61588:2009(E), sometimes
referred to as version 2 PTP. It does not support the previous version of the standard (version 1).
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-61
5 SETTINGS
PTP is a protocol that allows multiple clocks in a network to synchronize with one another. It permits synchronization accuracies better than 1 ns, but this requires each and every component in the network achieve very high levels of accuracy and
a very high baud rate, faster than normally used for relay communications. When operating over a generic Ethernet network, time error may amount to 1 ms or more. PP is a profile of PTP which specifies a limited subset of PTP suitable for use
in power system protection, control, automation and data communication applications, and thereby facilitates interoperability between different vendors clocks and switches. PP specifies a worst-case delivered time error of less than 1 s over a
16-hop network.
In a PTP system and in a PP system, the clocks automatically organize themselves into a master-slave synchronization
hierarchy with the best clock available making itself the "grandmaster" at the top of the hierarchy; all others make themselves slaves and track the grandmaster. Typically the grandmaster clock receives its time from GPS satellites or some
other link to the international time standard. If the grandmaster fails, the next best clock available in the domain assumes
the grandmaster role. Should a clock on starting up discover it is better that the present grandmaster, it assumes the
grandmaster role and the previous grandmaster reverts to slave.
Time messages issued by the grandmaster are delayed as they pass through the network both due to the finite speed of
the signal in the interconnecting fiber or wire. Each clock and switch implementing PP measures the propagation delay to
each of its PP neighbors, and compensates for these delays in the time received. Each network device implementing PP
measures the processing delay it introduces in each time message and compensates for this delay in the time it transmits.
As a result, the time delivered to end-devices such as the UR are virtually identical to the grandmaster time. Should one of
the network devices in the hierarchy not fully implement PP, the associated propagation delay and/or latency may not be
compensated for, and the time received at the end-device could be in error by more than 100 s.
See the Settings > Product Setup > Real Time Clock section of this manual for a description of when time values
received via PTP are used to update the relays real time clock.
The following settings are available for configuring the relay for PTP.
Power profile (IEEE Std C37.238 2011) requires that the relay only select as a grandmaster power profile compliant
clocks, that the delivered time have worst-case error of 1 s, and that the peer delay mechanism be implemented.
With the strict power profile setting enabled, the relay will only select as master clocks displaying the IEEE_C37_238
identification codes. It will use a port only when the peer delay mechanism is operational. With the strict power profile
setting disabled, the relay will use clocks without the power profile identification when no power profile clocks are present, and will use ports even if the peer delay mechanism is non-operational.
This setting should be set to the domain number of the grandmaster-capable clock(s) to be synchronized to. A network may support multiple time distribution domains, each distinguished with a unique domain number. More commonly, there is a single domain using the default domain number zero.
This setting selects the value of the priority field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in request messages issued by the relays
peer delay mechanism. In compliance with PP the default VLAN priority is 4, but it is recommended that in accordance
with PTP it be set to 7.
Depending on the characteristics of the device to which the relay is directly linked, VLAN Priority may have no effect.
PTP VLAN ID
This setting selects the value of the ID field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in request messages issued by the relays peer
delay mechanism. It is provided in compliance with PP. As these messages have a destination address that indicates
they are not to be bridged, their VLAN ID serves no function, and so may be left at its default value.
Depending on the characteristics of the device to which the relay is directly linked, VLAN ID may have no effect.
5-62
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
While this port setting is selected to disabled, PTP is disabled on this port. The relay does not generate or listen to
PTP messages on this port.
The time delivered by PTP is advanced by the time value in this setting prior to the time being used to synchronize the
relays real time clock. This is to compensate to the extent practical for time delivery delays not compensated for in the
network. In a fully compliant PP network, the peer delay and the processing delay mechanisms compensate for all the
delays between the grandmaster and the relay. In such networks, this setting should be zero.
In networks containing one or more switches and/or clocks that do not implement both of these mechanisms, not all
delays are compensated, so the time of message arrival at the relay will be later than the time indicated in the message. This setting can be used to approximately compensate for this delay. However, as the relay is not aware of network switching that dynamically changes the amount of uncompensated delay, there is no setting that will always
completely correct for uncompensated delay. A setting can be chosen that will reduce worst-case error to half of the
range between minimum and maximum uncompensated delay, if these values are known.
This setting corresponds to delayAsymmetry in PTP, which is used by the peer delay mechanism to compensate for
any difference in the propagation delay between the two directions of a link. Except in unusual cases, the two fibers are
of essentially identical length and composition, so this setting should be set to zero.
In unusual cases where the length of the link is different in different directions, this setting should be set to the number
of nanoseconds the Ethernet propagation delay to the relay is longer than the mean of path propagation delays to and
from the relay. For instance, if it is known say from the physical length of the fibers and the propagation speed in the
fibers that the delay from the relay to the Ethernet switch it is connected to is 9 000 ns and the that the delay from the
switch to the relay is 11 000 ns, then the mean delay is 10 000 ns, and the path delay asymmetry is 11000 - 10000 =
+1000 ns.
c) SNTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP REAL TIME CLOCK SNTP PROTOCOL
SNTP FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SNTP PROTOCOL
The C30 supports the Simple Network Time Protocol specified in RFC-2030. With SNTP, the C30 can obtain clock time
over an Ethernet network. The C30 acts as an SNTP client to receive time values from an SNTP/NTP server, usually a dedicated product using a GPS receiver to provide an accurate time. Unicast SNTP is supported. The UR-series relays do not
support the broadcast, multicast or anycast SNTP functionality.
The SNTP FUNCTION setting enables or disabled the SNTP feature on the C30.
To use SNTP, SNTP SERVER IP ADDR must be set to the SNTP/NTP server IP address. Once this address is set and SNTP
FUNCTION is Enabled, the C30 attempts to obtain time values from the SNTP/NTP server. Since many time values are
obtained and averaged, it generally takes three to four minutes until the C30 clock is closely synchronized with the SNTP/
NTP server. It takes up to two minutes for the C30 to signal an SNTP self-test error if the server is offline.
The SNTP UDP PORT NUMBER is 123 for normal SNTP operation. If SNTP is not required, close the port by setting it to 0.
When the SNTP UDP PORT NUMBER is set to 0, the change takes effect when the C30 is restarted.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-63
5 SETTINGS
d) LOCAL TIME
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP REAL TIME CLOCK LOCAL TIME
MESSAGE
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS
TIME: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 23
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 23
LOCAL TIME
The UR device maintains two times: local time and Universal Coordinated Time (UTC). Local time can be provided by IRIGB signals. UTC time is provided by SNTP servers.
The real-time clock (RTC) and communication protocol times are not correct unless Local Time is configured for the current
location. When the RTC is synchronized with IRIG-B, Local Time must be configured for the current location or else the
timestamps may not be accurate. Furthermore, times reported in historical records and communication protocols may be
incorrect if the Local Time setting is not configured properly.
The LOCAL TIME OFFSET FROM UTC setting is used to specify the local time zone offset from UTC (Greenwich Mean Time) in
hours. Time zones in the eastern hemisphere have positive values; time zones in the western hemisphere have negative
values. A value of zero causes the relay to use UTC for local time. This setting has two uses. When the system RTC is synchronized with a communications protocol providing only local time or it is free-running, the offset setting is used to calculate UTC from the local time these provide. When the RTC is synchronized with a communications protocol providing only
UTC (such as PTP or SNTP), the time offset setting is used to determine local time from the UTC provided. PTP
ALTERNATE_TIME_OFFSET_INDICATOR TLVs are not used to calculate local time. When a communications protocol
other than PTP provides UTC to local time offset (meaning IRIG-B), that offset is used instead of the local time and daylight
time settings.
The DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME (DST) settings can be used to allow the relay to follow the DST rules of the local time zone.
Note that when IRIG-B time synchronization is active, the local time in the IRIG-B signal contains any daylight savings time
offset and so the DST settings are ignored.
5-64
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY
NUMBER OF RECORDS:
15
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
TRIGGER MODE:
Automatic Overwrite
MESSAGE
TRIGGER POSITION:
50%
MESSAGE
TRIGGER SOURCE:
Off
MESSAGE
AC INPUT WAVEFORMS:
16 samples/cycle
MESSAGE
DIGITAL CHANNELS
MESSAGE
ANALOG CHANNELS
OSCILLOGRAPHY
Oscillography records contain waveforms captured at the sampling rate as well as other relay data at the point of trigger.
Oscillography records are triggered by a programmable FlexLogic operand. Multiple oscillography records may be captured
simultaneously.
The NUMBER OF RECORDS is selectable, but the number of cycles captured in a single record varies considerably based on
other factors such as sample rate and the number of operational modules. There is a fixed amount of data storage for oscillography; the more data captured, the less the number of cycles captured per record. See the ACTUAL VALUES
RECORDS OSCILLOGRAPHY menu to view the number of cycles captured per record. The following table provides sample configurations with corresponding cycles/record. The minimum number of oscillographic records is three.
Table 58: OSCILLOGRAPHY CYCLES/RECORD EXAMPLE
RECORDS
CT/VTS
SAMPLE
RATE
DIGITALS
ANALOGS
CYCLES/
RECORD
14663
16
16
6945
16
16
3472
16
16
2868
16
16
1691
16
63
16
1221
32
63
16
749
64
63
16
422
32
64
63
16
124
A new record may automatically overwrite an older record if TRIGGER MODE is set to Automatic Overwrite.
Set the TRIGGER POSITION to a percentage of the total buffer size (for example, 10%, 50%, 75%, etc.). A trigger position of
25% consists of 25% pre- and 75% post-trigger data. The TRIGGER SOURCE is always captured in oscillography and may be
any FlexLogic parameter (element state, contact input, virtual output, etc.). The relay sampling rate is 64 samples per cycle.
The AC INPUT WAVEFORMS setting determines the sampling rate at which AC input signals (that is, current and voltage) are
stored. Reducing the sampling rate allows longer records to be stored. This setting has no effect on the internal sampling
rate of the relay which is always 64 samples per cycle; that is, it has no effect on the fundamental calculations of the device.
When changes are made to the oscillography settings, all existing oscillography records will be CLEARED.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-65
5 SETTINGS
b) DIGITAL CHANNELS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY DIGITAL CHANNELS
DIGITAL CHANNEL
Off
1:
MESSAGE
DIGITAL CHANNEL
Off
2:
MESSAGE
DIGITAL CHANNEL
Off
3:
DIGITAL CHANNELS
MESSAGE
A DIGITAL 1(63) CHANNEL setting selects the FlexLogic operand state recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of each
oscillography trace depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to Off are ignored. Upon
startup, the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list.
c) ANALOG CHANNELS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY ANALOG CHANNELS
ANALOG CHANNEL
Off
1:
MESSAGE
ANALOG CHANNEL
Off
2:
MESSAGE
ANALOG CHANNEL
Off
3:
ANALOG CHANNELS
MESSAGE
These settings select the metering actual value recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of each oscillography trace
depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to Off are ignored. The parameters available
in a given relay are dependent on:
Upon startup, the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value
parameters is presented in Appendix A: FlexAnalog parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is
used to expedite the selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list
of parameters via the relay keypad and display - entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding
parameter to be displayed.
All eight CT/VT module channels are stored in the oscillography file. The CT/VT module channels are named as follows:
<slot_letter><terminal_number><I or V><phase A, B, or C, or 4th input>
The fourth current input in a bank is called IG, and the fourth voltage input in a bank is called VX. For example, F2-IB designates the IB signal on terminal 2 of the CT/VT module in slot F.
If there are no CT/VT modules and analog input modules, no analog traces will appear in the file; only the digital traces will
appear.
5-66
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
1:
MESSAGE
2:
MESSAGE
3:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DATA LOGGER
The data logger samples and records up to 16 analog parameters at a user-defined sampling rate. This recorded data may
be downloaded to EnerVista UR Setup and displayed with parameters on the vertical axis and time on the horizontal axis.
All data is stored in non-volatile memory, meaning that the information is retained when power to the relay is lost.
For a fixed sampling rate, the data logger can be configured with a few channels over a long period or a larger number of
channels for a shorter period. The relay automatically partitions the available memory between the channels in use. Example storage capacities for a system frequency of 60 Hz are shown in the following table.
Table 59: DATA LOGGER STORAGE CAPACITY EXAMPLE
SAMPLING RATE
CHANNELS
DAYS
STORAGE CAPACITY
15 ms
0.1
954 s
0.1
120 s
0.1
107 s
16
0.1
60 s
0.7
65457 s
0.1
8182 s
0.1
7273 s
16
0.1
4091 s
45.4
3927420 s
5.6
490920 s
436380 s
16
2.8
254460 s
2727.5
235645200 s
340.9
29455200 s
303
26182800 s
1000 ms
60000 ms
3600000 ms
Changing any setting affecting data logger operation will clear any data that is currently in the log.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-67
5 SETTINGS
DATA LOGGER MODE: This setting configures the mode in which the data logger will operate. When set to Continuous, the data logger will actively record any configured channels at the rate as defined by the DATA LOGGER RATE. The
data logger will be idle in this mode if no channels are configured. When set to Trigger, the data logger will begin to
record any configured channels at the instance of the rising edge of the DATA LOGGER TRIGGER source FlexLogic operand. The data logger will ignore all subsequent triggers and will continue to record data until the active record is full.
Once the data logger is full a CLEAR DATA LOGGER command is required to clear the data logger record before a new
record can be started. Performing the CLEAR DATA LOGGER command will also stop the current record and reset the
data logger to be ready for the next trigger.
DATA LOGGER TRIGGER: This setting selects the signal used to trigger the start of a new data logger record. Any
FlexLogic operand can be used as the trigger source. The DATA LOGGER TRIGGER setting only applies when the mode
is set to Trigger.
DATA LOGGER RATE: This setting selects the time interval at which the actual value data will be recorded.
DATA LOGGER CHNL 1(16): This setting selects the metering actual value that is to be recorded in Channel 1(16) of
the data log. The parameters available in a given relay are dependent on: the type of relay, the type and number of CT/
VT hardware modules installed, and the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup,
the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is
shown in Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to
expedite the selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list of
parameters via the relay keypad/display entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding
parameter to be displayed.
DATA LOGGER CONFIG: This display presents the total amount of time the Data Logger can record the channels not
selected to Off without over-writing old data.
5.2.9 USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LEDS
LED TEST
See below
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED1
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED2
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED48
b) LED TEST
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST
LED TEST
MESSAGE
When enabled, the LED test can be initiated from any digital input or user-programmable condition such as user-programmable pushbutton. The control operand is configured under the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The test covers all LEDs,
including the LEDs of the optional user-programmable pushbuttons.
The test consists of three stages.
5-68
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
1.
All 62 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is burned. This stage lasts as
long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of 1 minute. After 1 minute, the test will end.
2.
All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on for 1 second, then back off. The test routine starts at
the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom of each LED column. This test checks for hardware failures that lead
to more than one LED being turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
3.
All the LEDs are turned on. One LED at a time turns off for 1 second, then back on. The test routine starts at the top left
panel moving from top to bottom of each column of the LEDs. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to more
than one LED being turned off from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
When testing is in progress, the LEDs are controlled by the test sequence, rather than the protection, control, and monitoring features. However, the LED control mechanism accepts all the changes to LED states generated by the relay and
stores the actual LED states (on or off) in memory. When the test completes, the LEDs reflect the actual state resulting from
relay response during testing. The reset pushbutton will not clear any targets when the LED Test is in progress.
A dedicated FlexLogic operand, LED TEST IN PROGRESS, is set for the duration of the test. When the test sequence is initiated, the LED TEST INITIATED event is stored in the event recorder.
The entire test procedure is user-controlled. In particular, stage 1 can last as long as necessary, and stages 2 and 3 can be
interrupted. The test responds to the position and rising edges of the control input defined by the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The control pulses must last at least 250 ms to take effect. The following diagram explains how the test is executed.
READY TO TEST
Reset the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand
Set the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand
control input is on
STAGE 1
(all LEDs on)
time-out
(1 minute)
STAGE 2
(one LED on at a time)
Wait 1 second
STAGE 3
(one LED off at a time)
rising edge
of the control
input
842011A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-69
5 SETTINGS
Configure the LED test to recognize user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST menu:
LED TEST FUNCTION: Enabled
LED TEST CONTROL: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
The test will be initiated when the user-programmable pushbutton 1 is pressed. The pushbutton should remain pressed for
as long as the LEDs are being visually inspected. When finished, the pushbutton should be released. The relay will then
automatically start stage 2. At this point forward, test may be aborted by pressing the pushbutton.
APPLICATION EXAMPLE 2:
Assume one needs to check if any LEDs are burned as well as exercise one LED at a time to check for other failures. This
is to be performed via user-programmable pushbutton 1.
After applying the settings in application example 1, hold down the pushbutton as long as necessary to test all LEDs. Next,
release the pushbutton to automatically start stage 2. Once stage 2 has started, the pushbutton can be released. When
stage 2 is completed, stage 3 will automatically start. The test may be aborted at any time by pressing the pushbutton.
c) TRIP AND ALARM LEDS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS TRIP & ALARM LEDS
MESSAGE
The trip and alarm LEDs are in the first LED column (enhanced faceplate) and on LED panel 1 (standard faceplate). Each
indicator can be programmed to become illuminated when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.
d) USER-PROGRAMMABLE LED 1(48)
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS USER-PROGRAMMABLE LED 1(48)
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
LED 1
MESSAGE
LED 1 OPERAND:
Off
LED 1 TYPE:
Self-Reset
There are 48 amber LEDs across the relay faceplate LED panels. Each of these indicators can be programmed to illuminate when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.
For the standard faceplate, the LEDs are located as follows.
See the LED Indicators section in chapter 4 for information on the location of these indexed LEDs.
The user-programmable LED settings select the FlexLogic operands that control the LEDs. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is SelfReset (the default setting), the LED illumination will track the state of the selected LED operand. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is
Latched, the LED, once lit, remains so until reset by the faceplate RESET button, from a remote device via a communications channel, or from any programmed operand, even if the LED operand state de-asserts.
5-70
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PARAMETER
SETTING
PARAMETER
LED 1 operand
Off
LED 13 operand
Off
LED 2 operand
Off
LED 14 operand
Off
LED 3 operand
Off
LED 15 operand
Off
LED 4 operand
Off
LED 16 operand
Off
LED 5 operand
Off
LED 17 operand
Off
LED 6 operand
Off
LED 18 operand
Off
LED 7 operand
Off
LED 19 operand
Off
LED 8 operand
Off
LED 20 operand
Off
LED 9 operand
Off
LED 21 operand
Off
LED 10 operand
Off
LED 22 operand
Off
LED 11 operand
Off
LED 23 operand
Off
LED 12 operand
Off
LED 24 operand
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BATTERY FAIL
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
SNTP FAIL
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
IRIG-B FAIL
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
PTP FAIL
FUNCTION: Enabled
MESSAGE
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
SELF TESTS
All major self-test alarms are reported automatically with their corresponding FlexLogic operands, events, and targets. Most
of the minor alarms can be disabled if desired.
GE Multilin
5-71
5 SETTINGS
When in the Disabled mode, minor alarms do not assert a FlexLogic operand, write to the event recorder, or display target
messages. Moreover, they do not trigger the ANY MINOR ALARM or ANY SELF-TEST messages. When in Enabled mode,
minor alarms continue to function along with other major and minor alarms. See the Relay Self-tests section in chapter 7 for
information on major and minor self-test alarms.
5-72
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTON 1
MESSAGE
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON 1
EVENTS: Disabled
There are three standard control pushbuttons, labeled USER 1, USER 2, and USER 3, on the standard and enhanced front
panels. These are user-programmable and can be used for various applications such as performing an LED test, switching
setting groups, and invoking and scrolling though user-programmable displays.
The location of the control pushbuttons are shown in the following figures.
Control pushbuttons
842813A1.CDR
EVENT CAUSE
IN SERVICE
VOLTAGE
TROUBLE
CURRENT
TEST MODE
FREQUENCY
TRIP
OTHER
ALARM
PHASE A
PICKUP
PHASE B
RESET
USER 1
USER 2
PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND
USER 3
THREE
STANDARD
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
USER 4
USER 5
USER 6
USER 7
FOUR EXTRA
OPTIONAL
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
842733A2.CDR
GE Multilin
5-73
5 SETTINGS
When applicable
SETTING
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON
1 FUNCTION:
Enabled=1
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP/
BREAKERS/BREAKER 1/
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
Enabled=1
SYSTEM SETUP/
BREAKERS/BREAKER 2/
BREAKER 2 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
AND
RUN
OFF
ON
TIMER
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
100 msec
CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON
842010A2.CDR
Enabled=1
PUSHBUTTON 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT:
PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT:
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 HOLD:
0.0 s
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 SET:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST:
Disabled
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST
DELAY: 1.0 s
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL:
Off
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT
TIME: 0.00 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE:
Disabled
MESSAGE
PUSHBUTTON 1
EVENTS: Disabled
USER PUSHBUTTON 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
5-74
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The optional user-programmable pushbuttons (specified in the order code) provide an easy and error-free method of entering digital state (on, off) information. The number of available pushbuttons is dependent on the faceplate module ordered
with the relay.
The digital state can be entered locally (by directly pressing the front panel pushbutton) or remotely (via FlexLogic operands) into FlexLogic equations, protection elements, and control elements. Typical applications include breaker control,
autorecloser blocking, and setting groups changes. The user-programmable pushbuttons are under the control level of
password protection.
The user-configurable pushbuttons for the enhanced faceplate are shown below.
USER
LABEL 1
USER
LABEL 2
USER
LABEL 3
USER
LABEL 4
USER
LABEL 5
USER
LABEL 6
USER
LABEL 7
USER
LABEL 8
USER
LABEL 9
USER
LABEL 10
USER
LABEL 11
USER
LABEL 12
USER
LABEL 13
USER
LABEL 14
USER
LABEL 15
USER
LABEL 16
842814A1.CDR
11
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
10
12
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
USER LABEL
842779A1.CDR
Latched mode: In latched mode, a pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting or by directly pressing the associated front panel pushbutton. The pushbutton maintains the set state
until deactivated by the reset command or after a user-specified time delay. The state of each pushbutton is stored in
non-volatile memory and maintained through a loss of control power.
The pushbutton is reset (deactivated) in latched mode by asserting the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 RESET setting or by directly pressing the associated active front panel pushbutton.
GE Multilin
5-75
5 SETTINGS
It can also be programmed to reset automatically through the PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST and PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY settings. These settings enable the autoreset timer and specify the associated time delay. The autoreset timer can be
used in select-before-operate (SBO) breaker control applications, where the command type (close/open) or breaker
location (feeder number) must be selected prior to command execution. The selection must reset automatically if control is not executed within a specified time period.
Self-reset mode: In self-reset mode, a pushbutton will remain active for the time it is pressed (the pulse duration) plus
the dropout time specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME setting. If the pushbutton is activated via FlexLogic, the
pulse duration is specified by the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME only. The time the operand remains assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting has no effect on the pulse duration.
The pushbutton is reset (deactivated) in self-reset mode when the dropout delay specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT
setting expires.
TIME
NOTE
The pulse duration of the remote set, remote reset, or local pushbutton must be at least 50 ms to operate the pushbutton. This allows the user-programmable pushbuttons to properly operate during power cycling events and various system disturbances that may cause transient assertion of the operating signals.
The local and remote operation of each user-programmable pushbutton can be inhibited through the PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL and
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE settings, respectively. If local locking is applied, the pushbutton will ignore set and reset commands
executed through the front panel pushbuttons. If remote locking is applied, the pushbutton will ignore set and reset commands executed through FlexLogic operands.
The locking functions are not applied to the autorestart feature. In this case, the inhibit function can be used in SBO control
operations to prevent the pushbutton function from being activated and ensuring one-at-a-time select operation.
The locking functions can also be used to prevent the accidental pressing of the front panel pushbuttons. The separate
inhibit of the local and remote operation simplifies the implementation of local/remote control supervision.
Pushbutton states can be logged by the event recorder and displayed as target messages. In latched mode, user-defined
messages can also be associated with each pushbutton and displayed when the pushbutton is on or changing to off.
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: This setting selects the characteristic of the pushbutton. If set to Disabled, the pushbutton is not active and the corresponding FlexLogic operands (both On and Off) are de-asserted. If set to SelfReset, the control logic is activated by the pulse (longer than 100 ms) issued when the pushbutton is being physically
pressed or virtually pressed via a FlexLogic operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting.
When in Self-Reset mode and activated locally, the pushbutton control logic asserts the On corresponding FlexLogic operand as long as the pushbutton is being physically pressed, and after being released the deactivation of the
operand is delayed by the drop out timer. The Off operand is asserted when the pushbutton element is deactivated. If
the pushbutton is activated remotely, the control logic of the pushbutton asserts the corresponding On FlexLogic
operand only for the time period specified by the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME setting.
If set to Latched, the control logic alternates the state of the corresponding FlexLogic operand between On and Off
on each button press or by virtually activating the pushbutton (assigning set and reset operands). When in the
Latched mode, the states of the FlexLogic operands are stored in a non-volatile memory. Should the power supply be
lost, the correct state of the pushbutton is retained upon subsequent power up of the relay.
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT: This setting specifies the top 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
intended to provide ID information of the pushbutton. See the User-definable Displays section for instructions on how
to enter alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is in the on position. See the User-definable Displays section for instructions on
entering alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is activated from the on to the off position and the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is
Latched. This message is not displayed when the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is Self-reset as the pushbutton operand
status is implied to be Off upon its release. The length of the Off message is configured with the PRODUCT SETUP
DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
PUSHBTN 1 HOLD: This setting specifies the time required for a pushbutton to be pressed before it is deemed active.
This timer is reset upon release of the pushbutton. Note that any pushbutton operation will require the pushbutton to be
pressed a minimum of 50 ms. This minimum time is required prior to activating the pushbutton hold timer.
5-76
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PUSHBTN 1 SET: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to operate the pushbutton element and to assert
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand. The duration of the incoming set signal must be at least 100 ms.
PUSHBTN 1 RESET: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to reset pushbutton element and to assert
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF operand. This setting is applicable only if pushbutton is in latched mode. The duration of the
incoming reset signal must be at least 50 ms.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST: This setting enables the user-programmable pushbutton autoreset feature. This setting is
applicable only if the pushbutton is in the Latched mode.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY: This setting specifies the time delay for automatic reset of the pushbutton when in
the latched mode.
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit pushbutton operation from the
operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET or PUSHBTN 1 RESET settings.
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit pushbutton operation from the front
panel pushbuttons. This locking functionality is not applicable to pushbutton autoreset.
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: This setting applies only to Self-Reset mode and specifies the duration of the pushbutton active status after the pushbutton has been released. When activated remotely, this setting specifies the entire
activation time of the pushbutton status; the length of time the operand remains on has no effect on the pulse duration.
This setting is required to set the duration of the pushbutton operating pulse.
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to drive pushbutton LED. If this setting is
Off, then LED operation is directly linked to PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand.
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE: If pushbutton message is set to High Priority, the message programmed in the PUSHBTN 1
and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT settings will be displayed undisturbed as long as PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand is asserted.
The high priority option is not applicable to the PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT setting.
ID
This message can be temporary removed if any front panel keypad button is pressed. However, ten seconds of keypad
inactivity will restore the message if the PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand is still active.
If the PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE is set to Normal, the message programmed in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT
settings will be displayed as long as PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand is asserted, but not longer than time period specified
by FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. After the flash time is expired, the default message or other active target message is
displayed. The instantaneous reset of the flash message will be executed if any relay front panel button is pressed or
any new target or message becomes active.
The PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT setting is linked to PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF operand and will be displayed in
PUSHBTN 1 ID only if pushbutton element is in the Latched mode. The PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT message
as Normal if the PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE setting is High Priority or Normal.
conjunction with
will be displayed
PUSHBUTTON 1 EVENTS: If this setting is enabled, each pushbutton state change will be logged as an event into
event recorder.
GE Multilin
5-77
5 SETTINGS
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
SETTING
Function
LATCHED
= Enabled
= Latched
OR
= Self-Reset
LATCHED/SELF-RESET
To user-programmable
pushbuttons logic
sheet 2, 842024A2
SETTING
Local Lock
Off = 0
Non-volatile latch
AND
TIMER
50 ms
SETTING
Remote Lock
Latch
R
AND
Off = 0
SETTING
OR
TIMER
50 ms
Hold
TPKP
0
0
OR
SETTING
Set
AND
Off = 0
OR
OR
SETTING
Reset
PUSHBUTTON ON
To user-programmable
pushbuttons logic
sheet 2, 842024A2
AND
Off = 0
AND
SETTING
Autoreset Function
= Enabled
= Disabled
SETTING
Autoreset Delay
TPKP
AND
0
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
SETTING
Drop-Out Timer
0
TIMER
200 ms
OR
TRST
842021A3.CDR
AND
5-78
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
LCD MESSAGE
ENGAGE MESSAGE
SETTING
Flash Message Time
LATCHED
SETTINGS
Top Text
0
AND
OR
= XXXXXXXXXX
TRST
On Text
= XXXXXXXXXX
Instantaneous
reset *
From user-programmable
pushbuttons logic
sheet 1, 842021A3
LATCHED/SELF-RESET
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
PUSHBUTTON ON
SETTING
Message Priority
LCD MESSAGE
ENGAGE MESSAGE
AND
= Disabled
= High Priority
SETTINGS
Top Text
= Normal
= XXXXXXXXXX
OR
On Text
SETTING
Flash Message Time
= XXXXXXXXXX
0
AND
TRST
Instantaneous
reset *
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
PUSHBUTTON 2 ON
PUSHBUTTON 3 ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
Pushbutton 1
LED
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
ANY PB ON
SETTING
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL
= any FlexLogic operand
Pushbutton 1
LED
PUSHBUTTON 16 ON
The enhanced front panel has 16 operands;
the standard front panel has 12
842024A2.CDR
NOTE
PARAMETER
Off
1:
MESSAGE
PARAMETER
Off
2:
MESSAGE
PARAMETER
Off
3:
PARAMETER 256:
Off
FLEX STATE
PARAMETERS
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
5-79
5 SETTINGS
This feature provides a mechanism where any of 256 selected FlexLogic operand states can be used for efficient monitoring. The feature allows user-customized access to the FlexLogic operand states in the relay. The state bits are packed so
that 16 states may be read out in a single Modbus register. The state bits can be configured so that all of the states which
are of interest to the user are available in a minimum number of Modbus registers.
The state bits may be read out in the Flex States register array beginning at Modbus address 0900h. Sixteen states are
packed into each register, with the lowest-numbered state in the lowest-order bit. There are sixteen registers to accommodate the 256 state bits.
5.2.14 USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
MESSAGE
USER DISPLAY
MESSAGE
USER DISPLAY
MESSAGE
USER DISPLAY
USER DISPLAY 16
USER-DEFINABLE
DISPLAYS
MESSAGE
This menu provides a mechanism for manually creating up to 16 user-defined information displays in a convenient viewing
sequence in the USER DISPLAYS menu (between the TARGETS and ACTUAL VALUES top-level menus). The sub-menus facilitate text entry and Modbus register data pointer options for defining the user display content.
Once programmed, the user-definable displays can be viewed in two ways.
KEYPAD: Use the MENU key to select the USER DISPLAYS menu item to access the first user-definable display (note
that only the programmed screens are displayed). The screens can be scrolled using the UP and DOWN keys. The
display disappears after the default message time-out period specified by the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE CONTROL INPUT: The user-definable displays also respond to the INVOKE AND SCROLL
setting. Any FlexLogic operand (in particular, the user-programmable pushbutton operands), can be used to navigate
the programmed displays.
On the rising edge of the configured operand (such as when the pushbutton is pressed), the displays are invoked by
showing the last user-definable display shown during the previous activity. From this moment onward, the operand
acts exactly as the down key and allows scrolling through the configured displays. The last display wraps up to the first
one. The INVOKE AND SCROLL input and the DOWN key operate concurrently.
When the default timer expires (set by the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting), the relay will start to cycle through the
user displays. The next activity of the INVOKE AND SCROLL input stops the cycling at the currently displayed user display, not at the first user-defined display. The INVOKE AND SCROLL pulses must last for at least 250 ms to take effect.
5-80
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 1
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 2
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 3
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 4
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 5:
0
USER DISPLAY 1
MESSAGE
Any existing system display can be automatically copied into an available user display by selecting the existing display and
pressing the ENTER key. The display will then prompt ADD TO USER DISPLAY LIST?. After selecting Yes, a message indicates that the selected display has been added to the user display list. When this type of entry occurs, the sub-menus are
automatically configured with the proper content this content may subsequently be edited.
This menu is used to enter user-defined text and user-selected Modbus-registered data fields into the particular user display. Each user display consists of two 20-character lines (top and bottom). The tilde (~) character is used to mark the start
of a data field the length of the data field needs to be accounted for. Up to five separate data fields can be entered in a
user display the nth tilde (~) refers to the nth item.
A user display may be entered from the faceplate keypad or the EnerVista UR Setup interface (preferred for convenience).
The following procedure shows how to enter text characters in the top and bottom lines from the faceplate keypad:
1.
2.
3.
Use either VALUE key to scroll through the characters. A space is selected like a character.
4.
Press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
5.
Repeat step 3 and continue entering characters until the desired text is displayed.
6.
The HELP key may be pressed at any time for context sensitive help information.
7.
To enter a numerical value for any of the five items (the decimal form of the selected Modbus address) from the faceplate
keypad, use the number keypad. Use the value of 0 for any items not being used. Use the HELP key at any selected system display (setting, actual value, or command) which has a Modbus address, to view the hexadecimal form of the Modbus
address, then manually convert it to decimal form before entering it (EnerVista UR Setup usage conveniently facilitates this
conversion).
Use the MENU key to go to the user displays menu to view the user-defined content. The current user displays will show in
sequence, changing every four seconds. While viewing a user display, press the ENTER key and then select the Yes
option to remove the display from the user display list. Use the MENU key again to exit the user displays menu.
GE Multilin
5-81
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 1:
6016
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 2:
6357
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 3:
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 4:
0
MESSAGE
DISP 1 ITEM 5:
0
USER DISPLAYS
NOTE
Current X
Current Y
0.850
0.327 A
If the parameters for the top line and the bottom line items have the same units, then the unit is displayed on the
bottom line only. The units are only displayed on both lines if the units specified both the top and bottom line items
are different.
5.2.15 DIRECT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O
DIRECT OUTPUT
DEVICE ID: 1
Range: 1 to 16
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH1
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH2
DIRECT I/O
5-82
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Direct inputs and outputs are intended for exchange of status information (inputs and outputs) between UR-series relays
connected directly via type 7 digital communications cards. The mechanism is very similar to IEC 61850 GSSE, except that
communications takes place over a non-switchable isolated network and is optimized for speed. On type 7 cards that support two channels, direct output messages are sent from both channels simultaneously. This effectively sends direct output
messages both ways around a ring configuration. On type 7 cards that support one channel, direct output messages are
sent only in one direction. Messages will be resent (forwarded) when it is determined that the message did not originate at
the receiver.
Direct output message timing is similar to GSSE message timing. Integrity messages (with no state changes) are sent at
least every 1000 ms. Messages with state changes are sent within the main pass scanning the inputs and asserting the
outputs unless the communication channel bandwidth has been exceeded. Two self-tests are performed and signaled by
the following FlexLogic operands:
1.
DIRECT RING BREAK (direct input/output ring break). This FlexLogic operand indicates that direct output messages
sent from a UR-series relay are not being received back by the relay.
2.
DIRECT DEVICE 1 OFF to DIRECT DEVICE 16 OFF (direct device offline). These FlexLogic operands indicate that direct
output messages from at least one direct device are not being received.
Direct input and output settings are similar to remote input and output settings. The equivalent of the remote device name
strings for direct inputs and outputs is the DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID. The DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID setting identifies the
relay in all direct output messages. All UR-series IEDs in a ring should have unique numbers assigned. The IED ID is used
to identify the sender of the direct input and output message.
If the direct input and output scheme is configured to operate in a ring (DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION or DIRECT I/O
is Yes), all direct output messages should be received back. If not, the direct input/output ring
break self-test is triggered. The self-test error is signaled by the DIRECT RING BREAK FlexLogic operand.
Select the DIRECT I/O DATA RATE to match the data capabilities of the communications channel. All IEDs communicating
over direct inputs and outputs must be set to the same data rate. UR-series IEDs equipped with dual-channel communications cards apply the same data rate to both channels. Delivery time for direct input and output messages is approximately
0.2 of a power system cycle at 128 kbps and 0.4 of a power system cycle at 64 kbps, per each bridge.
Table 511: DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT DATA RATES
MODULE
CHANNEL
74
Channel 1
64 kbps
7L
7M
7P
Channel 2
64 kbps
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 1
Channel 2
7T
Channel 1
7W
Channel 1
Channel 2
7V
Channel 1
Channel 2
2A
Channel 1
64 kbps
2B
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
2G
Channel 1
128 kbps
2H
Channel 1
128 kbps
2I
2J
GE Multilin
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 1
Channel 2
5-83
5 SETTINGS
CHANNEL
76
Channel 1
64 kbps
77
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
75
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
7E
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
7F
7G
7Q
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
7R
Channel 1
64 kbps
7S
Channel 1
64 kbps
Channel 2
64 kbps
The G.703 modules are fixed at 64 kbps. The DIRECT I/O DATA RATE setting is not applicable to these modules.
NOTE
The DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting applies to C30s with dual-channel communication cards and allows crossing
over messages from channel 1 to channel 2. This places all UR-series IEDs into one direct input and output network
regardless of the physical media of the two communication channels.
The following application examples illustrate the basic concepts for direct input and output configuration. See the Inputs
and Outputs section in this chapter for information on configuring FlexLogic operands (flags, bits) to be exchanged.
EXAMPLE 1: EXTENDING THE INPUT/OUTPUT CAPABILITIES OF A UR-SERIES RELAY
Consider an application that requires additional quantities of digital inputs or output contacts or lines of programmable logic
that exceed the capabilities of a single UR-series chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR-series IED, such
as the C30, to satisfy the additional input and output and programmable logic requirements. The two IEDs are connected
via single-channel digital communication cards as shown in the figure below.
TX1
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
842711A1.CDR
Figure 517: INPUT AND OUTPUT EXTENSION VIA DIRECT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
In the above application, the following settings should be applied. For UR-series IED 1:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: 1
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION:
DIRECT I/O DATA RATE: 128 kbps
Yes
5-84
Yes
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The message delivery time is about 0.2 of power cycle in both ways (at 128 kbps); that is, from device 1 to device 2, and
from device 2 to device 1. Different communications cards can be selected by the user for this back-to-back connection (for
example: fiber, G.703, or RS422).
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme could be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3, and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown below.
BLOCK
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
UR IED 4
UR IED 3
842712A1.CDR
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX2
RX1
TX2
TX2
RX2
UR IED 2
TX1
TX1
UR IED 4
RX2
TX2
TX2
RX1
RX2
UR IED 3
RX1
TX1
842716A1.CDR
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Message delivery time is approximately 0.2 of power system cycle (at 128 kbps) times number of bridges between the origin and destination. Dual-ring configuration effectively reduces the maximum communications distance by a factor of two.
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps) if both rings are healthy:
GE Multilin
5-85
5 SETTINGS
UR IED 2
UR IED 3
842713A1.CDR
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX2
UR IED 2
RX1
TX1
TX2
RX1
UR IED 3
TX1
842714A1.CDR
Yes
Yes
5-86
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps):
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle;
IED 1 to IED 3: 0.5 of power system cycle;
IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle.
In the above scheme, IEDs 1 and 3 do not communicate directly. IED 2 must be configured to forward the messages as
explained in the Inputs and Outputs section. A blocking pilot-aided scheme should be implemented with more security and,
ideally, faster message delivery time. This is accomplished using a dual-ring configuration as shown here.
TX2
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX1
RX2
UR IED 2
RX2
TX2
TX1
TX1
RX1
UR IED 3
RX2
TX2
842715A1.CDR
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
In this configuration the following delivery times are expected (at 128 kbps) if both the rings are healthy:
IED 1 to IED 2: 0.2 of power system cycle;
IED 1 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle;
IED 2 to IED 3: 0.2 of power system cycle.
The two communications configurations could be applied to both permissive and blocking schemes. Speed, reliability and
cost should be taken into account when selecting the required architecture.
GE Multilin
5-87
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The C30 checks integrity of the incoming direct input and output messages using a 32-bit CRC. The CRC alarm function is
available for monitoring the communication medium noise by tracking the rate of messages failing the CRC check. The
monitoring function counts all incoming messages, including messages that failed the CRC check. A separate counter adds
up messages that failed the CRC check. When the failed CRC counter reaches the user-defined level specified by the CRC
ALARM CH1 THRESHOLD setting within the user-defined message count CRC ALARM 1 CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 CRC ALARM
FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions - if required - should be programmed accordingly.
The CRC alarm function is available on a per-channel basis. The total number of direct input and output messages that
failed the CRC check is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS CRC FAIL COUNT CH1 actual
value.
Message count and length of the monitoring window: To monitor communications integrity, the relay sends 1 message
per second (at 64 kbps) or 2 messages per second (128 kbps) even if there is no change in the direct outputs. For
example, setting the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT to 10000, corresponds a time window of about 160 minutes at
64 kbps and 80 minutes at 128 kbps. If the messages are sent faster as a result of direct outputs activity, the monitoring time interval will shorten. This should be taken into account when determining the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT
setting. For example, if the requirement is a maximum monitoring time interval of 10 minutes at 64 kbps, then the CRC
ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT should be set to 10 60 1 = 600.
Correlation of failed CRC and bit error rate (BER): The CRC check may fail if one or more bits in a packet are corrupted. Therefore, an exact correlation between the CRC fail rate and the BER is not possible. Under certain assumptions an approximation can be made as follows. A direct input and output packet containing 20 bytes results in 160 bits
of data being sent and therefore, a transmission of 63 packets is equivalent to 10,000 bits. A BER of 104 implies 1 bit
error for every 10000 bits sent or received. Assuming the best case of only 1 bit error in a failed packet, having 1 failed
packet for every 63 received is about equal to a BER of 104.
5-88
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH1
The C30 checks integrity of the direct input and output communication ring by counting unreturned messages. In the ring
configuration, all messages originating at a given device should return within a pre-defined period of time. The unreturned
messages alarm function is available for monitoring the integrity of the communication ring by tracking the rate of unreturned messages. This function counts all the outgoing messages and a separate counter adds the messages have failed
to return. When the unreturned messages counter reaches the user-definable level specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM
CH1 THRESHOLD setting and within the user-defined message count UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 UNRET
ALM FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 MESSAGE
COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions, if required, should be programmed accordingly.
The unreturned messages alarm function is available on a per-channel basis and is active only in the ring configuration.
The total number of unreturned input and output messages is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT
INPUTS UNRETURNED MSG COUNT CH1 actual value.
5.2.16 TELEPROTECTION
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP TELEPROTECTION
TELEPROTECTION
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
NUMBER OF TERMINALS:
2
Range: 2, 3
MESSAGE
NUMBER OF COMM
CHANNELS: 1
Range: 1, 2
MESSAGE
LOCAL RELAY ID
NUMBER: 0
MESSAGE
TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID
NUMBER: 0
MESSAGE
TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID
NUMBER: 0
TELEPROTECTION
Digital teleprotection functionality is designed to transfer protection commands between two or three relays in a secure,
fast, dependable, and deterministic fashion. Possible applications are permissive or blocking pilot schemes and direct
transfer trip (DTT). Teleprotection can be applied over any analog or digital channels and any communications media, such
as direct fiber, copper wires, optical networks, or microwave radio links. A mixture of communication media is possible.
Once teleprotection is enabled and the teleprotection input/outputs are configured, data packets are transmitted continuously every 1/4 cycle (3/8 cycle if using C37.94 modules) from peer-to-peer. Security of communication channel data is
achieved by using CRC-32 on the data packet.
GE Multilin
5-89
NOTE
5 SETTINGS
Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive as such, they cannot be used
simultaneously. Once teleprotection inputs and outputs are enabled, direct inputs and outputs are blocked, and vice
versa.
NUMBER OF TERMINALS: Specifies whether the teleprotection system operates between two peers or three peers.
NUMBER OF CHANNELS: Specifies how many channels are used. If the NUMBER OF TERMINALS is 3 (three-terminal
system), set the NUMBER OF CHANNELS to 2. For a two-terminal system, the NUMBER OF CHANNELS can set to 1 or
2 (redundant channels).
LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER, TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID NUMBER, and TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID NUMBER: In installations that use multiplexers or modems, it is desirable to ensure that the data used by the relays protecting a given line
is from the correct relays. The teleprotection function performs this check by reading the message ID sent by transmitting relays and comparing it to the programmed ID in the receiving relay. This check is also used to block inputs if inadvertently set to loopback mode or data is being received from a wrong relay by checking the ID on a received channel.
If an incorrect ID is found on a channel during normal operation, the TELEPROT CH1 ID FAIL or TELEPROT CH2 ID FAIL
FlexLogic operand is set, driving the event with the same name and blocking the teleprotection inputs. For commissioning purposes, the result of channel identification is also shown in the STATUS CHANNEL TESTS VALIDITY OF
CHANNEL CONFIGURATION actual value. The default value of 0 for the LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER indicates that relay ID
is not to be checked. On two- terminals two-channel systems, the same LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER is transmitted over
both channels; as such, only the TERMINAL 1 ID NUMBER has to be programmed on the receiving end.
5.2.17 INSTALLATION
INSTALLATION
MESSAGE
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
RELAY NAME:
Relay-1
To safeguard against the installation of a relay without any entered settings, the unit will not allow signaling of any output
relay until RELAY SETTINGS is set to "Programmed". This setting is defaulted to "Not Programmed" when at the factory. The
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED self-test error message is displayed until the relay is put into the "Programmed" state.
The RELAY NAME setting allows the user to uniquely identify a relay. This name will appear on generated reports.
5-90
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.3REMOTE RESOURCES
When C30 is ordered with a process card module as a part of HardFiber system, then an additional Remote Resources
menu tree is available in EnerVista UR Setup software to allow configuration of the HardFiber system.
Configure the field units. This establishes the point-to-point connection between a specific port on the relay process
bus module, and a specific digital core on a specific Brick. This is a necessary first step in configuring a process bus
relay.
Configure the AC banks. This sets the primary and secondary quantities and connections for currents and voltages.
AC bank configuration also provides a provision for redundant measurements for currents and voltages, a powerful
reliability improvement possible with process bus.
Configure signal sources. This functionality of the C30 has not changed other than the requirement to use currents and
voltages established by AC bank configuration under the remote resources menu.
Configure field contact inputs, field contact outputs, RTDs, and transducers as required for the application's functionality. These inputs and outputs are the physical interface to circuit breakers, transformers, and other equipment. They
replace the traditional contact inputs and outputs located at the relay to virtually eliminate copper wiring.
Configure shared inputs and outputs as required for the application's functionality. Shared inputs and outputs are distinct binary channels that provide high-speed protection quality signaling between relays through a Brick.
For additional information on how to configure a relay with a process bus module, see GE publication number GEK-113658:
HardFiber Process Bus System Instruction Manual.
GE Multilin
5-91
5 SETTINGS
5.4SYSTEM SETUP
5.4.1 BREAKERS
BREAKER 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 NAME:
Bkr 1
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 MODE:
3-Pole
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 OPEN:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 CLOSE:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 B CLOSED:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 B OPENED:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 C CLOSED:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 C OPENED:
Off
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 Toperate:
0.070 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 ALARM
DELAY:
0.000 s
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
BREAKER 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
BREAKER 1
5-92
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
A description of the operation of the breaker control and status monitoring features is provided in chapter 4. Only information concerning programming of the associated settings is covered here. These features are provided for two or more
breakers; a user may use only those portions of the design relevant to a single breaker, which must be breaker 1.
The number of breaker control elements is dependent on the number of CT/VT modules specified with the C30. The following settings are available for each breaker control element.
BREAKER 1 FUNCTION: This setting enables and disables the operation of the breaker control feature.
BREAKER1 PUSH BUTTON CONTROL: Set to Enable to allow faceplate push button operations.
BREAKER 1 NAME: Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the breaker. This name will be used in flash
messages related to breaker 1.
BREAKER 1 MODE: This setting selects 3-Pole mode, where all breaker poles are operated simultaneously, or 1Pole mode where all breaker poles are operated either independently or simultaneously.
BREAKER 1 OPEN: This setting selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate an output relay to
open breaker 1.
BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN: This setting selects an operand that prevents opening of the breaker. This setting can be
used for select-before-operate functionality or to block operation from a panel switch or from SCADA.
BREAKER 1 CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate an output relay
to close breaker 1.
BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that prevents closing of the breaker. This setting can be
used for select-before-operate functionality or to block operation from a panel switch or from SCADA.
BREAKER 1 A/3P CLOSED: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a breaker auxiliary position tracking mechanism. This input should be a normally-open 52/a status input to create a logic 1 when the
breaker is closed. If the BREAKER 1 MODE setting is selected as 3-Pole, this setting selects a single input as the operand used to track the breaker open or closed position. If the mode is selected as 1-Pole, the input mentioned above
is used to track phase A and the BREAKER 1 B and BREAKER 1 C settings select operands to track phases B and C,
respectively.
BREAKER 1 A/3P OPND: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input, that should be a normally-closed
52/b status input to create a logic 1 when the breaker is open. If a separate 52/b contact input is not available, then the
inverted BREAKER 1 CLOSED status signal can be used.
BREAKER 1 B CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B closed position as above for phase A.
BREAKER 1 B OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B opened position as above for phase A.
BREAKER 1 C CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C closed position as above for phase A.
BREAKER 1 C OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C opened position as above for phase A.
BREAKER 1 Toperate: This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the
52/a and 52/b auxiliary contacts during breaker operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time has
expired, the BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted from alarm or blocking purposes.
BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM: This setting selects an operand, usually an external contact input, connected to a breaker
alarm reporting contact.
BREAKER 1 ALARM DELAY: This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among
the three-pole position tracking operands will not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous operation of the poles.
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME: This setting specifies the interval required to maintain setting changes in effect after
an operator has initiated a manual close command to operate a circuit breaker.
GE Multilin
5-93
5 SETTINGS
5-94
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
From breaker
control logic
sheet 1
BKR ENABLED
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 CLOSED
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 OPEN
AND
BREAKER 1 DISCREP
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKER 1 TROUBLE
BREAKER 1
CLOSED
(DEFAULT)
OR
SETTING
BREAKER 1 MODE
= 3-Pole
= 1-Pole
AND
BKR1 A CLOSED
BKR1 B CLOSED
BKR1 C CLOSED
OR
SETTING
BREAKER 1 ALARM DELAY
AND
BREAKER 1
OPEN
(DEFAULT)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
BKR1 A OPENED
BKR1 B OPENED
BKR1 C OPENED
AND
OR
SETTING
BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM
= Off
SETTING
BREAKER 1 A/3P CLSD
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
OR
SETTING
BREAKER 1 Toperate
OR
AND
AND
0
SETTING
BREAKER 1 A/3P OPND
= Off
BREAKER 1
TROUBLE
(DEFAULT)
BKR1 A CLOSED
AND
BKR1 A OPENED
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 A BAD ST
BREAKER 1 A CLSD
BREAKER 1 A OPEN
BREAKER 1 A INTERM
AND
AND
SETTING
BREAKER 1 B CLSD
SETTING
BREAKER 1 Toperate
AND
= Off
AND
0
SETTING
BREAKER 1 B OPENED
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
AND
BKR1 B CLOSED
AND
BKR1 B OPENED
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 B BAD ST
BREAKER 1 B CLSD
BREAKER 1 B OPEN
BREAKER 1 B INTERM
AND
AND
SETTING
BREAKER 1 C CLSD
SETTING
BREAKER 1 Toperate
AND
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
AND
AND
0
SETTING
BREAKER 1 C OPENED
= Off
BKR1 C CLOSED
AND
BKR1 C OPENED
AND
AND
BREAKER 1 C BAD ST
BREAKER 1 C CLSD
BREAKER 1 C OPEN
BREAKER 1 C INTERM
AND
AND
BKR1 A CLOSED
BKR1 B CLOSED
BKR1 C CLOSED
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
AND
XOR
AND
SETTING
BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV
AND
= Off
859712A1.cdr
GE Multilin
5-95
5 SETTINGS
5.4.2 DISCONNECT SWITCHES
SWITCH 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 NAME:
SW 1
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 MODE:
3-Pole
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 OPEN:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 CLOSE:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 B CLOSED:
Off
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 B OPENED:
Off
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 C CLOSED:
Off
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 C OPENED:
Off
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 Toperate:
0.070 s
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 ALARM
DELAY:
0.000 s
MESSAGE
SWITCH 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
SWITCH 1
The disconnect switch element contains the auxiliary logic for status and serves as the interface for opening and closing of
disconnect switches from SCADA or through the front panel interface. The disconnect switch element can be used to create an interlocking functionality. For greater security in determination of the switch pole position, both the 89/a and 89/b
auxiliary contacts are used with reporting of the discrepancy between them. The number of available disconnect switches
depends on the number of the CT/VT modules ordered with the C30.
SWITCH 1 FUNCTION: This setting enables and disables the operation of the disconnect switch element.
SWITCH 1 NAME: Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the disconnect switch. This name will be used
in flash messages related to disconnect switch 1.
SWITCH 1 MODE: This setting selects 3-Pole mode, where disconnect switch poles have a single common auxiliary
switch, or 1-Pole mode where each disconnect switch pole has its own auxiliary switch.
5-96
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SWITCH 1 OPEN: This setting selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate a contact output to
open disconnect switch 1.
SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN: This setting selects an operand that prevents opening of the disconnect switch. This setting
can be used for select-before-operate functionality or to block operation from a panel switch or from SCADA.
SWITCH 1 CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate a contact output to
close disconnect switch 1.
SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that prevents closing of the disconnect switch. This setting
can be used for select-before-operate functionality or to block operation from a panel switch or from SCADA.
SWTCH 1 A/3P CLSD: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a disconnect switch
auxiliary position tracking mechanism. This input should be a normally-open 89/a status input to create a logic 1 when
the disconnect switch is closed. If the SWITCH 1 MODE setting is selected as 3-Pole, this setting selects a single input
as the operand used to track the disconnect switch open or closed position. If the mode is selected as 1-Pole, the
input mentioned above is used to track phase A and the SWITCH 1 B and SWITCH 1 C settings select operands to
track phases B and C, respectively.
SWTCH 1 A/3P OPND: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input, that should be a normally-closed 89/
b status input to create a logic 1 when the disconnect switch is open. If a separate 89/b contact input is not available,
then an inverted 89/a status signal can be used.
SWITCH 1 B CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B closed position as above for phase A.
SWITCH 1 B OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B opened position as above for phase A.
SWITCH 1 C CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C closed position as above for phase A.
SWITCH 1 C OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C opened position as above for phase A.
SWITCH 1 Toperate: This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the 89/a
and 89/b auxiliary contacts during disconnect switch operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time has
expired, the SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted from alarm or blocking purposes.
SWITCH 1 ALARM DELAY: This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among the
three-pole position tracking operands will not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous operation
of the poles.
IEC 61850 functionality is permitted when the C30 is in Programmed mode and not in the local control mode.
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-97
5 SETTINGS
5-98
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The switch element has direct hard-coded connections to IEC 61850 model as shown in the logic diagram. This allows
remote open/close operation of each switch, using either CSWI or XSWI IEC 61850 logical nodes. IEC 61850 selectbefore-operate functionality, local/remote switch functionality along with a blocking open/close commands are provided.
Note that IEC 61850 commands are event-driven and dwell time for these is one protection pass only. If you want to maintain close/open command for a certain time, do so either on the contact outputs using the "Seal-in" setting or in FlexLogic.
GE Multilin
5-99
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
5.5FLEXLOGIC
To provide maximum flexibility to the user, the arrangement of internal digital logic combines fixed and user-programmed
parameters. Logic upon which individual features are designed is fixed, and all other logic, from digital input signals through
elements or combinations of elements to digital outputs, is variable. The user has complete control of all variable logic
through FlexLogic. In general, the system receives analog and digital inputs which it uses to produce analog and digital outputs. The major sub-systems of a generic UR-series relay involved in this process are shown below.
5-100
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
The logic that determines the interaction of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs is field programmable through the use
of logic equations that are sequentially processed. The use of virtual inputs and outputs in addition to hardware is available
internally and on the communication ports for other relays to use (distributed FlexLogic).
FlexLogic allows users to customize the relay through a series of equations that consist of operators and operands. The
operands are the states of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs. The operators are logic gates, timers and latches (with
set and reset inputs). A system of sequential operations allows any combination of specified operands to be assigned as
inputs to specified operators to create an output. The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual output. Virtual outputs can be used as an input operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a
seal-in or other type of feedback.
A FlexLogic equation consists of parameters that are either operands or operators. Operands have a logic state of 1 or 0.
Operators provide a defined function, such as an AND gate or a Timer. Each equation defines the combinations of parameters to be used to set a Virtual Output flag. Evaluation of an equation results in either a 1 (=ON, i.e. flag set) or 0 (=OFF, i.e.
flag not set). Each equation is evaluated at least 4 times every power system cycle.
Some types of operands are present in the relay in multiple instances; e.g. contact and remote inputs. These types of operands are grouped together (for presentation purposes only) on the faceplate display. The characteristics of the different
types of operands are listed in the table below.
Table 512: C30 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND TYPES
OPERAND TYPE
STATE
EXAMPLE FORMAT
CHARACTERISTICS
[INPUT IS 1 (= ON) IF...]
Contact Input
On
Cont Ip On
Off
Cont Ip Off
Contact Output
(type Form-A contact
only)
Current On
Cont Op 1 Ion
Voltage On
Cont Op 1 VOn
Voltage Off
Cont Op 1 VOff
Direct Input
On
DIRECT INPUT 1 On
Element
(Digital)
Pickup
Dropout
Operate
Dig Element 1 OP
Element
(Digital Counter)
Higher than
Counter 1 HI
Equal to
Counter 1 EQL
Lower than
Counter 1 LO
Fixed
On
On
Logic 1
Off
Off
Logic 0
Remote Input
On
REMOTE INPUT 1 On
Virtual Input
On
Virt Ip 1 On
Virtual Output
On
Virt Op 1 On
GE Multilin
5-101
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
The operands available for this relay are listed alphabetically by types in the following table.
Table 513: C30 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS (Sheet 1 of 4)
OPERAND TYPE
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
CONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 2 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 3 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 4 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 5 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 6 ON
CONTROL PUSHBTN 7 ON
DIRECT DEVICES
DIRECT INPUT/
OUTPUT
CHANNEL
MONITORING
The rate of direct input messages received on channel 1 and failing the CRC
exceeded the user-specified level.
The rate of direct input messages received on channel 2 and failing the CRC
exceeded the user-specified level.
The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 1 exceeded the
user-specified level (ring configurations only).
The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 2 exceeded the
user-specified level (ring configurations only).
ELEMENT:
Eight-bit switch
5
ELEMENT:
Breaker control
BREAKER 1 C CLSD
BREAKER 1 C OPEN
BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS
BREAKER 1 CLOSED
BREAKER 1 OPEN
BREAKER 1 DISCREP
BREAKER 1 TROUBLE
BREAKER 1 MNL CLS
BREAKER 1 TRIP A
BREAKER 1 TRIP B
BREAKER 1 TRIP C
BREAKER 1 ANY P OPEN
BREAKER 1 ONE P OPEN
BREAKER 1 OOS
BREAKER 2...
Counter 1 HI
Counter 1 EQL
Counter 1 LO
Counter 2 to Counter 8
BREAKER 1 A INTERM
BREAKER 1 A CLSD
BREAKER 1 A OPEN
BREAKER 1 B BAD ST
BREAKER 1 B INTERM
BREAKER 1 B CLSD
BREAKER 1 B OPEN
BREAKER 1 C BAD ST
BREAKER 1 C INTERM
ELEMENT:
Digital counters
5-102
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT:
Digital elements
FxE 1 PKP
FxE 1 OP
FxE 1 DPO
FxE 2 to FxE 8
LATCH 1 ON
LATCH 1 OFF
LATCH 2 to LATCH 16
ELEMENT:
FlexElements
ELEMENT
Non-volatile latches
ELEMENT:
PID regulator
PID 1 RAISE
PID 1 LOWER
PID 2 RAISE
PID 2 LOWER
PID 3 RAISE
PID 3 LOWER
PID 4 RAISE
PID 4 LOWER
ELEMENT:
Selector switch
SELECTOR 1 POS Y
SELECTOR 1 BIT 0
SELECTOR 1 BIT 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 2
SELECTOR 1 STP ALARM
SELECTOR 1 BIT ALARM
SELECTOR 1 ALARM
SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM
ELEMENT:
Disconnect switch
SELECTOR 2
SWITCH 1 A INTERM
SWITCH 1 B CLSD
SWITCH 1 B OPEN
SWITCH 1 B BAD ST
SWITCH 1 B INTERM
SWITCH 1 C CLSD
SWITCH 1 C OPEN
SWITCH 1 C BAD ST
SWITCH 1 C INTERM
SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS
ELEMENT:
Teleprotection
channel tests
GE Multilin
SWITCH 2...
Channel 1 failed
Channel 2 failed
The ID check for a peer relay on channel 1 has failed
The ID check for a peer relay on channel 2 has failed
CRC detected packet corruption on channel 1
CRC detected packet corruption on channel 2
CRC detected lost packet on channel 1
CRC detected lost packet on channel 2
5-103
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
ELEMENT:
Teleprotection
inputs/outputs
ELEMENT
Trip bus
FIXED OPERANDS
Off
On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Contact inputs
Cont Ip 1
Cont Ip 2
Cont Ip 1
Cont Ip 2
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Contact outputs,
current
(from detector on
form-A output only)
Cont Op 1
Cont Op 2
IOn
IOn
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Contact outputs,
voltage
(from detector on
form-A output only)
Cont Op 1
Cont Op 2
VOn
VOn
Cont Op 1
Cont Op 2
VOff
VOff
INPUTS/OUTPUTS
Direct inputs
DIRECT INPUT 1 On
DIRECT INPUT 32 On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Remote doublepoint status inputs
RemDPS Ip 1 BAD
RemDPS Ip 1 INTERM
RemDPS Ip 1 OFF
RemDPS Ip 1 ON
Asserted while the remote double-point status input is in the bad state.
Asserted while the remote double-point status input is in the intermediate
state.
Asserted while the remote double-point status input is off.
Asserted while the remote double-point status input is on.
REMDPS Ip 2...
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Remote inputs
REMOTE INPUT 1 On
REMOTE INPUT 2 On
REMOTE INPUT 2 On
REMOTE INPUT 64 On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Virtual inputs
Virt Ip 1 On
Virt Ip 2 On
Virt Ip 3 On
Virt Ip 64 On
INPUTS/OUTPUTS:
Virtual outputs
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 2 On
Virt Op 3 On
Virt Op 96 On
LED INDICATORS:
Fixed front panel
LEDs
LED IN SERVICE
LED TROUBLE
LED TEST MODE
LED TRIP
LED ALARM
LED PICKUP
LED VOLTAGE
LED CURRENT
LED FREQUENCY
LED OTHER
LED PHASE A
LED PHASE B
LED PHASE C
LED NEUTRAL/GROUND
5-104
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
OPERAND SYNTAX
OPERAND DESCRIPTION
LED INDICATORS:
LED test
LED INDICATORS:
User-programmable
LEDs
LED USER 1
LED USER 2 to 48
PASSWORD
SECURITY
REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE DEVICE 1 On
REMOTE DEVICE 2 On
REMOTE DEVICE 2 On
REMOTE DEVICE 32 On
RESET OP
RESET OP (COMMS)
RESET OP (OPERAND)
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON)
SELFDIAGNOSTICS
(See Relay Selftests descriptions in
Chapter 7:
Commands and
Targets)
TEMPERATURE
MONITOR
TEMP MONITOR
USERPROGRAMMABLE
PUSHBUTTONS
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
ANY PB ON
PUSHBUTTON 2 to 12
RESETTING
Some operands can be re-named by the user. These are the names of the breakers in the breaker control feature, the ID
(identification) of contact inputs, the ID of virtual inputs, and the ID of virtual outputs. If the user changes the default name
or ID of any of these operands, the assigned name will appear in the relay list of operands. The default names are shown in
the FlexLogic operands table above.
The characteristics of the logic gates are tabulated below, and the operators available in FlexLogic are listed in the FlexLogic operators table.
GE Multilin
5-105
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
NUMBER OF INPUTS
NOT
input is 0
OR
2 to 16
any input is 1
AND
2 to 16
NOR
2 to 16
NAND
2 to 16
any input is 0
XOR
SYNTAX
DESCRIPTION
Editor
INSERT
DELETE
End
END
One-shot
NOTES
NEGATIVE ONE
SHOT
NOT
Logical NOT
OR(2)
OR(16)
2 input OR gate
16 input OR gate
AND(2)
AND(16)
NOR(2)
NOR(16)
NAND(2)
NAND(16)
XOR(2)
LATCH (S,R)
Timer
TIMER 1
TIMER 32
Assign
virtual
output
= Virt Op 1
= Virt Op 96
Logic
gate
POSITIVE ONE SHOT One shot that responds to a positive going edge.
Operands must precede the operator which uses the operands as inputs.
2.
Operators have only one output. The output of an operator must be used to create a virtual output if it is to be used as
an input to two or more operators.
3.
4.
A timer operator (for example, "TIMER 1") or virtual output assignment (for example, " = Virt Op 1") may only be used
once. If this rule is broken, a syntax error will be declared.
5-106
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5.5.3 FLEXLOGIC EVALUATION
Each equation is evaluated in the order in which the parameters have been entered.
FlexLogic provides latches which by definition have a memory action, remaining in the set state after the set input
has been asserted. However, they are volatile; that is, they reset on the re-application of control power.
NOTE
When making changes to settings, all FlexLogic equations are re-compiled whenever any new setting value is
entered, so all latches are automatically reset. If it is necessary to re-initialize FlexLogic during testing, for example,
it is suggested to power the unit down and then back up.
5.5.4 FLEXLOGIC EXAMPLE
This section provides an example of implementing logic for a typical application. The sequence of the steps is quite important as it should minimize the work necessary to develop the relay settings. Note that the example presented in the figure
below is intended to demonstrate the procedure, not to solve a specific application situation.
In the example below, it is assumed that logic has already been programmed to produce virtual outputs 1 and 2, and is only
a part of the full set of equations used. When using FlexLogic, it is important to make a note of each virtual output used a
virtual output designation (1 to 96) can only be properly assigned once.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
State=ON
Set
LATCH
OR #1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
State=ON
Reset
OR #2
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
State=Pickup
DIGITAL ELEMENT 2
State=Operated
Timer 2
XOR
Time Delay
on Dropout
Operate Output
Relay H1
(200 ms)
Timer 1
AND
Time Delay
on Pickup
(800 ms)
827025A2.vsd
Inspect the example logic diagram to determine if the required logic can be implemented with the FlexLogic operators.
If this is not possible, the logic must be altered until this condition is satisfied. Once this is done, count the inputs to
each gate to verify that the number of inputs does not exceed the FlexLogic limits, which is unlikely but possible. If the
number of inputs is too high, subdivide the inputs into multiple gates to produce an equivalent. For example, if 25
inputs to an AND gate are required, connect Inputs 1 through 16 to AND(16), 17 through 25 to AND(9), and the outputs
from these two gates to AND(2).
Inspect each operator between the initial operands and final virtual outputs to determine if the output from the operator
is used as an input to more than one following operator. If so, the operator output must be assigned as a virtual output.
For the example shown above, the output of the AND gate is used as an input to both OR#1 and Timer 1, and must
therefore be made a virtual output and assigned the next available number (i.e. Virtual Output 3). The final output must
also be assigned to a virtual output as virtual output 4, which will be programmed in the contact output section to operate relay H1 (that is, contact output H1).
GE Multilin
5-107
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
Therefore, the required logic can be implemented with two FlexLogic equations with outputs of virtual output 3 and virtual output 4 as shown below.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
State=ON
Set
LATCH
OR #1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
State=ON
Reset
Timer 2
XOR
OR #2
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
State=Pickup
DIGITAL ELEMENT 2
State=Operated
Time Delay
on Dropout
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 4
(200 ms)
Timer 1
Time Delay
on Pickup
AND
(800 ms)
CONTACT INPUT H1c
State=Closed
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 3
827026A2.VSD
Prepare a logic diagram for the equation to produce virtual output 3, as this output will be used as an operand in the
virtual output 4 equation (create the equation for every output that will be used as an operand first, so that when these
operands are required they will already have been evaluated and assigned to a specific virtual output). The logic for
virtual output 3 is shown below with the final output assigned.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 2
State=Operated
AND(2)
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 3
Prepare a logic diagram for virtual output 4, replacing the logic ahead of virtual output 3 with a symbol identified as virtual output 3, as shown below.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
State=ON
Set
LATCH
OR #1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
State=ON
Reset
Timer 2
XOR
OR #2
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
State=Pickup
Time Delay
on Dropout
VIRTUAL
OUTPUT 4
(200 ms)
Timer 1
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 3
State=ON
Time Delay
on Pickup
(800 ms)
827028A2.VSD
Program the FlexLogic equation for virtual output 3 by translating the logic into available FlexLogic parameters. The
equation is formed one parameter at a time until the required logic is complete. It is generally easier to start at the output end of the equation and work back towards the input, as shown in the following steps. It is also recommended to list
operator inputs from bottom to top. For demonstration, the final output will be arbitrarily identified as parameter 99, and
each preceding parameter decremented by one in turn. Until accustomed to using FlexLogic, it is suggested that a
worksheet with a series of cells marked with the arbitrary parameter numbers be prepared, as shown below.
5-108
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
01
02
03
04
05
.....
97
98
99
827029A1.VSD
DIG ELEM 2 OP
Cont Ip H1c On
NOT
AND(2)
= Virt Op 3
It is now possible to check that this selection of parameters will produce the required logic by converting the set of parameters into a logic diagram. The result of this process is shown below, which is compared to the logic for virtual output 3 diagram as a check.
95
96
97
98
99
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
DIG ELEM 2 OP
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Cont Ip H1c On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
NOT
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
AND (2)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
=Virt Op 3
AND
VIRTUAL
OUTPUT 3
827030A2.VSD
Repeating the process described for virtual output 3, select the FlexLogic parameters for Virtual Output 4.
99: The final output of the equation is virtual output 4 which is parameter = Virt Op 4".
98: The operator preceding the output is timer 2, which is operand TIMER 2". Note that the settings required for the
timer are established in the timer programming section.
GE Multilin
5-109
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
97: The operator preceding timer 2 is OR #2, a 3-input OR, which is parameter OR(3).
96: The lowest input to OR #2 is operand Cont Ip H1c On.
95: The center input to OR #2 is operand TIMER 1".
94: The input to timer 1 is operand Virt Op 3 On".
93: The upper input to OR #2 is operand LATCH (S,R).
92: There are two inputs to a latch, and the input immediately preceding the latch reset is OR #1, a 4-input OR, which
is parameter OR(4).
91: The lowest input to OR #1 is operand Virt Op 3 On".
90: The input just above the lowest input to OR #1 is operand XOR(2).
89: The lower input to the XOR is operand DIG ELEM 1 PKP.
88: The upper input to the XOR is operand Virt Ip 1 On".
87: The input just below the upper input to OR #1 is operand Virt Op 2 On".
86: The upper input to OR #1 is operand Virt Op 1 On".
85: The last parameter is used to set the latch, and is operand Virt Op 4 On".
The equation for virtual output 4 is:
[85]
[86]
[87]
[88]
[89]
[90]
[91]
[92]
[93]
[94]
[95]
[96]
[97]
[98]
[99]
Virt Op 4 On
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 2 On
Virt Ip 1 On
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
XOR(2)
Virt Op 3 On
OR(4)
LATCH (S,R)
Virt Op 3 On
TIMER 1
Cont Ip H1c On
OR(3)
TIMER 2
= Virt Op 4
It is now possible to check that the selection of parameters will produce the required logic by converting the set of parameters into a logic diagram. The result of this process is shown below, which is compared to the logic for virtual output 4 diagram as a check.
5-110
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 4 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 1 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 2 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Ip 1 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
XOR
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 3 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
OR (4)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
LATCH (S,R)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Virt Op 3 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
TIMER 1
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
Cont Ip H1c On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
OR (3)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
TIMER 2
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
=Virt Op 4
Set
LATCH
XOR
OR
Reset
OR
T2
VIRTUAL
OUTPUT 4
T1
827031A2.VSD
Now write the complete FlexLogic expression required to implement the logic, making an effort to assemble the equation in an order where Virtual Outputs that will be used as inputs to operators are created before needed. In cases
where a lot of processing is required to perform logic, this may be difficult to achieve, but in most cases will not cause
problems as all logic is calculated at least four times per power frequency cycle. The possibility of a problem caused by
sequential processing emphasizes the necessity to test the performance of FlexLogic before it is placed in service.
In the following equation, virtual output 3 is used as an input to both latch 1 and timer 1 as arranged in the order shown
below:
DIG ELEM 2 OP
Cont Ip H1c On
NOT
AND(2)
= Virt Op 3
Virt Op 4 On
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 2 On
Virt Ip 1 On
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
XOR(2)
Virt Op 3 On
OR(4)
LATCH (S,R)
Virt Op 3 On
TIMER 1
Cont Ip H1c On
OR(3)
TIMER 2
= Virt Op 4
END
In the expression above, the virtual output 4 input to the four-input OR is listed before it is created. This is typical of a
form of feedback, in this case, used to create a seal-in effect with the latch, and is correct.
GE Multilin
5-111
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
8.
5 SETTINGS
The logic should always be tested after it is loaded into the relay, in the same fashion as has been used in the past.
Testing can be simplified by placing an "END" operator within the overall set of FlexLogic equations. The equations will
then only be evaluated up to the first "END" operator.
The "On" and "Off" operands can be placed in an equation to establish a known set of conditions for test purposes, and
the "INSERT" and "DELETE" commands can be used to modify equations.
5.5.5 FLEXLOGIC EQUATION EDITOR
FLEXLOGIC
EQUATION EDITOR
MESSAGE
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY
END
1:
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY
END
2:
MESSAGE
There are 512 FlexLogic entries available, numbered from 1 to 512, with default END entry settings. If a "Disabled" Element
is selected as a FlexLogic entry, the associated state flag will never be set to 1. The +/ key may be used when editing
FlexLogic equations from the keypad to quickly scan through the major parameter types.
5.5.6 FLEXLOGIC TIMERS
TIMER 1
TYPE: millisecond
MESSAGE
TIMER 1 PICKUP
DELAY:
0
MESSAGE
TIMER 1 DROPOUT
DELAY:
0
FLEXLOGIC
TIMER 1
There are 32 identical FlexLogic timers available. These timers can be used as operators for FlexLogic equations.
TIMER 1 TYPE: This setting is used to select the time measuring unit.
TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set this function to "0".
TIMER 1 DROPOUT DELAY: Sets the time delay to dropout. If a dropout delay is not required, set this function to "0".
5-112
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5.5.7 FLEXELEMENTS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 NAME:
FxE1
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN:
Off
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 -IN:
Off
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
MODE: Signed
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP
MODE: Level
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
DIRECTION: Over
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
HYSTERESIS: 3.0%
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt
UNIT: milliseconds
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt:
20
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 RST
DELAY: 0.000 s
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK:
Off
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
FLEXELEMENT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
FLEXELEMENT 1
A FlexElement is a universal comparator that can be used to monitor any analog actual value calculated by the relay or a
net difference of any two analog actual values of the same type. The effective operating signal could be treated as a signed
number or its absolute value could be used as per user's choice.
The element can be programmed to respond either to a signal level or to a rate-of-change (delta) over a pre-defined period
of time. The output operand is asserted when the operating signal is higher than a threshold or lower than a threshold as
per user's choice.
GE Multilin
5-113
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE:
FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION:
SETTING
FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP:
FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK:
AND
Off = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
HYSTERESIS:
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT:
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt:
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
DELAY:
RUN
FLEXELEMENT 1 RST
DELAY:
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN:
Actual Value
FLEXELEMENT 1 -IN:
Actual Value
tPKP
+
-
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
FxE 1 OP
tRST
FxE 1 DPO
FxE 1 PKP
ACTUAL VALUE
FlexElement 1 OpSig
842004A4.CDR
The FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN setting specifies the first (non-inverted) input to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed as the input if
this setting is set to Off. For proper operation of the element at least one input must be selected. Otherwise, the element
will not assert its output operands.
This FLEXELEMENT 1 IN setting specifies the second (inverted) input to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed as the input if
this setting is set to Off. For proper operation of the element at least one input must be selected. Otherwise, the element
will not assert its output operands. This input should be used to invert the signal if needed for convenience, or to make the
element respond to a differential signal such as for a top-bottom oil temperature differential alarm. The element will not
operate if the two input signals are of different types, for example if one tries to use active power and phase angle to build
the effective operating signal.
The element responds directly to the differential signal if the FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE setting is set to Signed. The element responds to the absolute value of the differential signal if this setting is set to Absolute. Sample applications for the
Absolute setting include monitoring the angular difference between two phasors with a symmetrical limit angle in both
directions; monitoring power regardless of its direction, or monitoring a trend regardless of whether the signal increases of
decreases.
The element responds directly to its operating signal as defined by the FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN, FLEXELEMENT 1 IN and FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE settings if the FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE setting is set to Level. The element responds to the
rate of change of its operating signal if the FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE setting is set to Delta. In this case the FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT and FLEXELEMENT 1 dt settings specify how the rate of change is derived.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION setting enables the relay to respond to either high or low values of the operating signal. The
following figure explains the application of the FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION, FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP and FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS settings.
5-114
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over
PICKUP
HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under
PICKUP
HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP
FlexElement 1 OpSig
842705A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-115
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Signed;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Absolute;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Signed;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;
FLEXELEMENT INPUT
MODE = Absolute;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
842706A2.CDR
BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured
under the +IN and IN inputs.
DELTA TIME
BASE = 1 s
FREQUENCY
fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE
POWER FACTOR
PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs
BASE = 100C
SOURCE CURRENT
IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE POWER
PBASE = maximum value of VBASE IBASE for the +IN and IN inputs
5-116
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
The FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS setting defines the pickupdropout relation of the element by specifying the width of the
hysteresis loop as a percentage of the pickup value as shown in the FlexElement direction, pickup, and hysteresis diagram.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT UNIT setting specifies the time unit for the setting FLEXELEMENT 1 dt. This setting is applicable only if
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to Delta. The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT setting specifies duration of the time interval for the
rate of change mode of operation. This setting is applicable only if FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to Delta.
This FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP DELAY setting specifies the pickup delay of the element. The FLEXELEMENT 1 RST DELAY setting
specifies the reset delay of the element.
GE Multilin
5-117
5.5 FLEXLOGIC
5 SETTINGS
5.5.8 NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
LATCH 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
LATCH 1 TYPE:
Reset Dominant
MESSAGE
LATCH 1 SET:
Off
MESSAGE
LATCH 1 RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
LATCH 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
LATCH 1
EVENTS: Disabled
LATCH 1
The non-volatile latches provide a permanent logical flag that is stored safely and will not reset upon reboot after the relay
is powered down. Typical applications include sustaining operator commands or permanently block relay functions, such as
Autorecloser, until a deliberate interface action resets the latch. The settings element operation is described below:
SETTING
LATCH 1 FUNCTION:
LATCH 1 TYPE:
Enabled=1
RUN
LATCH N
TYPE
LATCH N
SET
LATCH N
RESET
LATCH N
ON
LATCH N
OFF
Reset
Dominant
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
Previous
State
Previous
State
ON
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
LATCH 1 SET:
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Off=0
ON
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
Previous
State
Previous
State
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
Set
Dominant
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SET
LATCH 1 ON
LATCH 1 OFF
SETTING
LATCH 1 SET:
Off=0
RESET
842005A2.CDR
5-118
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.6CONTROL ELEMENTS
5.6.1 OVERVIEW
Control elements are generally used for control rather than protection. See the Introduction to Elements section at the
beginning of this chapter for further information.
5.6.2 SELECTOR SWITCH
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SELECTOR SWITCH SELECTOR SWITCH 1(2)
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 FULL
RANGE: 7
Range: 1 to 7 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT:
5.0 s
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP:
Off
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP
MODE: Time-out
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 ACK:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 3BIT
MODE: Time-out
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP
MODE: Restore
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 TARGETS:
Self-reset
MESSAGE
SELECTOR 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
SELECTOR SWITCH 1
The selector switch element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic.
The element provides for two control inputs. The step-up control allows stepping through selector position one step at a
time with each pulse of the control input, such as a user-programmable pushbutton. The three-bit control input allows setting the selector to the position defined by a three-bit word.
The element allows pre-selecting a new position without applying it. The pre-selected position gets applied either after timeout or upon acknowledgement via separate inputs (user setting). The selector position is stored in non-volatile memory.
Upon power-up, either the previous position is restored or the relay synchronizes to the current three-bit word (user setting). Basic alarm functionality alerts the user under abnormal conditions; for example, the three-bit control input being out
of range.
GE Multilin
5-119
5 SETTINGS
SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE: This setting defines the upper position of the selector. When stepping up through available positions of the selector, the upper position wraps up to the lower position (position 1). When using a direct threebit control word for programming the selector to a desired position, the change would take place only if the control word
is within the range of 1 to the SELECTOR FULL RANGE. If the control word is outside the range, an alarm is established
by setting the SELECTOR ALARM FlexLogic operand for 3 seconds.
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: This setting defines the time-out period for the selector. This value is used by the relay in
the following two ways. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is Time-out, the setting specifies the required period of
inactivity of the control input after which the pre-selected position is automatically applied. When the SELECTOR STEPUP MODE is Acknowledge, the setting specifies the period of time for the acknowledging input to appear. The timer is
re-started by any activity of the control input. The acknowledging input must come before the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT
timer expires; otherwise, the change will not take place and an alarm will be set.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: This setting specifies a control input for the selector switch. The switch is shifted to a new
position at each rising edge of this signal. The position changes incrementally, wrapping up from the last (SELECTOR 1
FULL RANGE) to the first (position 1). Consecutive pulses of this control operand must not occur faster than every
50 ms. After each rising edge of the assigned operand, the time-out timer is restarted and the SELECTOR SWITCH 1:
POS Z CHNG INITIATED target message is displayed, where Z the pre-selected position. The message is displayed for
the time specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. The pre-selected position is applied after the selector times out
(Time-out mode), or when the acknowledging signal appears before the element times out (Acknowledge mode).
When the new position is applied, the relay displays the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POSITION Z IN USE message. Typically,
a user-programmable pushbutton is configured as the stepping up control input.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to Time-out, the
selector will change its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and
does not require any explicit confirmation of the intent to change the selector's position. When set to Acknowledge,
the selector will change its position only after the intent is confirmed through a separate acknowledging signal. If the
acknowledging signal does not appear within a pre-defined period of time, the selector does not accept the change
and an alarm is established by setting the SELECTOR STP ALARM output FlexLogic operand for 3 seconds.
SELECTOR 1 ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the stepping up control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned operand. This setting is active only under Acknowledge mode of
operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT setting after the
last activity of the control input. A user-programmable pushbutton is typically configured as the acknowledging input.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0, A1, and A2: These settings specify a three-bit control input of the selector. The three-bit control word pre-selects the position using the following encoding convention:
A2
A1
A0
POSITION
rest
The rest position (0, 0, 0) does not generate an action and is intended for situations when the device generating the
three-bit control word is having a problem. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is Time-out, the pre-selected position is
applied in SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT seconds after the last activity of the three-bit input. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is
Acknowledge, the pre-selected position is applied on the rising edge of the SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK acknowledging
input.
The stepping up control input (SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP) and the three-bit control inputs (SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0 through A2)
lock-out mutually: once the stepping up sequence is initiated, the three-bit control input is inactive; once the three-bit
control sequence is initiated, the stepping up input is inactive.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to Time-out, the selector
changes its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not
require explicit confirmation to change the selector position. When set to Acknowledge, the selector changes its posi-
5-120
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
tion only after confirmation via a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging signal does not appear within a
pre-defined period of time, the selector rejects the change and an alarm established by invoking the SELECTOR BIT
ALARM FlexLogic operand for 3 seconds.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the three-bit control input. The preselected position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned FlexLogic operand. This setting is active only under the
Acknowledge mode of operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR
TIME-OUT setting after the last activity of the three-bit control inputs. Note that the stepping up control input and threebit control input have independent acknowledging signals (SELECTOR 1 ACK and SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK, accordingly).
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE: This setting specifies the element behavior on power up of the relay.
When set to Restore, the last position of the selector (stored in the non-volatile memory) is restored after powering up
the relay. If the position restored from memory is out of range, position 0 (no output operand selected) is applied and
an alarm is set (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
When set to Synchronize selector switch acts as follows. For two power cycles, the selector applies position 0 to the
switch and activates SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM. After two power cycles expire, the selector synchronizes to the position
dictated by the three-bit control input. This operation does not wait for time-out or the acknowledging input. When the
synchronization attempt is unsuccessful (that is, the three-bit input is not available (0,0,0) or out of range) then the
selector switch output is set to position 0 (no output operand selected) and an alarm is established (SELECTOR 1 PWR
ALARM).
The operation of Synch/Restore mode is similar to the Synchronize mode. The only difference is that after an
unsuccessful synchronization attempt, the switch will attempt to restore the position stored in the relay memory. The
Synch/Restore mode is useful for applications where the selector switch is employed to change the setting group in
redundant (two relay) protection schemes.
EVENT NAME
DESCRIPTION
SELECTOR 1 POS Z
The selector position pre-selected via the stepping up control input has not been
confirmed before the time out.
The selector position pre-selected via the three-bit control input has not been confirmed
before the time out.
GE Multilin
5-121
5 SETTINGS
The following figures illustrate the operation of the selector switch. In these diagrams, T represents a time-out setting.
pre-existing
position 2
changed to 4 with
a pushbutton
changed to 1 with
a 3-bit input
changed to 2 with a
pushbutton
changed to 7 with
a 3-bit input
STEP-UP
T
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
T
POS 1
POS 2
POS 3
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6
POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842737A1.CDR
5-122
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
pre-existing
position 2
changed to 4 with
a pushbutton
changed to 1 with
a 3-bit input
changed to 2 with
a pushbutton
STEP-UP
ACK
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
3BIT ACK
POS 1
POS 2
POS 3
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6
POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842736A1.CDR
2"
3"
Make the following changes to selector switch element in the SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SELECTOR SWITCH
menu to assign control to user programmable pushbutton 1 and contact inputs 1 through 3:
SELECTOR SWITCH 1
GE Multilin
5-123
5 SETTINGS
ON
Now, assign the contact output operation (assume the H6E module) to the selector switch element by making the following
changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS menu:
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE:
OUTPUT H2 OPERATE:
OUTPUT H3 OPERATE:
Finally, assign configure user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS PRODUCT
SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: Self-reset
PUSHBUTTON 1 DROP-OUT TIME: 0.10 s
ACTUAL VALUE
SETTINGS
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT:
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
RUN
SELECTOR 1 POSITION
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP:
Off = 0
step up
SELECTOR 1 ACK:
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 POS 1
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2:
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 POS 3
SELECTOR 1 POS 2
acknowledge
ON
SELECTOR 1 POS 4
SELECTOR 1 POS 5
SELECTOR 1 POS 6
SELECTOR 1 POS 7
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
Off = 0
SELECTOR 1 ALARM
SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM
SELECTOR 1 BIT 0
SELECTOR 1 BIT 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 2
842012A2.CDR
5-124
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
Off
1 INPUT:
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
DELAY:
1 PICKUP
0.000 s
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
DELAY:
1 RESET
0.000 s
MESSAGE
DIG ELEMENT 1
PICKUP LED: Enabled
MESSAGE
DIG ELEM
Off
MESSAGE
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1
1 BLOCK:
There are 48 identical digital elements available, numbered 1 to 48. A digital element can monitor any FlexLogic operand
and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state. The digital element
settings include a name which will be referenced in any target message, a blocking input from any selected FlexLogic operand, and a timer for pickup and reset delays for the output operand.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 INPUT: Selects a FlexLogic operand to be monitored by the digital element.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set to "0".
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 RESET DELAY: Sets the time delay to reset. If a reset delay is not required, set to 0.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP LED: This setting enables or disabled the digital element pickup LED. When set to
Disabled, the operation of the pickup LED is blocked.
GE Multilin
5-125
5 SETTINGS
As long as the current through the voltage monitor is above a threshold (see technical specifications for form-A), the Cont
Op 1 VOn FlexLogic operand will be set (for contact input 1 corresponding operands exist for each contact output). If the
output circuit has a high resistance or the DC current is interrupted, the trickle current will drop below the threshold and the
Cont Op 1 VOff FlexLogic operand will be set. Consequently, the state of these operands can be used as indicators of the
integrity of the circuits in which form-A contacts are inserted.
EXAMPLE 1: BREAKER TRIP CIRCUIT INTEGRITY MONITORING
In many applications it is desired to monitor the breaker trip circuit integrity so problems can be detected before a trip operation is required. The circuit is considered to be healthy when the voltage monitor connected across the trip output contact
detects a low level of current, well below the operating current of the breaker trip coil. If the circuit presents a high resistance, the trickle current will fall below the monitor threshold and an alarm would be declared.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact which is open when the
breaker is open (see diagram below). To prevent unwanted alarms in this situation, the trip circuit monitoring logic must
include the breaker position.
85VHULHVGHYLFH
ZLWKIRUP$FRQWDFWV
+D
,
+E
'&
'&
+F
D
7ULSFRLO
, FXUUHQWPRQLWRU
9 YROWDJHPRQLWRU
$&'5
The PICKUP DELAY setting should be greater than the operating time of the breaker to avoid nuisance alarms.
NOTE
5-126
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
85VHULHVGHYLFH
ZLWKIRUP$FRQWDFWV
+E
'&
'&
+F
, FXUUHQWPRQLWRU
9 YROWDJHPRQLWRU
9DOXHVIRUUHVLVWRU5
+D
D
7ULSFRLO
5
%\SDVV
UHVLVWRU
3RZHUVXSSO\
5HVLVWDQFH
3RZHU
9'&
:
9'&
:
9'&
:
9'&
:
9'&
:
9'&
:
$&'5
GE Multilin
5-127
5 SETTINGS
5.6.4 DIGITAL COUNTERS
COUNTER 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
COUNTER 1 NAME:
Counter 1
COUNTER 1 UNITS:
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 PRESET:
0
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 COMPARE:
0
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 UP:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 DOWN:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 BLOCK:
Off
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
COUNTER 1 RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNT1 FREEZE/RESET:
Off
MESSAGE
COUNT1 FREEZE/COUNT:
Off
COUNTER 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
There are 8 identical digital counters, numbered from 1 to 8. A digital counter counts the number of state transitions from
Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element, the changes of state of an
external contact (e.g. breaker auxiliary switch), or pulses from a watt-hour meter.
COUNTER 1 UNITS: Assigns a label to identify the unit of measure pertaining to the digital transitions to be counted.
The units label will appear in the corresponding actual values status.
COUNTER 1 PRESET: Sets the count to a required preset value before counting operations begin, as in the case
where a substitute relay is to be installed in place of an in-service relay, or while the counter is running.
COUNTER 1 COMPARE: Sets the value to which the accumulated count value is compared. Three FlexLogic output
operands are provided to indicate if the present value is more than (HI), equal to (EQL), or less than (LO) the set
value.
COUNTER 1 UP: Selects the FlexLogic operand for incrementing the counter. If an enabled UP input is received when
the accumulated value is at the limit of +2,147,483,647 counts, the counter will rollover to 2,147,483,648.
COUNTER 1 DOWN: Selects the FlexLogic operand for decrementing the counter. If an enabled DOWN input is
received when the accumulated value is at the limit of 2,147,483,648 counts, the counter will rollover to
+2,147,483,647.
COUNTER 1 BLOCK: Selects the FlexLogic operand for blocking the counting operation. All counter operands are
blocked.
5-128
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CNT1 SET TO PRESET: Selects the FlexLogic operand used to set the count to the preset value. The counter will be
set to the preset value in the following situations:
1.
2.
When the counter is enabled and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1 (when the counter is enabled
and CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand is 0, the counter will be set to 0).
When the counter is running and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand changes the state from 0 to 1 (CNT1 SET TO
changing from 1 to 0 while the counter is running has no effect on the count).
PRESET
3.
When a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value
1 (when a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the
value 0, the counter will be set to 0).
COUNTER 1 RESET: Selects the FlexLogic operand for setting the count to either 0 or the preset value depending
on the state of the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand.
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/RESET: Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and resetting the count to 0.
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/COUNT: Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and continuing counting. The present accumulated
value and captured frozen value with the associated date/time stamp are available as actual values. If control power is
interrupted, the accumulated and frozen values are saved into non-volatile memory during the power down operation.
GE Multilin
5-129
5 SETTINGS
5.6.5 8-BIT SWITCHES
8BIT SWITCH 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
8-BIT
SWITCH 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
8BIT SW 1 CONTROL:
Off
This feature allows switching between two input arguments defined by 8 bits each. The bits are specified by FlexLogic operands. The feature could be viewed as an integrated two-position switch for 8 logic signals.
Typically this element is applied in conjunction with the Digitizer and 8-bit Comparator features.
8BIT SW 1 ARG A0 to 8BIT SW 1 ARG A7: These settings specify FlexLogic operands that constitute the first (A)
input of the switch. These operands are routed to the output operands if the control input is in the "Off" position.
BIT SW 1 ARG B0 to 8BIT SW 1 ARG B7: These settings specify FlexLogic operands that constitute the second (B)
input of the switch. These operands are routed to the output operands if the control input is in the "On" position.
8BIT SW 1 CONTROL: This setting specifies FlexLogic operands to control the routing between the A and B inputs of
the switch. If the control operand is in the "Off" state, the first (A) input is switched to the output. If the control operand
is in the "On" state, the second (B) input is switched to the output. The switching takes place instantaneously.
5-130
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
SETTING
8BIT SWITCH 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
RUN
SETTINGS
8BIT SW 1 ARG A0:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B0:
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A1:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B1:
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A2:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B2:
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A3:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B3:
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A4:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B4:
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A5:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B5:
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A6:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B6:
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG A7:
Off
Off = 0
8BIT SW 1 ARG B7:
On
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
8BIT SWITCH 1 BIT 7
SETTING
8BIT SW 1 CONTROL:
Off = 0
842017A1.CDR
GE Multilin
5-131
5 SETTINGS
5.6.6 PID REGULATOR
PID 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PID 1 PROCESS
SIGNAL: Off
MESSAGE
PID 1 SETPOINT
SIGNAL: 0.00
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PID 1 PROPORTIONAL
GAIN: 1.00
MESSAGE
PID 1 SETPOINT
WEIGHTING: 1.00
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PID 1 ANTIWINDUP:
Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
PID 1 DERIVATIVE
LIMIT: 10
Range: 1 to 20 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PID 1 MAX:
10
MESSAGE
PID 1 MIN:
10
MESSAGE
PID 1 Tmin:
500 ms
MESSAGE
Range: 1 to 20 s in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PID 1 BLK:
Off
MESSAGE
PID 1
TARGET: Self-reset
MESSAGE
PID 1
EVENTS: Disabled
PID 1
REGULATOR
5-132
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
+
sKTd
1+sTd/N
-1
d +
K
Ti
1
s
+
1
Tt
+
(EQ 5.1)
uk = pk + ik + dk
KT S e k T S
- + ------ w k u k AW
i k + 1 = i k + --------------------- Tt
Ti
Where TS is the sampling time and AW is a flag which enables anti-windup. The incremental form of the above equation is:
Du k = u k u k 1
= Dp k + Di k + Dd k
(EQ 5.2)
5-133
Where:
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Dp k = p k p k 1
= K br k y k br k 1 + y k 1
Di k = i k p k 1
TS
KT S
= e k 1 ----------- + AW w k 1 v k 1 ------
Ti
Tt
(EQ 5.3)
Dd k = d k d k 1
T d KN
Td
= Dd k 1 ------------------------ + y k 2y k 1 + y k 2 -----------------------T d + NT S
T d + NT S
The PID regulator logic is shown below.
SETTING
Function:
Enabled = 1
SETTING
u>Tmin
&
SETTING
Dead Time
Tdead
|u| ms
&
&
Off = 0
SETTING
SETTING
Ts, K, b,
Ti, Tt Td, N,
Antiwindup:
Enabled = 1
PID 1 LOWER
FLEXOPERAND
Blocked:
FLEXOPERAND
u>0
run
AW
&
PID 1 RAISE
u<0
ACTUAL VALUE
SETTING
Process:
Setpoint:
Tracking:
PID
u
SETTING
max, min
Out=MAX(min,MIN(max,u))
ACTUAL VALUE
PID 1 OUT
ACTUAL VALUE
SETPOINT
5-134
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
CONTACT INPUTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
CONTACT INPUT
THRESHOLDS
MESSAGE
Ips H5a,H5c,H6a,H6c
THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc
MESSAGE
Ips H7a,H7c,H8a,H8c
THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc
MESSAGE
Ips xxx,xxx,xxx,xxx
THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc
The contact inputs menu contains configuration settings for each contact input as well as voltage thresholds for each group
of four contact inputs. Upon startup, the relay processor determines (from an assessment of the installed modules) which
contact inputs are available and then display settings for only those inputs.
An alphanumeric ID may be assigned to a contact input for diagnostic, setting, and event recording purposes. The CONTACT IP X On (Logic 1) FlexLogic operand corresponds to contact input X being closed, while CONTACT IP X Off corresponds to contact input X being open. The CONTACT INPUT DEBNCE TIME defines the time required for the contact to
overcome contact bouncing conditions. As this time differs for different contact types and manufacturers, set it as a maximum contact debounce time (per manufacturer specifications) plus some margin to ensure proper operation. If CONTACT
INPUT EVENTS is set to Enabled, every change in the contact input state will trigger an event.
A raw status is scanned for all Contact Inputs synchronously at the constant rate of 0.5 ms as shown in the figure below.
The DC input voltage is compared to a user-settable threshold. A new contact input state must be maintained for a usersettable debounce time in order for the C30 to validate the new contact state. In the figure below, the debounce time is set
at 2.5 ms; thus the 6th sample in a row validates the change of state (mark no. 1 in the diagram). Once validated (debounced), the contact input asserts a corresponding FlexLogic operand and logs an event as per user setting.
A time stamp of the first sample in the sequence that validates the new state is used when logging the change of the contact input into the Event Recorder (mark no. 2 in the diagram).
Protection and control elements, as well as FlexLogic equations and timers, are executed eight times in a power system
cycle. The protection pass duration is controlled by the frequency tracking mechanism. The FlexLogic operand reflecting
the debounced state of the contact is updated at the protection pass following the validation (marks no. 3 and 4 on the figure below). The update is performed at the beginning of the protection pass so all protection and control functions, as well
as FlexLogic equations, are fed with the updated states of the contact inputs.
GE Multilin
5-135
5 SETTINGS
The FlexLogic operand response time to the contact input change is equal to the debounce time setting plus up to one protection pass (variable and depending on system frequency if frequency tracking enabled). If the change of state occurs just
after a protection pass, the recognition is delayed until the subsequent protection pass; that is, by the entire duration of the
protection pass. If the change occurs just prior to a protection pass, the state is recognized immediately. Statistically a delay
of half the protection pass is expected. Owing to the 0.5 ms scan rate, the time resolution for the input contact is below
1msec.
For example, 8 protection passes per cycle on a 60 Hz system correspond to a protection pass every 2.1 ms. With a contact debounce time setting of 3.0 ms, the FlexLogic operand-assert time limits are: 3.0 + 0.0 = 3.0 ms and 3.0 + 2.1 = 5.1
ms. These time limits depend on how soon the protection pass runs after the debouncing time.
Regardless of the contact debounce time setting, the contact input event is time-stamped with a 1 s accuracy using the
time of the first scan corresponding to the new state (mark no. 2 below). Therefore, the time stamp reflects a change in the
DC voltage across the contact input terminals that was not accidental as it was subsequently validated using the debounce
timer. Keep in mind that the associated FlexLogic operand is asserted/de-asserted later, after validating the change.
INPUT
VOLTAGE
The debounce algorithm is symmetrical: the same procedure and debounce time are used to filter the LOW-HIGH (marks
no.1, 2, 3, and 4 in the figure below) and HIGH-LOW (marks no. 5, 6, 7, and 8 below) transitions.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE THRESHOLD
1
At this time, the
new (HIGH)
contact state is
validated
3
TM
The FlexLogic
operand is going to
be asserted at this
protection pass
RAW CONTACT
STATE
7
The FlexLogicTM
operand is going to be
de-asserted at this
protection pass
DEBOUNCE TIME
(user setting)
4
FLEXLOGICTM
OPERAND
SCAN TIME
(0.5 msec)
DEBOUNCE TIME
(user setting)
PROTECTION PASS
(8 times a cycle controlled by the
frequency tracking mechanism)
842709A1.cdr
Figure 549: INPUT CONTACT DEBOUNCING MECHANISM AND TIME-STAMPING SAMPLE TIMING
Contact inputs are isolated in groups of four to allow connection of wet contacts from different voltage sources for each
group. The CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLDS determine the minimum voltage required to detect a closed contact input. This
value should be selected according to the following criteria: 17 for 24 V sources, 33 for 48 V sources, 84 for 110 to 125 V
sources and 166 for 250 V sources.
For example, to use contact input H5a as a status input from the breaker 52b contact to seal-in the trip relay and record it in
the Event Records menu, make the following settings changes:
CONTACT INPUT H5A ID: "Breaker Closed
CONTACT INPUT H5A EVENTS: "Enabled"
(52b)"
Note that the 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is closed.
5-136
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
VIRTUAL INPUT
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUT
Virt Ip 1
1 ID:
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUT
TYPE: Latched
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
There are 64 virtual inputs that can be individually programmed to respond to input signals from the keypad (via the COMmenu) and communications protocols. All virtual input operands are defaulted to Off (logic 0) unless the appropriate input signal is received.
MANDS
If the VIRTUAL INPUT x FUNCTION is to Disabled, the input will be forced to off (logic 0) regardless of any attempt to alter the
input. If set to Enabled, the input operates as shown on the logic diagram and generates output FlexLogic operands in
response to received input signals and the applied settings.
There are two types of operation: self-reset and latched. If VIRTUAL INPUT x TYPE is Self-Reset, when the input signal transits from off to on, the output operand will be set to on for only one evaluation of the FlexLogic equations and then return to
off. If set to Latched, the virtual input sets the state of the output operand to the same state as the most recent received
input.
NOTE
The self-reset operating mode generates the output operand for a single evaluation of the FlexLogic equations. If
the operand is to be used anywhere other than internally in a FlexLogic equation, it will likely have to be lengthened
in time. A FlexLogic timer with a delayed reset can perform this function.
SETTING
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled=1
S
AND
Latch
Virtual Input 1 to ON = 1
SETTING
AND
SETTING
OR
(Flexlogic Operand)
Virt Ip 1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
TYPE:
Latched
AND
Self - Reset
827080A3.CDR
GE Multilin
5-137
5 SETTINGS
5.7.3 CONTACT OUTPUTS
a) DIGITAL OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID
Cont Op 1
MESSAGE
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE:
Off
MESSAGE
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN:
Off
MESSAGE
CONTACT OUTPUT H1
EVENTS: Enabled
CONTACT OUTPUT H1
Upon startup of the relay, the main processor will determine from an assessment of the modules installed in the chassis
which contact outputs are available and present the settings for only these outputs.
An ID may be assigned to each contact output. The signal that can OPERATE a contact output may be any FlexLogic operand (virtual output, element state, contact input, or virtual input). An additional FlexLogic operand may be used to SEAL-IN
the relay. Any change of state of a contact output can be logged as an Event if programmed to do so.
For example, the trip circuit current is monitored by providing a current threshold detector in series with some Form-A contacts (see the trip circuit example in the Digital Elements section). The monitor sets a flag (see the specifications for FormA). The name of the FlexLogic operand set by the monitor, consists of the output relay designation, followed by the name of
the flag; for example, CONT OP 1 ION.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact used to interrupt current
flow after the breaker has tripped, to prevent damage to the less robust initiating contact. This can be done by monitoring
an auxiliary contact on the breaker which opens when the breaker has tripped, but this scheme is subject to incorrect operation caused by differences in timing between breaker auxiliary contact change-of-state and interruption of current in the
trip circuit. The most dependable protection of the initiating contact is provided by directly measuring current in the tripping
circuit, and using this parameter to control resetting of the initiating relay. This scheme is often called trip seal-in.
This can be realized in the C30 using the CONT OP 1 ION FlexLogic operand to seal-in the contact output as follows:
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID: Cont Op 1"
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: any suitable FlexLogic
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN: Cont Op 1 IOn
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 EVENTS: Enabled
operand
b) LATCHING OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a
OUTPUT H1a ID
L-Cont Op 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
5-138
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
The C30 latching output contacts are mechanically bi-stable and controlled by two separate (open and close) coils. As such
they retain their position even if the relay is not powered up. The relay recognizes all latching output contact cards and populates the setting menu accordingly. On power up, the relay reads positions of the latching contacts from the hardware
before executing any other functions of the relay (such as protection and control features or FlexLogic).
The latching output modules, either as a part of the relay or as individual modules, are shipped from the factory with all
latching contacts opened. It is highly recommended to double-check the programming and positions of the latching contacts when replacing a module.
Since the relay asserts the output contact and reads back its position, it is possible to incorporate self-monitoring capabilities for the latching outputs. If any latching outputs exhibits a discrepancy, the LATCHING OUTPUT ERROR self-test error is
declared. The error is signaled by the LATCHING OUT ERROR FlexLogic operand, event, and target message.
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the close coil of the contact. The
relay will seal-in this input to safely close the contact. Once the contact is closed and the RESET input is logic 0 (off),
any activity of the OPERATE input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and
RESET inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a RESET: This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the trip coil of the contact. The relay will
seal-in this input to safely open the contact. Once the contact is opened and the OPERATE input is logic 0 (off), any
activity of the RESET input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET
inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a TYPE: This setting specifies the contact response under conflicting control inputs; that is, when both the
OPERATE and RESET signals are applied. With both control inputs applied simultaneously, the contact will close if set to
Operate-dominant and will open if set to Reset-dominant.
Application Example 1:
A latching output contact H1a is to be controlled from two user-programmable pushbuttons (buttons number 1 and 2). The
following settings should be applied.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
OUTPUT H1a RESET: PUSHBUTTON 2 ON
Program the pushbuttons by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 and USER PUSHBUTTON 2 menus:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: Self-reset
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: 0.00 s
Application Example 2:
A relay, having two latching contacts H1a and H1c, is to be programmed. The H1a contact is to be a Type-a contact, while
the H1c contact is to be a Type-b contact (Type-a means closed after exercising the operate input; Type-b means closed
after exercising the reset input). The relay is to be controlled from virtual outputs: VO1 to operate and VO2 to reset.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: VO1
OUTPUT H1a RESET: VO2
Since the two physical contacts in this example are mechanically separated and have individual control inputs, they will not
operate at exactly the same time. A discrepancy in the range of a fraction of a maximum operating time may occur. Therefore, a pair of contacts programmed to be a multi-contact relay will not guarantee any specific sequence of operation (such
as make before break). If required, the sequence of operation must be programmed explicitly by delaying some of the control inputs as shown in the next application example.
Application Example 3:
A make before break functionality must be added to the preceding example. An overlap of 20 ms is required to implement
this functionality as described below:
GE Multilin
5-139
5 SETTINGS
Both timers (Timer 1 and Timer 2) should be set to 20 ms pickup and 0 ms dropout.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTand CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
Application Example 4:
A latching contact H1a is to be controlled from a single virtual output VO1. The contact should stay closed as long as VO1
is high, and should stay opened when VO1 is low. Program the relay as follows.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTmenu (assuming an H4L module):
VIRTUAL OUTPUT
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL OUTPUT
Virt Op 1
1 ID
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
There are 96 virtual outputs that may be assigned via FlexLogic. If not assigned, the output will be forced to OFF (Logic 0).
An ID may be assigned to each virtual output. Virtual outputs are resolved in each pass through the evaluation of the FlexLogic equations. Any change of state of a virtual output can be logged as an event if programmed to do so.
For example, if Virtual Output 1 is the trip signal from FlexLogic and the trip relay is used to signal events, the settings
would be programmed as follows:
5-140
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
GE Multilin
5-141
5 SETTINGS
REMOTE DEVICE
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 1
ETYPE APPID: 0
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 1
DATASET: Fixed
Remote devices are available for setting purposes. A receiving relay must be programmed to capture messages from only
those originating remote devices of interest. This setting is used to select specific remote devices by entering (bottom row)
the exact identification (ID) assigned to those devices.
The REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID setting is only used with GOOSE messages; they are not applicable to GSSE messages. This setting identifies the Ethernet application identification in the GOOSE message. It should match the corresponding settings on the sending device.
The REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET setting provides for the choice of the C30 fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset (that is, containing
DNA and UserSt bit pairs), or one of the configurable datasets.
Note that the dataset for the received data items must be made up of existing items in an existing logical node. For this reason, logical node GGIO3 is instantiated to hold the incoming data items. GGIO3 is not necessary to make use of the
received data. The remote input data item mapping takes care of the mapping of the inputs to remote input FlexLogic operands. However, GGIO3 data can be read by IEC 61850 clients.
REMOTE INPUT 1
REMOTE INPUT
Remote Ip 1
1 ID:
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE:
Remote Device 1
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN
None
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT
STATE: Off
MESSAGE
REMOTE IN 1
EVENTS: Disabled
1 ITEM:
Remote Inputs that create FlexLogic operands at the receiving relay are extracted from GSSE/GOOSE messages originating in remote devices. Each remote input can be selected from a list consisting of: DNA-1 through DNA-32, UserSt-1
through UserSt-32, and Dataset Item 1 through Dataset Item 32. The function of DNA inputs is defined in the IEC 61850
specification and is presented in the IEC 61850 DNA Assignments table in the Remote Outputs section. The function of
UserSt inputs is defined by the user selection of the FlexLogic operand whose state is represented in the GSSE/GOOSE
message. A user must program a DNA point from the appropriate FlexLogic operand.
Remote input 1 must be programmed to replicate the logic state of a specific signal from a specific remote device for local
use. This programming is performed via the three settings shown above.
The REMOTE INPUT 1 ID setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the remote input. The REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE setting
selects the remote device which originates the required signal, as previously assigned to the remote device via the setting
REMOTE DEVICE (32) ID (see the Remote Devices section). The REMOTE IN 1 ITEM setting selects the specific bits of the
GSSE/GOOSE message required.
The REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE setting selects the logic state for this point if the local relay has just completed startup or
the remote device sending the point is declared to be non-communicating. The following choices are available:
5-142
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to Off value defaults the input to logic 0.
Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/On freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to logic 1.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/Off freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to logic 0.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
For additional information on GSSE/GOOOSE messaging, see the Remote Devices section in this chapter.
NOTE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
REM DPS IN 1
EVENTS: Disabled
Remote double-point status inputs are extracted from GOOSE messages originating in the remote device. Each remote
double point status input must be programmed to replicate the logic state of a specific signal from a specific remote device
for local use. This functionality is accomplished with the five remote double-point status input settings.
REM DPS IN 1 ID: This setting assigns descriptive text to the remote double-point status input.
REM DPS IN 1 DEV: This setting selects a remote device ID to indicate the origin of a GOOSE message. The range is
selected from the remote device IDs specified in the Remote Devices section.
REM DPS IN 1 ITEM: This setting specifies the required bits of the GOOSE message.
The configurable GOOSE dataset items must be changed to accept a double-point status item from a GOOSE dataset
(changes are made in the SETTINGS COMMUNICATION IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(16) CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS menus). Dataset
items configured to receive any of GGIO3.ST.IndPos1.stV to GGIO3.ST.IndPos5.stV will accept double-point status
information that will be decoded by the remote double-point status inputs configured to this dataset item.
The remote double point status is recovered from the received IEC 61850 dataset and is available as through the RemDPS
Ip 1 BAD, RemDPS Ip 1 INTERM, RemDPS Ip 1 OFF, and RemDPS Ip 1 ON FlexLogic operands. These operands can then be
used in breaker or disconnect control schemes.
5.7.8 REMOTE OUTPUTS
a) DNA BIT PAIRS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE OUTPUTS DNA BIT PAIRS REMOTE OUTPUTS DNA- 1(32) BIT PAIR
REMOTE OUTPUTS
DNA- 1 BIT PAIR
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
DNA- 1 OPERAND:
Off
DNA- 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
5-143
5 SETTINGS
Remote outputs (1 to 32) are FlexLogic operands inserted into GSSE/GOOSE messages that are transmitted to remote
devices on a LAN. Each digital point in the message must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic operand. The above operand setting represents a specific DNA function (as shown in the following table) to be transmitted.
Table 517: IEC 61850 DNA ASSIGNMENTS
DNA
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Test
ConfRev
REMOTE OUTPUTS
UserSt- 1 BIT PAIR
MESSAGE
UserSt- 1 OPERAND:
Off
UserSt- 1 EVENTS:
Disabled
Remote outputs 1 to 32 originate as GSSE/GOOSE messages to be transmitted to remote devices. Each digital point in the
message must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic operand. The setting above is used to select the
operand which represents a specific UserSt function (as selected by the user) to be transmitted.
For more information on GSSE/GOOSE messaging, see the Remote Inputs/Outputs Overview in the Remote
Devices section.
NOTE
5.7.9 RESETTING
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS RESETTING
RESETTING
RESET OPERAND:
Off
Some events can be programmed to latch the faceplate LED event indicators and the target message on the display. Once
set, the latching mechanism will hold all of the latched indicators or messages in the set state after the initiating condition
has cleared until a RESET command is received to return these latches (not including FlexLogic latches) to the reset state.
The RESET command can be sent from the faceplate Reset button, a remote device via a communications channel, or any
programmed operand.
When the RESET command is received by the relay, two FlexLogic operands are created. These operands, which are
stored as events, reset the latches if the initiating condition has cleared. The three sources of RESET commands each create the RESET OP FlexLogic operand. Each individual source of a RESET command also creates its individual operand
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON), RESET OP (COMMS) or RESET OP (OPERAND) to identify the source of the command. The setting
shown above selects the operand that will create the RESET OP (OPERAND) operand.
5-144
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a) DIRECT INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT INPUTS DIRECT INPUT 1(32)
DIRECT INPUT
DIRECT INPUT 1
NAME: Dir Ip 1
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT
DEVICE ID: 1
Range: 1 to 16
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT 1
BIT NUMBER: 1
Range: 1 to 32
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT 1
DEFAULT STATE: Off
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
These settings specify how the direct input information is processed. The DIRECT INPUT 1 NAME setting allows the user to
assign a descriptive name to the direct input. The DIRECT INPUT 1 DEVICE ID represents the source of direct input 1. The
specified direct input is driven by the device identified here.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER is the bit number to extract the state for direct input 1. Direct Input 1 is driven by the bit
identified as DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER. This corresponds to the direct output number of the sending device.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE represents the state of the direct input when the associated direct device is offline. The
following choices are available:
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to On value defaults the input to Logic 1.
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to Off value defaults the input to Logic 0.
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/On freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest
state is not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to
Logic 1. When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to Latest/Off freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest
state is not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to
Logic 0. When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
b) DIRECT OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUT 1(32)
DIRECT OUTPUT
DIRECT OUT
Dir Out 1
1 NAME:
MESSAGE
DIRECT OUT
Off
1 OPERAND:
MESSAGE
DIRECT OUTPUT 1
EVENTS: Disabled
The DIRECT OUT 1 NAME setting allows the user to assign a descriptive name to the direct output. The DIR OUT 1 OPERAND is
the FlexLogic operand that determines the state of this direct output.
c) APPLICATION EXAMPLES
The examples introduced in the earlier Direct Inputs and Outputs section (part of the Product Setup section) are continued
below to illustrate usage of the direct inputs and outputs.
GE Multilin
5-145
5 SETTINGS
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
Figure 551: INPUT AND OUTPUT EXTENSION VIA DIRECT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
Assume contact input 1 from UR IED 2 is to be used by UR IED 1. The following settings should be applied (Direct Input 5
and bit number 12 are used, as an example):
UR IED 1:
UR IED 2:
= Cont Ip 1 On
The Cont Ip 1 On operand of UR IED 2 is now available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 5 ON.
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme can be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3 and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown in the figure below.
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
UR IED 3
BLOCK
UR IED 4
842712A1.CDR
UR IED 3:
UR IED 4:
UR IED 1:
5-146
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
Now the three blocking signals are available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 7 ON, DIRECT INPUT 8 ON, and DIRECT INPUT 9
ON. Upon losing communications or a device, the scheme is inclined to block (if any default state is set to On), or to trip
the bus on any overcurrent condition (all default states set to Off).
EXAMPLE 2: PILOT-AIDED SCHEMES
Consider a three-terminal line protection application shown in the figure below.
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
UR IED 3
842713A1.CDR
TX1
RX1
UR IED 1
RX2
UR IED 2
RX1
TX1
TX2
RX1
UR IED 3
TX1
842714A1.CDR
UR IED 3:
UR IED 2:
GE Multilin
IED 3)
IED 1)
5-147
5 SETTINGS
Signal flow between the three IEDs is shown in the figure below:
UR IED 1
UR IED 2
DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 6
UR IED 3
DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 6
Figure 555: SIGNAL FLOW FOR DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT EXAMPLE 3
In three-terminal applications, both the remote terminals must grant permission to trip. Therefore, at each terminal, direct
inputs 5 and 6 should be ANDed in FlexLogic and the resulting operand configured as the permission to trip (HYB POTT RX1
setting).
5-148
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
a) OVERVIEW
The relay provides sixteen teleprotection inputs on communications channel 1 (numbered 1-1 through 1-16) and sixteen
teleprotection inputs on communications channel 2 (on two-terminals two-channel and three-terminal systems only, numbered 2-1 through 2-16). The remote relay connected to channels 1 and 2 of the local relay is programmed by assigning
FlexLogic operands to be sent via the selected communications channel. This allows the user to create distributed protection and control schemes via dedicated communications channels. Some examples are directional comparison pilot
schemes and direct transfer tripping. It should be noted that failures of communications channels will affect teleprotection
functionality. The teleprotection function must be enabled to utilize the inputs.
b) TELEPROTECTION INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS TELEPROTECTION TELEPROT INPUTS
TELEPROT INPUTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Setting the TELEPROT INPUT ~~ DEFAULT setting to On defaults the input to logic 1 when the channel fails. A value of Off
defaults the input to logic 0 when the channel fails.
The Latest/On and Latest/Off values freeze the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is not known,
such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, then the input defaults to logic 1 for Latest/On
and logic 0 for Latest/Off.
GE Multilin
5-149
5 SETTINGS
c) TELEPROTECTION OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS TELEPROTECTION TELEPROT OUTPUTS
TELEPROT OUTPUTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
As the following figure demonstrates, processing of the teleprotection inputs/outputs is dependent on the number of communication channels and terminals. On two-terminal two-channel systems, they are processed continuously on each channel and mapped separately per channel. Therefore, to achieve redundancy, the user must assign the same operand on
both channels (teleprotection outputs at the sending end or corresponding teleprotection inputs at the receiving end). On
three-terminal two-channel systems, redundancy is achieved by programming signal re-transmittal in the case of channel
failure between any pair of relays.
UR-1
UR-2
ACTUAL VALUES
SETTING
CHANNEL 1 STATUS:
SETTING
TELEPROT OUTPUT 1-1:
(same for 1-2...1-16)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
CHANNEL 1 STATUS:
SETTING
(same for 1-2...1-16)
Fail
Off
OK
SETTING
TELEPROT INPUT 2-1
DEFAULT:
(same for 2-2...2-16)
OK
OR
Off
On
Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
ACTUAL VALUES
SETTING
UR-2 or UR-3
ACTUAL VALUES
CHANNEL 2 STATUS:
Fail
On
Communication channel #1
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
On
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
ACTUAL VALUES
Off
OK
SETTING
On
Fail
CHANNEL 2 STATUS:
Communication channel #2
(On 3-terminal system or 2-terminal
with redundant channel)
SETTING
TELEPROT OUTPUT 2-1:
Fail
OK
842750A2.CDR
5-150
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS IEC 61850 GOOSE ANALOGS GOOSE ANALOG INPUT 1(32)
ANALOG 1 DEFAULT:
1000.000
MESSAGE
ANALOG 1 DEFAULT
MODE: Default Value
MESSAGE
GOOSE ANALOG
UNITS:
MESSAGE
GOOSE ANALOG
INPUT 1
The IEC 61850 GOOSE analog inputs feature allows the transmission of analog values between any two UR-series
devices. The following settings are available for each GOOSE analog input.
ANALOG 1 DEFAULT: This setting specifies the value of the GOOSE analog input when the sending device is offline
and the ANALOG 1 DEFAULT MODE is set to Default Value.This setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating
point number. Because of the large range of this setting, not all possible values can be stored. Some values may be
rounded to the closest possible floating point number.
ANALOG 1 DEFAULT MODE: When the sending device is offline and this setting is Last Known, the value of the
GOOSE analog input remains at the last received value. When the sending device is offline and this setting value is
Default Value, then the value of the GOOSE analog input is defined by the ANALOG 1 DEFAULT setting.
GOOSE ANALOG 1 UNITS: This setting specifies a four-character alphanumeric string that can is used in the actual
values display of the corresponding GOOSE analog input value.
GOOSE ANALOG 1 PU: This setting specifies the per-unit base factor when using the GOOSE analog input FlexAnalog values in other C30 features, such as FlexElements. The base factor is applied to the GOOSE analog input FlexAnalog quantity to normalize it to a per-unit quantity. The base units are described in the following table.
BASE UNITS
dcmA
BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured
under the +IN and IN inputs.
FREQUENCY
fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE
POWER FACTOR
PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs
BASE = 100C
SOURCE CURRENT
IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE POWER
PBASE = maximum value of VBASE IBASE for the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE VOLTAGE
VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
The GOOSE analog input FlexAnalog values are available for use in other C30 functions that use FlexAnalog values.
GE Multilin
5-151
5 SETTINGS
5.7.13 IEC 61850 GOOSE INTEGERS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS IEC 61850 GOOSE UINTEGERS GOOSE UINTEGER INPUT 1(16)
GOOSE UINTEGER
INPUT 1
MESSAGE
UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT:
1000
UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT
MODE: Default Value
The IEC 61850 GOOSE uinteger inputs feature allows the transmission of FlexInteger values between any two UR-series
devices. The following settings are available for each GOOSE uinteger input.
UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT: This setting specifies the value of the GOOSE uinteger input when the sending device is
offline and the UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT MODE is set to Default Value.This setting is stored as a 32-bit unsigned integer
number.
UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT MODE: When the sending device is offline and this setting is Last Known, the value of the
GOOSE uinteger input remains at the last received value. When the sending device is offline and this setting value is
Default Value, then the value of the GOOSE uinteger input is defined by the UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT setting.
The GOOSE integer input FlexInteger values are available for use in other C30 functions that use FlexInteger values.
5-152
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
DCMA INPUT F1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DCMA INPUT F1
UNITS: A
MESSAGE
DCMA INPUT F1
RANGE: 0 to -1 mA
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DCMA INPUT F1
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external transducers and convert these signals into a digital format for use as required. The relay will accept inputs in the range of 1 to +20 mA DC, suitable for use with most common
transducer output ranges; all inputs are assumed to be linear over the complete range. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
Before the dcmA input signal can be used, the value of the signal measured by the relay must be converted to the range
and quantity of the external transducer primary input parameter, such as DC voltage or temperature. The relay simplifies
this process by internally scaling the output from the external transducer and displaying the actual primary parameter.
dcmA input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels
with the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel of
a type 5F transducer module installed in slot F.
The function of the channel may be either Enabled or Disabled. If Disabled, no actual values are created for the channel. An alphanumeric ID is assigned to each channel; this ID will be included in the channel actual value, along with the
programmed units associated with the parameter measured by the transducer, such as volts, C, megawatts, etc. This ID is
also used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. The
DCMA INPUT F1 RANGE setting specifies the mA DC range of the transducer connected to the input channel.
The DCMA INPUT F1 MIN VALUE and DCMA INPUT F1 MAX VALUE settings are used to program the span of the transducer in primary units. For example, a temperature transducer might have a span from 0 to 250C; in this case the DCMA INPUT F1 MIN
VALUE value is 0 and the DCMA INPUT F1 MAX VALUE value is 250. Another example would be a watts transducer with a
span from 20 to +180 MW; in this case the DCMA INPUT F1 MIN VALUE value would be 20 and the DCMA INPUT F1 MAX
VALUE value 180. Intermediate values between the min and max values are scaled linearly.
GE Multilin
5-153
5 SETTINGS
5.8.2 RTD INPUTS
RTD INPUT F1
FUNCTION: Disabled
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
RTD INPUT F1
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external resistance temperature detectors and convert these
signals into a digital format for use as required. These channels are intended to be connected to any of the RTD types in
common use. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
RTD input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with
the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel of
a type 5C transducer module installed in the first available slot.
The function of the channel may be either Enabled or Disabled. If Disabled, there will not be an actual value created for
the channel. An alphanumeric ID is assigned to the channel; this ID will be included in the channel actual values. It is also
used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. Selecting the
type of RTD connected to the channel configures the channel.
Actions based on RTD overtemperature, such as trips or alarms, are done in conjunction with the FlexElements feature. In
FlexElements, the operate level is scaled to a base of 100C. For example, a trip level of 150C is achieved by setting the
operate level at 1.5 pu. FlexElement operands are available to FlexLogic for further interlocking or to operate an output
contact directly.
Refer to the following table for reference temperature values for each RTD type.
5-154
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
100 PT
(DIN 43760)
120 NI
100 NI
10 CU
50
58
80.31
86.17
71.81
7.10
40
40
84.27
92.76
77.30
7.49
30
22
88.22
99.41
82.84
7.88
20
92.16
106.15
88.45
8.26
10
14
96.09
113.00
94.17
8.65
32
100.00
120.00
100.00
9.04
10
50
103.90
127.17
105.97
9.42
20
68
107.79
134.52
112.10
9.81
30
86
111.67
142.06
118.38
10.19
40
104
115.54
149.79
124.82
10.58
50
122
119.39
157.74
131.45
10.97
60
140
123.24
165.90
138.25
11.35
70
158
127.07
174.25
145.20
11.74
80
176
130.89
182.84
152.37
12.12
90
194
134.70
191.64
159.70
12.51
100
212
138.50
200.64
167.20
12.90
110
230
142.29
209.85
174.87
13.28
120
248
146.06
219.29
182.75
13.67
130
266
149.82
228.96
190.80
14.06
140
284
153.58
238.85
199.04
14.44
150
302
157.32
248.95
207.45
14.83
160
320
161.04
259.30
216.08
15.22
170
338
164.76
269.91
224.92
15.61
180
356
168.47
280.77
233.97
16.00
190
374
172.46
291.96
243.30
16.39
200
392
175.84
303.46
252.88
16.78
210
410
179.51
315.31
262.76
17.17
220
428
183.17
327.54
272.94
17.56
230
446
186.82
340.14
283.45
17.95
240
464
190.45
353.14
294.28
18.34
250
482
194.08
366.53
305.44
18.73
GE Multilin
5-155
5 SETTINGS
5.8.3 DCMA OUTPUTS
DCMA OUTPUT F1
SOURCE: Off
MESSAGE
DCMA OUTPUT F1
RANGE: 1 to 1 mA
MESSAGE
DCMA OUTPUT F1
MIN VAL: 0.000 pu
MESSAGE
DCMA OUTPUT F1
MAX VAL: 1.000 pu
DCMA OUTPUT F1
Hardware and software is provided to generate dcmA signals that allow interfacing with external equipment. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3. The dcmA output channels are arranged in a manner similar to transducer input or
CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with the settings shown below.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up, the
relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same manner used
for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as
the channel number.
Both the output range and a signal driving a given output are user-programmable via the following settings menu (an example for channel M5 is shown).
The relay checks the driving signal (x in equations below) for the minimum and maximum limits, and subsequently rescales so the limits defined as MIN VAL and MAX VAL match the output range of the hardware defined as RANGE. The following equation is applied:
I out
where:
(EQ 5.4)
(EQ 5.5)
The feature is intentionally inhibited if the MAX VAL and MIN VAL settings are entered incorrectly, e.g. when MAX VAL MIN
< 0.1 pu. The resulting characteristic is illustrated in the following figure.
VAL
Imax
OUTPUT CURRENT
Imin
DRIVING SIGNAL
MIN VAL
MAX VAL
842739A1.CDR
5-156
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
DCMA OUTPUT F1 SOURCE: This setting specifies an internal analog value to drive the analog output. Actual values
(FlexAnalog parameters) such as power, current amplitude, voltage amplitude, power factor, etc. can be configured as
sources driving dcmA outputs. Refer to Appendix A for a complete list of FlexAnalog parameters.
DCMA OUTPUT F1 RANGE: This setting allows selection of the output range. Each dcmA channel may be set independently to work with different ranges. The three most commonly used output ranges are available.
DCMA OUTPUT F1 MIN VAL: This setting allows setting the minimum limit for the signal that drives the output. This
setting is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current. The setting is entered
in per-unit values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.
DCMA OUTPUT F1 MAX VAL: This setting allows setting the maximum limit for the signal that drives the output. This
setting is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current. The setting is entered
in per-unit values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.
The DCMA OUTPUT F1 MIN VAL and DCMA OUTPUT F1 MAX VAL settings are ignored for power factor base units (i.e. if
the DCMA OUTPUT F1 SOURCE is set to FlexAnalog value based on power factor measurement).
NOTE
GE Multilin
5-157
5.9 TESTING
5 SETTINGS
5.9TESTING
SETTINGS
TESTING
MESSAGE
TEST MODE
FUNCTION: Disabled
The C30 provides a test facility to verify the functionality of contact inputs and outputs, some communication channels and
the phasor measurement unit (where applicable), using simulated conditions. The test mode is indicated on the relay faceplate by a Test Mode LED indicator.
The test mode may be in any of three states: disabled, isolated, or forcible.
In the Disabled mode, C30 operation is normal and all test features are disabled.
In the Isolated mode, the C30 is prevented from performing certain control actions, including tripping via contact outputs.
All relay contact outputs, including latching outputs, are disabled. Channel tests and phasor measurement unit tests remain
usable on applicable UR-series models.
In the Forcible mode, the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting controls the relay inputs and outputs. If the
test mode is forcible, and the operand assigned to the TEST MODE FORCING setting is Off, the C30 inputs and outputs operate normally. If the test mode is forcible, and the operand assigned to the TEST MODE FORCING setting is On, the C30 contact inputs and outputs are forced to the values specified in the following sections. Forcing may be controlled by manually
changing the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting between on and off, or by selecting a user-programmable pushbutton, contact input, or communication-based input operand. Channel tests and phasor measurement unit tests
remain usable on applicable UR-series models.
Communications based inputs and outputs remain fully operational in test mode. If a control action is programmed
using direct inputs and outputs or remote inputs and outputs, then the test procedure must take this into account.
NOTE
When in Forcible mode, the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting dictates further response of the C30 to
testing conditions. To force contact inputs and outputs through relay settings, set TEST MODE FORCING to On. To force contact inputs and outputs through a user-programmable condition, such as FlexLogic operand (pushbutton, digital input, communication-based input, or a combination of these), set TEST MODE FORCING to the desired operand. The contact input or
output is forced when the selected operand assumes a logic 1 state.
The C30 remains fully operational in test mode, allowing for various testing procedures. In particular, the protection and
control elements, FlexLogic, and communication-based inputs and outputs function normally.
The only difference between the normal operation and the test mode is the behavior of the input and output contacts. The
contact inputs can be forced to report as open or closed or remain fully operational, whereas the contact outputs can be
forced to open, close, freeze, or remain fully operational. The response of the digital input and output contacts to the test
mode is programmed individually for each input and output using the force contact inputs and force contact outputs test
functions described in the following sections.
The test mode state is indicated on the relay faceplate by a combination of the Test Mode LED indicator, the In-Service LED
indicator, and by the critical fail relay, as shown in the following table.
5-158
GE Multilin
5 SETTINGS
5.9 TESTING
TEST MODE
FORCING
OPERAND
IN-SERVICE
LED
TEST MODE
LED
CRITICAL
FAIL
RELAY
Disabled
No effect
Unaffected
Off
Unaffected
Isolated
No effect
Off
On
Deenergized
Forcible
On (logic 1)
Off
Flashing
Deenergized
Off (logic 0)
Off
Flashing
Deenergized
The TEST MODE FUNCTION setting can only be changed by a direct user command. Following a restart, power up, settings
upload, or firmware upgrade, the test mode will remain at the last programmed value. This allows a C30 that has been
placed in isolated mode to remain isolated during testing and maintenance activities. On restart, the TEST MODE FORCING
setting and the force contact input and force contact output settings all revert to their default states.
5.9.2 FORCE CONTACT INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS TESTING FORCE CONTACT INPUTS
FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Ip 1
:Disabled
FORCE Cont Ip 2
:Disabled
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Ip xx
:Disabled
The relay digital inputs (contact inputs) could be pre-programmed to respond to the test mode in the following ways:
If set to Disabled, the input remains fully operational. It is controlled by the voltage across its input terminals and can
be turned on and off by external circuitry. This value should be selected if a given input must be operational during the
test. This includes, for example, an input initiating the test, or being a part of a user pre-programmed test sequence.
If set to Open, the input is forced to report as opened (Logic 0) for the entire duration of the test mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
If set to Closed, the input is forced to report as closed (Logic 1) for the entire duration of the test mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
The force contact inputs feature provides a method of performing checks on the function of all contact inputs. Once
enabled, the relay is placed into test mode, allowing this feature to override the normal function of contact inputs. The Test
Mode LED will be on, indicating that the relay is in test mode. The state of each contact input may be programmed as Disabled, Open, or Closed. All contact input operations return to normal when all settings for this feature are disabled.
GE Multilin
5-159
5.9 TESTING
5 SETTINGS
5.9.3 FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS
FORCE CONTACT
OUTPUTS
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Op 1
:Disabled
FORCE Cont Op 2
:Disabled
MESSAGE
FORCE Cont Op xx
:Disabled
The relay contact outputs can be pre-programmed to respond to the test mode.
If set to Disabled, the contact output remains fully operational. If operates when its control operand is logic 1 and will
resets when its control operand is logic 0. If set to Energized, the output will close and remain closed for the entire duration of the test mode, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact. If set to De-energized, the output will open and remain opened for the entire duration of the test mode regardless of the status of the
operand configured to control the output contact. If set to Freeze, the output retains its position from before entering the
test mode, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact.
These settings are applied two ways. First, external circuits may be tested by energizing or de-energizing contacts. Second, by controlling the output contact state, relay logic may be tested and undesirable effects on external circuits avoided.
Example 1: Initiating test mode through user-programmable pushbutton 1
For example, the test mode can be initiated from user-programmable pushbutton 1. The pushbutton will be programmed as
Latched (pushbutton pressed to initiate the test, and pressed again to terminate the test). During the test, digital input 1
should remain operational, digital inputs 2 and 3 should open, and digital input 4 should close. Also, contact output 1 should
freeze, contact output 2 should open, contact output 3 should close, and contact output 4 should remain fully operational.
The required settings are shown below.
To enable user-programmable pushbutton 1 to initiate the test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS
TESTING TEST MODE menu: TEST MODE FUNCTION: Enabled and TEST MODE INITIATE: PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
Make the following changes to configure the contact inputs and outputs. In the SETTINGS TESTING FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS and FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS menus, set:
FORCE Cont Ip 1: Disabled, FORCE Cont Ip 2: Open, FORCE Cont Ip 3: Open, and FORCE Cont Ip 4:
FORCE Cont Op 1: Freeze, FORCE Cont Op 2: De-energized, FORCE Cont Op 3: Energized,
and FORCE Cont Op 4: Disabled
Closed
Set the user-programmable pushbutton as latching by changing SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE
USER PUSHBUTTON 1 PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION to Latched. To enable either pushbutton 1 or remote
input 1 to initiate the Test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS TESTING TEST MODE menu:
PUSHBUTTONS
5-160
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.1 OVERVIEW
ACTUAL VALUES
STATUS
GE Multilin
CONTACT INPUTS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
REMOTE INPUTS
TELEPROTECTION
INPUTS
CONTACT OUTPUTS
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
REMOTE DEVICES
STATUS
REMOTE DEVICES
STATISTICS
SELECTOR SWITCHES
DIGITAL COUNTERS
FLEX STATES
ETHERNET
DIRECT INPUTS
DIRECT DEVICES
STATUS
IEC 61850
GOOSE UINTEGERS
EGD PROTOCOL
STATUS
TELEPROT CH TESTS
COMM STATUS
REMAINING CONNECT
PRP
6-1
6.1 OVERVIEW
ACTUAL VALUES
METERING
ACTUAL VALUES
RECORDS
ACTUAL VALUES
PRODUCT INFO
6 ACTUAL VALUES
FLEXELEMENTS
IEC 61850
GOOSE ANALOGS
TRANSDUCER I/O
DCMA INPUTS
TRANSDUCER I/O
RTD INPUTS
EVENT RECORDS
OSCILLOGRAPHY
DATA LOGGER
MODEL INFORMATION
FIRMWARE REVISIONS
6-2
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
6.2STATUS
CONTACT INPUTS
MESSAGE
Cont Ip 1
Off
Cont Ip 2
Off
MESSAGE
Cont Ip xx
Off
The present status of the contact inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
input. For example, Cont Ip 1 refers to the contact input in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the contact input.
6.2.2 VIRTUAL INPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS VIRTUAL INPUTS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
MESSAGE
Virt Ip 1
Off
Virt Ip 2
Off
MESSAGE
Virt Ip 64
Off
The present status of the 64 virtual inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
input. For example, Virt Ip 1 refers to the virtual input in terms of the default name. The second line of the display indicates
the logic state of the virtual input.
6.2.3 REMOTE INPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE INPUTS
REMOTE INPUTS
MESSAGE
REMOTE INPUT
STATUS: Off
REMOTE INPUT
STATUS: Off
REMOTE INPUT 64
STATUS: Off
MESSAGE
GE Multilin
6-3
6.2 STATUS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2.4 REMOTE DOUBLE-POINT STATUS INPUTS
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The present state of the remote double-point status inputs is shown here. The actual values indicate if the remote doublepoint status inputs are in the on (close), off (open), intermediate, or bad state.
6.2.5 TELEPROTECTION INPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS TELEPROTECTION INPUTS
TELEPROTECTION
INPUTS
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 1-1: Off
Range: Off, On
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 1-2: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 1-16: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 2-1: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 2-2: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
TELEPROTECTION
INPUT 2-16: Off
Range: Off, On
The present state of teleprotection inputs from communication channels 1 and 2 are shown here. The state displayed will
be that of corresponding remote output unless the channel is declared failed.
6.2.6 CONTACT OUTPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS CONTACT OUTPUTS
CONTACT OUTPUTS
MESSAGE
Cont Op 1
Off
Cont Op 2
Off
MESSAGE
Cont Op xx
Off
The present state of the contact outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
output. For example, Cont Op 1 refers to the contact output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of
the display indicates the logic state of the contact output.
6-4
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
For form-A contact outputs, the state of the voltage and current detectors is displayed as Off, VOff, IOff, On, IOn,
and VOn. For form-C contact outputs, the state is displayed as Off or On.
NOTE
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
MESSAGE
Virt Op
Off
Virt Op
Off
MESSAGE
Virt Op 96
Off
The present state of up to 96 virtual outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
output. For example, Virt Op 1 refers to the virtual output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the virtual output, as calculated by the FlexLogic equation for that output.
6.2.8 REMOTE DEVICES
a) STATUS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE DEVICES STATUS
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 1
STATUS: Offline
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 2
STATUS: Offline
REMOTE DEVICES
STATUS
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 32
STATUS: Offline
The present state of the programmed remote devices is shown here. The ALL REMOTE DEVICES ONLINE message indicates
whether or not all programmed remote devices are online. If the corresponding state is "No", then at least one required
remote device is not online.
b) STATISTICS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE DEVICES STATISTICS REMOTE DEVICE 1(32)
REMOTE DEVICE
MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE
StNum:
REMOTE DEVICE
SqNum:
0
0
Statistical data (two types) for up to 32 programmed remote devices is shown here.
The STNUM number is obtained from the indicated remote device and increments whenever a change of state of at least
one item occurs in the GSSE/GOOSE message. The SQNUM number is obtained from the indicated remote device and
increments whenever a GSSE/GOOSE message, without a state change, is sent. When the GSSE/GOOSE message
trasmits a state change, the SQNUM resets to 0. This number rolls over to zero when a count of 4,294,967,295 is incremented.
GE Multilin
6-5
6.2 STATUS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2.9 SELECTOR SWITCHES
SELECTOR SWITCHES
MESSAGE
SELECTOR SWITCH 1
POSITION: 0/7
SELECTOR SWITCH 2
POSITION: 0/7
The display shows both the current position and the full range. The current position only (an integer from 0 through 7) is the
actual value.
6.2.10 DIGITAL COUNTERS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIGITAL COUNTERS DIGITAL COUNTERS Counter 1(8)
DIGITAL COUNTERS
Counter 1
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Counter 1
ACCUM:
0
Counter 1
FROZEN:
0
Counter 1
FROZEN:
YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS
Counter 1
MICROS:
0
The present status of the eight digital counters is shown here. The status of each counter, with the user-defined counter
name, includes the accumulated and frozen counts (the count units label will also appear). Also included, is the date and
time stamp for the frozen count. The COUNTER 1 MICROS value refers to the microsecond portion of the time stamp.
FLEX STATES
MESSAGE
PARAM
Off
1: Off
Range: Off, On
PARAM
Off
2: Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
Range: Off, On
There are 256 FlexStateTM bits available. The second line value indicates the state of the given FlexState bit.
6.2.12 ETHERNET
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS ETHERNET
Range: Fail, OK
MESSAGE
Range: Fail, OK
MESSAGE
Range: Fail, OK
ETHERNET
6-6
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
These values indicate the status of the first, second, and third Ethernet links.
6.2.13 REAL TIME CLOCK SYNCHRONIZING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REAL TIME CLOCK SYNCHRONIZING
MESSAGE
GrandMaster ID:
0X0000000000000000
MESSAGE
Accuracy:
999,999,999 ns
MESSAGE
(No
MESSAGE
(No
MESSAGE
(No
MESSAGE
The RTC Sync Source actual value is the time synchronizing source the relay is using at present. Possible sources are:
Port 1 PTP Clock, Port 2 PTP Clock, Port 3 PTP Clock, IRIG-B, SNTP, and None.
The Grandmaster ID is the grandmasterIdentity code being received from the present PTP grandmaster, if any. When the
relay is not using any PTP grandmaster, this actual value is zero. The grandmasterIdentity code is specified by PTP to be
globally unique, so one can always know which clock is grandmaster in a system with multiple grandmaster-capable clocks.
Accuracy is the estimated maximum time error at present in the RTC, considering the quality information imbedded in the
received time signal. The value 999,999,999 indicates that the magnitude of the estimated error is one second or more, or
that the error cannot be estimated.
PORT 13 PTP STATE
is the present state of the ports PTP clock. The PTP clock state is:
DISABLED
NO SIGNAL
CALIBRATING
SYNCHRONIZED
if synchronized.
is the time difference, measured in nanoseconds, between the fractional seconds portion of the time
being received via PTP and that being received via IRIG-B. A positive value indicates that PTP time is fast compared to
IRIG-B time.
GE Multilin
6-7
6.2 STATUS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2.14 DIRECT INPUTS
DIRECT INPUTS
UNRETURNED MSG
COUNT CH1: 0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
UNRETURNED MSG
COUNT CH2: 0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT
On
1:
MESSAGE
DIRECT INPUT
On
2:
MESSAGE
The AVERAGE MSG RETURN TIME is the time taken for direct output messages to return to the sender in a direct input/output
ring configuration (this value is not applicable for non-ring configurations). This is a rolling average calculated for the last
ten messages. There are two return times for dual-channel communications modules.
The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the direct output messages that do not
make the trip around the communications ring. The CRC FAIL COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the
direct output messages that have been received but fail the CRC check. High values for either of these counts may indicate
on a problem with wiring, the communication channel, or one or more relays. The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT and CRC FAIL
COUNT values can be cleared using the CLEAR DIRECT I/O COUNTERS command.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 to DIRECT INPUT (32) values represent the state of each direct input.
6.2.15 DIRECT DEVICES STATUS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT DEVICES STATUS
DIRECT DEVICES
STATUS
MESSAGE
DIRECT DEVICE 1
STATUS: Offline
DIRECT DEVICE 2
STATUS: Offline
MESSAGE
DIRECT DEVICE 16
STATUS: Offline
These actual values represent the state of direct devices 1 through 16.
6-8
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
6.2.16 IEC 61850 GOOSE INTEGERS
IEC 61850
GOOSE UINTEGERS
MESSAGE
UINT INPUT
0
UINT INPUT
0
MESSAGE
UINT INPUT 16
0
The C30 Controller System is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability. This feature is
specified as a software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.
The IEC 61850 GGIO5 integer input data points are displayed in this menu. The GGIO5 integer data values are received
via IEC 61850 GOOSE messages sent from other devices.
6.2.17 EGD PROTOCOL STATUS
a) FAST EXCHANGE
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS EGD PROTOCOL STATUS PRODUCER STATUS FAST EXCHANGE 1
FAST EXCHANGE 1
MESSAGE
FAST EXCHANGE 1
SIGNATURE: 0
FAST EXCHANGE 1
DATA LENGTH: 0
These values provide information that may be useful for debugging an EGD network. The EGD signature and packet size
for the fast EGD exchange is displayed.
b) SLOW EXCHANGE
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS EGD PROTOCOL STATUS PRODUCER STATUS SLOW EXCHANGE 1(2)
SLOW EXCHANGE 1
MESSAGE
SLOW EXCHANGE 1
SIGNATURE: 0
SLOW EXCHANGE 1
DATA LENGTH: 0
These values provide information that may be useful for debugging an EGD network. The EGD signature and packet size
for the slow EGD exchanges are displayed.
GE Multilin
6-9
6.2 STATUS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2.18 TELEPROTECTION CHANNEL TESTS
CHANNEL 1
STATUS: n/a
MESSAGE
CHANNEL 1 LOST
PACKETS:
1
MESSAGE
CHANNEL 2
STATUS: n/a
MESSAGE
CHANNEL 2 LOST
PACKETS:
1
MESSAGE
VALIDITY OF CHANNEL
CONFIGURATION: FAIL
TELEPROT CH TESTS
CHANNEL 1 STATUS: This represents the receiver status of each channel. If the value is OK, teleprotection is
enabled and data is being received from the remote terminal; If the value is FAIL, teleprotection enabled and data is
not being received from the remote terminal. If n/a, teleprotection is disabled.
CHANNEL 1 LOST PACKETS: Data is transmitted to the remote terminals in data packets at a rate of two packets per
cycle. The number of lost packets represents data packets lost in transmission; this count can be reset to 0 through the
COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu.
VALIDITY OF CHANNEL CONFIGURATION: This value displays the current state of the communications channel
identification check, and hence validity. If a remote relay ID does not match the programmed ID at the local relay, the
FAIL message will be displayed. The N/A value appears if the local relay ID is set to a default value of 0, the channel is failed, or if the teleprotection inputs/outputs are not enabled.
6.2.19 REMAINING CONNECTION STATUS
MMS (max 5)
5
Range: 0 to 5
MESSAGE
Range: 0 to 4
MESSAGE
DNP (max 2)
2
Range: 0 to 2
MESSAGE
IEC-104 (max 2)
2
Range: 0 to 2
MESSAGE
PMU
4
COMM STATUS
REMAINING CONNECT
These values specify the remaining number of TCP connections still available for each protocol. Every time a connection is
used, the remaining number of connections decrements. When released, the remaining number of connections increments.
If no connection is made over the specific protocol, the number equals the maximum number available for the specific protocol.
For example, the maximum number of Modbus TCP connections is 4. Once an EnerVista session is opened on a computer
connected to the UR over Ethernet, the Modbus TCP status shows 3. If the EnerVista application is closed, the Modbus
TCP status shows 4.
Note that the maximum number of PMU TCP connections matches the number of aggregators.
6-10
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.2 STATUS
6.2.20 PARALLEL REDUNDANCY PROTOCOL (PRP)
The Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) defines a redundancy protocol for high availability in substation automation networks.
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS PRP
PRP
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
Total Rx Port A:
Total Rx Port B:
Total Errors:
Mismatches Port A:
Mismatches Port B:
The C30 Controller System is provided with optional PRP capability. This feature is specified as a software
option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section in chapter 2 for details.
a counter for total messages received (either from DANPs or from SANs) on Port A.
a counter for total messages received (either from DANPs or from SANs) on Port B.
TOTAL ERRORS
is a counter for total messages received with an error (bad port code, frame length too short).
MISMATCHES PORT A is a counter for total messages received with an error on Port A (PRP frame, but port received through
and LAN ID in the frame do not match).
is a counter for total messages received with an error on Port B (PRP frame, but port received through
and LAN ID in the frame do not match).
MISMATCHES PORT B
GE Multilin
6-11
6.3 METERING
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3METERING
6.3.1 FLEXELEMENTS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FLEXELEMENT 1
OpSig: 0.000 pu
The operating signals for the FlexElements are displayed in pu values using the following definitions of the base units.
Table 61: FLEXELEMENT BASE UNITS
dcmA
BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured
under the +IN and IN inputs.
FREQUENCY
fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE
POWER FACTOR
PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs
BASE = 100C
SOURCE CURRENT
IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE POWER
PBASE = maximum value of VBASE IBASE for the +IN and IN inputs
SOURCE VOLTAGE
VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and IN inputs
IEC 61850
GOOSE ANALOGS
ANALOG INPUT
0.000
MESSAGE
ANALOG INPUT
0.000
MESSAGE
ANALOG INPUT
0.000
MESSAGE
ANALOG INPUT 32
0.000
The C30 Controller System is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability. This feature is
specified as a software option at the time of ordering. See the Order Codes section of chapter 2 for details.
The IEC 61850 GGIO3 analog input data points are displayed in this menu. The GGIO3 analog data values are received
via IEC 61850 GOOSE messages sent from other devices.
6.3.3 TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O DCMA INPUTS DCMA INPUT xx
DCMA INPUT xx
DCMA INPUT xx
0.000 mA
Actual values for each dcmA input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID
and the bottom line as the value followed by the programmed units.
6-12
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.3 METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS RTD INPUT xx
RTD INPUT xx
RTD INPUT xx
-50 C
Actual values for each RTD input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID and
the bottom line as the value.
GE Multilin
6-13
6.4 RECORDS
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.4RECORDS
EVENT RECORDS
EVENT: XXXX
RESET OP(PUSHBUTTON)
MESSAGE
EVENT: 3
POWER ON
EVENT 3
DATE: 2000/07/14
MESSAGE
EVENT: 2
POWER OFF
EVENT 3
TIME: 14:53:00.03405
MESSAGE
EVENT: 1
EVENTS CLEARED
The event records menu shows the contextual data associated with up to the last 1024 events, listed in chronological order
from most recent to oldest. If all 1024 event records have been filled, the oldest record will be removed as a new record is
added. Each event record shows the event identifier/sequence number, cause, and date/time stamp associated with the
event trigger. Refer to the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing event records.
6.4.2 OSCILLOGRAPHY
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS OSCILLOGRAPHY
OSCILLOGRAPHY
FORCE TRIGGER?
No
MESSAGE
NUMBER OF TRIGGERS:
0
MESSAGE
AVAILABLE RECORDS:
0
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
This menu allows the user to view the number of triggers involved and number of oscillography traces available. The
CYCLES PER RECORD value is calculated to account for the fixed amount of data storage for oscillography. See the Oscillography section of chapter 5 for additional details.
A trigger can be forced here at any time by setting Yes to the FORCE TRIGGER? command. Refer to the COMMANDS
menu for information on clearing the oscillography records.
CLEAR RECORDS
6-14
GE Multilin
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.4 RECORDS
6.4.3 DATA LOGGER
DATA LOGGER
The OLDEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time at which the oldest available samples were taken. It will be static until the log
gets full, at which time it will start counting at the defined sampling rate. The NEWEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time the
most recent samples were taken. It counts up at the defined sampling rate. If the data logger channels are defined, then
both values are static.
Refer to the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing data logger records.
GE Multilin
6-15
6 ACTUAL VALUES
6.5PRODUCT INFORMATION
SERIAL NUMBER:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
MANUFACTURING DATE:
0
MESSAGE
Range: Yes, No
MESSAGE
OPERATING TIME:
0:00:00
MESSAGE
MODEL INFORMATION
MESSAGE
The order code, serial number, Ethernet MAC address, date and time of manufacture, and operating time are shown here.
6.5.2 FIRMWARE REVISIONS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES PRODUCT INFO FIRMWARE REVISIONS
C30 Controller
REVISION:
7.2x
MESSAGE
MODIFICATION FILE
NUMBER:
0
MESSAGE
BOOT PROGRAM
REVISION:
3.01
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
COMPILE DATE:
2012/09/15 04:55:16
MESSAGE
BOOT DATE:
2012/09/15 16:41:32
FIRMWARE REVISIONS
The shown data is illustrative only. A modification file number of 0 indicates that, currently, no modifications have been
installed.
6-16
GE Multilin
7.1 COMMANDS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
SET DATE AND TIME
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
RELAY MAINTENANCE
MESSAGE
COMMANDS
SECURITY
The commands menu contains relay directives intended for operations personnel. All commands can be protected from
unauthorized access via the command password; see the Security section of chapter 5 for details. The following flash message appears after successfully command entry:
COMMAND
EXECUTED
7.1.2 VIRTUAL INPUTS
PATH: COMMANDS VIRTUAL INPUTS
COMMANDS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
Virt Ip
Off
Range: Off, On
Virt Ip
Off
Range: Off, On
MESSAGE
Virt Ip 64
Off
Range: Off, On
The states of up to 64 virtual inputs are changed here. The first line of the display indicates the ID of the virtual input. The
second line indicates the current or selected status of the virtual input. This status will be a state off (logic 0) or on (logic 1).
GE Multilin
7-1
7.1 COMMANDS
COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS
CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY?
No
CLEAR UNAUTHORIZED
ACCESS? No
Range: No, Yes. Valid only for units with Direct Input/
Output module.
CLEAR TELEPROTECT
COUNTERS? No
This menu contains commands for clearing historical data such as the event records. Data is cleared by changing a command setting to Yes and pressing the ENTER key. After clearing data, the command setting automatically reverts to No.
7.1.4 SET DATE AND TIME
PATH: COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME
COMMANDS
SET DATE AND TIME
(YYYY/MM/DD HH:MM:SS)
The date and time can be entered on the faceplate keypad. The time setting is based on the 24-hour clock. The complete
date, as a minimum, must be entered to allow execution of this command. The new time and date take effect when the
ENTER key is pressed.
When the relay is synchronizing to an external time source such as PTP, IRIG-B, or SNTP, the manually entered time is
over-written.
The timescale of the entered time is local time, including daylight savings time where and when applicable.
7-2
GE Multilin
7.1 COMMANDS
7.1.5 RELAY MAINTENANCE
COMMANDS
RELAY MAINTENANCE
PERFORM LAMPTEST?
No
REBOOT RELAY?
No
SERVICE COMMAND:
0
Range: 0, 101
This menu contains commands for relay maintenance purposes. Commands for the lamp test and order code are activated
by changing a command setting to Yes and pressing the ENTER key. The command setting will then automatically revert
to No. The service command is activated by entering a numerical code and pressing the ENTER key.
The PERFORM LAMPTEST command turns on all faceplate LEDs and display pixels for a short duration. The UPDATE
ORDER CODE command causes the relay to scan the backplane for the hardware modules and update the order code to
match. If an update occurs, the following message is shown.
UPDATING...
PLEASE WAIT
There is no impact if there have been no changes to the hardware modules. When an update does not occur, the ORDER
CODE NOT UPDATED message will be shown.
The SERVICE COMMAND is used to perform specific C30 service actions. Presently, there is only one service action available. Code 101 is used to clear factory diagnostic information stored in the non-volatile memory. If a code other than 101
is entered, the command will be ignored and no actions will be taken. Various self-checking diagnostics are performed in
the background while the C30 is running, and diagnostic information is stored on the non-volatile memory from time to time
based on the self-checking result. Although the diagnostic information is cleared before the C30 is shipped from the factory,
the user may want to clear the diagnostic information for themselves under certain circumstances. For example, it may be
desirable to clear diagnostic information after replacement of hardware. Once the diagnostic information is cleared, all selfchecking variables are reset to their initial state and diagnostics will restart from scratch.
The REBOOT RELAY COMMAND reboots the relay so that changes to configuration settings can take effect. In most cases, if
changes are made to the configuration settings these changes do not take effect unless the relay is rebooted.
With the CyberSentry option, the Administrator or Operator role can initiate the Reboot Relay command.
NOTE
7.1.6 SECURITY
iPATH: COMMANDS SECURITY
SECURITY
ADMINISTRATOR
LOGOFF: No
Range: Yes, No
Default: No
ENGINEER
LOGOFF: No
Range: Yes, No
Default: No
OPERATOR
LOGOFF: No
Range: Yes, No
Default: No
Range: Yes, No
Default: No
With the CyberSentry option, this setting is available to enable or disable the following commands:
Administrator Logoff: Selecting Yes allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an administrator session.
GE Multilin
7-3
7.1 COMMANDS
Engineer Logoff: Selecting Yes allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an engineer session.
Operator Logoff: Selecting Yes allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an operator session.
Clear Security Data: Selecting Yes allows the Supervisor to forcefully clear all the security logs and clears all the
operands associated with the self-tests.
7-4
GE Multilin
7.2 TARGETS
7.2TARGETS
TARGETS
MESSAGE
DIGITAL ELEMENT
LATCHED
1:
MESSAGE
MESSAGE
The status of any active targets will be displayed in the targets menu. If no targets are active, the display will read NO
ACTIVE TARGETS:
ACTIVE STATUS
DESCRIPTION
OP
PKP
LATCHED
If a self test error is detected, a message appears indicating the cause of the error. For example UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED
indicates that the minimal relay settings have not been programmed.
7.2.3 RELAY SELF-TESTS
a) DESCRIPTION
The relay performs a number of self-test diagnostic checks to ensure device integrity. The two types of self-tests (major and
minor) are listed in the tables below. When either type of self-test error occurs, the Trouble LED Indicator will turn on and a
target message displayed. All errors record an event in the event recorder. Latched errors can be cleared by pressing the
RESET key, providing the condition is no longer present.
Major self-test errors also result in the following:
All other output relays are de-energized and are prevented from further operation.
GE Multilin
7-5
7.2 TARGETS
What to do: Contact the factory and supply the failure code noted in the display. The xxx text identifies the failed module (for example, F8L).
INCOMPATIBLE H/W:
Contact Factory (xxx)
Description of problem: One or more installed hardware modules is not compatible with the C30 order code.
What to do: Contact the factory and supply the failure code noted in the display. The xxx text identifies the failed module (for example, F8L).
EQUIPMENT MISMATCH:
with 2nd line detail
Description of problem: The configuration of modules does not match the order code stored in the C30.
How often the test is performed: On power up. Afterwards, the backplane is checked for missing cards every five seconds.
What to do: Check all modules against the order code, ensure they are inserted properly, and cycle control power. If
the problem persists, contact the factory.
FLEXLOGIC ERROR:
with 2nd line detail
How often the test is performed: The test is event driven, performed whenever FlexLogic equations are modified.
What to do: Finish all equation editing and use self tests to debug any errors.
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED:
Check Settings
Description of problem: The PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS setting indicates the C30 is not programmed.
How often the test is performed: On power up and whenever the PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS
setting is altered.
What to do: Program all settings and then set PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS to Programmed.
7-6
GE Multilin
7.2 TARGETS
Description of problem: A data item in a configurable GOOSE data set is not supported by the C30 order code.
What to do: Verify that all the items in the GOOSE data set are supported by the C30. The EnerVista UR Setup software will list the valid items. An IEC61850 client will also show which nodes are available for the C30.
Description of problem: A data item in a configurable report data set is not supported by the C30 order code.
What to do: Verify that all the items in the configurable report data set are supported by the C30. The EnerVista UR
Setup software will list the valid items. An IEC61850 client will also show which nodes are available for the C30.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Replace Battery
How often the test is performed: The battery is monitored every five seconds. The error message displays after 60 seconds if the problem persists.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Direct I/O Ring Break
Description of problem: Direct input and output settings are configured for a ring, but the connection is not in a ring.
What to do: Check direct input and output configuration and wiring.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
ENET PORT # OFFLINE
Description of problem: The Ethernet connection has failed for the specified port.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
**Bad IRIG-B Signal**
GE Multilin
7-7
7.2 TARGETS
How often the test is performed: Monitored whenever an IRIG-B signal is received.
Proper cable functionality (that is, check for physical damage or perform a continuity test).
Check the input signal level (it may be less than specification).
Description of problem: No PTP enabled port has good PTP signal input.
How often the test is performed: Activated when no acceptable signal is being received.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Port ## Failure
What to do: Check Ethernet connections. Port 1 is the primary port and port 2 is the secondary port.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
SNTP Failure
What to do: Check that Ethernet cable(s) are properly connected. Check that configuration for the SNTP server corresponds to the actual server settings. Check connectivity to the server (ping the server IP address.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
4L Discrepancy
Description of problem: A discrepancy has been detected between the actual and desired state of a latching contact
output of an installed type 4L module.
How often the test is performed: Upon initiation of a contact output state change.
What to do: Verify the state of the output contact and contact the factory if the problem persists.
7-8
GE Multilin
7.2 TARGETS
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
GGIO Ind xxx oscill
How often the test is performed: Upon scanning of each configurable GOOSE data set.
What to do: The xxx text denotes the data item that has been detected as oscillating. Evaluate all logic pertaining to
this item.
What to do: Check direct input and output configuration and wiring.
How often the test is performed: Event driven. The test is performed when a device programmed to receive GOOSE
messages stops receiving. This can be from 1 to 60 seconds, depending on GOOSE packets.
TEMP MONITOR:
OVER TEMPERATURE
Description of problem: The ambient temperature is greater than the maximum operating temperature (+80C).
What to do: Remove the C30 from service and install in a location that meets operating temperature standards.
UNEXPECTED RESTART:
Press RESET key
Description of problem: Abnormal restart from modules being removed or inserted while the C30 is powered-up, when
there is an abnormal DC supply, or as a result of internal relay failure.
GE Multilin
7-9
7.2 TARGETS
Description of problem: A link loss detection on an Ethernet port. The link loss is due to unplugging the cable or the
switch port being down.
7-10
GE Multilin
7.2 TARGETS
GE Multilin
7-11
7.2 TARGETS
7-12
GE Multilin
8 MAINTENANCE
8.1 MODULES
Withdraw or insert a module only when control power has been removed from the unit, and be
sure to insert only the correct module type into a slot, else personal injury, damage to the unit
or connected equipment, or undesired operation can result.
To avoid damage to the equipment, use proper electrostatic discharge protection (for example, a
static strap) when coming in contact with modules while the relay is energized.
The relay, being modular in design, allows for the withdrawal and insertion of modules. Modules must only be replaced with
like modules in their original factory configured slots.
The enhanced faceplate can be opened to the left, once the thumb screw has been removed, as shown below. This allows
for easy accessibility of the modules for withdrawal. The new wide-angle hinge assembly in the enhanced front panel opens
completely and allows easy access to all modules in the C30.
842812A1.CDR
GE Multilin
8-1
8.1 MODULES
8 MAINTENANCE
To properly insert a module, ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot position. The ejector/
inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as the module is
smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage the clips simultaneously.
When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
CPU connections must be individually disconnected from the module before the module can be removed from the
chassis.
NOTE
NOTE
8-2
GE Multilin
8 MAINTENANCE
8.2 BATTERIES
8.2 BATTERIES
When required, the battery can be replaced. Because the power supply module contains the battery and there are two possible power supplies, two procedures are possible. Check the power supply module or use the photographs here to determine which procedure to use.
a) REPLACE BATTERY FOR RH POWER SUPPLY
When required, the battery can be replaced. The power supply module contains the battery.
To avoid injury, ensure that the unit has been powered off for a minimum of three minutes
before replacing the battery.
Risk of fire if battery is replaced with incorrect type or polarity.
To replace the battery:
1.
2.
Wait a minimum of three minutes to ensure that there is no power to the battery.
3.
As outlined in the previous section, open the unit by sliding up the latch on the right side of the front panel and opening
the panel to the left.
4.
Unscrew the bracket on the front left of the unit so that you can open fully the front panel to access the power supply
module, which is typically in the first slot on the left side.
5.
Simultaneously pull the ejector clips at the top and bottom of the power supply module and remove the module.
6.
Unscrew the screw that attaches the metal cover to the module.
7.
Slide the metal cover away from the clips about 1 cm (1/4 inch) and remove the cover.
8.
Unclip the black plastic holder that keeps the battery in place. The plastic clips into the socket at the bottom on both
sides. Use a flat-head screwdriver if you cannot unclip the plastic with your fingers.
9.
Observe the + and - polarity of the battery and replace it with the same polarity as marked on the battery holder.
Replace the battery with the identical make and model. For example, do not use a rechargeable battery.
Figure 83: BATTERY LOCATION ON RH POWER SUPPLY MODULE
8
10. Reinstall the battery clip and the metal cover, and reinsert the power supply module into the unit.
11. Power on the unit.
12. Dispose of the old battery as outlined in the next section.
GE Multilin
8-3
8.2 BATTERIES
8 MAINTENANCE
2.
Wait a minimum of three minutes to ensure that there is no power to the battery.
3.
As outlined in the previous section, open the unit by sliding up the latch on the right side of the front panel and opening
the panel to the left.
4.
Unscrew the bracket on the front left of the unit so that you can open fully the front panel to access the power supply
module, which is typically in the first slot on the left side.
5.
Simultaneously pull the ejector clips at the top and bottom of the power supply module and remove the module.
6.
Unscrew all four screws (not three) that attach the metal cover to the module.
7.
Slide the metal cover away from the clips about 1 cm (1/4 inch) and remove the cover.
8.
Unclip the black plastic holder that keeps the battery in place. The plastic clips into the socket at the bottom on both
sides. Use a flat-head screwdriver if you cannot unclip the plastic with your fingers.
9.
Observe the + and - polarity of the battery and replace it with the same polarity as marked on the battery holder.
Replace the battery with the identical make and model. For example, do not use a rechargeable battery.
Figure 84: BATTERY LOCATION ON RH REV B POWER SUPPLY MODULE
8
10. Reinstall the battery clip and the metal cover, and reinsert the power supply module into the unit.
11. Power on the unit.
12. Dispose of the old battery as outlined in the next section.
8-4
GE Multilin
8 MAINTENANCE
8.2 BATTERIES
8.2.2 DISPOSE OF BATTERY
EN Battery Disposal
This product contains a battery that cannot be disposed of as unsorted municipal waste in the European Union. See the product
documentation for specific battery information. The battery is marked with this symbol, which may include lettering to indicate cadmium
(Cd), lead (Pb), or mercury (Hg). For proper recycling return the battery to your supplier or to a designated collection point. For more
information see: www.recyclethis.info.
CS Nakldn s bateriemi
Tento produkt obsahuje baterie, kter nemohou bt znekodnny v Evropsk unii jako netdn komunln odpadu. Viz dokumentace k
produktu pro informace pro konkrtn baterie. Baterie je oznaena tmto symbolem, kter me zahrnovat i uvedena psmena, kadmium
(Cd), olovo (Pb), nebo rtu (Hg). Pro sprvnou recyklaci bateri vrate svmudodavateli nebo na urenm sbrnm mst. Pro vce informac
viz: www.recyclethis.info.
DA Batteri affald
Dette produkt indeholder et batteri som ikke kan bortskaffes sammen med almindeligt husholdningsaffald i Europa. Se
produktinformation for specifikke informationer om batteriet. Batteriet er forsynet med indgraveret symboler for hvad batteriet
indeholder: kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb) og kvikslv (Hg). Europiske brugere af elektrisk udstyr skal aflevere kasserede produkter til genbrug
eller til leverandren. Yderligere oplysninger findes p webstedet www.recyclethis.info.
EL
. .
, (Cd), (Pb),
(Hg). .
: www.recyclethis.info.
ES Eliminacion de baterias
Este producto contiene una batera que no se pueda eliminar como basura normal sin clasificar en la Unin Europea. Examine la
documentacin del producto para la informacin especfica de la batera. La batera se marca con este smbolo, que puede incluir siglas
para indicar el cadmio (Cd), el plomo (Pb), o el mercurio (Hg ). Para el reciclaje apropiado, devuelva este producto a su distribuidor
deshgase de l en los puntos de reciclaje designados. Para mas informacin : wwwrecyclethis.info.
ET Patareide krvaldamine
Kesolev toode sisaldab patareisid, mida Euroopa Liidus ei tohi krvaldada sorteerimata olmejtmetena. Andmeid patareide kohta
vaadake toote dokumentatsioonist. Patareid on mrgistatud kesoleva smboliga, millel vib olla kaadmiumi (Cd), pliid (Pb) vi
elavhbedat (Hg) thistavad thed. Nuetekohaseks ringlusse vtmiseks tagastage patarei tarnijale vi kindlaksmratud
vastuvtupunkti. Lisainformatsiooni saab Internetist aadressil: www.recyclethis.info.
GE Multilin
8-5
8.2 BATTERIES
8 MAINTENANCE
IT Smaltimento batterie
Questo prodotto contiene una batteria che non pu essere smaltita nei comuni contenitori per lo smaltimento rifiuti, nell' Unione
Europea. Controllate la documentazione del prodotto per le informazioni specifiche sulla batteria. La batteria contrassegnata con
questo simbolo e pu includere alcuni caratteri ad indicare la presenza di cadmio (Cd), piombo (Pb) oppure mercurio (Hg). Per il corretto
smaltimento, potete restituirli al vostro fornitore locale, oppure rivolgervi e consegnarli presso i centri di raccolta preposti. Per maggiori
informazioni vedere: ww.recyclethis.info.
LT Baterij alinimas
ios rangos sudtyje yra baterij, kurias draudiama alinti Europos Sjungos vieose neriuot atliek alinimo sistemose. Informacij
apie baterijas galite rasti rangos techninje dokumentacijoje. Baterijos ymimos iuo simboliu, papildomai gali bti nurodoma kad
baterij sudtyje yra kadmio (Cd), vino (Pb) ar gyvsidabrio (Hg). Eksploatavimui nebetinkamas baterijas pristatykite tam skirtas
surinkimo vietas arba grinkite jas tiesioginiam tiekjui, kad jos bt tinkamai utilizuotos. Daugiau informacijos rasite ioje interneto
svetainje: www.recyclethis.info.
LV Bateriju likvidana
is produkts satur bateriju vai akumulatoru, kuru nedrkst izmest Eiropas Savienb esoajs sadzves atkritumu sistms. Sk. produkta
dokumentcij, kur ir nordta konkrta informcija par bateriju vai akumulatoru. Baterijas vai akumulatora marjum ir is simbols,
kas var ietvert burtus, kuri norda kadmiju (Cd), svinu (Pb) vai dzvsudrabu (Hg). Pc ekspluatcijas laika beigm baterijas vai akumulatori
jnodod piegdtjam vai specializt bateriju savkanas viet. Skku informciju var iegt vietn: www.recyclethis.info.
NO Retur av batteri
Dette produkt inneholder et batteri som ikke kan kastes med usortert kommunalt sppel i den Europeiske Unionen. Se
produktdokumentasjonen for spesifikk batteriinformasjon. Batteriet er merket med dette symbolet som kan inkludere symboler for
indikere at kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb), eller kvikkslv (Hg) forekommer. Returner batteriet til leverandren din eller til et dedikert
oppsamlingspunkt for korrekt gjenvinning. For mer informasjon se: www.recyclethis.info.
PT Eliminao de Baterias
Este produto contm uma bateria que no pode ser considerado lixo municipal na Unio Europeia. Consulte a documentao do
produto para obter informao especfica da bateria. A bateria identificada por meio de este smbolo, que pode incluir a rotulao
para indicar o cdmio (Cd), chumbo (Pb), ou o mercrio (hg). Para uma reciclagem apropriada envie a bateria para o seu fornecedor ou
para um ponto de recolha designado. Para mais informao veja: www.recyclethis.info.
RU
, , ,
.
. , , (Cd), (Pb)
(Hg).
. -: www.recyclethis.info.
SK Zaobchdzanie s batriami
Tento produkt obsahuje batriu, s ktorou sa v Eurpskej nii nesmie naklada ako s netriedenm komunlnym odpadom. Dokumentcia
k produktu obsahuje pecifick informcie o batrii. Batria je oznaen tmto symbolom, ktor me obsahova psmen na oznaenie
kadmia (Cd), olova (Pb), alebo ortuti (Hg). Na sprvnu recyklciu vrte batriu vmu loklnemu dodvateovi alebo na uren zbern
miesto. Pre viac informcii pozrite: www.recyclethis.info.
SL Odlaganje baterij
Ta izdelek vsebuje baterijo, ki je v Evropski uniji ni dovoljeno odstranjevati kot nesortiran komunalni odpadek. Za posebne informacije o
bateriji glejte dokumentacijo izdelka. Baterija je oznaena s tem simbolom, ki lahko vkljuuje napise, ki oznaujejo kadmij (Cd), svinec (Pb)
ali ivo srebro (Hg). Za ustrezno recikliranje baterijo vrnite dobavitelju ali jo odstranite na doloenem zbiraliu. Za ve informacij obiite
spletno stran: www.recyclethis.info.
8-6
GE Multilin
8 MAINTENANCE
8.2 BATTERIES
SV Kassering av batteri
Denna produkt innehller ett batteri som inte fr kastas i allmnna sophanteringssytem inom den europeiska unionen. Se
produktdokumentationen fr specifik batteriinformation. Batteriet r mrkt med denna symbol, vilket kan innebra att det innehller
kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb) eller kvicksilver (Hg). Fr korrekt tervinning skall batteriet returneras till leverantren eller till en drfr avsedd
deponering. Fr mer information, se: www.recyclethis.info.
Global Contacts
North America
905-294-6222
Latin America
+(34) 94 485 88 00
Asia
+86-21-2401-3208
India
+91 80 41314617
GE Multilin
8-7
8.2 BATTERIES
8 MAINTENANCE
8-8
GE Multilin
APPENDIX A
FlexAnalog items are also viewable in a web browser. In the browser, enter the IP address of the UR, access the Device
Information Menu option, then the FlexAnalog Parameter Listing option.
TABLE A1: FLEXANALOG DATA ITEMS (Sheet 1 of 4)
ADDRESS
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
5824
---
5825
---
5826
---
5827
---
5828
---
5829
---
5830
---
5831
---
5832
---
5834
---
5836
---
5838
---
5840
---
5842
---
5844
---
5846
---
12306
---
13504
mA
13506
mA
13508
mA
13510
mA
13512
mA
13514
mA
13516
mA
13518
mA
13520
mA
13522
mA
13524
mA
13526
mA
13528
mA
13530
mA
13532
mA
13534
mA
13536
mA
13538
mA
13540
mA
13542
mA
13544
mA
13546
mA
13548
mA
13550
mA
13552
---
GE Multilin
A-1
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
13553
---
13554
---
13555
---
13556
---
13557
---
13558
---
13559
---
13560
---
13561
---
13562
---
13563
---
13564
---
13565
---
13566
---
13567
---
13568
---
13569
---
13570
---
13571
---
13572
---
13573
---
13574
---
13575
---
13576
---
13577
---
13578
---
13579
---
13580
---
13581
---
13582
---
13583
---
13584
---
13585
---
13586
---
13587
---
13588
---
13589
---
13590
---
13591
---
13592
---
13593
---
13594
---
13595
---
13596
---
13597
---
13598
---
13599
---
A-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
13600
Ohms
13601
Ohms
14189
PTPIRIG-B Delta
ns
24447
---
32768
Tracking Frequency
Hz
Tracking frequency
39168
FlexElement 1 Value
---
39170
FlexElement 2 Value
---
39172
FlexElement 3 Value
---
39174
FlexElement 4 Value
---
39176
FlexElement 5 Value
---
39178
FlexElement 6 Value
---
39180
FlexElement 7 Value
---
39182
FlexElement 8 Value
---
39184
FlexElement 9 Value
---
39186
FlexElement 10 Value
---
39188
FlexElement 11 Value
---
39190
FlexElement 12 Value
---
39192
FlexElement 13 Value
---
39194
FlexElement 14 Value
---
39196
FlexElement 15 Value
---
39198
FlexElement 16 Value
---
42336
PID 1 Out
---
PID 1 out
42338
---
42340
PID 1 Setpoint
---
PID 1 setpoint
42342
PID 2 Out
---
PID 2 out
42344
---
42346
PID 2 Setpoint
---
PID 2 setpoint
42348
PID 3 Out
---
PID 3 out
42350
---
42352
PID 3 Setpoint
---
PID 3 setpoint
42354
PID 4 Out
---
PID 4 out
42356
---
42358
PID 4 Setpoint
---
PID 4 setpoint
45584
GOOSE Analog In 1
---
45586
GOOSE Analog In 2
---
45588
GOOSE Analog In 3
---
45590
GOOSE Analog In 4
---
45592
GOOSE Analog In 5
---
45594
GOOSE Analog In 6
---
45596
GOOSE Analog In 7
---
45598
GOOSE Analog In 8
---
45600
GOOSE Analog In 9
---
45602
GOOSE Analog In 10
---
45604
GOOSE Analog In 11
---
45606
GOOSE Analog In 12
---
45608
GOOSE Analog In 13
---
45610
GOOSE Analog In 14
---
GE Multilin
A-3
APPENDIX A
FLEXANALOG NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
45612
GOOSE Analog In 15
---
45614
GOOSE Analog In 16
---
FLEXINTEGER NAME
UNITS
DESCRIPTION
9968
---
9970
---
9972
---
9974
---
9976
---
9978
---
9980
---
9982
---
9984
---
9986
---
9988
---
9990
---
9992
---
9994
---
9996
---
9998
---
A-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
B.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The UR-series relays support a number of communications protocols to allow connection to equipment such as personal
computers, RTUs, SCADA masters, and programmable logic controllers. The Modicon Modbus RTU protocol is the most
basic protocol supported by the UR. Modbus is available via RS232 or RS485 serial links or via ethernet (using the Modbus/TCP specification). The following description is intended primarily for users who wish to develop their own master communication drivers and applies to the serial Modbus RTU protocol. Note that:
The UR always acts as a slave device, meaning that it never initiates communications; it only listens and responds to
requests issued by a master computer.
For Modbus, a subset of the Remote Terminal Unit (RTU) protocol format is supported that allows extensive monitoring, programming, and control functions using read and write register commands.
B.1.2 PHYSICAL LAYER
The Modbus RTU protocol is hardware-independent so that the physical layer can be any of a variety of standard hardware
configurations including RS232 and RS485. The relay includes a faceplate (front panel) RS232 port and two rear terminal
communications ports that may be configured as RS485, fiber optic, 10Base-T, or 10Base-F. Data flow is half-duplex in all
configurations. See chapter 3 for communications wiring.
Each data byte is transmitted in an asynchronous format consisting of 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, and possibly 1 parity
bit. This produces a 10 or 11 bit data frame. This can be important for transmission through modems at high bit rates (11 bit
data frames are not supported by many modems at baud rates greater than 300).
The baud rate and parity are independently programmable for each communications port. Baud rates of 300, 1200, 2400,
4800, 9600, 14400, 19200, 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, or 115200 bps are available. Even, odd, and no parity are available. See the Communications section of chapter 5 for details.
The master device in any system must know the address of the slave device with which it is to communicate. The relay will
not act on a request from a master if the address in the request does not match the relays slave address (unless the
address is the broadcast address see below).
A single setting selects the slave address used for all ports, with the exception that for the faceplate port, the relay will
accept any address when the Modbus RTU protocol is used.
B.1.3 DATA LINK LAYER
Communications takes place in packets which are groups of asynchronously framed byte data. The master transmits a
packet to the slave and the slave responds with a packet. The end of a packet is marked by dead-time on the communications line. The following describes general format for both transmit and receive packets. For exact details on packet formatting, refer to subsequent sections describing each function code.
Table B1: MODBUS PACKET FORMAT
DESCRIPTION
SIZE
SLAVE ADDRESS
1 byte
FUNCTION CODE
1 byte
DATA
N bytes
CRC
2 bytes
DEAD TIME
SLAVE ADDRESS: This is the address of the slave device that is intended to receive the packet sent by the master
and to perform the desired action. Each slave device on a communications bus must have a unique address to prevent
bus contention. All of the relays ports have the same address which is programmable from 1 to 254; see chapter 5 for
details. Only the addressed slave will respond to a packet that starts with its address. Note that the faceplate port is an
exception to this rule; it will act on a message containing any slave address.
A master transmit packet with slave address 0 indicates a broadcast command. All slaves on the communication link
take action based on the packet, but none respond to the master. Broadcast mode is only recognized when associated
with function code 05h. For any other function code, a packet with broadcast mode slave address 0 will be ignored.
GE Multilin
B-1
APPENDIX B
FUNCTION CODE: This is one of the supported functions codes of the unit which tells the slave what action to perform. See the Supported Function Codes section for details. An exception response from the slave is indicated by setting the high order bit of the function code in the response packet. See the Exception Responses section for details.
DATA: This will be a variable number of bytes depending on the function code. This may include actual values, settings, or addresses sent by the master to the slave or by the slave to the master.
CRC: This is a two byte error checking code. The RTU version of Modbus includes a 16-bit cyclic redundancy check
(CRC-16) with every packet which is an industry standard method used for error detection. If a Modbus slave device
receives a packet in which an error is indicated by the CRC, the slave device will not act upon or respond to the packet
thus preventing any erroneous operations. See the CRC-16 Algorithm section for details on calculating the CRC.
DEAD TIME: A packet is terminated when no data is received for a period of 3.5 byte transmission times (about 15 ms
at 2400 bps, 2 ms at 19200 bps, and 300 s at 115200 bps). Consequently, the transmitting device must not allow gaps
between bytes longer than this interval. Once the dead time has expired without a new byte transmission, all slaves
start listening for a new packet from the master except for the addressed slave.
ALGORITHM:
B-2
-->
data transfer
Alow
Ahigh
CRC
i,j
loop counters
(+)
Di
16 bit characteristic polynomial = 1010000000000001 (binary) with MSbit dropped and bit order reversed
shr (x)
right shift operator (th LSbit of x is shifted into a carry flag, a '0' is shifted into the MSbit of x, all other bits
are shifted right one location)
1.
2.
0 --> i
3.
0 --> j
4.
5.
j + 1 --> j
6.
shr (A)
7.
Is there a carry?
8.
Is j = 8?
9.
i + 1 --> i
10.
Is i = N?
11.
A --> CRC
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Modbus officially defines function codes from 1 to 127 though only a small subset is generally needed. The relay supports
some of these functions, as summarized in the following table. Subsequent sections describe each function code in detail.
FUNCTION CODE
MODBUS DEFINITION
GE MULTILIN DEFINITION
04
05
Execute operation
06
10
16
HEX
DEC
03
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
EXAMPLE (HEX)
11
FUNCTION CODE
04
FUNCTION CODE
04
06
40
BYTE COUNT
50
DATA #1 - high
00
00
DATA #1 - low
28
03
DATA #2 - high
01
2C
CRC - low
A7
DATA #2 - low
CRC - high
4A
DATA #3 - high
00
DATA #3 - low
00
CRC - low
0D
CRC - high
60
GE Multilin
B-3
APPENDIX B
B.2.3 EXECUTE OPERATION (FUNCTION CODE 05H)
This function code allows the master to perform various operations in the relay. Available operations are shown in the Summary of operation codes table below.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows a master device requesting the
slave device 11h (17 decimal) to perform a reset. The high and low code value bytes always have the values FF and 00
respectively and are a remnant of the original Modbus definition of this function code.
Table B4: MASTER AND SLAVE DEVICE PACKET TRANSMISSION EXAMPLE
MASTER TRANSMISSION
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
FUNCTION CODE
05
FUNCTION CODE
05
00
00
01
01
FF
FF
00
00
CRC - low
DF
CRC - low
DF
CRC - high
6A
CRC - high
6A
DEFINITION
DESCRIPTION
0000
NO OPERATION
0001
RESET
0005
Performs the same function as the faceplate CLEAR EVENT RECORDS menu
command.
0006
CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY
1000 to 103F
VIRTUAL IN 1 to 64 ON/OFF
SLAVE RESPONSE
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
FUNCTION CODE
06
FUNCTION CODE
06
40
40
51
51
DATA - high
00
DATA - high
00
DATA - low
C8
DATA - low
C8
CRC - low
CE
CRC - low
CE
CRC - high
DD
CRC - high
DD
B-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
This function code allows the master to modify the contents of a one or more consecutive setting registers in a relay. Setting
registers are 16-bit (two byte) values transmitted high order byte first. The maximum number of setting registers that can be
stored in a single packet is 60. The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows
a master device storing the value 200 at memory map address 4051h, and the value 1 at memory map address 4052h to
slave device 11h (17 decimal).
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
EXAMPLE (HEX)
11
FUNCTION CODE
10
FUNCTION CODE
10
40
40
51
51
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - hi
00
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - hi
00
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - lo
02
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - lo
02
BYTE COUNT
04
CRC - lo
07
00
CRC - hi
64
C8
00
01
12
62
SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
PACKET FORMAT
EXAMPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
SLAVE ADDRESS
11
FUNCTION CODE
39
FUNCTION CODE
B9
CD
ERROR CODE
01
F2
93
95
GE Multilin
B-5
APPENDIX B
B.3FILE TRANSFERS
a) DESCRIPTION
The UR relay has a generic file transfer facility, meaning that you use the same method to obtain all of the different types of
files from the unit. The Modbus registers that implement file transfer are found in the "Modbus File Transfer (Read/Write)"
and "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" modules, starting at address 3100 in the Modbus Memory Map. To read a file from
the UR relay, use the following steps:
1.
Write the filename to the "Name of file to read" register using a write multiple registers command. If the name is shorter
than 80 characters, you may write only enough registers to include all the text of the filename. Filenames are not case
sensitive.
2.
Repeatedly read all the registers in "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" using a read multiple registers command. It is
not necessary to read the entire data block, since the UR relay will remember which was the last register you read. The
"position" register is initially zero and thereafter indicates how many bytes (2 times the number of registers) you have
read so far. The "size of..." register indicates the number of bytes of data remaining to read, to a maximum of 244.
3.
Keep reading until the "size of..." register is smaller than the number of bytes you are transferring. This condition indicates end of file. Discard any bytes you have read beyond the indicated block size.
4.
If you need to re-try a block, read only the "size of.." and "block of data", without reading the position. The file pointer is
only incremented when you read the position register, so the same data block will be returned as was read in the previous operation. On the next read, check to see if the position is where you expect it to be, and discard the previous
block if it is not (this condition would indicate that the UR relay did not process your original read request).
The UR relay retains connection-specific file transfer information, so files may be read simultaneously on multiple Modbus
connections.
b) OTHER PROTOCOLS
All the files available via Modbus may also be retrieved using the standard file transfer mechanisms in other protocols (for
example, TFTP or MMS).
c) COMTRADE, OSCILLOGRAPHY, AND DATA LOGGER FILES
Oscillography and data logger files are formatted using the COMTRADE file format per IEEE C37.111-1999 Standard Common Format for Transient Data Exchange (COMTRADE) for Power Systems. The files can be obtained in either text or
binary COMTRADE format.
d) READING OSCILLOGRAPHY FILES
Familiarity with the oscillography feature is required to understand the following description. See the Oscillography section
in chapter 5 for details.
The Oscillography Number of Triggers register increments by one every time a new oscillography file is triggered (captured)
and cleared to zero when oscillography data is cleared. When a new trigger occurs, the associated oscillography file is
assigned a file identifier number equal to the incremented value of this register; the newest file number is equal to the
Oscillography_Number_of_Triggers register. This register can be used to determine if any new data has been captured by
periodically reading it to see if the value has changed; if the number has increased then new data is available.
The Oscillography Number of Records register specifies the maximum number of files (and the number of cycles of data
per file) that can be stored in memory of the relay. The Oscillography Available Records register specifies the actual number of files that are stored and still available to be read out of the relay.
Writing Yes (i.e. the value 1) to the Oscillography Clear Data register clears oscillography data files, clears both the Oscillography Number of Triggers and Oscillography Available Records registers to zero, and sets the Oscillography Last
Cleared Date to the present date and time.
To read binary COMTRADE oscillography files, read the following filenames:
OSCnnnn.CFG and OSCnnn.DAT
Replace nnn with the desired oscillography trigger number. For ASCII format, use the following file names
OSCAnnnn.CFG and OSCAnnn.DAT
B-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
To read from a specific time to the end of the log: <space> startTime
Replace <startTime> and <endTime> with Julian dates (seconds since Jan. 1 1970) as numeric text.
GE Multilin
B-7
APPENDIX B
Local access is defined as any access to settings or commands via the faceplate interface. This includes both keypad entry
and the faceplate RS232 connection. Remote access is defined as any access to settings or commands via any rear communications port. This includes both Ethernet and RS485 connections. Any changes to the local or remote passwords
enables this functionality.
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the C30, the remote password must be used. If the connection
is to the RS232 port of the faceplate, the local password must be used.
The command password is set up at memory location 4000. Command security is required to change the command password. Similarly, the setting password is set up at memory location 4002. These are the same settings found in the SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP PASSWORD SECURITY menu via the keypad. Enabling password security for the faceplate display will
also enable it for Modbus, and vice-versa.
To gain command level security access, the command password must be entered at memory location 4008. To gain setting
level security access, the setting password must be entered at memory location 400A. The entered setting password must
match the current setting password setting, or must be zero, to change settings or download firmware.
Command and setting passwords each have a 30 minute timer. Each timer starts when you enter the particular password,
and is re-started whenever you use it. For example, writing a setting re-starts the setting password timer and writing a command register or forcing a coil re-starts the command password timer. The value read at memory location 4010 can be used
to confirm whether a command password is enabled or disabled (a value of 0 represents disabled). The value read at memory location 4011 can be used to confirm whether a setting password is enabled or disabled.
Command or setting password security access is restricted to the particular port or particular TCP/IP connection on which
the entry was made. Passwords must be entered when accessing the relay through other ports or connections, and the
passwords must be re-entered after disconnecting and re-connecting on TCP/IP.
B-8
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
B.4MEMORY MAPPING
The map is also viewable in a web browser. In the browser, enter the IP address of the UR and click the option.
Table B9: MODBUS MEMORY MAP (Sheet 1 of 51)
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
UR Product Type
0 to 65535
---
F001
0002
Product Version
0 to 655.35
---
0.01
F001
0003
0 to 65535
---
F001
0
0
Serial Number
---
---
---
F203
0020
Manufacturing Date
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
0022
Modification Number
0 to 65535
---
F001
0040
Order Code
---
---
---
F204
Order Code x
0090
---
---
---
F072
0093
---
---
---
F001
00A0
---
---
---
F203
(none)
00B0
---
---
---
F203
(none)
00C0
---
---
---
F203
(none)
FPGA Version
0113
FPGA Date
---
---
---
F206
(none)
0 to 4294967295
--
F050
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 4294967295
F143
Undefined
0 to 65535
---
F501
0220
Display Message
---
---
---
F204
(none)
0248
0 to 47
---
F530
0 (None)
0 to 46
---
F190
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0401
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0402
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0403
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0404
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0405
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0406
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0407
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0408
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0409
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
040F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0410
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0411
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0412
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0413
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
GE Multilin
B-9
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0414
REGISTER NAME
Virtual Input 21 State
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0415
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0416
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0417
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0418
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0419
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
041F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0420
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0421
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0422
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0423
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0424
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0425
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0426
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0427
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0428
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0429
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
042F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0430
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0431
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0432
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0433
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0434
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0435
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0436
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0437
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0438
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0439
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043A
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043B
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043C
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043D
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043E
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
043F
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 254
---
F001
0583
1 to 1440
min
F001
0 to 255
---
F001
0585
0 to 255
---
F001
0586
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0588
058C
0590
B-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0598
059C
05A0
05A4
05A8
05AC
05B0
05B4
05B8
05BC
05C0
05C4
05C8
05CC
05D0
05D4
05D8
05DC
05E0
05E4
05E8
05EC
05F0
05F4
05F8
05FC
0600
0604
0608
060C
0610
0614
0618
061C
0620
0624
0628
062C
0630
0634
0638
063C
0640
0644
0648
064C
0650
0654
0658
065C
0660
0664
0668
GE Multilin
B-11
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
066C
0670
0674
0678
067C
0680
0684
0688
068C
0690
0694
0698
069C
06A0
06A4
06A8
06AC
06B0
06B4
06B8
06BC
06C0
06C4
06C8
06CC
06D0
06D4
06D8
06DC
06E0
06E4
06E8
06EC
06F0
06F4
06F8
06FC
0700
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
1(9)
0 to 1
---
F630
0705
0 to 255
---
F001
0706
0 to 255
---
F001
0707
0 to 1000
---
F001
0708
0 to 65535
---
F600
0709
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
070A
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
070B
0 to 65535
---
F600
070C
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
070D
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
070E
0 to 65535
---
F600
070F
0 to 65.535
---
F001
1000
0710
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
0711
0 to 65535
---
F600
0712
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
B-12
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0713
REGISTER NAME
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
0714
0 to 65535
---
F600
0715
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
0716
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
0717
0 to 65535
---
F600
0718
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
0719
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
071A
0 to 65535
---
F600
071B
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
071C
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
071D
0 to 65535
---
F600
071E
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
071F
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
0720
0 to 65535
---
F600
0721
0 to 65.535
---
0.001
F001
1000
0722
-32768 to 32767
---
F002
0723
0742
0761
0 to 255
---
F001
0781
0 to 255
---
F001
0782
0 to 64
---
F631
0 (OFF)
0783
0 to 64
---
F631
0 (OFF)
0784
0788
078C
0790
0794
0798
079C
07A0
07A4
07A8
07AC
07B0
07B4
07B8
07BC
07C0
07C4
07C8
07CC
07D0
07D4
07D8
07DC
07E0
07E4
07E8
07EC
07F0
07F4
07F8
GE Multilin
B-13
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
07FC
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0800
-2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
0802
-2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
0804
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
0806
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
0808
0810
0818
0820
0828
0830
0838
---
F001
0 to 65535
---
F502
---
---
---
F200
(none)
0 to 65535
---
F001
Target Sequence
0 to 65535
---
F001
14E1
Number of Targets
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 65535
---
F001
---
---
---
F200
Target to Read
Target Message
0 to 65535
---
F500
1508
0 to 65535
---
F500
1510
0 to 65535
---
F500
1518
0 to 65535
---
F500
1520
0 to 65535
---
F500
1528
0 to 65535
---
F500
1530
0 to 65535
---
F500
0 to 65535
---
F500
1542
0 to 65535
---
F500
1550
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
1551
0 to 3
---
F605
3 (Bad)
1552
0 to 3
---
F605
3 (Bad)
1553
0 to 3
---
F605
3 (Bad)
1554
0 to 3
---
F605
3 (Bad)
1555
0 to 3
---
F605
3 (Bad)
0 to 65535
---
F500
15C8
0 to 65535
ms
F001
15C9
0 to 65535
ms
F001
15CA
0 to 65535
---
F001
15CB
0 to 65535
---
F001
15D0
0 to 65535
---
F500
15D1
Reserved
0 to 65535
---
F001
B-14
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
15D2
0 to 65535
---
F001
15D3
0 to 65535
---
F001
0
0
0 to 65535
---
F500
15E3
0 to 65535
---
F500
15EB
0 to 65535
---
F500
15F3
0 to 65535
---
F500
15FB
0 to 65535
---
F500
1603
0 to 65535
---
F500
1604
0 to 65535
---
F500
1605
0 to 65535
---
F500
1606
0 to 65535
---
F500
1607
0 to 65535
---
F500
1608
0 to 65535
---
F500
1609
0 to 65535
---
F500
160A
0 to 65535
---
F500
160B
0 to 65535
---
F500
160C
0 to 65535
---
F500
160D
0 to 65535
---
F500
160E
0 to 65535
---
F500
0
0 (Fail)
0 to 2
---
F134
1611
0 to 2
---
F134
0 (Fail)
1612
0 to 2
---
F134
0 (Fail)
0 to 16
channel
F001
1619
0 to 4294967295
seconds
F050
161B
0 to 4294967295
seconds
F050
161D
0 to 999.9
days
0.1
F001
-32768 to 32767
F002
-32.768 to 32.767
---
0.001
F004
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
16C1
16C2
16C3
16C4
16C5
16C6
16C7
16CA
16CC
16CE
16D0
16D2
16D4
16D6
0 to 7
---
F244
6 (H1a)
2461
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
F001
GE Multilin
1 to 32
B-15
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
2541
0 to 64
---
F606
0 (None)
2542
1 to 64
---
F205
"RemDPS Ip 1"
2548
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
2549
2552
255B
2564
DEFAULT
---
---
---
F612
26D1
---
---
---
F612
26D2
---
---
---
F612
26D3
---
---
---
F612
26D4
---
---
---
F612
26D5
---
---
---
F612
26D6
---
---
---
F612
26D7
---
---
---
F612
26D8
---
---
---
F612
26D9
---
---
---
F612
26DA
---
---
---
F612
26DB
---
---
---
F612
26DC
---
---
---
F612
26DD
---
---
---
F612
26DE
---
---
---
F612
26DF
---
---
---
F612
IEC 61850 Received Integers (Read Only Actual Values) (16 Modules)
26F0
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
26F2
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
26F4
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
26F6
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
26F8
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
26FA
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
26FC
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
26FE
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
2700
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
2702
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
2704
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
2706
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
2708
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
270A
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
270C
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
270E
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 (Off)
0 to 1
---
F108
2D80
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
2E00
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 1
---
F155
0 (Offline)
2F80
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
0 to 65535
---
F001
3001
0 to 65535
---
F001
3002
0 to 400000000
---
F050
B-16
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
Oscillography Number Of Cycles Per Record
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
3011
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 32767
---
F001
---
---
---
F204
(none)
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
3202
0 to 65535
---
F001
3203
0 to 65535
---
F001
---
---
---
F202
(none)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
---
---
---
F202
(none)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
F202
(none)
Security (Read/Write)
3280
Security (Read/Write)
328B
Security (Read/Write)
32A0
Security (Read/Write)
32B5
Security (Read/Write)
32CA
Security (Read/Write)
32DF
0 to 65535
---
F001
3328
0 to 65535
---
F618
0
3
Session Lockout
332A
332B
332C
332E
0 to 99
---
F001
0 to 9999
min
F001
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
1 to 65535
---
F001
514
0 to 1
---
F126
1 (Yes)
3332
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
GE Multilin
B-17
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
3333
Lock Relay
REGISTER NAME
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
3334
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
3335
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
3336
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
3337
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
3338
Bypass Access
0 to 1
---
F628
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
1 to 9999
---
F001
3339
Encryption
333A
Operator Logoff
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
3351
Engineer Logoff
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
3352
Administrator Logoff
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
3353
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 9999
---
F001
3374
0 to 9999
---
F001
0 to 5
---
F617
3 (Engineer)
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
3402
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
3404
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C2
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C4
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C6
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34C8
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34CA
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34CC
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34CE
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34D0
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34D2
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34D4
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34D6
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
0
0
34D8
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34DA
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34DC
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34DE
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E0
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E2
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E4
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E6
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34E8
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34EA
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34EC
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
34EE
-9999999 to 9999999
---
F004
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F1
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F2
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F3
-32768 to 32767
F002
B-18
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
34F4
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F5
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F6
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F7
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F8
-32768 to 32767
F002
34F9
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FA
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FB
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FC
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FD
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FE
-32768 to 32767
F002
34FF
-32768 to 32767
F002
3500
-32768 to 32767
F002
3501
-32768 to 32767
F002
3502
-32768 to 32767
F002
3503
-32768 to 32767
F002
3504
-32768 to 32767
F002
3505
-32768 to 32767
F002
3506
-32768 to 32767
F002
3507
-32768 to 32767
F002
3508
-32768 to 32767
F002
3509
-32768 to 32767
F002
350A
-32768 to 32767
F002
350B
-32768 to 32767
F002
350C
-32768 to 32767
F002
350D
-32768 to 32767
F002
350E
-32768 to 32767
F002
350F
-32768 to 32767
F002
3510
-32768 to 32767
F002
3511
-32768 to 32767
F002
3512
-32768 to 32767
F002
3513
-32768 to 32767
F002
3514
-32768 to 32767
F002
3515
-32768 to 32767
F002
3516
-32768 to 32767
F002
3517
-32768 to 32767
F002
3518
-32768 to 32767
F002
3519
-32768 to 32767
F002
351A
-32768 to 32767
F002
351B
-32768 to 32767
F002
351C
-32768 to 32767
F002
351D
-32768 to 32767
F002
351E
-32768 to 32767
F002
351F
-32768 to 32767
F002
F001
F001
0 to 65535
3521
0 to 65535
0 to 1
---
F155
0 (Offline)
3570
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
Undefined
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
3737
Undefined
1 to 65535
---
F001
1812
3738
Undefined
1 to 65535
---
F001
1813
GE Multilin
B-19
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
3739
Undefined
REGISTER NAME
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
373B
Undefined
0 to 65535
---
F001
1812
373D
Undefined
0 to 65535
---
F001
1813
373F
Undefined
---
---
F619
0 (EAP-TTLS)
3740
Undefined
1 to 65535
---
F001
2910
3741
Undefined
0 to 9999
sec
F001
10
3742
Undefined
0 to 9999
---
F001
3743
Undefined
---
---
---
F002
(none)
3751
3752
3753
PTP VLAN ID
3754
Undefined (2 items)
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
0 to 255
---
F001
0 to 7
---
F001
0 to 4095
---
F001
0 to 1
---
F001
3757
3758
3759
375C
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 60000
ns
F001
-1000 to 1000
ns
F002
3760
PTP GrandMaster ID
0 to 5
---
F624
0 (none)
0 to 100
--
F073
3764
0 to 999999999
ns
F003
3766
0 to 4
--
F625
0 (Disabled)
3769
RTC Offset
376B
0 to 999999999
ns
F004
-500000000 to 500000000
ns
F004
-262143 to 262143
---
F004
Field Unit 1 ID
0 to 1
---
F205
"U1"
3806
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
3807
0 to 3
---
F243
0 (CC-05)
3808
1 to1
---
F205
"000000000000"
380E
1 to 4
---
F001
380F
381E
382D
383C
384B
385A
3869
0 to 7
---
F244
6 (H1a)
3879
0 to 7
---
F244
4 (H2a)
387A
0 to 7
---
F244
2 (H3a)
387B
0 to 7
---
F244
0 (H4a)
387C
0 to 7
---
F244
7 (H1b)
387D
0 to 7
---
F244
5 (H2b)
387E
0 to 7
---
F244
3 (H3b)
387F
0 to 7
---
F244
1 (H4b)
0 to 16
---
F247
0 (none)
3891
0 to 16
---
F247
0 (none)
B-20
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
3892
0 to 16
---
F248
0 (none))
3893
0 to 16
---
F248
0 (none)
3894
0 to 2
---
F261
1 (Dependability
Biased)
3895
1 to 65000
---
F001
3896
0 to 1
---
F123
0 (1 A)
3897
1 to 65000
---
F001
3898
0 to 1
---
F123
0 (1 A)
3899
0 to 1
---
F100
0 (Wye)
389A
25 to 240
---
0.1
F001
664
389B
1 to 24000
---
F060
389D
0 to 6
---
F166
1 (Vag)
389E
25 to 240
---
0.1
F001
664
389F
1 to 24000
---
F060
38A1
38B2
38C3
38D4
38E5
---
---
---
F205
"FCI 1"
3906
0 to 8
---
F256
0 (none)
3907
1 to 18
---
F001
3908
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
3909
0 to 16
ms
0.5
F001
20
390A
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
390B
3916
3921
392C
3937
3942
394D
3958
3963
396E
3979
3984
398F
399A
39A5
39B0
39BB
39C6
39D1
39DC
39E7
39F2
39FD
3A08
3A13
3A1E
3A29
3A34
GE Multilin
B-21
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
3A3F
3A4A
3A55
3A60
3A6B
3A76
3A81
3A8C
3A97
3AA2
3AAD
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 65535
---
F205
"SI 1"
3B06
0 to 8
---
F256
0 (none)
3B07
1 to 15
---
F001
3B08
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
3B09
3B12
3B1B
3B24
3B2D
3B36
3B3F
3B48
3B51
3B5A
3B63
3B6C
3B75
3B7E
3B87
---
---
---
F205
"FCO U /OUT"
3BB4
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
3BC0
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
3BCC
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
3BD2
3C14
3C56
3C98
3CDA
3D1C
3D5E
0 to 1
---
---
F205
"FLO Ux /LO"
3DCD
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
3DCF
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
3DD1
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
3DD2
0 to 1
---
F001
3DD4
3DE1
3DEE
3DFB
3E08
B-22
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
3E15
3E22
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
"SO 1"
3E36
0 to 65535
---
---
F205
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
3E38
0 to 8
---
F256
0 (none)
3E39
1 to 15
---
F001
3E3A
0 to 8
---
F256
0 (none)
3E3B
1 to 15
---
F001
3E3C
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
3E3D
3E4A
3E57
3E64
3E71
3E7E
3E8B
3E98
3EA5
3EB2
3EBF
3ECC
3ED9
3EE6
3EF3
0 to 1
---
F205
"RTD 1"
3F06
0 to 24
---
F253
0 (none)
3F07
0 to 2
---
F259
0 (100 Ohm
Nickel)
3F08
3F10
3F18
3F20
3F28
3F30
3F38
0 to 1
---
F205
"TRD 1"
3F46
0 to 24
---
F53
0 (none)
3F47
0 to 9
---
F246
6 (0...20mA)
3F48
-9999.999 to 9999.999
---
0.01
F004
3F4A
-9999.999 to 9999.999
---
0.001
F004
100000
3F4C
---
---
---
F206
(none)
3F4F
3F5E
3F6D
3F7C
3F8B
3F9A
3FA9
---
---
F205
(none)
3FBE
---
---
F001
GE Multilin
B-23
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
3FBF
0 to 3
---
F243
0 (CC-05)
3FC0
0 to 4
---
F262
0 (Disabled)
0 to 4294967295
---
F202
0 to 4294967295
---
F202
3FC1
3FCA
3FD3
3FDC
3FE5
3FEE
3FF7
DEFAULT
Passwords (Read/Write)
4014
0 to 4294967295
---
F202
(none)
401E
0 to 4294967295
---
F202
(none)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4029
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
5 to 480
min
F001
402B
5 to 480
min
F001
30
402C
2 to 5
---
F001
402D
5 to 60
min
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
Passwords (Read/Write)
402E
1 to 4294967295
---
F300
4031
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
4033
5 to 480
min
F001
30
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
4049
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0
0 (English)
Language
0 to 3
---
F531
4050
0.5 to 10
0.1
F001
10
4051
10 to 900
F001
300
4052
0 to 3
---
F101
0 (25%)
4053
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4054
1 to 65535
min
F001
30
4055
0.002 to 0.02
pu
0.001
F001
20
4056
0.1 to 1
0.1
F001
10
COM2 Selection
0 to 3
---
F601
0 (RS485)
407E
0 to 1000
ms
10
F001
407F
0 to 1000
ms
10
F001
4080
1 to 254
---
F001
254
8 (115200)
4083
0 to 11
---
F112
4084
0 to 2
---
F113
0 (None)
4085
0 to 11
---
F112
8 (115200)
4086
0 to 2
---
F113
0 (None)
4087
IP Address
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
B-24
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
IP Subnet Mask
REGISTER NAME
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4294966272
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554497
---
---
---
F074
408B
408D
4097
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4098
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4099
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
409A
0 to 5
---
F177
0 (None)
409B
409C
DNP Address
0 to 5
---
F177
0 (None)
0 to 65519
---
F001
409E
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40A3
0 to 65535
---
F001
502
40A4
0 to 65535
---
F001
20000
40A5
0 to 65535
---
F001
80
40A6
0 to 65535
---
F001
69
40A7
0 to 65535
---
F001
0
0 (Disabled)
40A9
0 to 1
---
F102
40AA
0 to 60
F001
40AB
1 to 255
---
F001
10
40AC
0 to 65519
---
F001
40AD
0 to 1
---
F192
1 (Half-Duplex)
40AE
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40AF
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40B0
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40B1
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40B2
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
40B3
40B4
0 to 8
---
F194
2 (1)
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40B6
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40B8
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40BA
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40BC
0 to 100000000
--
F003
30000
40BE
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40C0
1 to 10080
min
F001
1440
40C1
30 to 2048
---
F001
240
40C2
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40C4
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40C6
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
40C8
0 to 32
---
F001
40C9
10 to 65535
---
F001
120
40CA
40E0
0 to 1
---
F001
0 to 65535
---
F001
2404
40E1
40E2
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F001
40E3
1 to 65535
F001
60
40E4
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40E6
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40E8
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40EA
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40EC
0 to1
---
0.01
F001
100
40EE
0 to 100000000
---
F003
30000
40F0
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4104
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
4105
Port 2 IP Address
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
GE Multilin
B-25
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
REGISTER NAME
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4294966272
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554497
0 to 1
---
F192
1 (Full-Duplex)
0 to 2
---
F627
0 (None)
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
4294966272
4109
410B
410C
410D
Port 3 IP Address
410F
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4111
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554497
4113
0 to 1
---
F192
1 (Full-Duplex)
4114
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4115
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4116
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4119
---
---
---
F072
411C
0 to 1
---
F001
413E
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
413F
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4140
1 to 2
---
F001
4141
1 to 3
---
F001
4142
0 to 3
---
F523
0 (1)
4143
0 to 3
---
F524
0 (1)
4144
0 to 3
---
F523
0 (1)
4145
0 to 3
---
F523
0 (1)
4146
1 to 5
---
F001
4147
0 to 5
---
F525
0 (1)
4148
SCADA Protocol
0 to 2
---
F629
0 (DNP 3.0)
4
0 to 4
---
F001
4161
0 to 2
---
F001
4162
0 to 2
---
F001
4163
0 to 5
---
F001
4164
0 to 4
---
F001
4
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
4169
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
416B
1 to 65535
---
F001
123
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
---
---
---
F600
0 to 1
---
F260
0 (continuous)
4191
4192
4194
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
15 to 3600000
ms
F003
60000
0 to 3
---
F623
0 (none)
0 to 235959
---
F050
Synchronizing Source
SR Date Format
0 to 4294967295
---
F051
41A4
SR Time Format
0 to 4294967295
---
F052
41A6
0 to 2
---
F114
0 (None)
41A7
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
41A8
24 to 24
hours
0.5
F002
41A9
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
41AA
0 to 11
---
F237
0 (January)
41AB
0 to 6
---
F238
0 (Sunday)
B-26
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
41AC
0 to 4
---
F239
0 (First)
41AD
0 to 23
---
F001
41AE
0 to 11
---
F237
0 (January)
41AF
0 to 6
---
F238
0 (Sunday)
41B0
0 to 4
---
F239
0 (First)
41B1
0 to 23
---
F001
3 to 64
---
F001
15
41C1
0 to 1
---
F118
0 (Auto.
Overwrite)
41C2
0 to 100
F001
50
41C3
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
41C5
0 to 4
---
F183
2 (16 samples/
cycle)
41D0
0 to 65535
---
F600
4200
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
42B2
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F127
1 (Self-Reset)
42C2
42C3
42C6
42C9
42CC
42CF
42D2
42D5
42D8
42DB
42DE
42E1
42E4
42E7
42EA
42ED
42F0
42F3
42F6
42F9
42FC
42FF
4302
4305
4308
430B
430E
4311
4314
4317
431A
431D
4320
4323
GE Multilin
B-27
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
4326
4329
432C
432F
4332
4335
4338
433B
433E
4341
4344
4347
434A
434D
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4365
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4367
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
4369
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
436B
Total Errors
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
4372
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
4374
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
56554706
4376
437C
4382
4388
438E
---
F133
0 (Not
Programmed)
---
---
---
F202
Relay-1
1 (Enabled)
43E1
Relay Name
0 to 1
---
F102
4442
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4443
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4444
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4445
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
4446
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
4447
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
1 (Enabled)
4448
444A
444C
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
444D
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
444E
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 (Disabled)
Breaker 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
47D1
Breaker 1 Name
---
---
---
F206
Bkr 1"
47D4
Breaker 1 Mode
0 to 1
---
F157
0 (3-Pole)
47D5
Breaker 1 Open
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47D7
Breaker 1 Close
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47D9
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47DB
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
B-28
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
47DD
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47DF
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47E1
0 to 65.535
0.001
F003
47E3
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
47E4
0 to 4294967295
0.001
F003
47E6
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47E8
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47EA
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47EC
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47EE
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
47F0
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
70
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
F001
0 to 65535
---
F001
47F2
47F3
Breaker 1 Events
47F4
Reserved
47F5
---
---
---
F202
4C0A
---
---
---
F202
4C14
0 to 65535
---
F001
4C19
Reserved (7 items)
---
---
---
F001
4C20
4C40
4C60
4C80
4CA0
0 to 0.001
0.001
F003
0 to 0.1
degree
0.1
F002
0 to 0.001
0.001
F003
0 to 0.1
degree
0.1
F002
0
0
4CC0
4CE0
4D00
4D20
4D40
4D60
4D80
4DA0
4DC0
4DE0
4E02
4E03
4E05
4E06
0 to 0.001
0.001
F003
4E08
0 to 0.01
degree
0.1
F002
4E09
0 to 0.001
0.001
F003
0
0
4E0B
0 to 0.01
degree
0.1
F002
4E0C
0 to 0.001
A/V
0.001
F003
4E0E
0 to 0.01
degree
0.1
F002
4E0F
0 to 0.001
A/V
0.001
F003
4E11
0 to 0.01
degree
0.1
F002
4E12
0 to 0.001
A/V
0.001
F003
4E14
0 to 0.01
degree
0.1
F002
4E15
0 to 0.001
A/V
0.001
F003
4E17
0 to 0.01
degree
0.1
F002
GE Multilin
B-29
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
4E18
0 to 0.001
0.001
F002
4E19
0 to 0.001
0.001
F002
4E1A
0 to 0.001
0.001
F002
4E1B
0 to 1
---
F500
4E1D
0 to 1
---
F500
4E1E
0 to 1
---
F500
4E1F
0 to 1
degree
F002
4E20
0 to 1
degree
F002
4E21
0 to 0.01
0.01
F001
4E22
4E23
4E24
4E25
4E27
4E28
4E29
0 to 1
mA
F001
0 to 0.01
dBm
0.1
F002
0
0
0 to 0.1
dBm
0.1
F002
0 to 65535
---
F500
0 to 1
degree
F002
0 to 0.01
0.01
F001
0 to 1
mA
F001
4E2A
0 to 0.1
dBm
0.1
F002
4E2B
0 to 0.1
dBm
0.1
F002
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
2097152
0 (Disabled)
4E2C
4E58
4E84
4E80
4EDC
4F08
4F34
5401
RTD Input 1 ID
5407
5414
5428
543C
5450
5464
5478
548C
54A0
54B4
54C8
54DC
54F0
5404
5518
552C
5540
5554
5568
557C
5590
55A4
55B8
B-30
0 to 1
---
F102
---
---
---
F205
RTD Ip 1
0 to 3
---
F174
0 (100 ohm
Platinum)
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
55CC
55E0
55F4
5508
561C
5630
5644
5658
566C
5680
5694
56A8
56BC
56D0
56E4
56F8
560C
5620
5734
5748
575C
5770
5784
5798
57AC
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 2
---
F129
0 (millisecond)
5801
0 to 60000
---
F001
5802
0 to 60000
---
F001
5803
Reserved (5 items)
0 to 65535
---
F001
5808
5810
5818
5820
5828
5830
5838
5840
5848
5850
5858
5860
5868
5870
5878
5880
5888
5890
5898
58A0
58A8
58B0
58B8
58C0
GE Multilin
B-31
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
58C8
58D0
58D8
58E0
58E8
58F0
58F8
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
74A1
---
---
---
F206
SW 1"
74A4
0 to 1
---
F157
0 (3-Pole)
74A5
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74A7
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74A9
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74AB
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74AD
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74AF
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74B1
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74B3
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74B5
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74B7
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
74B9
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
70
0 to 65.535
0.001
F003
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
---
---
74BA
74BC
74BD
Reserved (2 items)
74BF
74DE
74FD
741C
743B
755A
7579
7598
75B7
75D6
75F5
7614
7633
7652
7671
7690
76AF
76CE
76ED
770C
772B
774A
7769
77F9
Ohm Inputs 1 ID
77FF
7808
B-32
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F205
"Ohm Ip 1 "
0 to 65535
---
F001
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 (Disabled)
0 to 2
---
F137
7B61
---
---
---
F202
(none)
7B6B
---
---
---
F202
(none)
(none)
7B75
---
---
---
F202
7B7F
0 to 60
0.05
F001
7B80
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
7B81
7B82
7B84
7B85
7B86
7B88
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 600
0.05
F001
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 2
---
F220
0 (Disabled)
0
7B89
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
7B8B
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
7B8D
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
7B8F
0 to 10
0.1
F001
7B90
7BC0
7BF0
7C20
7C50
7C80
7CB0
7DE0
7D10
7D40
7D70
7DA0
7DD0
7E00
7E30
Reserved Register T1
-55 to 125
F002
-55
81C1
Reserved Register T2
-55 to 125
F002
125
81C2
Reserved Register T3
-2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
81C4
Reserved Register T4
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
81C6
Reserved Register T5
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
81C8
Reserved Register T6
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
81CA
Reserved Register T7
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
81CC
Reserved Register T8
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
Switch 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
82C1
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
82D9
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
82E1
Switch 1 Control
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
82E3
Reserved (6 items)
0 to 4294967295
---
F001
82E9
8312
833B
8364
838D
GE Multilin
B-33
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0
83E0
83E1
83E3
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
---
F003
0 to 65535
---
F001
83F1
83F3
83F4
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
---
F003
0 to 65535
---
F001
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
8401
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
8403
50 to 1000
ms
50
F001
1000
8404
0 to 65535
---
F001
8418
---
---
---
F001
0
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
8469
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
846B
500 to 1000
ms
50
F001
1000
846C
0 to 65535
---
F001
846E
---
---
---
F001
84D0
---
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
8A01
---
---
---
F203
Dig Element 1
0
8A09
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
8A0B
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F003
8A0D
0 to 999999.999
0.001
F003
8A0F
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
8A11
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
8A12
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
8A13
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
8A14
Reserved (2 items)
---
---
---
F001
8A16
8A2C
8A42
8A58
8A6E
8A84
8A9A
8AB0
8AC6
8ADC
8AF2
8B08
8B1E
8B34
8B4A
8B60
8B76
8B8C
8BA2
B-34
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
8BB8
8BCE
8BE4
8BFA
8C10
8C26
8C3C
8C52
8C68
8C7E
8C94
8CAA
8CC0
8CD6
8CEC
8D02
8D18
8D2E
8D44
8D5A
8D70
8D86
8D9C
8DB2
8DC8
8DDE
8DF4
8E0A
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
8ED1
8ED3
8ED4
8ED5
8EF5
8EF6
8EF8
8EF9
8EFA
Reserved (8 items)
8F02
8F34
8F66
8F98
8FCA
0 to 1
---
F102
0 to 4294967295
---
---
F300
0 (Disabled)
0
0 to 600
0.01
F001
0
0
0 to 600
0.01
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 65535
---
F300
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F001
FlexElement 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
9001
FlexElement 1 Name
---
---
---
F206
FxE 1
9004
FlexElement 1 InputP
0 to 65535
---
F600
9005
FlexElement 1 InputM
0 to 65535
---
F600
9006
FlexElement 1 Compare
0 to 1
---
F516
0 (LEVEL)
9007
FlexElement 1 Input
0 to 1
---
F515
0 (SIGNED)
9008
FlexElement 1 Direction
0 to 1
---
F517
0 (OVER)
9009
FlexElement 1 Hysteresis
0.1 to 50
0.1
F001
30
900A
FlexElement 1 Pickup
-90 to 90
pu
0.001
F004
1000
GE Multilin
B-35
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
900C
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 2
---
F518
0 (Milliseconds)
900D
900F
FlexElement 1 DeltaT
20 to 86400
---
F003
20
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
9010
0 to 65.535
0.001
F001
9011
FlexElement 1 Block
0 to 65535
---
F300
9013
FlexElement 1 Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
9014
FlexElement 1 Events
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
9015
902A
903F
9054
9069
907E
9093
90A8
90BD
90D2
90E7
90FC
9111
9126
913B
0 to 65535
---
F600
9361
0 to 2
---
F522
0 (1 to 1 mA)
9362
90 to 90
pu
0.001
F004
9364
90 to 90
pu
0.001
F004
1000
9366
936C
9372
9378
937E
9384
938A
9390
9396
939C
93A2
93A8
93AE
93B4
93BA
93C0
93C6
93CC
93D2
93D8
93DE
93E4
93EA
0 to 96
---
F205
Dir Ip 1
9406
1 to 96
---
F205
Dir Out 1
940C
B-36
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
9418
9424
9430
943C
9448
9454
9460
946C
9478
9484
9490
949C
94A8
94B4
94C0
94CC
94D8
94E4
94F0
94FC
9508
9514
9520
952C
9538
9544
9550
955C
9568
9574
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
98A2
98A3
98A6
98A9
98AC
98AF
98B2
98B5
98B8
98BB
98BE
98C1
98C4
98C7
98CA
98CD
0 to 429496295
---
F003
1000
0 to 1
---
F491
0 (Default
Value)
FlexElement 1 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9902
FlexElement 2 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9904
FlexElement 3 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
9906
FlexElement 4 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
GE Multilin
B-37
APPENDIX B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
9908
FlexElement 5 Actual
REGISTER NAME
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
990A
FlexElement 6 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
990C
FlexElement 7 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
990E
FlexElement 8 Actual
-2147483.647 to 2147483.647
---
0.001
F004
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 (Disabled)
Teleprotection Function
0 to 1
---
F102
9991
2 to 3
---
F001
9992
1 to 2
---
F001
9993
0 to 255
---
F001
9994
Teleprotection Terminal 1 ID
0 to 255
---
F001
9995
Teleprotection Terminal 2 ID
0 to 255
---
F001
9996
0 to 1
---
---
F001
9A00
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
9A10
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
9A20
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
9A40
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0
1 (OK)
9AA1
0 to 2
---
F134
0 to 65535
---
F001
9AA2
0 to 2
---
F134
1 (OK)
9AA3
0 to 65535
---
F001
9AA4
0 to 2
---
F134
2 (n/a)
9AAF
0 to 1
---
F500
9AB0
0 to 1
---
F500
9AC0
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
9AD0
0 to 1
---
F108
0 (Off)
1 to 7
---
F001
A211
1 to 7
---
F001
1
0 (Disabled)
Selector 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
A281
Selector 1 Range
1 to 7
---
F001
A282
Selector 1 Timeout
3 to 60
0.1
F001
50
A283
Selector 1 Step Up
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A285
0 to 1
---
F083
0 (Time-out)
A286
Selector 1 Acknowledge
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A288
Selector 1 Bit0
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0
0
A28A
Selector 1 Bit1
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A28C
Selector 1 Bit2
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A28E
0 to 1
---
F083
0 (Time-out)
A28F
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A291
0 to 2
---
F084
0 (Restore)
A292
Selector 1 Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
A293
Selector 1 Events
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A294
---
---
F001
A29E
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A301
---
---
---
F205
Counter 1"
A307
---
---
---
F206
(none)
A30A
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A30C
Digital Counter 1 Up
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
B-38
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
A30E
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A311
2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
A313
2147483647 to
2147483647
---
F004
A315
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A317
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A319
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
---
---
---
F001
0 (Disabled)
A31B
A31D
A328
A350
A378
A3A0
A3C8
A3F0
A418
DEFAULT
PID 1 Function
0 to 1
---
F102
A501
0.05 to 30
sec
0.01
F001
A502
0 to 65535
---
F600
A503
-99999.99 to 99999.99
---
0.01
F004
A505
0 to 56635
---
F600
A506
0.01 to 100
---
0.01
F001
100
A507
0.01 to 1
---
0.01
F001
100
A508
0 to 600
sec
0.01
F001
100
A509
PID 1 Antiwindup
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A50A
0 to 600
sec
0.01
F001
100
A50B
0 to 600
sec
0.01
F001
100
A50C
1 to 20
---
F001
10
A50D
PID 1 Max
-10000 to 10000
---
F002
10
A50E
PID 1 Min
-10000 to 10000
---
F002
10
A50F
PID 1 T Min
100 to 9999
ms
F001
500
A510
1 to 20
sec
F001
A511
PID 1 Block
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A513
PID 1 Target
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
A514
PID 1 Events
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A515
A52A
A53F
PID 1 Out
0 to 999999
---
F004
A562
0 to 999999
---
F004
A564
PID 1 Setpoint
-99999.99 to 99999.99
---
0.01
F004
A566
A56C
A572
---
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
A701
0 to 1
---
F519
0 (Reset
Dominant)
A702
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A704
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
A706
0 to 2
---
F109
0 (Self-reset)
A707
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
GE Multilin
B-39
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
A708
Reserved (4 items)
---
---
---
F001
A70C
A718
A724
A730
1000000 to 1000000
---
0.001
F060
1000
0 to 1
---
F491
0 (Default Value)
A73C
A748
A754
A760
A76C
A778
A784
A790
A79C
A7A8
A7B4
AA02
AA03
AA05
AA07
AA0E
AA15
AA1C
AA23
AA2A
AA31
AA38
AA3F
AA46
AA4D
AA54
AA5B
AA62
AA69
AA70
AA77
AA7E
AA85
AA8C
AA93
AA9A
AAA1
AAA8
AAAF
AAB6
AABD
AAC4
AACB
AAD2
AAD9
---
---
---
F207
(none)
0 to 999999999.999
---
0.001
F060
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
B-40
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
AB02
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F126
AB03
0 (No)
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
AB05
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
AB07
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
AB09
0 to 4
---
F001
AB0A
2 to 60
F001
30
AB0B
AB16
AB21
AB2C
AB37
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AB4B
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
(none)
AC23
0 to 65534
---
F206
AC6B
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AC92
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
ACB0
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
ACCE
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD16
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD19
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD2B
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD3D
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD4C
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD5B
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD6D
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD7F
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AD8B
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
ADFA
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AE54
0 to 65534
---
F206
(none)
AF01
4 to 32
---
F001
100 to 5000
---
10
F001
1000
---
---
---
F600
AF11
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
100000
AF13
1000000000000 to
1000000000000
---
0.001
F060
AF15
1000000000000 to
1000000000000
---
0.001
F060
1000000
AF17
AF1E
AF25
AF2C
AF33
AF3A
AF41
AF48
AF4F
AF56
AF5D
AF64
AF6B
AF72
GE Multilin
B-41
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
AF79
AF80
AF87
AF8E
AF95
AF9C
AFA3
AFAA
AFB1
AFB8
AFBF
AFC6
AFCD
AFD4
AFDB
AFE2
AFE9
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
1 to 60
F001
60
B01D
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
---
---
---
F209
GSSEOut
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
B013
B03F
B040
---
---
---
F072
B043
---
---
---
F209
GOOSEOut
B064
B067
B068
---
---
---
F072
0 to 7
---
F001
0 to 4095
---
F001
B069
0 to 16383
---
F001
B06A
Reserved (2 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0 to 65535
---
F001
102
---
---
---
F213
IECName
B06D
B07D
B08D
B0B5
B0B6
---
---
---
F213
LDInst
0 to 65534
---
---
F204
Location
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0
B0B7
-90 to 90
degree
0.001
F004
B0B9
-180 to 180
degree
0.001
F004
B9BB
0 to 10000
F003
B0BD
Reserved (3 items)
0 to 1
---
F001
0
10000
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
B0C2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0C4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0C6
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0C8
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0CA
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0CC
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0CE
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D0
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D6
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0D8
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B-42
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
B0DA
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
DEFAULT
10000
B0DC
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
10000
B0DE
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
B0E0
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E6
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0E8
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0EA
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0EC
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0EE
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0F0
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0F2
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
B0F4
0.001 to 100
0.001
F003
10000
-1000000000000 to
1000000000000
---
0.001
F060
B0F6
B12C
B162
B198
B1CE
B212
B214
B216
B218
B21A
B21C
B21E
B220
B222
B224
B226
B228
B22A
B22C
B22E
B230
B232
B234
B236
B238
B23A
B23C
B23E
B240
B242
B244
B246
B248
B24A
B24C
B24E
GE Multilin
B-43
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 848
---
F615
0 (None)
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
B373
B376
B379
B37C
B37F
B382
B385
B388
B38B
B38E
B391
B394
B397
B39A
B39D
B3A0
B3A3
B3A6
B3AC
B3AF
B3B2
B3B5
B402
8 to 128
---
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
B5A1
B5C2
B5C5
B5C6
B5C7
B5C8
B5CA
B5CB
B60B
B676
B6E1
B74C
B7B7
B822
B88D
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (None)
---
---
---
F209
GOOSEOut_x_
0
---
---
---
F072
0 to 7
---
F001
0 to 4095
---
F001
0 to 16383
---
F001
1 to 4294967295
---
F003
0 to 3
---
F611
3 (Relaxed)
0 to 1008
---
F616
0 (None)
---
F233
0 (None)
B920
B940
B-44
0 to 197
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
B960
B980
B9A0
B9C0
B9E0
BA00
BA20
BA40
BA60
BA80
BAA0
BAC0
BAE0
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
---
---
---
F205
Cont Ip 1
BB06
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
BB07
0 to 16
ms
0.5
F001
20
BB08
BB10
BB18
BB20
BB28
BB30
BB38
BB40
BB48
BB50
BB58
BB60
BB68
BB70
BB78
BB80
BB88
BB90
BB98
BBA0
BBA8
BBB0
BBB8
BBC0
BBC8
BBD0
BBD8
BBE0
BBE8
BBF0
BBF8
BC00
BC08
BC10
BC18
BC20
BC28
GE Multilin
B-45
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
BC30
BC38
BC40
BC48
BC50
BC58
BC60
BC68
BC70
BC78
BC80
BC88
BC90
BC98
BCA0
BCA8
BCB0
BCB8
BCC0
BCC8
BCD0
BCD8
BCE0
BCE8
BCF0
BCF8
BD00
BD08
BD10
BD18
BD20
BD28
BD30
BD38
BD40
BD48
BD50
BD58
BD60
BD68
BD70
BD78
BD80
BD88
BD90
BD98
BDA0
BDA8
BDB0
BDB8
BDC0
BDC8
BDD0
BDD8
B-46
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
BDE0
BDE8
BDF0
BDF8
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 3
---
F128
1 (33 Vdc)
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
---
---
---
F205
Virt Ip 1
F127
0 (Latched)
BE31
BE37
0 to 1
---
BE38
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
BE39
Reserved (3 items)
---
---
---
F001
BE3C
BE48
BE54
BE60
BE6C
BE78
BE84
BE90
BE9C
BEA8
BEB4
BEC0
BECC
BED8
BEE4
BEF0
BEFC
BF08
BF14
BF20
BF2C
BF38
BF44
BF50
BF5C
BF68
BF74
BF80
BF8C
BF98
BFA4
BFB0
BFBC
BFC8
BFD4
BFE0
BFEC
BFF8
C004
C010
C01C
C028
GE Multilin
B-47
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
C034
C040
C04C
C058
C064
C070
C07C
C088
C094
C0A0
C0AC
C0B8
C0C4
C0D0
C0DC
C0E8
C0F4
C100
C10C
C118
C124
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
---
---
---
F205
Virt Op 1
C136
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
C137
Reserved
---
---
---
F001
C138
C140
C148
C150
C158
C160
C168
C170
C178
C180
C188
C190
C198
C1A0
C1A8
C1B0
C1B8
C1C0
C1C8
C1D0
C1D8
C1E0
C1E8
C1F0
C1F8
C200
C208
C210
C218
B-48
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
C220
C228
C230
C238
C240
C248
C250
C258
C260
C268
C270
C278
C280
C288
C290
C298
C2A0
C2A8
C2B0
C2B8
C2C0
C2C8
C2D0
C2D8
C2E0
C2E8
C2F0
C2F8
C300
C308
C310
C318
C320
C328
C330
C338
C340
C348
C350
C358
C360
C368
C370
C378
C380
C388
C390
C398
C3A0
C3A8
C3B0
C3B8
C3C0
C3C8
GE Multilin
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
B-49
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
C3D0
C3D8
C3E0
C3E8
C3F0
C3F8
C400
C408
C410
C418
C420
C428
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 2
---
F245
0 (Disabled)
C431
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
C432
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 1
--
F126
0 (No)
C436
0 to 1
--
F126
0 (No)
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
C438
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
C456
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
C458
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
C46C
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
C470
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
C472
---
---
---
F001
C602
C603
C606
C609
C60C
C60F
C612
C615
C618
C61B
C61E
C621
C624
C627
C62A
C62D
C630
C633
C636
C639
C63C
B-50
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
C63F
C642
C645
C648
C64B
C64E
C651
C654
C657
C65A
C65E
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
C761
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
C762
C764
C766
C768
C76A
C76C
0 to 2
---
F144
0 (Disabled)
C800
0 to 3
---
F131
0 (Disabled)
Direct Device ID
1 to 16
---
F001
C881
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
C882
64 to 128
kbps
64
F001
64
C883
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
C884
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 to 1
---
F126
0 (No)
0 to 16
---
F001
C891
0 to 96
---
F001
C892
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
C893
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
C894
C898
C89C
C8A0
C8A4
C8A8
C8AC
C8B0
C8B4
C8B8
C8BC
C8C0
C8C4
C8C8
C8CC
C8D0
GE Multilin
B-51
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
C8D4
C8D8
C8DC
C8E0
C8E4
C8E8
C8EC
C8F0
C8F4
C8F8
C8FC
C900
C904
C908
C90C
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
CAD1
CAD2
CAD3
CAD4
Reserved (4 items)
CAD8
CAD9
CADA
CADB
CADC
Reserved (4 items)
CAE0
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
100 to 10000
---
F001
600
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
600
100 to 10000
---
F001
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
600
CAE1
100 to 10000
---
F001
CAE2
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
CAE3
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
CAE4
Reserved (4 items)
CAE8
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
600
CAE9
100 to 10000
---
F001
CAEA
1 to 1000
---
F001
10
CAEB
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
CAEC
Reserved (4 items)
---
---
F001
10
---
---
---
F209
Remote Device
1
CB21
0 to 16383
---
F001
CB22
0 to 16
---
F184
0 (Fixed)
CB24
Undefined
0 to 3
---
F626
0 (None)
CB25
CB4A
CB6F
CB94
CBB9
CBDE
CC03
CC28
CC4D
CC72
CC97
CCBC
B-52
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
CCE1
CD06
CD2B
CD50
CD75
CD9A
CDBF
CDE4
CE09
CE2E
CE53
CE78
CE9D
CEC2
CEE7
CF0C
CF31
CF56
CF7B
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
1 to 32
---
F001
CFA1
0 to 96
---
F156
0 (None)
CFA2
0 to 3
---
F086
0 (Off)
CFA3
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
CFA4
1 to 64
---
F205
Rem Ip 1
CFAA
CFB4
CFBE
CFC8
CFD2
CFDC
CFE6
CFF0
CFFA
D004
D00E
D018
D022
D02C
D036
D040
D04A
D054
D05E
D068
D072
D07C
D086
D090
D09A
D0A4
D0AE
D0B8
D0C2
GE Multilin
B-53
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
D0CC
D0D6
D0E0
D0EA
D0F4
D0FE
D108
D112
D11C
D126
D130
D13A
D144
D14E
D158
D162
D16C
D176
D180
D18A
D194
D19E
D1A8
D1B2
D1BC
D1C6
D1D0
D1DA
D1E4
D1EE
D1F8
D202
D20C
D216
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
D222
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
D223
Reserved
0 to 1
---
F001
D224
D228
D22C
D230
D234
D238
D23C
D240
D244
D248
D24C
D250
D254
D258
D25C
D260
B-54
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
D264
D268
D26C
D270
D274
D278
D27C
D280
D284
D288
D28C
D290
D294
D298
D29C
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
D2A2
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
D2A3
Reserved
0 to 1
---
F001
D2A4
D2A8
D2AC
D2B0
D2B4
D2B8
D2BC
D2C0
D2C4
D2C8
D2CC
D2D0
D2D4
D2D8
D2DC
D2E0
D2E4
D2E8
D2EC
D2F0
D2F4
D2F8
D2FC
D300
D304
D308
D30C
D310
D314
D318
D31C
0 to 2
---
F001
D321
0 to 2
---
F001
D322
0 to 2
---
F001
GE Multilin
B-55
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
D323
0 to 2
---
F001
D324
0 to 2
---
F001
D325
0 to 2
---
F001
D326
0 to 2
---
F001
D327
0 to 2
---
F001
D328
0 to 2
---
F001
D329
0 to 2
---
F001
D32A
0 to 2
---
F001
D32B
0 to 2
---
F001
D32C
0 to 2
---
F001
D32D
0 to 2
---
F001
D32E
0 to 2
---
F001
D32F
0 to 2
---
F001
D330
0 to 2
---
F001
D331
0 to 2
---
F001
D332
0 to 2
---
F001
D333
0 to 2
---
F001
D334
0 to 2
---
F001
D335
0 to 2
---
F001
D336
0 to 2
---
F001
D337
0 to 2
---
F001
D338
0 to 2
---
F001
D339
0 to 2
---
F001
D33A
0 to 2
---
F001
D33B
0 to 2
---
F001
D33C
0 to 2
---
F001
D33D
0 to 2
---
F001
D33E
0 to 2
---
F001
D33F
0 to 2
---
F001
D340
0 to 2
---
F001
D341
0 to 2
---
F001
D342
0 to 2
---
F001
D343
0 to 2
---
F001
D344
0 to 2
---
F001
D345
0 to 2
---
F001
D346
0 to 2
---
F001
D347
0 to 2
---
F001
D348
0 to 2
---
F001
D349
0 to 2
---
F001
D34A
0 to 2
---
F001
D34B
0 to 2
---
F001
D34C
0 to 2
---
F001
D34D
0 to 2
---
F001
D34E
0 to 2
---
F001
D34F
0 to 2
---
F001
D350
0 to 2
---
F001
D351
0 to 2
---
F001
D352
0 to 2
---
F001
D353
0 to 2
---
F001
D354
0 to 2
---
F001
D355
0 to 2
---
F001
D356
0 to 2
---
F001
D357
0 to 2
---
F001
D358
0 to 2
---
F001
B-56
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
D359
0 to 2
---
F001
D35A
0 to 2
---
F001
D35B
0 to 2
---
F001
D35C
0 to 2
---
F001
D35D
0 to 2
---
F001
D35E
0 to 2
---
F001
D35F
0 to 2
---
F001
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
D362
0 to 4294967295
---
F003
D364
D368
Cont Op 1"
D36C
D370
D374
D378
D37C
D380
D384
D388
D38C
D390
D394
D398
D39C
D3A0
D3A4
D3A8
D3AC
D3B0
D3B4
D3B8
D3BC
D3C0
D3C4
D3C8
D3CC
D3D0
D3D4
D3D8
D3DC
---
---
---
F205
D3E6
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
D3E8
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
D3EA
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
D3EC
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
D3ED
0 to 1
---
F090
0 (Operatedominant)
D3EE
Reserved
---
---
---
F001
D3EF
D3FE
D40D
D41C
GE Multilin
B-57
APPENDIX B
ADDR
REGISTER NAME
D42B
D43A
D449
D458
D467
D476
D485
D494
D4A3
D4B2
D4C1
D4D0
D4DF
D4EE
D4FD
D50C
D51B
D52A
D539
D548
D557
D566
D575
D584
D593
D5A2
D5B1
D5C0
D5CF
D5DE
D5ED
D5FC
D60B
D61A
D629
D638
D647
D656
D665
D674
D683
D692
D6A1
D6B0
D6BF
D6CE
D6DD
D6EC
D6FB
D70A
D719
D728
D737
D746
B-58
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
REGISTER NAME
D755
D764
D773
D782
D791
RANGE
UNITS
STEP
FORMAT
DEFAULT
0 to 1
---
F102
0 (Disabled)
DCMA I 1"
D7A1
dcmA Inputs 1 ID
---
---
---
F205
D7A7
Reserved 1 (4 items)
0 to 65535
---
F001
D7AB
---
---
---
F206
mA
6 (4 to 20 mA)
D7AE
0 to 6
---
F173
D7AF
-9999.999 to 9999.999
---
0.001
F004
4000
D7B1
-9999.999 to 9999.999
---
0.001
F004
20000
D7B3
D7C6
D7D9
D7EC
D7FF
D812
D825
D838
D84B
D85E
D871
D884
D897
D8AA
D8BD
D8D0
D8E3
D9F6
D909
D91C
D92F
D942
D955
0 to 4294967295
---
F300
DB68
0 to 65535
---
F600
ED01
Template Access
0 to 1
---
F102
1 (Enabled)
---
---
---
F205
(none)
0 to 4294967295
---
F050
0 to 65535
---
F001
GE Multilin
B-59
APPENDIX B
B.4.2 DATA FORMATS
F001
UR_UINT16 UNSIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER
F060
FLOATING_POINT IEEE FLOATING POINT (32 bits)
F002
UR_SINT16 SIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER
F072
HEX6 6 BYTES - 12 ASCII DIGITS
F003
UR_UINT32 UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
F073
HEX8 8 BYTES - 16 ASCII DIGITS
F074
HEX20 20 BYTES - 40 ASCII DIGITS
F004
UR_SINT32 SIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
F083
ENUMERATION: SELECTOR MODES
0 = Time-Out, 1 = Acknowledge
F050
UR_UINT32 TIME and DATE (UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER)
F084
ENUMERATION: SELECTOR POWER UP
0 = Restore, 1 = Synchronize, 2 = Sync/Restore
F052
UR_UINT32 TIME in SR format (alternate format for F050)
F100
ENUMERATION: VT CONNECTION TYPE
0 = Wye; 1 = Delta
(xx:xx:.SS.SSS):
0=00.000s,
F101
ENUMERATION: MESSAGE DISPLAY INTENSITY
0 = 25%, 1 = 50%, 2 = 75%, 3 = 100%
F102
ENUMERATION: DISABLED/ENABLED
0 = Disabled; 1 = Enabled
F108
ENUMERATION: OFF/ON
0 = Off, 1 = On
B-60
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F109
ENUMERATION: CONTACT OUTPUT OPERATION
Element
39
40
41
42
43
48
49
50
51
52
53
56
57
F113
ENUMERATION: PARITY
60
61
64
65
66
F114
ENUMERATION: IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
80
81
82
83
84
85
96
F112
ENUMERATION: RS485 BAUD RATES
Bitmask
Value
Bitmask
Value
Bitmask
Value
300
9600
115200
1200
19200
14400
2400
38400
10
28800
4800
57600
11
33600
F118
ENUMERATION: OSCILLOGRAPHY MODE
0 = Automatic Overwrite, 1 = Protected
F123
ENUMERATION: CT SECONDARY
0 = 1 A, 1 = 5 A
F124
ENUMERATION: LIST OF ELEMENTS
Bitmask
Element
16
17
18
19
20
21
24
25
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
GE Multilin
97
101
112
113
120
144
Phase Undervoltage 1
145
Phase Undervoltage 2
148
Auxiliary Overvoltage 1
151
Phase Overvoltage 1
154
Compensated Overvoltage 1
156
Neutral Overvoltage 1
336
Setting Group
337
Reset
388
Selector 1
389
Selector 2
390
Control pushbutton 1
391
Control pushbutton 2
392
Control pushbutton 3
393
Control pushbutton 4
B-61
Element
APPENDIX B
Bitmask
Element
394
Control pushbutton 5
704
Digital Element 13
395
Control pushbutton 6
705
Digital Element 14
396
Control pushbutton 7
706
Digital Element 15
400
FlexElement 1
707
Digital Element 16
401
FlexElement 2
708
Digital Element 17
402
FlexElement 3
709
Digital Element 18
403
FlexElement 4
710
Digital Element 19
404
FlexElement 5
711
Digital Element 20
405
FlexElement 6
712
Digital Element 21
406
FlexElemen 7
713
Digital Element 22
407
FlexElement 8
714
Digital Element 23
420
Non-volatile Latch 1
715
Digital Element 24
421
Non-volatile Latch 2
716
Digital Element 25
422
Non-volatile Latch 3
717
Digital Element 26
423
Non-volatile Latch 4
718
Digital Element 27
424
Non-volatile Latch 5
719
Digital Element 28
425
Non-volatile Latch 6
720
Digital Element 29
426
Non-volatile Latch 7
721
Digital Element 30
427
Non-volatile Latch 8
722
Digital Element 31
428
Non-volatile Latch 9
723
Digital Element 32
429
Non-volatile Latch 10
724
Digital Element 33
430
Non-volatile Latch 11
725
Digital Element 34
431
Non-volatile Latch 12
726
Digital Element 35
432
Non-volatile Latch 13
727
Digital Element 36
433
Non-volatile Latch 14
728
Digital Element 37
434
Non-volatile Latch 15
729
Digital Element 38
435
Non-volatile Latch 16
730
Digital Element 39
536
8-bit Switch 1
731
Digital Element 40
537
8-bit Switch 2
732
Digital Element 41
538
8-bit Switch 3
733
Digital Element 42
539
8-bit Switch 4
734
Digital Element 43
540
8-bit Switch 5
735
Digital Element 44
541
8-bit Switch 6
736
Digital Element 45
544
Digital Counter 1
737
Digital Element 46
545
Digital Counter 2
738
Digital Element 47
546
Digital Counter 3
739
Digital Element 48
547
Digital Counter 4
842
Trip Bus 1
548
Digital Counter 5
843
Trip Bus 2
549
Digital Counter 6
844
Trip Bus 3
550
Digital Counter 7
845
Trip Bus 4
551
Digital Counter 8
846
Trip Bus 5
692
Digital Element 1
847
Trip Bus 6
693
Digital Element 2
849
RTD Input 1
694
Digital Element 3
850
RTD Input 2
695
Digital Element 4
851
RTD Input 3
696
Digital Element 5
852
RTD Input 4
697
Digital Element 6
853
RTD Input 5
698
Digital Element 7
854
RTD Input 6
699
Digital Element 8
855
RTD Input 7
700
Digital Element 9
856
RTD Input 8
701
Digital Element 10
857
RTD Input 9
702
Digital Element 11
858
RTD Input 10
703
Digital Element 12
859
RTD Input 11
B-62
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Bitmask
Element
Element
860
RTD Input 12
913
User-Programmable Pushbutton 14
861
RTD Input 13
914
User-Programmable Pushbutton 15
862
RTD Input 14
915
User-Programmable Pushbutton 16
863
RTD Input 15
920
Disconnect switch 1
864
RTD Input 16
921
Disconnect switch 2
865
RTD Input 17
922
Disconnect switch 3
866
RTD Input 18
923
Disconnect switch 4
867
RTD Input 19
924
Disconnect switch 5
868
RTD Input 20
925
Disconnect switch 6
869
RTD Input 21
926
Disconnect switch 7
870
RTD Input 22
927
Disconnect switch 8
871
RTD Input 23
968
Breaker 1
872
RTD Input 24
969
Breaker 2
873
RTD Input 25
874
RTD Input 26
875
RTD Input 27
876
RTD Input 28
877
RTD Input 29
878
RTD Input 30
879
RTD Input 31
880
RTD Input 32
F127
ENUMERATION: LATCHED OR SELF-RESETTING
881
RTD Input 33
0 = Latched, 1 = Self-Reset
882
RTD Input 34
883
RTD Input 35
884
RTD Input 36
885
RTD Input 37
886
RTD Input 38
887
RTD Input 39
888
RTD Input 40
889
RTD Input 41
890
RTD Input 42
891
RTD Input 43
892
RTD Input 44
893
RTD Input 45
894
RTD Input 46
895
RTD Input 47
896
RTD Input 48
900
User-Programmable Pushbutton 1
901
User-Programmable Pushbutton 2
902
User-Programmable Pushbutton 3
903
User-Programmable Pushbutton 4
904
User-Programmable Pushbutton 5
905
User-Programmable Pushbutton 6
906
User-Programmable Pushbutton 7
F134
ENUMERATION: PASS/FAIL
907
User-Programmable Pushbutton 8
908
User-Programmable Pushbutton 9
909
User-Programmable Pushbutton 10
910
User-Programmable Pushbutton 11
911
User-Programmable Pushbutton 12
912
User-Programmable Pushbutton 13
GE Multilin
F126
ENUMERATION: NO/YES CHOICE
0 = No, 1 = Yes
F128
ENUMERATION: CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLD
0 = 17 V DC, 1 = 33 V DC, 2 = 84 V DC, 3 = 166 V DC
F129
ENUMERATION: FLEXLOGIC TIMER TYPE
0 = millisecond, 1 = second, 2 = minute
F131
ENUMERATION: FORCED CONTACT OUTPUT STATE
0 = Disabled, 1 = Energized, 2 = De-energized, 3 = Freeze
F133
ENUMERATION: PROGRAM STATE
0 = Not Programmed, 1 = Programmed
F137
ENUMERATION: USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTON
FUNCTION
0 = Disabled, 1 = Self-Reset, 2 = Latched
B-63
F141
ENUMERATION: SELF TEST ERRORS
Bitmask
81
Error
Module Failure 08
82
Module Failure 09
Incompatible H/W
Error
83
84
Module Failure 10
IRIG-B Failure
85
Module Failure 11
Port 1 Offline
86
Module Failure 12
Port 2 Offline
87
Port 3 Offline
89
Relay Restart
Port 4 Offline
90
FGM Failure
Port 5 Offline
91
FGM Failure
Port 6 Offline
92
FGM Failure
93
FGM Failure
Voltage Monitor
94
FGM Failure
95
FGM Error
Equipment Mismatch
96
Maintenance Alert
97
PHY Monitor
98
14
System Exception
99
Wrong Transceiver
15
Bitmask
0
APPENDIX B
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
17
Maintenance Alert 01
18
SNTP Failure
19
Maintenance Alert
20
Maintenance Alert
F143
UR_UINT32: 32 BIT ERROR CODE (F141 specifies bit number)
A bit value of 0 = no error, 1 = error
21
Maintenance Alert
22
Temperature Monitor
23
F144
ENUMERATION: FORCED CONTACT INPUT STATE
24
Brick Trouble
25
26
27
28
F146
ENUMERATION: MISCELLANEOUS EVENT CAUSES
29
Maintenance Alert
30
Events Cleared
31
Oscillography Triggered
33
Maintenance Alert
Date/time Changed
64
Maintenance Alert
65
66
Aggregator Error
67
Power On
68
Power Off
69
Relay In Service
70
Program Memory
71
Watchdog Error
10
Watchdog Reset
Bitmask
Definition
72
Low On Memory
11
Oscillography Clear
73
Prototype Firmware
12
Reboot Command
74
Module Failure 01
13
75
Module Failure 02
14
Flash Programming
76
Module Failure 03
15
77
Module Failure 04
16
78
Module Failure 05
17
---
79
Module Failure 06
18
80
Module Failure 07
19
---
B-64
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Bitmask
Definition
Bitmask
Value
Bitmask
Value
20
22
DNA-22
57
UserSt-25
21
23
DNA-23
58
UserSt-26
22
24
DNA-24
59
UserSt-27
23
25
DNA-25
60
UserSt-28
24
26
DNA-26
61
UserSt-29
25
27
DNA-27
62
UserSt-30
26
28
DNA-28
63
UserSt-31
27
29
DNA-29
64
UserSt-32
28
30
DNA-30
65
Dataset Item 1
29
Temperature Warning On
31
DNA-31
66
Dataset Item 2
30
32
DNA-32
67
Dataset Item 3
31
Unauthorized Access
33
UserSt-1
32
34
UserSt-2
96
Dataset Item 32
33
34
F157
ENUMERATION: BREAKER MODE
F152
ENUMERATION: SETTING GROUP
0 = 3-Pole, 1 = 1-Pole
F166
ENUMERATION: AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION TYPE
0 = Vn, 1 = Vag, 2 = Vbg, 3 = Vcg, 4 = Vab, 5 = Vbc, 6 = Vca
F155
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DEVICE STATE
F172
ENUMERATION: SLOT LETTERS
0 = Offline, 1 = Online
Bitmas
k
Slot
Bitmas
k
Slot
Value
10
11
F156
ENUMERATION: REMOTE INPUT BIT PAIRS
Bitmask
Value
Bitmask
Bitmas
k
NONE
35
UserSt-3
DNA-1
36
UserSt-4
DNA-2
37
UserSt-5
DNA-3
38
UserSt-6
DNA-4
39
UserSt-7
DNA-5
40
UserSt-8
DNA-6
41
UserSt-9
Bitmask
UserSt-10
0 to 1 mA
UserSt-11
0 to 1 mA
1 to 1 mA
7
8
DNA-7
DNA-8
42
43
DNA-9
44
UserSt-12
10
DNA-10
45
UserSt-13
0 to 5 mA
0 to 10 mA
11
DNA-11
46
UserSt-14
12
DNA-12
47
UserSt-15
0 to 20 mA
4 to 20 mA
DNA-13
48
UserSt-16
14
DNA-14
49
UserSt-17
15
DNA-15
50
UserSt-18
16
DNA-16
51
UserSt-19
17
DNA-17
52
UserSt-20
18
DNA-18
53
UserSt-21
19
DNA-19
54
UserSt-22
20
DNA-20
55
UserSt-23
21
DNA-21
56
UserSt-24
GE Multilin
Bitmas
k
Slot
12
13
14
15
F173
ENUMERATION: DCMA INPUT/OUTPUT RANGE
13
Slot
F174
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER RTD INPUT TYPE
0 = 100 Ohm Platinum, 1 = 120 Ohm Nickel,
2 = 100 Ohm Nickel, 3 = 10 Ohm Copper
B-65
APPENDIX B
F177
ENUMERATION: COMMUNICATION PORT
F190
ENUMERATION: SIMULATED KEYPRESS
F183
ENUMERATION: AC INPUT WAVEFORMS
Bitmask
0
1
2
3
4
Definition
Off
8 samples/cycle
16 samples/cycle
32 samples/cycle
64 samples/cycle
F184
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DEVICE GOOSE DATASET
Value
GOOSE dataset
Off
GooseIn 1
GooseIn 2
GooseIn 3
GooseIn 4
GooseIn 5
GooseIn 6
GooseIn 7
GooseIn 8
Bitmask Keypress
0
Bitmask Keypress
23
Reset
24
User 1
25
User 2
26
User 3
27
User-programmable key 1
28
User-programmable key 2
29
User-programmable key 3
30
User-programmable key 4
31
User-programmable key 5
32
User-programmable key 6
33
User-programmable key 7
10
34
User-programmable key 8
11
Decimal Point
35
User-programmable key 9
12
Plus/Minus
36
User-programmable key 10
13
Value Up
37
User-programmable key 11
14
Value Down
38
User-programmable key 12
15
Message Up
43
User-programmable key 13
16
Message Down
44
User-programmable key 14
17
Message Left
45
User-programmable key 15
18
Message Right
46
User-programmable key 16
19
Menu
47
20
Help
48
21
Escape
49
22
---
50
GooseIn 9
10
GooseIn 10
F192
ENUMERATION: ETHERNET OPERATION MODE
0 = Half-Duplex, 1 = Full-Duplex
11
GooseIn 11
12
GooseIn 12
13
GooseIn 13
14
GooseIn 14
15
GooseIn 15
16
GooseIn 16
F194
ENUMERATION: DNP SCALE
0 = 0.01, 1 = 0.1, 2 = 1, 3 = 10, 4 = 100, 5 = 1000, 6 = 10000,
7 = 100000, 8 = 0.001
F200
TEXT40: 40-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
20 registers, 16 Bits: 1st Char MSB, 2nd Char. LSB
F202
TEXT20: 20-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
10 registers, 16 Bits: 1st Char MSB, 2nd Char. LSB
F203
TEXT16: 16-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F204
TEXT80: 80-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
B-66
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F205
TEXT12: 12-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F206
TEXT6: 6-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F207
TEXT4: 4-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F213
TEXT32: 32-CHARACTER ASCII TEXT
F220
ENUMERATION: PUSHBUTTON MESSAGE PRIORITY
Value
Priority
Disabled
Normal
High Priority
F232
ENUMERATION: CONFIGURABLE GOOSE DATASET ITEMS
FOR TRANSMISSION
275
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
276
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
277
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
278
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
279
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
280
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
281
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
282
MMXU1.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
283
MMXU1.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
284
MMXU1.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
285
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
286
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
287
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
288
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
289
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
290
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
291
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
292
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
293
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
294
MMXU2.MX.TotW.mag.f
295
MMXU2.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
296
MMXU2.MX.TotVA.mag.f
297
MMXU2.MX.TotPF.mag.f
298
MMXU2.MX.Hz.mag.f
299
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
300
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
301
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
None
302
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q
303
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal
304
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
GGIO1.ST.Ind2.q
305
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
GGIO1.ST.Ind2.stVal
306
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
Value
307
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
255
GGIO1.ST.Ind128.q
308
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
256
GGIO1.ST.Ind128.stVal
309
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
257
MMXU1.MX.TotW.mag.f
310
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
258
MMXU1.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
311
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
259
MMXU1.MX.TotVA.mag.f
312
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
260
MMXU1.MX.TotPF.mag.f
313
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
261
MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f
314
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
262
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
315
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
263
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
316
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
264
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
317
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
265
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
318
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
266
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
319
MMXU2.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
267
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
320
MMXU2.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
268
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
321
MMXU2.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
269
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
322
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
270
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
323
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
271
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
324
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
272
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
325
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
273
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
326
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
274
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
327
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
GE Multilin
B-67
APPENDIX B
Value
328
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
381
329
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
382
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
330
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
383
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
331
MMXU3.MX.TotW.mag.f
384
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
332
MMXU3.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
385
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
333
MMXU3.MX.TotVA.mag.f
386
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
334
MMXU3.MX.TotPF.mag.f
387
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
335
MMXU3.MX.Hz.mag.f
388
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
336
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
389
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
337
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
390
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
338
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
391
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
339
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
392
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
340
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
393
MMXU4.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
341
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
394
MMXU4.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
342
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
395
MMXU4.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
343
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
396
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
344
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
397
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
345
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
398
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
346
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
399
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
347
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
400
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
348
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
401
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
349
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
402
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
350
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
403
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
351
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
404
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
352
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
405
MMXU5.MX.TotW.mag.f
353
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
406
MMXU5.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
354
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
407
MMXU5.MX.TotVA.mag.f
355
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
408
MMXU5.MX.TotPF.mag.f
356
MMXU3.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
409
MMXU5.MX.Hz.mag.f
357
MMXU3.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
410
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
358
MMXU3.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
411
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
359
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
412
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
360
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
413
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
361
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
414
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
362
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
415
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
363
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
416
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
364
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
417
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
365
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
418
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
366
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
419
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
367
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
420
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
368
MMXU4.MX.TotW.mag.f
421
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
369
MMXU4.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
422
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
370
MMXU4.MX.TotVA.mag.f
423
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
371
MMXU4.MX.TotPF.mag.f
424
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
372
MMXU4.MX.Hz.mag.f
425
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
373
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
426
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
374
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
427
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
375
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
428
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
376
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
429
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
377
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
430
MMXU5.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
378
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
431
MMXU5.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
379
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
432
MMXU5.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
380
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
433
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
B-68
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Value
434
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
487
435
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
488
GGIO4.MX.AnIn10.mag.f
436
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
489
GGIO4.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
437
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
490
GGIO4.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
438
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
491
GGIO4.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
439
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
492
GGIO4.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
440
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
493
GGIO4.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
441
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
494
GGIO4.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
442
MMXU6.MX.TotW.mag.f
495
GGIO4.MX.AnIn17.mag.f
443
MMXU6.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
496
GGIO4.MX.AnIn18.mag.f
444
MMXU6.MX.TotVA.mag.f
497
GGIO4.MX.AnIn19.mag.f
445
MMXU6.MX.TotPF.mag.f
498
GGIO4.MX.AnIn20.mag.f
446
MMXU6.MX.Hz.mag.f
499
GGIO4.MX.AnIn21.mag.f
447
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
500
GGIO4.MX.AnIn22.mag.f
448
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
501
GGIO4.MX.AnIn23.mag.f
449
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
502
GGIO4.MX.AnIn24.mag.f
450
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
503
GGIO4.MX.AnIn25.mag.f
451
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
504
GGIO4.MX.AnIn26.mag.f
452
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
505
GGIO4.MX.AnIn27.mag.f
453
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
506
GGIO4.MX.AnIn28.mag.f
454
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
507
GGIO4.MX.AnIn29.mag.f
455
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
508
GGIO4.MX.AnIn30.mag.f
456
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
509
GGIO4.MX.AnIn31.mag.f
457
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
510
GGIO4.MX.AnIn32.mag.f
458
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
511
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1.q
459
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
512
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1.stVal
460
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
513
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn2.q
461
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
514
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn2.stVal
462
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
515
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn3.q
463
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
516
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn3.stVal
464
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
517
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn4.q
465
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
518
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn4.stVal
466
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
519
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn5.q
467
MMXU6.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
520
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn5.stVal
468
MMXU6.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
521
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn6.q
469
MMXU6.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
522
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn6.stVal
470
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
523
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn7.q
471
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
524
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn7.stVal
472
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
525
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn8.q
473
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
526
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn8.stVal
474
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
527
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn9.q
475
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
528
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn9.stVal
476
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
529
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn10.q
477
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
530
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn10.stVal
478
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
531
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn11.q
479
GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.mag.f
532
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn11.stVal
480
GGIO4.MX.AnIn2.mag.f
533
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn12.q
481
GGIO4.MX.AnIn3.mag.f
534
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn12.stVal
482
GGIO4.MX.AnIn4.mag.f
535
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn13.q
483
GGIO4.MX.AnIn5.mag.f
536
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn13.stVal
484
GGIO4.MX.AnIn6.mag.f
537
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn14.q
485
GGIO4.MX.AnIn7.mag.f
538
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn14.stVal
486
GGIO4.MX.AnIn8.mag.f
539
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn15.q
GE Multilin
GGIO4.MX.AnIn9.mag.f
B-69
APPENDIX B
Value
540
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn15.stVal
164
GGIO3.ST.IndPos4.stVal
541
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn16.q
165
GGIO3.ST.IndPos5.stVal
542
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn16.stVal
166
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn1.q
F233
ENUMERATION: CONFIGURABLE GOOSE DATASET ITEMS
FOR RECEPTION
167
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn1.stVal
168
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn2.q
169
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn2.stVal
170
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn3.q
171
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn3.stVal
172
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn4.q
None
173
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn4.stVal
GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q
174
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn5.q
GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal
175
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn5.stVal
GGIO3.ST.Ind2.q
176
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn6.q
GGIO3.ST.Ind2.stVal
Value
177
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn6.stVal
178
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn7.q
127
GGIO1.ST.Ind64q
179
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn7.stVal
128
GGIO1.ST.Ind64.stVal
180
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn8.q
129
GGIO3.MX.AnIn1.mag.f
181
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn8.stVal
130
GGIO3.MX.AnIn2.mag.f
182
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn9.q
131
GGIO3.MX.AnIn3.mag.f
183
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn9.stVal
132
GGIO3.MX.AnIn4.mag.f
184
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn10.q
133
GGIO3.MX.AnIn5.mag.f
185
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn10.stVal
134
GGIO3.MX.AnIn6.mag.f
186
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn11.q
135
GGIO3.MX.AnIn7.mag.f
187
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn11.stVal
136
GGIO3.MX.AnIn8.mag.f
188
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn12.q
137
GGIO3.MX.AnIn9.mag.f
189
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn12.stVal
138
GGIO3.MX.AnIn10.mag.f
190
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn13.q
139
GGIO3.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
191
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn13.stVal
140
GGIO3.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
192
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn14.q
141
GGIO3.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
193
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn14.stVal
142
GGIO3.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
194
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn15.q
143
GGIO3.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
195
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn15.stVal
144
GGIO3.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
196
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn16.q
145
GGIO3.MX.AnIn17.mag.f
197
GGIO3.ST.UIntIn16.stVal
146
GGIO3.MX.AnIn18.mag.f
147
GGIO3.MX.AnIn19.mag.f
148
GGIO3.MX.AnIn20.mag.f
149
GGIO3.MX.AnIn21.mag.f
150
GGIO3.MX.AnIn22.mag.f
151
GGIO3.MX.AnIn23.mag.f
152
GGIO3.MX.AnIn24.mag.f
Value
Month
153
GGIO3.MX.AnIn25.mag.f
January
154
GGIO3.MX.AnIn26.mag.f
February
GGIO3.MX.AnIn27.mag.f
March
GGIO3.MX.AnIn28.mag.f
April
GGIO3.MX.AnIn29.mag.f
May
GGIO3.MX.AnIn30.mag.f
June
GGIO3.MX.AnIn31.mag.f
July
GGIO3.MX.AnIn32.mag.f
August
GGIO3.ST.IndPos1.stVal
September
GGIO3.ST.IndPos2.stVal
October
GGIO3.ST.IndPos3.stVal
10
November
11
December
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
B-70
F237
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK MONTH
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F238
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK DAY
Value
Description
potentiometer
tap position
Day
Sunday
Monday
Tuesday
Wednesday
F247
ENUMERATION: BRICK AC BANK ORIGIN
Value
Thursday
Friday
U1/AC1..3
Saturday
U1/AC5..7
U2/AC1..3
U2/AC5..7
U3/AC1..3
U3/AC5..7
U4/AC1..3
Instance
U4/AC5..7
First
U5/AC1..3
Second
10
U5/AC5..7
Third
11
U6/AC1..3
Fourth
12
U6/AC5..7
Last
13
U7/AC1..3
14
U7/AC5..7
15
U8/AC1..3
16
U8/AC5..7
F239
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK DAYLIGHT SAVINGS
TIME START DAY INSTANCE
Value
0
F243
ENUMERATION: FIELD UNIT TYPE
Description
None
Value
F245
ENUMERATION: TEST MODE FUNCTION
Description
None
U1/AC4
U1/AC8
U2/AC4
U2/AC8
U3/AC4
Value
Instance
U3/AC8
Disabled
U4/AC4
Isolated
U4/AC8
Forcible
U5/AC4
10
U5/AC8
F246
ENUMERATION: BRICK TRANSDUCER RANGE
11
U6/AC4
12
U6/AC8
13
U7/AC5
Description
14
U7/AC8
-5...5V
15
U8/AC5
-1...1mA
16
U8/AC8
0...1mA
0...-1mA
0...5mA
0...10mA
0...20mA
Value
4...20mA
Value
GE Multilin
F253
ENUMERATION: BRICK TRANSDUCER ORIGIN
Description
None
B-71
APPENDIX B
Description
U1/DC1
U1/DC2
U1/DC3
U2/DC1
...
...
24
U8/DC3
F256
ENUMERATION: BRICK ORIGIN/DESTINATION
Value
Description
None
U1
U2
U3
U4
U5
U6
U7
U8
F259
ENUMERATION: BRICK RTD TYPE
0 = 100 Ohm Nickel, 1 = 120 Ohm Nickel, 2 = 100 Ohm Platinum
F260
ENUMERATION: DATA LOGGER MODE
0 = Continuous, 1 = Trigger
F261
ENUMERATION: BANK REDUNDANCY TYPE
0 = None, 1 = Dependability Biased, 2 = Security Biased
F491
ENUMERATION: ANALOG INPUT MODE
F262
ENUMERATION: BRICK STATUS
B-72
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F501
UR_UINT16: LED STATUS
F524
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECT 21 DEFAULT VARIATION
Bitmask
Default variation
F502
BITFIELD: ELEMENT OPERATE STATES
Each bit contains the operate state for an element. See the F124
format code for a list of element IDs. The operate bit for element ID
X is bit [X mod 16] in register [X/16].
10
F525
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECT 32 DEFAULT VARIATION
Bitmask
Default variation
F515
ENUMERATION ELEMENT INPUT MODE
0 = Signed, 1 = Absolute
F516
ENUMERATION ELEMENT COMPARE MODE
F530
ENUMERATION: FRONT PANEL INTERFACE KEYPRESS
0 = Level, 1 = Delta
F517
ENUMERATION: ELEMENT DIRECTION OPERATION
0 = Over, 1 = Under
F518
ENUMERATION: FLEXELEMENT UNITS
0 = Milliseconds, 1 = Seconds, 2 = Minutes
Valu
e
Keypress
Valu
e
Keypress
Valu
e
Keypress
None
15
33
User PB 3
Menu
16
Enter
34
User PB 4
Message Up
17
Message
Down
35
User PB 5
18
36
User PB 6
19
Decimal
37
User PB 7
20
+/
38
User PB 8
Help
21
Value Up
39
User PB 9
Message Left
22
Value Down
40
User PB 10
F519
ENUMERATION: NON-VOLATILE LATCH
23
Reset
41
User PB 11
24
User 1
42
User PB 12
0 = Reset-Dominant, 1 = Set-Dominant
10
25
User 2
44
User 4
11
Escape
26
User 3
45
User 5
12
Message
Right
31
User PB 1
46
User 6
13
32
User PB 2
47
User 7
14
F522
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER DCMA OUTPUT RANGE
0 = 1 to 1 mA; 1 = 0 to 1 mA; 2 = 4 to 20 mA
F523
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECTS 20, 22, AND 23 DEFAULT
VARIATION
Bitmask
Default variation
GE Multilin
F531
ENUMERATION: LANGUAGE
0 = English, 1 = French, 2 = Chinese, 3 = Russian, 4 = Turkish, 5 =
German
B-73
APPENDIX B
F550
ENUMERATION: RTD INPUT APPLICATION
Enumeration
Enumeration
Stator
Intermediate
Bearing
Off
Ambient
On
Group 1
Bad
Group 2
0
1
2
F605
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DOUBLE-POINT STATUS INPUT
STATUS
F606
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DOUBLE-POINT STATUS INPUT
F551
ENUMERATION: RTD TRIP VOTING
Enumeration
None
None
Remote input 1
Group
Remote input 2
RTD Input 1
Remote input 3
RTD Input 2
RTD Input 3
64
RTD Input 4
RTD Input 5
RTD Input 6
RTD Input 7
RTD Input 8
Enumeration
10
RTD Input 9
Heartbeat
11
RTD Input 10
Aggressive
12
RTD Input 11
Medium
13
RTD Input 12
Relaxed
Enumeration
Enumeration
None
Alarm
Block
F612
UR_UINT16: FLEXINTEGER PARAMETER
This 16-bit value corresponds to the Modbus address of the
selected FlexInteger parameter. Only certain values may be used
as FlexIntegers.
RTD open
Remote input 64
F611
ENUMERATION: GOOSE RETRANSMISSION SCHEME
F552
ENUMERATION: RTD INPUT OPEN
F615
ENUMERATION: IEC 61850 REPORT DATASET ITEMS
F600
UR_UINT16: FLEXANALOG PARAMETER
Enumeration
None
PDIF1.ST.Str.general
PDIF1.ST.Op.general
PDIF2.ST.Str.general
PDIF2.ST.Op.general
PDIF3.ST.Str.general
PDIF3.ST.Op.general
PDIF4.ST.Str.general
RS485
PDIF4.ST.Op.general
RRTD
PDIS1.ST.Str.general
GPM-F
10
PDIS1.ST.Op.general
11
PDIS2.ST.Str.general
12
PDIS2.ST.Op.general
13
PDIS3.ST.Str.general
F601
ENUMERATION: COM2 PORT USAGE
Enumeration
0
B-74
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
14
PDIS3.ST.Op.general
67
15
PDIS4.ST.Str.general
68
PIOC20.ST.Op.general
16
PDIS4.ST.Op.general
69
PIOC21.ST.Str.general
17
PDIS5.ST.Str.general
70
PIOC21.ST.Op.general
18
PDIS5.ST.Op.general
71
PIOC22.ST.Str.general
19
PDIS6.ST.Str.general
72
PIOC22.ST.Op.general
20
PDIS6.ST.Op.general
73
PIOC23.ST.Str.general
21
PDIS7.ST.Str.general
74
PIOC23.ST.Op.general
22
PDIS7.ST.Op.general
75
PIOC24.ST.Str.general
23
PDIS8.ST.Str.general
76
PIOC24.ST.Op.general
24
PDIS8.ST.Op.general
77
PIOC25.ST.Str.general
25
PDIS9.ST.Str.general
78
PIOC25.ST.Op.general
26
PDIS9.ST.Op.general
79
PIOC26.ST.Str.general
27
PDIS10.ST.Str.general
80
PIOC26.ST.Op.general
28
PDIS10.ST.Op.general
81
PIOC27.ST.Str.general
29
PIOC1.ST.Str.general
82
PIOC27.ST.Op.general
30
PIOC1.ST.Op.general
83
PIOC28.ST.Str.general
31
PIOC2.ST.Str.general
84
PIOC28.ST.Op.general
32
PIOC2.ST.Op.general
85
PIOC29.ST.Str.general
33
PIOC3.ST.Str.general
86
PIOC29.ST.Op.general
34
PIOC3.ST.Op.general
87
PIOC30.ST.Str.general
35
PIOC4.ST.Str.general
88
PIOC30.ST.Op.general
36
PIOC4.ST.Op.general
89
PIOC31.ST.Str.general
37
PIOC5.ST.Str.general
90
PIOC31.ST.Op.general
38
PIOC5.ST.Op.general
91
PIOC32.ST.Str.general
39
PIOC6.ST.Str.general
92
PIOC32.ST.Op.general
40
PIOC6.ST.Op.general
93
PIOC33.ST.Str.general
41
PIOC7.ST.Str.general
94
PIOC33.ST.Op.general
42
PIOC7.ST.Op.general
95
PIOC34.ST.Str.general
43
PIOC8.ST.Str.general
96
PIOC34.ST.Op.general
44
PIOC8.ST.Op.general
97
PIOC35.ST.Str.general
45
PIOC9.ST.Str.general
98
PIOC35.ST.Op.general
46
PIOC9.ST.Op.general
99
PIOC36.ST.Str.general
47
PIOC10.ST.Str.general
100
PIOC36.ST.Op.general
48
PIOC10.ST.Op.general
101
PIOC37.ST.Str.general
49
PIOC11.ST.Str.general
102
PIOC37.ST.Op.general
50
PIOC11.ST.Op.general
103
PIOC38.ST.Str.general
51
PIOC12.ST.Str.general
104
PIOC38.ST.Op.general
52
PIOC12.ST.Op.general
105
PIOC39.ST.Str.general
53
PIOC13.ST.Str.general
106
PIOC39.ST.Op.general
54
PIOC13.ST.Op.general
107
PIOC40.ST.Str.general
55
PIOC14.ST.Str.general
108
PIOC40.ST.Op.general
56
PIOC14.ST.Op.general
109
PIOC41.ST.Str.general
57
PIOC15.ST.Str.general
110
PIOC41.ST.Op.general
58
PIOC15.ST.Op.general
111
PIOC42.ST.Str.general
59
PIOC16.ST.Str.general
112
PIOC42.ST.Op.general
60
PIOC16.ST.Op.general
113
PIOC43.ST.Str.general
61
PIOC17.ST.Str.general
114
PIOC43.ST.Op.general
62
PIOC17.ST.Op.general
115
PIOC44.ST.Str.general
63
PIOC18.ST.Str.general
116
PIOC44.ST.Op.general
64
PIOC18.ST.Op.general
117
PIOC45.ST.Str.general
65
PIOC19.ST.Str.general
118
PIOC45.ST.Op.general
66
PIOC19.ST.Op.general
119
PIOC46.ST.Str.general
GE Multilin
PIOC20.ST.Str.general
B-75
B-76
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
PIOC46.ST.Op.general
173
PTOC1.ST.Str.general
121
PIOC47.ST.Str.general
174
PTOC1.ST.Op.general
122
PIOC47.ST.Op.general
175
PTOC2.ST.Str.general
123
PIOC48.ST.Str.general
176
PTOC2.ST.Op.general
124
PIOC48.ST.Op.general
177
PTOC3.ST.Str.general
125
PIOC49.ST.Str.general
178
PTOC3.ST.Op.general
126
PIOC49.ST.Op.general
179
PTOC4.ST.Str.general
127
PIOC50.ST.Str.general
180
PTOC4.ST.Op.general
128
PIOC50.ST.Op.general
181
PTOC5.ST.Str.general
129
PIOC51.ST.Str.general
182
PTOC5.ST.Op.general
130
PIOC51.ST.Op.general
183
PTOC6.ST.Str.general
131
PIOC52.ST.Str.general
184
PTOC6.ST.Op.general
132
PIOC52.ST.Op.general
185
PTOC7.ST.Str.general
133
PIOC53.ST.Str.general
186
PTOC7.ST.Op.general
134
PIOC53.ST.Op.general
187
PTOC8.ST.Str.general
135
PIOC54.ST.Str.general
188
PTOC8.ST.Op.general
136
PIOC54.ST.Op.general
189
PTOC9.ST.Str.general
137
PIOC55.ST.Str.general
190
PTOC9.ST.Op.general
138
PIOC55.ST.Op.general
191
PTOC10.ST.Str.general
139
PIOC56.ST.Str.general
192
PTOC10.ST.Op.general
140
PIOC56.ST.Op.general
193
PTOC11.ST.Str.general
141
PIOC57.ST.Str.general
194
PTOC11.ST.Op.general
142
PIOC57.ST.Op.general
195
PTOC12.ST.Str.general
143
PIOC58.ST.Str.general
196
PTOC12.ST.Op.general
144
PIOC58.ST.Op.general
197
PTOC13.ST.Str.general
145
PIOC59.ST.Str.general
198
PTOC13.ST.Op.general
146
PIOC59.ST.Op.general
199
PTOC14.ST.Str.general
147
PIOC60.ST.Str.general
200
PTOC14.ST.Op.general
148
PIOC60.ST.Op.general
201
PTOC15.ST.Str.general
149
PIOC61.ST.Str.general
202
PTOC15.ST.Op.general
150
PIOC61.ST.Op.general
203
PTOC16.ST.Str.general
151
PIOC62.ST.Str.general
204
PTOC16.ST.Op.general
152
PIOC62.ST.Op.general
205
PTOC17.ST.Str.general
153
PIOC63.ST.Str.general
206
PTOC17.ST.Op.general
154
PIOC63.ST.Op.general
207
PTOC18.ST.Str.general
155
PIOC64.ST.Str.general
208
PTOC18.ST.Op.general
156
PIOC64.ST.Op.general
209
PTOC19.ST.Str.general
157
PIOC65.ST.Str.general
210
PTOC19.ST.Op.general
158
PIOC65.ST.Op.general
211
PTOC20.ST.Str.general
159
PIOC66.ST.Str.general
212
PTOC20.ST.Op.general
160
PIOC66.ST.Op.general
213
PTOC21.ST.Str.general
161
PIOC67.ST.Str.general
214
PTOC21.ST.Op.general
162
PIOC67.ST.Op.general
215
PTOC22.ST.Str.general
163
PIOC68.ST.Str.general
216
PTOC22.ST.Op.general
164
PIOC68.ST.Op.general
217
PTOC23.ST.Str.general
165
PIOC69.ST.Str.general
218
PTOC23.ST.Op.general
166
PIOC69.ST.Op.general
219
PTOC24.ST.Str.general
167
PIOC70.ST.Str.general
220
PTOC24.ST.Op.general
168
PIOC70.ST.Op.general
221
PTOV1.ST.Str.general
169
PIOC71.ST.Str.general
222
PTOV1.ST.Op.general
170
PIOC71.ST.Op.general
223
PTOV2.ST.Str.general
171
PIOC72.ST.Str.general
224
PTOV2.ST.Op.general
172
PIOC72.ST.Op.general
225
PTOV3.ST.Str.general
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
226
PTOV3.ST.Op.general
279
RBRF1.ST.OpEx.general
227
PTOV4.ST.Str.general
280
RBRF1.ST.OpIn.general
228
PTOV4.ST.Op.general
281
RBRF2.ST.OpEx.general
229
PTOV5.ST.Str.general
282
RBRF2.ST.OpIn.general
230
PTOV5.ST.Op.general
283
RBRF3.ST.OpEx.general
231
PTOV6.ST.Str.general
284
RBRF3.ST.OpIn.general
232
PTOV6.ST.Op.general
285
RBRF4.ST.OpEx.general
233
PTOV7.ST.Str.general
286
RBRF4.ST.OpIn.general
234
PTOV7.ST.Op.general
287
RBRF5.ST.OpEx.general
235
PTOV8.ST.Str.general
288
RBRF5.ST.OpIn.general
236
PTOV8.ST.Op.general
289
RBRF6.ST.OpEx.general
237
PTOV9.ST.Str.general
290
RBRF6.ST.OpIn.general
238
PTOV9.ST.Op.general
291
RBRF7.ST.OpEx.general
239
PTOV10.ST.Str.general
292
RBRF7.ST.OpIn.general
240
PTOV10.ST.Op.general
293
RBRF8.ST.OpEx.general
241
PTRC1.ST.Tr.general
294
RBRF8.ST.OpIn.general
242
PTRC1.ST.Op.general
295
RBRF9.ST.OpEx.general
243
PTRC2.ST.Tr.general
296
RBRF9.ST.OpIn.general
244
PTRC2.ST.Op.general
297
RBRF10.ST.OpEx.general
245
PTRC3.ST.Tr.general
298
RBRF10.ST.OpIn.general
246
PTRC3.ST.Op.general
299
RBRF11.ST.OpEx.general
247
PTRC4.ST.Tr.general
300
RBRF11.ST.OpIn.general
248
PTRC4.ST.Op.general
301
RBRF12.ST.OpEx.general
249
PTRC5.ST.Tr.general
302
RBRF12.ST.OpIn.general
250
PTRC5.ST.Op.general
303
RBRF13.ST.OpEx.general
251
PTRC6.ST.Tr.general
304
RBRF13.ST.OpIn.general
252
PTRC6.ST.Op.general
305
RBRF14.ST.OpEx.general
253
PTUV1.ST.Str.general
306
RBRF14.ST.OpIn.general
254
PTUV1.ST.Op.general
307
RBRF15.ST.OpEx.general
255
PTUV2.ST.Str.general
308
RBRF15.ST.OpIn.general
256
PTUV2.ST.Op.general
309
RBRF16.ST.OpEx.general
257
PTUV3.ST.Str.general
310
RBRF16.ST.OpIn.general
258
PTUV3.ST.Op.general
311
RBRF17.ST.OpEx.general
259
PTUV4.ST.Str.general
312
RBRF17.ST.OpIn.general
260
PTUV4.ST.Op.general
313
RBRF18.ST.OpEx.general
261
PTUV5.ST.Str.general
314
RBRF18.ST.OpIn.general
262
PTUV5.ST.Op.general
315
RBRF19.ST.OpEx.general
263
PTUV6.ST.Str.general
316
RBRF19.ST.OpIn.general
264
PTUV6.ST.Op.general
317
RBRF20.ST.OpEx.general
265
PTUV7.ST.Str.general
318
RBRF20.ST.OpIn.general
266
PTUV7.ST.Op.general
319
RBRF21.ST.OpEx.general
267
PTUV8.ST.Str.general
320
RBRF21.ST.OpIn.general
268
PTUV8.ST.Op.general
321
RBRF22.ST.OpEx.general
269
PTUV9.ST.Str.general
322
RBRF22.ST.OpIn.general
270
PTUV9.ST.Op.general
323
RBRF23.ST.OpEx.general
271
PTUV10.ST.Str.general
324
RBRF23.ST.OpIn.general
272
PTUV10.ST.Op.general
325
RBRF24.ST.OpEx.general
273
PTUV11.ST.Str.general
326
RBRF24.ST.OpIn.general
274
PTUV11.ST.Op.general
327
RFLO1.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
275
PTUV12.ST.Str.general
328
RFLO2.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
276
PTUV12.ST.Op.general
329
RFLO3.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
277
PTUV13.ST.Str.general
330
RFLO4.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
278
PTUV13.ST.Op.general
331
RFLO5.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
GE Multilin
B-77
B-78
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
RPSB1.ST.Str.general
385
CSWI20.ST.Loc.stVal
333
RPSB1.ST.Op.general
386
CSWI20.ST.Pos.stVal
334
RPSB1.ST.BlkZn.stVal
387
CSWI21.ST.Loc.stVal
335
RREC1.ST.Op.general
388
CSWI21.ST.Pos.stVal
336
RREC1.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
389
CSWI22.ST.Loc.stVal
337
RREC2.ST.Op.general
390
CSWI22.ST.Pos.stVal
338
RREC2.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
391
CSWI23.ST.Loc.stVal
339
RREC3.ST.Op.general
392
CSWI23.ST.Pos.stVal
340
RREC3.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
393
CSWI24.ST.Loc.stVal
341
RREC4.ST.Op.general
394
CSWI24.ST.Pos.stVal
342
RREC4.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
395
CSWI25.ST.Loc.stVal
343
RREC5.ST.Op.general
396
CSWI25.ST.Pos.stVal
344
RREC5.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
397
CSWI26.ST.Loc.stVal
345
RREC6.ST.Op.general
398
CSWI26.ST.Pos.stVal
346
RREC6.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
399
CSWI27.ST.Loc.stVal
347
CSWI1.ST.Loc.stVal
400
CSWI27.ST.Pos.stVal
348
CSWI1.ST.Pos.stVal
401
CSWI28.ST.Loc.stVal
349
CSWI2.ST.Loc.stVal
402
CSWI28.ST.Pos.stVal
350
CSWI2.ST.Pos.stVal
403
CSWI29.ST.Loc.stVal
351
CSWI3.ST.Loc.stVal
404
CSWI29.ST.Pos.stVal
352
CSWI3.ST.Pos.stVal
405
CSWI30.ST.Loc.stVal
353
CSWI4.ST.Loc.stVal
406
CSWI30.ST.Pos.stVal
354
CSWI4.ST.Pos.stVal
407
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal
355
CSWI5.ST.Loc.stVal
408
GGIO1.ST.Ind2.stVal
356
CSWI5.ST.Pos.stVal
409
GGIO1.ST.Ind3.stVal
357
CSWI6.ST.Loc.stVal
410
GGIO1.ST.Ind4.stVal
358
CSWI6.ST.Pos.stVal
411
GGIO1.ST.Ind5.stVal
359
CSWI7.ST.Loc.stVal
412
GGIO1.ST.Ind6.stVal
360
CSWI7.ST.Pos.stVal
413
GGIO1.ST.Ind7.stVal
361
CSWI8.ST.Loc.stVal
414
GGIO1.ST.Ind8.stVal
362
CSWI8.ST.Pos.stVal
415
GGIO1.ST.Ind9.stVal
363
CSWI9.ST.Loc.stVal
416
GGIO1.ST.Ind10.stVal
364
CSWI9.ST.Pos.stVal
417
GGIO1.ST.Ind11.stVal
365
CSWI10.ST.Loc.stVal
418
GGIO1.ST.Ind12.stVal
366
CSWI10.ST.Pos.stVal
419
GGIO1.ST.Ind13.stVal
367
CSWI11.ST.Loc.stVal
420
GGIO1.ST.Ind14.stVal
368
CSWI11.ST.Pos.stVal
421
GGIO1.ST.Ind15.stVal
369
CSWI12.ST.Loc.stVal
422
GGIO1.ST.Ind16.stVal
370
CSWI12.ST.Pos.stVal
423
GGIO1.ST.Ind17.stVal
371
CSWI13.ST.Loc.stVal
424
GGIO1.ST.Ind18.stVal
372
CSWI13.ST.Pos.stVal
425
GGIO1.ST.Ind19.stVal
373
CSWI14.ST.Loc.stVal
426
GGIO1.ST.Ind20.stVal
374
CSWI14.ST.Pos.stVal
427
GGIO1.ST.Ind21.stVal
375
CSWI15.ST.Loc.stVal
428
GGIO1.ST.Ind22.stVal
376
CSWI15.ST.Pos.stVal
429
GGIO1.ST.Ind23.stVal
377
CSWI16.ST.Loc.stVal
430
GGIO1.ST.Ind24.stVal
378
CSWI16.ST.Pos.stVal
431
GGIO1.ST.Ind25.stVal
379
CSWI17.ST.Loc.stVal
432
GGIO1.ST.Ind26.stVal
380
CSWI17.ST.Pos.stVal
433
GGIO1.ST.Ind27.stVal
381
CSWI18.ST.Loc.stVal
434
GGIO1.ST.Ind28.stVal
382
CSWI18.ST.Pos.stVal
435
GGIO1.ST.Ind29.stVal
383
CSWI19.ST.Loc.stVal
436
GGIO1.ST.Ind30.stVal
384
CSWI19.ST.Pos.stVal
437
GGIO1.ST.Ind31.stVal
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
438
GGIO1.ST.Ind32.stVal
491
GGIO1.ST.Ind85.stVal
439
GGIO1.ST.Ind33.stVal
492
GGIO1.ST.Ind86.stVal
440
GGIO1.ST.Ind34.stVal
493
GGIO1.ST.Ind87.stVal
441
GGIO1.ST.Ind35.stVal
494
GGIO1.ST.Ind88.stVal
442
GGIO1.ST.Ind36.stVal
495
GGIO1.ST.Ind89.stVal
443
GGIO1.ST.Ind37.stVal
496
GGIO1.ST.Ind90.stVal
444
GGIO1.ST.Ind38.stVal
497
GGIO1.ST.Ind91.stVal
445
GGIO1.ST.Ind39.stVal
498
GGIO1.ST.Ind92.stVal
446
GGIO1.ST.Ind40.stVal
499
GGIO1.ST.Ind93.stVal
447
GGIO1.ST.Ind41.stVal
500
GGIO1.ST.Ind94.stVal
448
GGIO1.ST.Ind42.stVal
501
GGIO1.ST.Ind95.stVal
449
GGIO1.ST.Ind43.stVal
502
GGIO1.ST.Ind96.stVal
450
GGIO1.ST.Ind44.stVal
503
GGIO1.ST.Ind97.stVal
451
GGIO1.ST.Ind45.stVal
504
GGIO1.ST.Ind98.stVal
452
GGIO1.ST.Ind46.stVal
505
GGIO1.ST.Ind99.stVal
453
GGIO1.ST.Ind47.stVal
506
GGIO1.ST.Ind100.stVal
454
GGIO1.ST.Ind48.stVal
507
GGIO1.ST.Ind101.stVal
455
GGIO1.ST.Ind49.stVal
508
GGIO1.ST.Ind102.stVal
456
GGIO1.ST.Ind50.stVal
509
GGIO1.ST.Ind103.stVal
457
GGIO1.ST.Ind51.stVal
510
GGIO1.ST.Ind104.stVal
458
GGIO1.ST.Ind52.stVal
511
GGIO1.ST.Ind105.stVal
459
GGIO1.ST.Ind53.stVal
512
GGIO1.ST.Ind106.stVal
460
GGIO1.ST.Ind54.stVal
513
GGIO1.ST.Ind107.stVal
461
GGIO1.ST.Ind55.stVal
514
GGIO1.ST.Ind108.stVal
462
GGIO1.ST.Ind56.stVal
515
GGIO1.ST.Ind109.stVal
463
GGIO1.ST.Ind57.stVal
516
GGIO1.ST.Ind110.stVal
464
GGIO1.ST.Ind58.stVal
517
GGIO1.ST.Ind111.stVal
465
GGIO1.ST.Ind59.stVal
518
GGIO1.ST.Ind112.stVal
466
GGIO1.ST.Ind60.stVal
519
GGIO1.ST.Ind113.stVal
467
GGIO1.ST.Ind61.stVal
520
GGIO1.ST.Ind114.stVal
468
GGIO1.ST.Ind62.stVal
521
GGIO1.ST.Ind115.stVal
469
GGIO1.ST.Ind63.stVal
522
GGIO1.ST.Ind116.stVal
470
GGIO1.ST.Ind64.stVal
523
GGIO1.ST.Ind117.stVal
471
GGIO1.ST.Ind65.stVal
524
GGIO1.ST.Ind118.stVal
472
GGIO1.ST.Ind66.stVal
525
GGIO1.ST.Ind119.stVal
473
GGIO1.ST.Ind67.stVal
526
GGIO1.ST.Ind120.stVal
474
GGIO1.ST.Ind68.stVal
527
GGIO1.ST.Ind121.stVal
475
GGIO1.ST.Ind69.stVal
528
GGIO1.ST.Ind122.stVal
476
GGIO1.ST.Ind70.stVal
529
GGIO1.ST.Ind123.stVal
477
GGIO1.ST.Ind71.stVal
530
GGIO1.ST.Ind124.stVal
478
GGIO1.ST.Ind72.stVal
531
GGIO1.ST.Ind125.stVal
479
GGIO1.ST.Ind73.stVal
532
GGIO1.ST.Ind126.stVal
480
GGIO1.ST.Ind74.stVal
533
GGIO1.ST.Ind127.stVal
481
GGIO1.ST.Ind75.stVal
534
GGIO1.ST.Ind128.stVal
482
GGIO1.ST.Ind76.stVal
535
MMXU1.MX.TotW.mag.f
483
GGIO1.ST.Ind77.stVal
536
MMXU1.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
484
GGIO1.ST.Ind78.stVal
537
MMXU1.MX.TotVA.mag.f
485
GGIO1.ST.Ind79.stVal
538
MMXU1.MX.TotPF.mag.f
486
GGIO1.ST.Ind80.stVal
539
MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f
487
GGIO1.ST.Ind81.stVal
540
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
488
GGIO1.ST.Ind82.stVal
541
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
489
GGIO1.ST.Ind83.stVal
542
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
490
GGIO1.ST.Ind84.stVal
543
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
GE Multilin
B-79
Enumeration
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
597
MMXU2.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
545
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
598
MMXU2.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
546
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
599
MMXU2.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
547
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
600
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
548
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
601
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
549
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
602
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
550
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
603
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
551
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
604
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
552
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
605
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
553
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
606
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
554
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
607
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
555
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
608
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
556
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
609
MMXU3.MX.TotW.mag.f
557
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
610
MMXU3.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
558
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
611
MMXU3.MX.TotVA.mag.f
559
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
612
MMXU3.MX.TotPF.mag.f
560
MMXU1.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
613
MMXU3.MX.Hz.mag.f
561
MMXU1.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
614
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
562
MMXU1.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
615
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
563
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
616
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
564
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
617
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
565
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
618
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
566
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
619
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
567
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
620
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
568
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
621
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
569
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
622
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
570
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
623
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
571
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
624
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
572
MMXU2.MX.TotW.mag.f
625
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
573
MMXU2.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
626
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
574
MMXU2.MX.TotVA.mag.f
627
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
575
MMXU2.MX.TotPF.mag.f
628
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
576
MMXU2.MX.Hz.mag.f
629
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
577
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
630
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
544
B-80
APPENDIX B
578
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
631
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
579
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
632
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
580
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
633
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
581
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
634
MMXU3.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
582
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
635
MMXU3.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
583
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
636
MMXU3.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
584
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
637
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
585
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
638
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
586
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
639
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
587
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
640
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
588
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
641
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
589
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
642
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
590
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
643
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
591
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
644
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
592
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
645
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
593
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
646
MMXU4.MX.TotW.mag.f
594
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
647
MMXU4.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
595
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
648
MMXU4.MX.TotVA.mag.f
596
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
649
MMXU4.MX.TotPF.mag.f
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
650
MMXU4.MX.Hz.mag.f
703
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
651
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
704
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
652
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
705
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
653
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
706
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
654
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
707
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
655
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
708
MMXU5.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
656
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
709
MMXU5.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
657
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
710
MMXU5.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
658
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
711
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
659
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
712
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
660
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
713
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
661
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
714
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
662
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
715
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
663
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
716
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
664
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
717
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
665
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
718
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
666
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
719
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
667
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
720
MMXU6.MX.TotW.mag.f
668
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
721
MMXU6.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
669
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
722
MMXU6.MX.TotVA.mag.f
MMXU6.MX.TotPF.mag.f
670
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
723
671
MMXU4.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
724
MMXU6.MX.Hz.mag.f
672
MMXU4.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
725
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
673
MMXU4.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
726
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
674
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
727
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
675
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
728
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
676
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
729
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
677
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
730
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
678
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
731
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
679
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
732
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
680
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
733
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
681
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
734
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
682
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
735
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
683
MMXU5.MX.TotW.mag.f
736
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
684
MMXU5.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
737
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
685
MMXU5.MX.TotVA.mag.f
738
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
686
MMXU5.MX.TotPF.mag.f
739
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
687
MMXU5.MX.Hz.mag.f
740
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
688
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
741
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
689
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
742
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
690
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
743
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
691
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
744
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
692
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
745
MMXU6.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
693
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
746
MMXU6.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
694
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
747
MMXU6.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
695
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
748
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
696
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
749
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
697
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
750
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
698
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
751
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
699
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
752
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
700
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
753
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
701
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
754
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
702
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
755
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
GE Multilin
B-81
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
Enumeration
756
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
809
757
GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.mag.f
810
XSWI11.ST.Pos.stVal
758
GGIO4.MX.AnIn2.mag.f
811
XSWI12.ST.Loc.stVal
759
GGIO4.MX.AnIn3.mag.f
812
XSWI12.ST.Pos.stVal
760
GGIO4.MX.AnIn4.mag.f
813
XSWI13.ST.Loc.stVal
761
GGIO4.MX.AnIn5.mag.f
814
XSWI13.ST.Pos.stVal
762
GGIO4.MX.AnIn6.mag.f
815
XSWI14.ST.Loc.stVal
763
GGIO4.MX.AnIn7.mag.f
816
XSWI14.ST.Pos.stVal
764
GGIO4.MX.AnIn8.mag.f
817
XSWI15.ST.Loc.stVal
765
GGIO4.MX.AnIn9.mag.f
818
XSWI15.ST.Pos.stVal
766
GGIO4.MX.AnIn10.mag.f
819
XSWI16.ST.Loc.stVal
767
GGIO4.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
820
XSWI16.ST.Pos.stVal
768
GGIO4.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
821
XSWI17.ST.Loc.stVal
769
GGIO4.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
822
XSWI17.ST.Pos.stVal
770
GGIO4.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
823
XSWI18.ST.Loc.stVal
771
GGIO4.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
824
XSWI18.ST.Pos.stVal
772
GGIO4.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
825
XSWI19.ST.Loc.stVal
773
GGIO4.MX.AnIn17.mag.f
826
XSWI19.ST.Pos.stVal
774
GGIO4.MX.AnIn18.mag.f
827
XSWI20.ST.Loc.stVal
775
GGIO4.MX.AnIn19.mag.f
828
XSWI20.ST.Pos.stVal
776
GGIO4.MX.AnIn20.mag.f
829
XSWI21.ST.Loc.stVal
777
GGIO4.MX.AnIn21.mag.f
830
XSWI21.ST.Pos.stVal
778
GGIO4.MX.AnIn22.mag.f
831
XSWI22.ST.Loc.stVal
779
GGIO4.MX.AnIn23.mag.f
832
XSWI22.ST.Pos.stVal
780
GGIO4.MX.AnIn24.mag.f
833
XSWI23.ST.Loc.stVal
781
GGIO4.MX.AnIn25.mag.f
834
XSWI23.ST.Pos.stVal
782
GGIO4.MX.AnIn26.mag.f
835
XSWI24.ST.Loc.stVal
783
GGIO4.MX.AnIn27.mag.f
836
XSWI24.ST.Pos.stVal
784
GGIO4.MX.AnIn28.mag.f
837
XCBR1.ST.Loc.stVal
785
GGIO4.MX.AnIn29.mag.f
838
XCBR1.ST.Pos.stVal
786
GGIO4.MX.AnIn30.mag.f
839
XCBR2.ST.Loc.stVal
787
GGIO4.MX.AnIn31.mag.f
840
XCBR2.ST.Pos.stVal
788
GGIO4.MX.AnIn32.mag.f
841
XCBR3.ST.Loc.stVal
789
XSWI1.ST.Loc.stVal
842
XCBR3.ST.Pos.stVal
790
XSWI1.ST.Pos.stVal
843
XCBR4.ST.Loc.stVal
791
XSWI2.ST.Loc.stVal
844
XCBR4.ST.Pos.stVal
792
XSWI2.ST.Pos.stVal
845
XCBR5.ST.Loc.stVal
793
XSWI3.ST.Loc.stVal
846
XCBR5.ST.Pos.stVal
794
XSWI3.ST.Pos.stVal
847
XCBR6.ST.Loc.stVal
795
XSWI4.ST.Loc.stVal
848
XCBR6.ST.Pos.stVal
796
XSWI4.ST.Pos.stVal
B-82
797
XSWI5.ST.Loc.stVal
798
XSWI5.ST.Pos.stVal
F616
ENUMERATION: IEC 61850 GOOSE DATASET ITEMS
799
XSWI6.ST.Loc.stVal
800
XSWI6.ST.Pos.stVal
Enumeration
801
XSWI7.ST.Loc.stVal
None
802
XSWI7.ST.Pos.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q
803
XSWI8.ST.Loc.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal
804
XSWI8.ST.Pos.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind2.q
805
XSWI9.ST.Loc.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind2.stVal
806
XSWI9.ST.Pos.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind3.q
807
XSWI10.ST.Loc.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind3.stVal
808
XSWI10.ST.Pos.stVal
GGIO1.ST.Ind4.q
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
Enumeration
GGIO1.ST.Ind4.stVal
61
GGIO1.ST.Ind5.q
62
GGIO1.ST.Ind31.stVal
10
GGIO1.ST.Ind5.stVal
63
GGIO1.ST.Ind32.q
11
GGIO1.ST.Ind6.q
64
GGIO1.ST.Ind32.stVal
12
GGIO1.ST.Ind6.stVal
65
GGIO1.ST.Ind33.q
13
GGIO1.ST.Ind7.q
66
GGIO1.ST.Ind33.stVal
14
GGIO1.ST.Ind7.stVal
67
GGIO1.ST.Ind34.q
15
GGIO1.ST.Ind8.q
68
GGIO1.ST.Ind34.stVal
16
GGIO1.ST.Ind8.stVal
69
GGIO1.ST.Ind35.q
17
GGIO1.ST.Ind9.q
70
GGIO1.ST.Ind35.stVal
18
GGIO1.ST.Ind9.stVal
71
GGIO1.ST.Ind36.q
19
GGIO1.ST.Ind10.q
72
GGIO1.ST.Ind36.stVal
20
GGIO1.ST.Ind10.stVal
73
GGIO1.ST.Ind37.q
21
GGIO1.ST.Ind11.q
74
GGIO1.ST.Ind37.stVal
22
GGIO1.ST.Ind11.stVal
75
GGIO1.ST.Ind38.q
23
GGIO1.ST.Ind12.q
76
GGIO1.ST.Ind38.stVal
24
GGIO1.ST.Ind12.stVal
77
GGIO1.ST.Ind39.q
25
GGIO1.ST.Ind13.q
78
GGIO1.ST.Ind39.stVal
26
GGIO1.ST.Ind13.stVal
79
GGIO1.ST.Ind40.q
27
GGIO1.ST.Ind14.q
80
GGIO1.ST.Ind40.stVal
28
GGIO1.ST.Ind14.stVal
81
GGIO1.ST.Ind41.q
29
GGIO1.ST.Ind15.q
82
GGIO1.ST.Ind41.stVal
30
GGIO1.ST.Ind15.stVal
83
GGIO1.ST.Ind42.q
31
GGIO1.ST.Ind16.q
84
GGIO1.ST.Ind42.stVal
32
GGIO1.ST.Ind16.stVal
85
GGIO1.ST.Ind43.q
33
GGIO1.ST.Ind17.q
86
GGIO1.ST.Ind43.stVal
34
GGIO1.ST.Ind17.stVal
87
GGIO1.ST.Ind44.q
35
GGIO1.ST.Ind18.q
88
GGIO1.ST.Ind44.stVal
36
GGIO1.ST.Ind18.stVal
89
GGIO1.ST.Ind45.q
37
GGIO1.ST.Ind19.q
90
GGIO1.ST.Ind45.stVal
38
GGIO1.ST.Ind19.stVal
91
GGIO1.ST.Ind46.q
39
GGIO1.ST.Ind20.q
92
GGIO1.ST.Ind46.stVal
40
GGIO1.ST.Ind20.stVal
93
GGIO1.ST.Ind47.q
41
GGIO1.ST.Ind21.q
94
GGIO1.ST.Ind47.stVal
42
GGIO1.ST.Ind21.stVal
95
GGIO1.ST.Ind48.q
43
GGIO1.ST.Ind22.q
96
GGIO1.ST.Ind48.stVal
44
GGIO1.ST.Ind22.stVal
97
GGIO1.ST.Ind49.q
45
GGIO1.ST.Ind23.q
98
GGIO1.ST.Ind49.stVal
46
GGIO1.ST.Ind23.stVal
99
GGIO1.ST.Ind50.q
47
GGIO1.ST.Ind24.q
100
GGIO1.ST.Ind50.stVal
48
GGIO1.ST.Ind24.stVal
101
GGIO1.ST.Ind51.q
49
GGIO1.ST.Ind25.q
102
GGIO1.ST.Ind51.stVal
50
GGIO1.ST.Ind25.stVal
103
GGIO1.ST.Ind52.q
51
GGIO1.ST.Ind26.q
104
GGIO1.ST.Ind52.stVal
52
GGIO1.ST.Ind26.stVal
105
GGIO1.ST.Ind53.q
53
GGIO1.ST.Ind27.q
106
GGIO1.ST.Ind53.stVal
54
GGIO1.ST.Ind27.stVal
107
GGIO1.ST.Ind54.q
55
GGIO1.ST.Ind28.q
108
GGIO1.ST.Ind54.stVal
56
GGIO1.ST.Ind28.stVal
109
GGIO1.ST.Ind55.q
57
GGIO1.ST.Ind29.q
110
GGIO1.ST.Ind55.stVal
58
GGIO1.ST.Ind29.stVal
111
GGIO1.ST.Ind56.q
59
GGIO1.ST.Ind30.q
112
GGIO1.ST.Ind56.stVal
60
GGIO1.ST.Ind30.stVal
113
GGIO1.ST.Ind57.q
GE Multilin
B-83
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
Enumeration
114
GGIO1.ST.Ind57.stVal
167
GGIO1.ST.Ind84.q
115
GGIO1.ST.Ind58.q
168
GGIO1.ST.Ind84.stVal
116
GGIO1.ST.Ind58.stVal
169
GGIO1.ST.Ind85.q
117
GGIO1.ST.Ind59.q
170
GGIO1.ST.Ind85.stVal
118
GGIO1.ST.Ind59.stVal
171
GGIO1.ST.Ind86.q
119
GGIO1.ST.Ind60.q
172
GGIO1.ST.Ind86.stVal
120
GGIO1.ST.Ind60.stVal
173
GGIO1.ST.Ind87.q
121
GGIO1.ST.Ind61.q
174
GGIO1.ST.Ind87.stVal
122
GGIO1.ST.Ind61.stVal
175
GGIO1.ST.Ind88.q
123
GGIO1.ST.Ind62.q
176
GGIO1.ST.Ind88.stVal
124
GGIO1.ST.Ind62.stVal
177
GGIO1.ST.Ind89.q
125
GGIO1.ST.Ind63.q
178
GGIO1.ST.Ind89.stVal
126
GGIO1.ST.Ind63.stVal
179
GGIO1.ST.Ind90.q
127
GGIO1.ST.Ind64.q
180
GGIO1.ST.Ind90.stVal
128
GGIO1.ST.Ind64.stVal
181
GGIO1.ST.Ind91.q
129
GGIO1.ST.Ind65.q
182
GGIO1.ST.Ind91.stVal
130
GGIO1.ST.Ind65.stVal
183
GGIO1.ST.Ind92.q
131
GGIO1.ST.Ind66.q
184
GGIO1.ST.Ind92.stVal
132
GGIO1.ST.Ind66.stVal
185
GGIO1.ST.Ind93.q
133
GGIO1.ST.Ind67.q
186
GGIO1.ST.Ind93.stVal
134
GGIO1.ST.Ind67.stVal
187
GGIO1.ST.Ind94.q
135
GGIO1.ST.Ind68.q
188
GGIO1.ST.Ind94.stVal
136
GGIO1.ST.Ind68.stVal
189
GGIO1.ST.Ind95.q
137
GGIO1.ST.Ind69.q
190
GGIO1.ST.Ind95.stVal
138
GGIO1.ST.Ind69.stVal
191
GGIO1.ST.Ind96.q
139
GGIO1.ST.Ind70.q
192
GGIO1.ST.Ind96.stVal
140
GGIO1.ST.Ind70.stVal
193
GGIO1.ST.Ind97.q
141
GGIO1.ST.Ind71.q
194
GGIO1.ST.Ind97.stVal
142
GGIO1.ST.Ind71.stVal
195
GGIO1.ST.Ind98.q
143
GGIO1.ST.Ind72.q
196
GGIO1.ST.Ind98.stVal
144
GGIO1.ST.Ind72.stVal
197
GGIO1.ST.Ind99.q
145
GGIO1.ST.Ind73.q
198
GGIO1.ST.Ind99.stVal
146
GGIO1.ST.Ind73.stVal
199
GGIO1.ST.Ind100.q
147
GGIO1.ST.Ind74.q
200
GGIO1.ST.Ind100.stVal
148
GGIO1.ST.Ind74.stVal
201
GGIO1.ST.Ind101.q
149
GGIO1.ST.Ind75.q
202
GGIO1.ST.Ind101.stVal
150
GGIO1.ST.Ind75.stVal
203
GGIO1.ST.Ind102.q
151
GGIO1.ST.Ind76.q
204
GGIO1.ST.Ind102.stVal
152
GGIO1.ST.Ind76.stVal
205
GGIO1.ST.Ind103.q
153
GGIO1.ST.Ind77.q
206
GGIO1.ST.Ind103.stVal
154
GGIO1.ST.Ind77.stVal
207
GGIO1.ST.Ind104.q
155
GGIO1.ST.Ind78.q
208
GGIO1.ST.Ind104.stVal
156
GGIO1.ST.Ind78.stVal
209
GGIO1.ST.Ind105.q
157
GGIO1.ST.Ind79.q
210
GGIO1.ST.Ind105.stVal
158
GGIO1.ST.Ind79.stVal
211
GGIO1.ST.Ind106.q
159
GGIO1.ST.Ind80.q
212
GGIO1.ST.Ind106.stVal
160
GGIO1.ST.Ind80.stVal
213
GGIO1.ST.Ind107.q
161
GGIO1.ST.Ind81.q
214
GGIO1.ST.Ind107.stVal
162
GGIO1.ST.Ind81.stVal
215
GGIO1.ST.Ind108.q
163
GGIO1.ST.Ind82.q
216
GGIO1.ST.Ind108.stVal
164
GGIO1.ST.Ind82.stVal
217
GGIO1.ST.Ind109.q
165
GGIO1.ST.Ind83.q
218
GGIO1.ST.Ind109.stVal
166
GGIO1.ST.Ind83.stVal
219
GGIO1.ST.Ind110.q
B-84
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
Enumeration
220
GGIO1.ST.Ind110.stVal
273
221
GGIO1.ST.Ind111.q
274
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
222
GGIO1.ST.Ind111.stVal
275
MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
223
GGIO1.ST.Ind112.q
276
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
224
GGIO1.ST.Ind112.stVal
277
MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
225
GGIO1.ST.Ind113.q
278
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
226
GGIO1.ST.Ind113.stVal
279
MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
227
GGIO1.ST.Ind114.q
280
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
228
GGIO1.ST.Ind114.stVal
281
MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
229
GGIO1.ST.Ind115.q
282
MMXU1.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
230
GGIO1.ST.Ind115.stVal
283
MMXU1.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
231
GGIO1.ST.Ind116.q
284
MMXU1.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
232
GGIO1.ST.Ind116.stVal
285
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
233
GGIO1.ST.Ind117.q
286
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
234
GGIO1.ST.Ind117.stVal
287
MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
235
GGIO1.ST.Ind118.q
288
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
236
GGIO1.ST.Ind118.stVal
289
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
237
GGIO1.ST.Ind119.q
290
MMXU1.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
238
GGIO1.ST.Ind119.stVal
291
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
239
GGIO1.ST.Ind120.q
292
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
240
GGIO1.ST.Ind120.stVal
293
MMXU1.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
241
GGIO1.ST.Ind121.q
294
MMXU2.MX.TotW.mag.f
242
GGIO1.ST.Ind121.stVal
295
MMXU2.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
243
GGIO1.ST.Ind122.q
296
MMXU2.MX.TotVA.mag.f
244
GGIO1.ST.Ind122.stVal
297
MMXU2.MX.TotPF.mag.f
245
GGIO1.ST.Ind123.q
298
MMXU2.MX.Hz.mag.f
246
GGIO1.ST.Ind123.stVal
299
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
247
GGIO1.ST.Ind124.q
300
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
248
GGIO1.ST.Ind124.stVal
301
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
249
GGIO1.ST.Ind125.q
302
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
250
GGIO1.ST.Ind125.stVal
303
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
251
GGIO1.ST.Ind126.q
304
MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
252
GGIO1.ST.Ind126.stVal
305
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
253
GGIO1.ST.Ind127.q
306
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
254
GGIO1.ST.Ind127.stVal
307
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
255
GGIO1.ST.Ind128.q
308
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
256
GGIO1.ST.Ind128.stVal
309
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
257
MMXU1.MX.TotW.mag.f
310
MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
258
MMXU1.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
311
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
259
MMXU1.MX.TotVA.mag.f
312
MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
260
MMXU1.MX.TotPF.mag.f
313
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
261
MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f
314
MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
262
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
315
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
263
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
316
MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
264
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
317
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
265
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
318
MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
266
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
319
MMXU2.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
267
MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
320
MMXU2.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
268
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
321
MMXU2.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
269
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
322
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
270
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
323
271
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
324
MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
272
MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
325
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
GE Multilin
B-85
B-86
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
326
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
379
327
MMXU2.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
380
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
328
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
381
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
329
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
382
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
330
MMXU2.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
383
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
331
MMXU3.MX.TotW.mag.f
384
MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
332
MMXU3.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
385
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
333
MMXU3.MX.TotVA.mag.f
386
MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
334
MMXU3.MX.TotPF.mag.f
387
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
335
MMXU3.MX.Hz.mag.f
388
MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
336
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
389
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
337
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
390
MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
338
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
391
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
339
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
392
MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
340
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
393
MMXU4.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
341
MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
394
MMXU4.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
342
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
395
MMXU4.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
343
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
396
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
344
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
397
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
345
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
398
MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
346
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
399
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
347
MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
400
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
348
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
401
MMXU4.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
349
MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
402
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
350
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
403
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
351
MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
404
MMXU4.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
352
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
405
MMXU5.MX.TotW.mag.f
353
MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
406
MMXU5.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
354
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
407
MMXU5.MX.TotVA.mag.f
355
MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
408
MMXU5.MX.TotPF.mag.f
356
MMXU3.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
409
MMXU5.MX.Hz.mag.f
357
MMXU3.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
410
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
358
MMXU3.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
411
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
359
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
412
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
360
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
413
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
361
MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
414
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
362
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
415
MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
363
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
416
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
364
MMXU3.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
417
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
365
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
418
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
366
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
419
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
367
MMXU3.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
420
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
368
MMXU4.MX.TotW.mag.f
421
MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
369
MMXU4.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
422
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
370
MMXU4.MX.TotVA.mag.f
423
MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
371
MMXU4.MX.TotPF.mag.f
424
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
372
MMXU4.MX.Hz.mag.f
425
MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
373
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
426
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
374
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
427
MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
375
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
428
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
376
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
429
MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
377
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
430
MMXU5.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
378
MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
431
MMXU5.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
432
MMXU5.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
485
GGIO4.MX.AnIn7.mag.f
433
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
486
GGIO4.MX.AnIn8.mag.f
434
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
487
GGIO4.MX.AnIn9.mag.f
435
MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
488
GGIO4.MX.AnIn10.mag.f
436
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
489
GGIO4.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
437
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
490
GGIO4.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
438
MMXU5.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
491
GGIO4.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
439
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
492
GGIO4.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
440
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
493
GGIO4.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
441
MMXU5.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
494
GGIO4.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
442
MMXU6.MX.TotW.mag.f
495
GGIO4.MX.AnIn17.mag.f
443
MMXU6.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
496
GGIO4.MX.AnIn18.mag.f
444
MMXU6.MX.TotVA.mag.f
497
GGIO4.MX.AnIn19.mag.f
445
MMXU6.MX.TotPF.mag.f
498
GGIO4.MX.AnIn20.mag.f
446
MMXU6.MX.Hz.mag.f
499
GGIO4.MX.AnIn21.mag.f
447
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
500
GGIO4.MX.AnIn22.mag.f
448
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
501
GGIO4.MX.AnIn23.mag.f
449
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
502
GGIO4.MX.AnIn24.mag.f
450
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
503
GGIO4.MX.AnIn25.mag.f
451
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
504
GGIO4.MX.AnIn26.mag.f
452
MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
505
GGIO4.MX.AnIn27.mag.f
453
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
506
GGIO4.MX.AnIn28.mag.f
454
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
507
GGIO4.MX.AnIn29.mag.f
455
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
508
GGIO4.MX.AnIn30.mag.f
456
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
509
GGIO4.MX.AnIn31.mag.f
457
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
510
GGIO4.MX.AnIn32.mag.f
458
MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
511
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1.q
459
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
512
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1.stVal
460
MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
513
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn2.q
461
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
514
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn2.stVal
462
MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
515
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn3.q
463
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
516
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn3.stVal
464
MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
517
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn4.q
465
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
518
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn4.stVal
466
MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
519
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn5.q
467
MMXU6.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
520
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn5.stVal
468
MMXU6.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
521
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn6.q
469
MMXU6.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
522
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn6.stVal
470
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
523
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn7.q
471
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
524
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn7.stVal
472
MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
525
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn8.q
473
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
526
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn8.stVal
474
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
527
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn9.q
475
MMXU6.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
528
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn9.stVal
476
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
529
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn10.q
477
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
530
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn10.stVal
478
MMXU6.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
531
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn11.q
479
GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.mag.f
532
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn11.stVal
480
GGIO4.MX.AnIn2.mag.f
533
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn12.q
481
GGIO4.MX.AnIn3.mag.f
534
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn12.stVal
482
GGIO4.MX.AnIn4.mag.f
535
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn13.q
483
GGIO4.MX.AnIn5.mag.f
536
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn13.stVal
484
GGIO4.MX.AnIn6.mag.f
537
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn14.q
GE Multilin
B-87
B-88
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
538
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn14.stVal
591
PIOC11.ST.Str.general
539
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn15.q
592
PIOC11.ST.Op.general
540
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn15.stVal
593
PIOC12.ST.Str.general
541
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn16.q
594
PIOC12.ST.Op.general
542
GGIO5.ST.UIntIn16.stVal
595
PIOC13.ST.Str.general
543
PDIF1.ST.Str.general
596
PIOC13.ST.Op.general
544
PDIF1.ST.Op.general
597
PIOC14.ST.Str.general
545
PDIF2.ST.Str.general
598
PIOC14.ST.Op.general
546
PDIF2.ST.Op.general
599
PIOC15.ST.Str.general
547
PDIF3.ST.Str.general
600
PIOC15.ST.Op.general
548
PDIF3.ST.Op.general
601
PIOC16.ST.Str.general
549
PDIF4.ST.Str.general
602
PIOC16.ST.Op.general
550
PDIF4.ST.Op.general
603
PIOC17.ST.Str.general
551
PDIS1.ST.Str.general
604
PIOC17.ST.Op.general
552
PDIS1.ST.Op.general
605
PIOC18.ST.Str.general
553
PDIS2.ST.Str.general
606
PIOC18.ST.Op.general
554
PDIS2.ST.Op.general
607
PIOC19.ST.Str.general
555
PDIS3.ST.Str.general
608
PIOC19.ST.Op.general
556
PDIS3.ST.Op.general
609
PIOC20.ST.Str.general
557
PDIS4.ST.Str.general
610
PIOC20.ST.Op.general
558
PDIS4.ST.Op.general
611
PIOC21.ST.Str.general
559
PDIS5.ST.Str.general
612
PIOC21.ST.Op.general
560
PDIS5.ST.Op.general
613
PIOC22.ST.Str.general
561
PDIS6.ST.Str.general
614
PIOC22.ST.Op.general
562
PDIS6.ST.Op.general
615
PIOC23.ST.Str.general
563
PDIS7.ST.Str.general
616
PIOC23.ST.Op.general
564
PDIS7.ST.Op.general
617
PIOC24.ST.Str.general
565
PDIS8.ST.Str.general
618
PIOC24.ST.Op.general
566
PDIS8.ST.Op.general
619
PIOC25.ST.Str.general
567
PDIS9.ST.Str.general
620
PIOC25.ST.Op.general
568
PDIS9.ST.Op.general
621
PIOC26.ST.Str.general
569
PDIS10.ST.Str.general
622
PIOC26.ST.Op.general
570
PDIS10.ST.Op.general
623
PIOC27.ST.Str.general
571
PIOC1.ST.Str.general
624
PIOC27.ST.Op.general
572
PIOC1.ST.Op.general
625
PIOC28.ST.Str.general
573
PIOC2.ST.Str.general
626
PIOC28.ST.Op.general
574
PIOC2.ST.Op.general
627
PIOC29.ST.Str.general
575
PIOC3.ST.Str.general
628
PIOC29.ST.Op.general
576
PIOC3.ST.Op.general
629
PIOC30.ST.Str.general
577
PIOC4.ST.Str.general
630
PIOC30.ST.Op.general
578
PIOC4.ST.Op.general
631
PIOC31.ST.Str.general
579
PIOC5.ST.Str.general
632
PIOC31.ST.Op.general
580
PIOC5.ST.Op.general
633
PIOC32.ST.Str.general
581
PIOC6.ST.Str.general
634
PIOC32.ST.Op.general
582
PIOC6.ST.Op.general
635
PIOC33.ST.Str.general
583
PIOC7.ST.Str.general
636
PIOC33.ST.Op.general
584
PIOC7.ST.Op.general
637
PIOC34.ST.Str.general
585
PIOC8.ST.Str.general
638
PIOC34.ST.Op.general
586
PIOC8.ST.Op.general
639
PIOC35.ST.Str.general
587
PIOC9.ST.Str.general
640
PIOC35.ST.Op.general
588
PIOC9.ST.Op.general
641
PIOC36.ST.Str.general
589
PIOC10.ST.Str.general
642
PIOC36.ST.Op.general
590
PIOC10.ST.Op.general
643
PIOC37.ST.Str.general
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
Enumeration
644
PIOC37.ST.Op.general
697
PIOC64.ST.Str.general
645
PIOC38.ST.Str.general
698
PIOC64.ST.Op.general
646
PIOC38.ST.Op.general
699
PIOC65.ST.Str.general
647
PIOC39.ST.Str.general
700
PIOC65.ST.Op.general
648
PIOC39.ST.Op.general
701
PIOC66.ST.Str.general
649
PIOC40.ST.Str.general
702
PIOC66.ST.Op.general
650
PIOC40.ST.Op.general
703
PIOC67.ST.Str.general
651
PIOC41.ST.Str.general
704
PIOC67.ST.Op.general
652
PIOC41.ST.Op.general
705
PIOC68.ST.Str.general
653
PIOC42.ST.Str.general
706
PIOC68.ST.Op.general
654
PIOC42.ST.Op.general
707
PIOC69.ST.Str.general
655
PIOC43.ST.Str.general
708
PIOC69.ST.Op.general
656
PIOC43.ST.Op.general
709
PIOC70.ST.Str.general
657
PIOC44.ST.Str.general
710
PIOC70.ST.Op.general
658
PIOC44.ST.Op.general
711
PIOC71.ST.Str.general
659
PIOC45.ST.Str.general
712
PIOC71.ST.Op.general
660
PIOC45.ST.Op.general
713
PIOC72.ST.Str.general
661
PIOC46.ST.Str.general
714
PIOC72.ST.Op.general
662
PIOC46.ST.Op.general
715
PTOC1.ST.Str.general
663
PIOC47.ST.Str.general
716
PTOC1.ST.Op.general
664
PIOC47.ST.Op.general
717
PTOC2.ST.Str.general
665
PIOC48.ST.Str.general
718
PTOC2.ST.Op.general
666
PIOC48.ST.Op.general
719
PTOC3.ST.Str.general
667
PIOC49.ST.Str.general
720
PTOC3.ST.Op.general
668
PIOC49.ST.Op.general
721
PTOC4.ST.Str.general
669
PIOC50.ST.Str.general
722
PTOC4.ST.Op.general
670
PIOC50.ST.Op.general
723
PTOC5.ST.Str.general
671
PIOC51.ST.Str.general
724
PTOC5.ST.Op.general
672
PIOC51.ST.Op.general
725
PTOC6.ST.Str.general
673
PIOC52.ST.Str.general
726
PTOC6.ST.Op.general
674
PIOC52.ST.Op.general
727
PTOC7.ST.Str.general
675
PIOC53.ST.Str.general
728
PTOC7.ST.Op.general
676
PIOC53.ST.Op.general
729
PTOC8.ST.Str.general
677
PIOC54.ST.Str.general
730
PTOC8.ST.Op.general
678
PIOC54.ST.Op.general
731
PTOC9.ST.Str.general
679
PIOC55.ST.Str.general
732
PTOC9.ST.Op.general
680
PIOC55.ST.Op.general
733
PTOC10.ST.Str.general
681
PIOC56.ST.Str.general
734
PTOC10.ST.Op.general
682
PIOC56.ST.Op.general
735
PTOC11.ST.Str.general
683
PIOC57.ST.Str.general
736
PTOC11.ST.Op.general
684
PIOC57.ST.Op.general
737
PTOC12.ST.Str.general
685
PIOC58.ST.Str.general
738
PTOC12.ST.Op.general
686
PIOC58.ST.Op.general
739
PTOC13.ST.Str.general
687
PIOC59.ST.Str.general
740
PTOC13.ST.Op.general
688
PIOC59.ST.Op.general
741
PTOC14.ST.Str.general
689
PIOC60.ST.Str.general
742
PTOC14.ST.Op.general
690
PIOC60.ST.Op.general
743
PTOC15.ST.Str.general
691
PIOC61.ST.Str.general
744
PTOC15.ST.Op.general
692
PIOC61.ST.Op.general
745
PTOC16.ST.Str.general
693
PIOC62.ST.Str.general
746
PTOC16.ST.Op.general
694
PIOC62.ST.Op.general
747
PTOC17.ST.Str.general
695
PIOC63.ST.Str.general
748
PTOC17.ST.Op.general
696
PIOC63.ST.Op.general
749
PTOC18.ST.Str.general
GE Multilin
B-89
B-90
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
750
PTOC18.ST.Op.general
803
PTUV5.ST.Str.general
751
PTOC19.ST.Str.general
804
PTUV5.ST.Op.general
752
PTOC19.ST.Op.general
805
PTUV6.ST.Str.general
753
PTOC20.ST.Str.general
806
PTUV6.ST.Op.general
754
PTOC20.ST.Op.general
807
PTUV7.ST.Str.general
755
PTOC21.ST.Str.general
808
PTUV7.ST.Op.general
756
PTOC21.ST.Op.general
809
PTUV8.ST.Str.general
757
PTOC22.ST.Str.general
810
PTUV8.ST.Op.general
758
PTOC22.ST.Op.general
811
PTUV9.ST.Str.general
759
PTOC23.ST.Str.general
812
PTUV9.ST.Op.general
760
PTOC23.ST.Op.general
813
PTUV10.ST.Str.general
761
PTOC24.ST.Str.general
814
PTUV10.ST.Op.general
762
PTOC24.ST.Op.general
815
PTUV11.ST.Str.general
763
PTOV1.ST.Str.general
816
PTUV11.ST.Op.general
764
PTOV1.ST.Op.general
817
PTUV12.ST.Str.general
765
PTOV2.ST.Str.general
818
PTUV12.ST.Op.general
766
PTOV2.ST.Op.general
819
PTUV13.ST.Str.general
767
PTOV3.ST.Str.general
820
PTUV13.ST.Op.general
768
PTOV3.ST.Op.general
821
RBRF1.ST.OpEx.general
769
PTOV4.ST.Str.general
822
RBRF1.ST.OpIn.general
770
PTOV4.ST.Op.general
823
RBRF2.ST.OpEx.general
771
PTOV5.ST.Str.general
824
RBRF2.ST.OpIn.general
772
PTOV5.ST.Op.general
825
RBRF3.ST.OpEx.general
773
PTOV6.ST.Str.general
826
RBRF3.ST.OpIn.general
774
PTOV6.ST.Op.general
827
RBRF4.ST.OpEx.general
775
PTOV7.ST.Str.general
828
RBRF4.ST.OpIn.general
776
PTOV7.ST.Op.general
829
RBRF5.ST.OpEx.general
777
PTOV8.ST.Str.general
830
RBRF5.ST.OpIn.general
778
PTOV8.ST.Op.general
831
RBRF6.ST.OpEx.general
779
PTOV9.ST.Str.general
832
RBRF6.ST.OpIn.general
780
PTOV9.ST.Op.general
833
RBRF7.ST.OpEx.general
781
PTOV10.ST.Str.general
834
RBRF7.ST.OpIn.general
782
PTOV10.ST.Op.general
835
RBRF8.ST.OpEx.general
783
PTRC1.ST.Tr.general
836
RBRF8.ST.OpIn.general
784
PTRC1.ST.Op.general
837
RBRF9.ST.OpEx.general
785
PTRC2.ST.Tr.general
838
RBRF9.ST.OpIn.general
786
PTRC2.ST.Op.general
839
RBRF10.ST.OpEx.general
787
PTRC3.ST.Tr.general
840
RBRF10.ST.OpIn.general
788
PTRC3.ST.Op.general
841
RBRF11.ST.OpEx.general
789
PTRC4.ST.Tr.general
842
RBRF11.ST.OpIn.general
790
PTRC4.ST.Op.general
843
RBRF12.ST.OpEx.general
791
PTRC5.ST.Tr.general
844
RBRF12.ST.OpIn.general
792
PTRC5.ST.Op.general
845
RBRF13.ST.OpEx.general
793
PTRC6.ST.Tr.general
846
RBRF13.ST.OpIn.general
794
PTRC6.ST.Op.general
847
RBRF14.ST.OpEx.general
795
PTUV1.ST.Str.general
848
RBRF14.ST.OpIn.general
796
PTUV1.ST.Op.general
849
RBRF15.ST.OpEx.general
797
PTUV2.ST.Str.general
850
RBRF15.ST.OpIn.general
798
PTUV2.ST.Op.general
851
RBRF16.ST.OpEx.general
799
PTUV3.ST.Str.general
852
RBRF16.ST.OpIn.general
800
PTUV3.ST.Op.general
853
RBRF17.ST.OpEx.general
801
PTUV4.ST.Str.general
854
RBRF17.ST.OpIn.general
802
PTUV4.ST.Op.general
855
RBRF18.ST.OpEx.general
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
Enumeration
856
RBRF18.ST.OpIn.general
909
CSWI11.ST.Loc.stVal
857
RBRF19.ST.OpEx.general
910
CSWI11.ST.Pos.stVal
858
RBRF19.ST.OpIn.general
911
CSWI12.ST.Loc.stVal
859
RBRF20.ST.OpEx.general
912
CSWI12.ST.Pos.stVal
860
RBRF20.ST.OpIn.general
913
CSWI13.ST.Loc.stVal
861
RBRF21.ST.OpEx.general
914
CSWI13.ST.Pos.stVal
862
RBRF21.ST.OpIn.general
915
CSWI14.ST.Loc.stVal
863
RBRF22.ST.OpEx.general
916
CSWI14.ST.Pos.stVal
864
RBRF22.ST.OpIn.general
917
CSWI15.ST.Loc.stVal
865
RBRF23.ST.OpEx.general
918
CSWI15.ST.Pos.stVal
866
RBRF23.ST.OpIn.general
919
CSWI16.ST.Loc.stVal
867
RBRF24.ST.OpEx.general
920
CSWI16.ST.Pos.stVal
868
RBRF24.ST.OpIn.general
921
CSWI17.ST.Loc.stVal
869
RFLO1.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
922
CSWI17.ST.Pos.stVal
870
RFLO2.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
923
CSWI18.ST.Loc.stVal
871
RFLO3.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
924
CSWI18.ST.Pos.stVal
872
RFLO4.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
925
CSWI19.ST.Loc.stVal
873
RFLO5.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f
926
CSWI19.ST.Pos.stVal
874
RPSB1.ST.Str.general
927
CSWI20.ST.Loc.stVal
875
RPSB1.ST.Op.general
928
CSWI20.ST.Pos.stVal
876
RPSB1.ST.BlkZn.stVal
929
CSWI21.ST.Loc.stVal
877
RREC1.ST.Op.general
930
CSWI21.ST.Pos.stVal
878
RREC1.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
931
CSWI22.ST.Loc.stVal
879
RREC2.ST.Op.general
932
CSWI22.ST.Pos.stVal
880
RREC2.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
933
CSWI23.ST.Loc.stVal
881
RREC3.ST.Op.general
934
CSWI23.ST.Pos.stVal
882
RREC3.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
935
CSWI24.ST.Loc.stVal
883
RREC4.ST.Op.general
936
CSWI24.ST.Pos.stVal
884
RREC4.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
937
CSWI25.ST.Loc.stVal
885
RREC5.ST.Op.general
938
CSWI25.ST.Pos.stVal
886
RREC5.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
939
CSWI26.ST.Loc.stVal
887
RREC6.ST.Op.general
940
CSWI26.ST.Pos.stVal
888
RREC6.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
941
CSWI27.ST.Loc.stVal
889
CSWI1.ST.Loc.stVal
942
CSWI27.ST.Pos.stVal
890
CSWI1.ST.Pos.stVal
943
CSWI28.ST.Loc.stVal
891
CSWI2.ST.Loc.stVal
944
CSWI28.ST.Pos.stVal
892
CSWI2.ST.Pos.stVal
945
CSWI29.ST.Loc.stVal
893
CSWI3.ST.Loc.stVal
946
CSWI29.ST.Pos.stVal
894
CSWI3.ST.Pos.stVal
947
CSWI30.ST.Loc.stVal
895
CSWI4.ST.Loc.stVal
948
CSWI30.ST.Pos.stVal
896
CSWI4.ST.Pos.stVal
949
XSWI1.ST.Loc.stVal
897
CSWI5.ST.Loc.stVal
950
XSWI1.ST.Pos.stVal
898
CSWI5.ST.Pos.stVal
951
XSWI2.ST.Loc.stVal
899
CSWI6.ST.Loc.stVal
952
XSWI2.ST.Pos.stVal
900
CSWI6.ST.Pos.stVal
953
XSWI3.ST.Loc.stVal
901
CSWI7.ST.Loc.stVal
954
XSWI3.ST.Pos.stVal
902
CSWI7.ST.Pos.stVal
955
XSWI4.ST.Loc.stVal
903
CSWI8.ST.Loc.stVal
956
XSWI4.ST.Pos.stVal
904
CSWI8.ST.Pos.stVal
957
XSWI5.ST.Loc.stVal
905
CSWI9.ST.Loc.stVal
958
XSWI5.ST.Pos.stVal
906
CSWI9.ST.Pos.stVal
959
XSWI6.ST.Loc.stVal
907
CSWI10.ST.Loc.stVal
960
XSWI6.ST.Pos.stVal
908
CSWI10.ST.Pos.stVal
961
XSWI7.ST.Loc.stVal
GE Multilin
B-91
F617
ENUMERATION: LOGIN ROLES
962
XSWI7.ST.Pos.stVal
963
XSWI8.ST.Loc.stVal
964
XSWI8.ST.Pos.stVal
Enumeration
Role
965
XSWI9.ST.Loc.stVal
None
966
XSWI9.ST.Pos.stVal
Administrator
967
XSWI10.ST.Loc.stVal
Supervisor
968
XSWI10.ST.Pos.stVal
Engineer
969
XSWI11.ST.Loc.stVal
Operator
970
XSWI11.ST.Pos.stVal
Factory
971
XSWI12.ST.Loc.stVal
972
XSWI12.ST.Pos.stVal
973
XSWI13.ST.Loc.stVal
974
XSWI13.ST.Pos.stVal
975
XSWI14.ST.Loc.stVal
F623
ENUMERATION: RTC SYNCHRONIZING SOURCE CONFIGURATION
976
XSWI14.ST.Pos.stVal
Enumeration
Item
977
XSWI15.ST.Loc.stVal
None
978
XSWI15.ST.Pos.stVal
PP/IRIG-B/PTP/SNTP
979
XSWI16.ST.Loc.stVal
IRIG-B/PP/PTP/SNTP
980
XSWI16.ST.Pos.stVal
PP/PTP/IRIG-B/SNTP
981
XSWI17.ST.Loc.stVal
982
XSWI17.ST.Pos.stVal
983
XSWI18.ST.Loc.stVal
F624
ENUMERATION: RTC SYNCHRONZING SOURCE ACTUALS
984
XSWI18.ST.Pos.stVal
985
XSWI19.ST.Loc.stVal
Enumeration
Item
986
XSWI19.ST.Pos.stVal
None
987
XSWI20.ST.Loc.stVal
988
XSWI20.ST.Pos.stVal
989
XSWI21.ST.Loc.stVal
990
XSWI21.ST.Pos.stVal
IRIG-B
991
XSWI22.ST.Loc.stVal
SNTP
992
XSWI22.ST.Pos.stVal
993
XSWI23.ST.Loc.stVal
994
XSWI23.ST.Pos.stVal
995
XSWI24.ST.Loc.stVal
996
XSWI24.ST.Pos.stVal
997
XCBR1.ST.Loc.stVal
998
XCBR1.ST.Pos.stVal
999
1000
XCBR2.ST.Loc.stVal
XCBR2.ST.Pos.stVal
1001
XCBR3.ST.Loc.stVal
1002
XCBR3.ST.Pos.stVal
1003
XCBR4.ST.Loc.stVal
1004
XCBR4.ST.Pos.stVal
1005
XCBR5.ST.Loc.stVal
1006
XCBR5.ST.Pos.stVal
1007
XCBR6.ST.Loc.stVal
1008
XCBR6.ST.Pos.stVal
B-92
APPENDIX B
F625
ENUMERATION: PTP STATE
Enumeration
Item
Disabled
No Signal
Calibrating
Synchronized
F626
ENUMERATION: NETWORK PORT FOR REMOTE DEVICE
Enumeration
Item
None
Network Port 1
Network Port 2
Network Port 3
GE Multilin
APPENDIX B
F627
ENUMERATION: REDUNDANCY MODE
Enumeration
Item
None
Failover
PRP
GE Multilin
B-93
APPENDIX B
B-94
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
C.1 OVERVIEW
C.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The IEC 61850 standard is the result of electric utilities and vendors of electronic equipment to produce standardized communications systems. IEC 61850 is a series of standards describing client/server and peer-to-peer communications, substation design and configuration, testing, environmental and project standards. The complete set includes:
IEC 61850-5: Communications and requirements for functions and device models
IEC 61850-6: Configuration description language for communication in electrical substations related to IEDs
IEC 61850-7-1: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment - Principles and models
IEC 61850-7-2: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment - Abstract communication service
interface (ACSI)
IEC 61850-7-3: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment Common data classes
IEC 61850-7-4: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment Compatible logical node classes
and data classes
IEC 61850-8-1: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) Mappings to MMS (ISO 9506-1 and ISO 9506-2)
and to ISO/IEC 8802-3
IEC 61850-9-1: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) Sampled values over serial unidirectional multidrop point to point link
IEC 61850-9-2: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) Sampled values over ISO/IEC 8802-3
These documents can be obtained from the IEC (http://www.iec.ch). It is strongly recommended that all those involved with
any IEC 61850 implementation obtain this document set.
C.1.2 COMMUNICATION PROFILES
IEC 61850 specifies the use of the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) at the upper (application) layer for transfer
of real-time data. This protocol has been in existence for several of years and provides a set of services suitable for the
transfer of data within a substation LAN environment. Actual MMS protocol services are mapped to IEC 61850 abstract services in IEC 61850-8-1.
The C30 relay supports IEC 61850 server services over TCP/IP. The TCP/IP profile requires the C30 to have an IP address
to establish communications. These addresses are located in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
NETWORK menu. It is possible to have up to five simultaneous connections (in addition to DNP and Modbus/TCP (non-IEC
61850) connections).
Client/server: This is a connection-oriented type of communication. The connection is initiated by the client, and communication activity is controlled by the client. IEC 61850 clients are often substation computers running HMI programs
or SOE logging software. Servers are usually substation equipment such as protection relays, meters, RTUs, transformer tap changers, or bay controllers.
Peer-to-peer: This is a non-connection-oriented, high speed type of communication usually between substation equipment such as protection relays. GSSE and GOOSE are methods of peer-to-peer communication.
Substation configuration language (SCL): A substation configuration language is a number of files used to describe
the configuration of substation equipment. Each configured device has an IEC Capability Description (ICD) file. The
substation single line information is stored in a System Specification Description (SSD) file. The entire substation configuration is stored in a Substation Configuration Description (SCD) file. The SCD file is the combination of the individual ICD files and the SSD file.
GE Multilin
C-1
APPENDIX C
C.2.1 OVERVIEW
IEC 61850 defines an object-oriented approach to data and services. An IEC 61850 physical device can contain one or
more logical device(s). Each logical device can contain many logical nodes. Each logical node can contain many data
objects. Each data object is composed of data attributes and data attribute components. Services are available at each
level for performing various functions, such as reading, writing, control commands, and reporting.
Each C30 IED represents one IEC 61850 physical device. The physical device contains one logical device, and the logical
device contains many logical nodes. The logical node LPHD1 contains information about the C30 IED physical device. The
logical node LLN0 contains information about the C30 IED logical device.
C.2.2 GGIO1: DIGITAL STATUS VALUES
The GGIO1 logical node is available in the C30 to provide access to as many 128 digital status points and associated timestamps and quality flags. The data content must be configured before the data can be used. GGIO1 provides digital status
points for access by clients.
It is intended that clients use GGIO1 in order to access digital status values from the C30. Configuration settings are provided to allow the selection of the number of digital status indications available in GGIO1 (8 to 128), and to allow the choice
of the C30 FlexLogic operands that drive the status of the GGIO1 status indications. Clients can utilize the IEC 61850 buffered and unbuffered reporting features available from GGIO1 in order to build sequence of events (SOE) logs and HMI display screens. Buffered reporting should generally be used for SOE logs since the buffering capability reduces the chances
of missing data state changes. Unbuffered reporting should generally be used for local status display.
C.2.3 GGIO2: DIGITAL CONTROL VALUES
The GGIO2 logical node is available to provide access to the C30 virtual inputs. Virtual inputs are single-point control
(binary) values that can be written by clients. They are generally used as control inputs. GGIO2 provides access to the virtual inputs through the IEC 61850 standard control model (ctlModel) services:
Status only.
Configuration settings are available to select the control model for each point. Each virtual input used through GGIO2
should have its VIRTUAL INPUT 1(64) FUNCTION setting programmed as Enabled and its corresponding GGIO2 CF SPSCO1(64)
CTLMODEL setting programmed to the appropriate control configuration.
C.2.4 GGIO3: DIGITAL STATUS AND ANALOG VALUES FROM GOOSE DATA
The GGIO3 logical node is available to provide access for clients to values received via configurable GOOSE messages.
The values of the digital status indications and analog values in GGIO3 originate in GOOSE messages sent from other
devices.
C.2.5 GGIO4: GENERIC ANALOG MEASURED VALUES
The GGIO4 logical node provides access to as many as 32 analog value points, as well as associated timestamps and
quality flags. The data content must be configured before the data can be used. GGIO4 provides analog values for access
by clients.
It is intended that clients use GGIO4 to access generic analog values from the C30. Configuration settings allow the selection of the number of analog values available in GGIO4 (4 to 32) and the choice of the FlexAnalog values that determine
the value of the GGIO4 analog inputs. Clients can utilize polling or the IEC 61850 unbuffered reporting feature available
from GGIO4 in order to obtain the analog values provided by GGIO4.
C-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
A limited number of measured analog values are available through the MMXU logical nodes.
Each MMXU logical node provides data from a C30 current and voltage source. There is one MMXU available for each
configurable source (programmed in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES menu). MMXU1 provides data
from C30 source 1, and MMXU2 provides data from C30 source 2.
MMXU data is provided in two forms: instantaneous and deadband. The instantaneous values are updated every time a
read operation is performed by a client. The deadband values are calculated as described in IEC 61850 parts 7-1 and 7-3.
The selection of appropriate deadband settings for the C30 is described in chapter 5 of this manual.
IEC 61850 buffered and unbuffered reporting capability is available in all MMXU logical nodes. MMXUx logical nodes provide the following data for each source:
MMXU1.MX.Hz: frequency
The following list describes the protection elements for all UR-series relays. The C30 relay will contain a subset of protection elements from this list.
PDIF: bus differential, transformer instantaneous differential, transformer percent differential, current differential
GE Multilin
C-3
APPENDIX C
PIOC: phase instantaneous overcurrent, neutral instantaneous overcurrent, ground instantaneous overcurrent, negative-sequence instantaneous overcurrent.
PTOC: phase time overcurrent, neutral time overcurrent, ground time overcurrent, negative-sequence time overcurrent, neutral directional overcurrent, negative-sequence directional overcurrent
PTOV: phase overvoltage, neutral overvoltage, auxiliary overvoltage, negative sequence overvoltage
RREC: autoreclosure
The protection elements listed above contain start (pickup) and operate flags. For example, the start flag for PIOC1 is
PIOC1.ST.Str.general. The operate flag for PIOC1 is PIOC1.ST.Op.general. For the C30 protection elements, these flags
take their values from the pickup and operate FlexLogic operands for the corresponding element.
Some protection elements listed above contain directional start values. For example, the directional start value for PDIS1 is
PDIS1.ST.Str.dirGeneral. This value is built from the directional FlexLogic operands for the element.
The RFLO logical node contains the measurement of the distance to fault calculation in kilometers. This value originates in
the fault locator function.
The XCBR logical node is directly associated with the breaker control feature.
XCBR1.ST.Loc: This is the state of the XCBR1 local/remote switch. A setting is provided to assign a FlexLogic operand
to determine the state. When local mode is true, IEC 61850 client commands will be rejected.
XCBR1.ST.Opcnt: This is an operation counter as defined in IEC 61850. Command settings are provided to allow the
counter to be cleared.
XCBR1.ST.Pos: This is the position of the breaker. The breaker control FlexLogic operands are used to determine this
state.
Intermediate state (00) is indicated when the BREAKER 1 OPEN and BREAKER 1 CLOSED operands are both On.
Off state (01) is indicated when the BREAKER 1 OPEN operand is On.
Bad state (11) is indicated when the BREAKER 1 OPEN and BREAKER 1 CLOSED operands are Off.
XCBR1.ST.BlkOpn: This is the state of the block open command logic. When true, breaker open commands from IEC
61850 clients will be rejected.
XCBR1.ST.BlkCls: This is the state of the block close command logic. When true, breaker close commands from IEC
61850 clients will be rejected.
XCBR1.CO.Pos: This is where IEC 61850 clients can issue open or close commands to the breaker. SBO control with
normal security is the only supported IEC 61850 control model.
XCBR1.CO.BlkOpn: This is where IEC 61850 clients can issue block open commands to the breaker. Direct control
with normal security is the only supported IEC 61850 control model.
XCBR1.CO.BlkCls: This is where IEC 61850 clients can issue block close commands to the breaker. Direct control
with normal security is the only supported IEC 61850 control model.
C-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
IEC 61850 buffered and unbuffered reporting is provided in the GGIO1 logical nodes (for binary status values) and MMXU1
to MMXU6 (for analog measured values). Report settings can be configured using the EnerVista UR Setup software, substation configurator software, or via an IEC 61850 client. The following items can be configured:
TrgOps: Trigger options. The following bits are supported by the C30:
Bit 1: data-change
Bit 4: integrity
OptFlds: Option Fields. The following bits are supported by the C30:
Bit 1: sequence-number
Bit 2: report-time-stamp
Bit 3: reason-for-inclusion
Bit 4: data-set-name
Bit 5: data-reference
Bit 8: conf-revision
Bit 9: segmentation
MMS file services are supported to allow transfer of oscillography, event record, or other files from a C30 relay.
C.3.3 TIMESTAMPS AND SCANNING
The timestamp values associated with all IEC 61850 data items represent the time of the last change of either the value or
quality flags of the data item. To accomplish this functionality, all IEC 61850 data items must be regularly scanned for data
changes, and the timestamp updated when a change is detected, regardless of the connection status of any IEC 61850 clients. For applications where there is no IEC 61850 client in use, the IEC 61850 SERVER SCANNING setting can be programmed as Disabled. If a client is in use, this setting should be programmed as Enabled to ensure the proper
generation of IEC 61850 timestamps.
C.3.4 LOGICAL DEVICE NAME
The logical device name is used to identify the IEC 61850 logical device that exists within the C30. This name is composed
of two parts: the IED name setting and the logical device instance. The complete logical device name is the combination of
the two character strings programmed in the IEDNAME and LD INST settings. The default values for these strings are IEDName and LDInst. These values should be changed to reflect a logical naming convention for all IEC 61850 logical
devices in the system.
C.3.5 LOCATION
The LPHD1 logical node contains a data attribute called location (LPHD1.DC.PhyNam.location). This is a character string
meant to describe the physical location of the C30. This attribute is programmed through the LOCATION setting and its
default value is Location. This value should be changed to describe the actual physical location of the C30.
GE Multilin
C-5
APPENDIX C
C.3.6 LOGICAL NODE NAME PREFIXES
IEC 61850 specifies that each logical node can have a name with a total length of 11 characters. The name is composed of:
Complete names are of the form xxxxxxPIOC1, where the xxxxxx character string is configurable. Details regarding the
logical node naming rules are given in IEC 61850 parts 6 and 7-2. It is recommended that a consistent naming convention
be used for an entire substation project.
C-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
C.4.1 OVERVIEW
IEC 61850 specifies two types of peer-to-peer data transfer services: Generic Substation State Events (GSSE) and Generic
Object Oriented Substation Events (GOOSE). GSSE services are compatible with UCA 2.0 GOOSE. IEC 61850 GOOSE
services provide virtual LAN (VLAN) support, Ethernet priority tagging, and Ethertype Application ID configuration. The support for VLANs and priority tagging allows for the optimization of Ethernet network traffic. GOOSE messages can be given
a higher priority than standard Ethernet traffic, and they can be separated onto specific VLANs. Because of the additional
features of GOOSE services versus GSSE services, it is recommended that GOOSE be used wherever backwards compatibility with GSSE (or UCA 2.0 GOOSE) is not required.
Devices that transmit GSSE and/or GOOSE messages also function as servers. Each GSSE publisher contains a GSSE
control block to configure and control the transmission. Each GOOSE publisher contains a GOOSE control block to configure and control the transmission. The transmission is also controlled via device settings. These settings can be seen in
the ICD and/or SCD files, or in the device configuration software or files.
IEC 61850 recommends a default priority value of 4 for GOOSE. Ethernet traffic that does not contain a priority tag has a
default priority of 1. More details are specified in IEC 61850 part 8-1.
IEC 61850 recommends that the Ethertype Application ID number be configured according to the GOOSE source. In the
C30, the transmitted GOOSE Application ID number must match the configured receive Application ID number in the
receiver. A common number may be used for all GOOSE transmitters in a system. More details are specified in IEC 61850
part 8-1.
C.4.2 GSSE CONFIGURATION
IEC 61850 Generic Substation Status Event (GSSE) communication is compatible with UCA GOOSE communication.
GSSE messages contain a number of double point status data items. These items are transmitted in two pre-defined data
structures named DNA and UserSt. Each DNA and UserSt item is referred to as a bit pair. GSSE messages are transmitted in response to state changes in any of the data points contained in the message. GSSE messages always contain the
same number of DNA and UserSt bit pairs. Depending the on the configuration, only some of these bit pairs may have values that are of interest to receiving devices.
The GSSE FUNCTION, GSSE ID, and GSSE DESTINATION MAC ADDRESS settings are used to configure GSSE transmission.
GSSE FUNCTION is set to Enabled to enable the transmission. If a valid multicast Ethernet MAC address is entered for the
GSSE DESTINATION MAC ADDRESS setting, this address will be used as the destination MAC address for GSSE messages. If
a valid multicast Ethernet MAC address is not entered (for example, 00 00 00 00 00 00), the C30 will use the source Ethernet MAC address as the destination, with the multicast bit set.
C.4.3 FIXED GOOSE
The C30 supports two types of IEC 61850 Generic Object Oriented Substation Event (GOOSE) communication: fixed
GOOSE and configurable GOOSE. All GOOSE messages contain IEC 61850 data collected into a dataset. It is this dataset
that is transferred using GOOSE message services. The dataset transferred using the C30 fixed GOOSE is the same data
that is transferred using the GSSE feature; that is, the DNA and UserSt bit pairs. The FlexLogic operands that determine
the state of the DNA and UserSt bit pairs are configurable via settings, but the fixed GOOSE dataset always contains the
same DNA/UserSt data structure. Upgrading from GSSE to GOOSE services is simply a matter of enabling fixed GOOSE
and disabling GSSE. The remote inputs and outputs are configured in the same manner for both GSSE and fixed GOOSE.
It is recommended that the fixed GOOSE be used for implementations that require GOOSE data transfer between URseries IEDs. Configurable GOOSE may be used for implementations that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers.
C.4.4 CONFIGURABLE GOOSE
The configurable GOOSE feature allows for the configuration of the datasets to be transmitted or received from the C30.
The C30 supports the configuration of eight (8) transmission and reception datasets, allowing for the optimization of data
transfer between devices.
GE Multilin
C-7
APPENDIX C
Items programmed for dataset 1 and 2 will have changes in their status transmitted as soon as the change is detected.
Dataset 1 should be used for high-speed transmission of data that is required for applications such as transfer tripping,
blocking, and breaker fail initiate. At least one digital status value needs to be configured in dataset 1 to enable transmission of all data configured for dataset 1. Configuring analog data only to dataset 1 will not activate transmission.
Items programmed for datasets 3 through 8 will have changes in their status transmitted at a maximum rate of every
100 ms. Datasets 3 through 8 will regularly analyze each data item configured within them every 100 ms to identify if any
changes have been made. If any changes in the data items are detected, these changes will be transmitted through a
GOOSE message. If there are no changes detected during this 100 ms period, no GOOSE message will be sent.
For all datasets 1 through 8, the integrity GOOSE message will still continue to be sent at the pre-configured rate even if no
changes in the data items are detected.
The GOOSE functionality was enhanced to prevent the relay from flooding a communications network with GOOSE messages due to an oscillation being created that is triggering a message.
The C30 has the ability of detecting if a data item in one of the GOOSE datasets is erroneously oscillating. This can be
caused by events such as errors in logic programming, inputs improperly being asserted and de-asserted, or failed station
components. If erroneously oscillation is detected, the C30 will stop sending GOOSE messages from the dataset for a minimum period of one second. Should the oscillation persist after the one second time-out period, the C30 will continue to
block transmission of the dataset. The C30 will assert the MAINTENANCE ALERT: GGIO Ind XXX oscill self-test error message on the front panel display, where XXX denotes the data item detected as oscillating.
The configurable GOOSE feature is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers. Fixed GOOSE is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data
transfer between UR-series IEDs.
IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging contains a number of configurable parameters, all of which must be correct to achieve the
successful transfer of data. It is critical that the configured datasets at the transmission and reception devices are an exact
match in terms of data structure, and that the GOOSE addresses and name strings match exactly. Manual configuration is
possible, but third-party substation configuration software may be used to automate the process. The EnerVista UR Setupsoftware can produce IEC 61850 ICD files and import IEC 61850 SCD files produced by a substation configurator (see
the IEC 61850 IED configuration information later in this appendix).
Use independent ports for IEC 61850 communication and take care when configuring the settings,
else loss of protection or misoperation of the relay can result.
The following example illustrates the configuration required to transfer IEC 61850 data items between two devices. The
general steps required for transmission configuration are:
1.
2.
3.
2.
3.
This example shows how to configure the transmission and reception of three IEC 61850 data items: a single point status
value, its associated quality flags, and a floating point analog value.
The following procedure illustrates the transmission configuration.
1.
Configure the transmission dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO1 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO1 status indication 1.
The transmission dataset now contains a set of quality flags and a single point status Boolean value. The reception
dataset on the receiving device must exactly match this structure.
C-8
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
2.
3.
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1 settings menu:
Set CONFIG GSE 1 ID to an appropriate descriptive string (the default value is GOOSEOut_1).
Set CONFIG GSE 1 DST MAC to a multicast address (for example, 01 00 00 12 34 56).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN PRIORITY; the default value of 4 is OK for this example.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 VLAN ID value; the default value is 0, but some switches may require this value to be 1.
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 ETYPE APPID value. This setting represents the Ethertype application ID and must match the
configuration on the receiver (the default value is 0).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 CONFREV value. This value changes automatically as described in IEC 61850 part 7-2. For
this example it can be left at its default value.
Configure the data by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC 61850 PROTOsettings menu:
Set GGIO1 INDICATION 1 to a FlexLogic operand used to provide the status of GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal (for example, a
contact input, virtual input, a protection element status, etc.).
The C30 must be rebooted (control power removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The following procedure illustrates the reception configuration.
1.
Configure the reception dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC
61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE
1 CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS settings menu:
Set ITEM 1 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q to indicate quality flags for GGIO3 status indication 1.
Set ITEM 2 to GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal to indicate the status value for GGIO3 status indication 1.
The reception dataset now contains a set of quality flags, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point analog value. This matches the transmission dataset configuration above.
2.
3.
Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE DEVICE 1 settings menu:
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ID to match the GOOSE ID string for the transmitting device. Enter GOOSEOut_1.
Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID to match the Ethertype application ID from the transmitting device. This is 0 in
the example above.
Set the REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET value. This value represents the dataset number in use. Since we are using
configurable GOOSE 1 in this example, program this value as GOOSEIn 1.
Configure the data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE INPUTS REMOTE INPUT 1
settings menu:
Set REMOTE IN 1 ITEM to Dataset Item 2. This assigns the value of the GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal single point status
item to remote input 1.
Remote input 1 can now be used in FlexLogic equations or other settings. The C30 must be rebooted (control power
removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of remote input 1 (Boolean on or off) in the receiving device will be determined by the GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal value
in the sending device. The above settings will be automatically populated by the EnerVista UR Setup software when a complete SCD file is created by third party substation configurator software.
GE Multilin
C-9
APPENDIX C
By default, the C30 is configured to use an automated multicast MAC scheme. If the C30 destination MAC address setting
is not a valid multicast address (that is, the least significant bit of the first byte is not set), the address used as the destination MAC will be the same as the local MAC address, but with the multicast bit set. Thus, if the local MAC address is 00 A0
F4 01 02 03, then the destination MAC address will be 01 A0 F4 01 02 03.
C.4.6 GSSE ID AND GOOSE ID SETTINGS
GSSE messages contain an identifier string used by receiving devices to identify the sender of the message, defined in IEC
61850 part 8-1 as GsID. This is a programmable 65-character string. This string should be chosen to provide a descriptive
name of the originator of the GSSE message.
GOOSE messages contain an identifier string used by receiving devices to identify the sender of the message, defined in
IEC 61850 part 8-1 as GoID. This programmable 65-character string should be a descriptive name of the originator of the
GOOSE message. GOOSE messages also contain two additional character strings used for identification of the message:
DatSet - the name of the associated dataset, and GoCBRef - the reference (name) of the associated GOOSE control block.
These strings are automatically populated and interpreted by the C30; no settings are required.
C-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
C.5.1 OVERVIEW
The C30 can be configured for IEC 61850 via the EnerVista UR Setup software as follows.
1.
An ICD file is generated for the C30 by the EnerVista UR Setup software that describe the capabilities of the IED.
2.
The ICD file is then imported into a system configurator along with other ICD files for other IEDs (from GE or other vendors) for system configuration.
3.
The result is saved to a SCD file, which is then imported back to EnerVista UR Setup to create one or more settings
file(s). The settings file(s) can then be used to update the relay(s) with the new configuration information.
GE Multilin
C-11
APPENDIX C
SCL: Substation Configuration Description Language. The configuration language is an application of the Extensible
Markup Language (XML) version 1.0.
SDI: Instantiated Sub DATA; middle name part of a structured DATA name
The following IEC related tools are referenced in the procedures that describe the IED configuration process for IEC 61850:
System configurator or Substation configurator: This is an IED independent system level tool that can import or
export configuration files defined by IEC 61850-6. It can import configuration files (ICD) from several IEDs for system
level engineering and is used to add system information shared by different IEDs. The system configuration generates
a substation related configuration file (SCD) which is fed back to the IED configurator (for example, EnerVista UR
Setup) for system related IED configuration. The system configurator should also be able to read a system specification file (SSD) to use as base for starting system engineering, or to compare it with an engineered system for the same
substation.
IED configurator: This is a vendor specific tool that can directly or indirectly generate an ICD file from the IED (for
example, from a settings file). It can also import a system SCL file (SCD) to set communication configuration parameters (that is, required addresses, reception GOOSE datasets, IDs of incoming GOOSE datasets, etc.) for the IED. The
IED configurator functionality is implemented in the GE Multilin EnerVista UR Setup software.
C.5.2 CONFIGURING IEC 61850 SETTINGS
Before creating an ICD file, the user can customize the IEC 61850 related settings for the IED. For example, the IED name
and logical device instance can be specified to uniquely identify the IED within the substation, or transmission GOOSE
datasets created so that the system configurator can configure the cross-communication links to send GOOSE messages
from the IED. Once the IEC 61850 settings are configured, the ICD creation process will recognize the changes and generate an ICD file that contains the updated settings.
Some of the IED settings will be modified during they system configuration process. For example, a new IP address may be
assigned, line items in a Transmission GOOSE dataset may be added or deleted, or prefixes of some logical nodes may be
changed. While all new configurations will be mapped to the C30 settings file when importing an SCD file, all unchanged
settings will preserve the same values in the new settings file.
These settings can be configured either directly through the relay panel or through the EnerVista UR Setup software (preferred method). The full list of IEC 61850 related settings for are as follows:
Network configuration: IP address, IP subnet mask, and default gateway IP address (access through the Settings >
Product Setup > Communications > Network menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
Server configuration: IED name and logical device instance (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Server Configuration menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
Logical node prefixes, which includes prefixes for all logical nodes except LLN0 (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Logical Node Prefixes menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
C-12
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
MMXU deadbands, which includes deadbands for all available MMXUs. The number of MMXUs is related to the number of CT/VT modules in the relay. There are two MMXUs for each CT/VT module. For example, if a relay contains two
CT/VT modules, there will be four MMXUs available (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > MMXU Deadbands menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
GGIO1 status configuration, which includes the number of status points in GGIO1 as well as the potential internal mappings for each GGIO1 indication. However only the number of status points will be used in the ICD creation process
(access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO1 Status Configuration
menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
GGIO2 control configuration, which includes ctlModels for all SPCSOs within GGIO2 (access through the Settings >
Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO2 Control Configuration menu tree in EnerVista UR
Setup).
Configurable transmission GOOSE, which includes eight configurable datasets that can be used for GOOSE transmission. The GOOSE ID can be specified for each dataset (it must be unique within the IED as well as across the whole
substation), as well as the destination MAC address, VLAN priority, VLAN ID, ETYPE APPID, and the dataset items.
The selection of the dataset item is restricted by firmware version; for version 7.2x, only GGIO1.ST.Indx.stVal and
GGIO1.ST.Indx.q are valid selection (where x is between 1 to N, and N is determined by number of GGIO1 status
points). Although configurable transmission GOOSE can also be created and altered by some third-party system configurators, we recommend configuring transmission GOOSE for GE Multilin IEDs before creating the ICD, and strictly
within EnerVista UR Setup software or the front panel display (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GSSE/GOOSE Configuration > Transmission > Tx Configurable GOOSE menu tree
in EnerVista UR Setup).
Configurable reception GOOSE, which includes eight configurable datasets that can be used for GOOSE reception.
However, unlike datasets for transmission, datasets for reception only contains dataset items, and they are usually created automatically by process of importing the SCD file (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GSSE/GOOSE Configuration > Reception > Rx Configurable GOOSE menu tree in
EnerVista UR Setup).
Remote devices configuration, which includes remote device ID (GOOSE ID or GoID of the incoming transmission
GOOSE dataset), ETYPE APPID (of the GSE communication block for the incoming transmission GOOSE), and
DATASET (which is the name of the associated reception GOOSE dataset). These settings are usually done automatically by process of importing SCD file (access through the Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Remote Devices menu tree
in EnerVista UR Setup).
Remote inputs configuration, which includes device (remote device ID) and item (which dataset item in the associated
reception GOOSE dataset to map) values. Only the items with cross-communication link created in SCD file should be
mapped. These configurations are usually done automatically by process of importing SCD file (access through the
Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Remote Inputs menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
C.5.3 ABOUT ICD FILES
The SCL language is based on XML, and its syntax definition is described as a W3C XML Schema. ICD is one type of SCL
file (which also includes SSD, CID and SCD files). The ICD file describes the capabilities of an IED and consists of four
major sections:
Header
Communication
IEDs
DataTypeTemplates
GE Multilin
C-13
APPENDIX C
Communication
DataTypeTemplates
842795A1.CDR
The Header node identifies the ICD file and its version, and specifies options for the mapping of names to signals
The Communication node describes the direct communication connection possibilities between logical nodes by means of
logical buses (sub-networks) and IED access ports. The communication section is structured as follows.
Communication
SubNetwork (name)
ConnectedAP (iedName, apName)
Address
P (type)
Text
Other P elements
Other P elements
C-14
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
GetDataSetValue
ReadWrite
ConfLogControl (max)
GetDirectory
SetDataSetValue
TimerActivatedControl
GSEDir
GetDateObjectDefinition
DataSetDirectory
ConfReportControl (max)
GOOSE (max)
DataObjectDirectory
GetCBValues
GSSE (max)
AccessPoint (name)
Server
Authentication (none)
LDevice (inst)
LN0 (InType, InClass, inst)
DataSet (name)
FCDA (fc, doName, daName, IdInst, prefix, InClass, InInst)
Other FCDA elements
Other DataSet elements
ReportControl (name, datSet, intgPd, rptID, confRev, buffered)
TrgOps (dchg)
RptEnabled
OptFields (seqNum)
DOI (name)
SDI (name)
DAI (name)
Val
Text
SDI (name)
DAI (name)
Val
Text
OptFields (seqNum)
RptEnabled
DAI (name)
Val
Text
SDI (name)
DAI (name)
Val
Text
Other LN elements
842797A1.CDR
GE Multilin
C-15
APPENDIX C
The DataTypeTemplates node defines instantiable logical node types. A logical node type is an instantiable template of the
data of a logical node. A LnodeType is referenced each time that this instantiable type is needed with an IED. A logical
node type template is built from DATA (DO) elements, which again have a DO type, which is derived from the DATA classes
(CDC). DOs consist of attributes (DA) or of elements of already defined DO types (SDO). The attribute (DA) has a functional constraint, and can either have a basic type, be an enumeration, or a structure of a DAType. The DAType is built from
BDA elements, defining the structure elements, which again can be BDA elements of have a base type such as DA.
DataTypeTemplates
LNodeType (id, InClass)
DO (name, type)
Other DO elements
Other DA elements
Val
Text
DAType (id)
BDA (name, bType, type)
Other BDA elements
Other DAType elements
EnumType (id)
EnumVal (ord)
Text
C-16
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
An ICD file can be created directly from a connected C30 IED or from an offline C30 settings file with the EnerVista UR
Setup software using the following procedure:
1.
Right-click the connected UR-series relay or settings file and select Create ICD File.
2.
The EnerVista UR Setup will prompt to save the file. Select the file path and enter the name for the ICD file, then click
OK to generate the file.
The time to create an ICD file from the offline C30 settings file is typically much quicker than create an ICD file directly from
the relay.
C.5.5 ABOUT SCD FILES
System configuration is performed in the system configurator. While many vendors (including GE Multilin) are working their
own system configuration tools, there are some system configurators available in the market (for example, Siemens DIGSI
version 4.6 or above and ASE Visual SCL Beta 0.12).
Although the configuration tools vary from one vendor to another, the procedure is pretty much the same. First, a substation
project must be created, either as an empty template or with some system information by importing a system specification
file (SSD). Then, IEDs are added to the substation. Since each IED is represented by its associated ICD, the ICD files are
imported into the substation project, and the system configurator validates the ICD files during the importing process. If the
ICD files are successfully imported into the substation project, it may be necessary to perform some additional minor steps
to attach the IEDs to the substation (see the system configurator manual for details).
Once all IEDs are inserted into the substation, further configuration is possible, such as:
Creating cross-communication links (configuring GOOSE messages to send from one IED to others).
When system configurations are complete, the results are saved to an SCD file, which contains not only the configuration
for each IED in the substation, but also the system configuration for the entire substation. Finally, the SCD file is passed
back to the IED configurator (vendor specific tool) to update the new configuration into the IED.
The SCD file consists of at least five major sections:
GE Multilin
C-17
Header.
Substation.
Communication.
DataTypeTemplates.
APPENDIX C
Substation
Communication
DataTypeTemplates
842791A1.CDR
Power Transformer
GeneralEquipment
EquipmentContainer
VoltageLevel
Bay
Voltage
PowerSystemResource
Function
SubFunction
GeneralEquipment
842792A1.CDR
C-18
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
The Communication node describes the direct communication connection possibilities between logical nodes by means of
logical buses (sub-networks) and IED access ports. The communication section is structured as follows.
Communication
SubNetwork (name)
ConnectedAP (IED 1)
Address
P (type)
Text
Other P elements
Address
P (type)
Text
Other GSE elements
Other P elements
GE Multilin
C-19
APPENDIX C
DataSet elements
ReportControl elements
DOI elements
Inputs
GSEControl elements
842794A1.CDR
Right-click anywhere in the files panel and select the Import Contents From SCD File item.
2.
C-20
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
3.
The software will open the SCD file and then prompt the user to save a UR-series settings file. Select a location and
name for the URS (UR-series relay settings) file.
If there is more than one GE Multilin IED defined in the SCD file, the software prompt the user to save a UR-series settings file for each IED.
4.
After the URS file is created, modify any settings (if required).
5.
To update the relay with the new settings, right-click on the settings file in the settings tree and select the Write Settings File to Device item.
6.
The software will prompt for the target device. Select the target device from the list provided and click Send. The new
settings will be updated to the selected device.
GE Multilin
C-21
APPENDIX C
C.6ACSI CONFORMANCE
SERVICES
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR-FAMILY
Yes
CLIENT-SERVER ROLES
B11
c1
B12
---
SCSMS SUPPORTED
B21
B22
B23
B24
SCSM: other
Yes
Publisher side
Yes
B32
Subscriber side
---
Yes
Publisher side
B42
Subscriber side
---
NOTE
c1: shall be "M" if support for LOGICAL-DEVICE model has been declared
O: Optional
M: Mandatory
C.6.2 ACSI MODELS CONFORMANCE STATEMENT
SERVICES
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR-FAMILY
Logical device
c2
Yes
M2
Logical node
c3
Yes
M3
Data
c4
Yes
M4
Data set
c5
Yes
M5
Substitution
M6
REPORTING
M7
M7-1
sequence-number
M7-2
report-time-stamp
M7-3
reason-for-inclusion
M7-4
data-set-name
M7-5
data-reference
M7-6
buffer-overflow
M7-7
entryID
M7-8
BufTm
M7-9
IntgPd
M7-10
GI
M8
M8-1
sequence-number
M8-2
report-time-stamp
M8-3
reason-for-inclusion
C-22
Yes
Yes
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
SERVICES
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
M8-4
UR-FAMILY
data-set-name
M8-5
data-reference
M8-6
BufTm
M8-7
IntgPd
M8-8
GI
Logging
M9
Log control
M9-1
IntgPd
M10
Log
M11
Control
Yes
Yes
Yes
entryID
M12-2
DataReflnc
M13
GSSE
Multicast SVC
M15
Unicast SVC
M16
Time
Yes
M17
File transfer
Yes
NOTE
c2: shall be "M" if support for LOGICAL-NODE model has been declared
c3: shall be "M" if support for DATA model has been declared
c4: shall be "M" if support for DATA-SET, Substitution, Report, Log Control, or Time models has been declared
c5: shall be "M" if support for Report, GSE, or SMV models has been declared
M: Mandatory
C.6.3 ACSI SERVICES CONFORMANCE STATEMENT
In the table below, the acronym AA refers to Application Associations (TP: Two Party / MC: Multicast). The c6 to c10 entries
are defined in the notes following the table.
SERVICES
AA: TP/MC
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR FAMILY
TP
Yes
SERVER (CLAUSE 7)
S1
ServerDirectory
Associate
TP
Yes
S3
Abort
TP
Yes
S4
Release
TP
Yes
TP
Yes
LogicalDeviceDirectory
LogicalNodeDirectory
TP
Yes
S7
GetAllDataValues
TP
Yes
Yes
Yes
GetDataValues
TP
S9
SetDataValues
TP
S10
GetDataDirectory
TP
Yes
S11
GetDataDefinition
TP
Yes
GE Multilin
C-23
APPENDIX C
SERVICES
AA: TP/MC
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR FAMILY
Yes
GetDataSetValues
TP
S13
SetDataSetValues
TP
S14
CreateDataSet
TP
S15
DeleteDataSet
TP
S16
GetDataSetDirectory
TP
O
O
Yes
S18
SelectActiveSG
TP
S19
SelectEditSG
TP
S20
SetSGValues
TP
S21
ConfirmEditSGValues
TP
S22
GetSGValues
TP
S23
GetSGCBValues
TP
Report
S24-1
data-change (dchg)
S24-2
qchg-change (qchg)
S24-3
data-update (dupd)
TP
c6
Yes
Yes
S25
GetBRCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
S26
SetBRCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
S27
Report
c6
Yes
data-change (dchg)
S27-2
qchg-change (qchg)
S27-3
TP
Yes
data-update (dupd)
S28
GetURCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
S29
SetURCBValues
TP
c6
Yes
GetLCBValues
TP
S31
SetLCBValues
TP
LOG
S32
QueryLogByTime
TP
S33
QueryLogByEntry
TP
S34
GetLogStatusValues
TP
SendGOOSEMessage
MC
c8
Yes
S36
GetReference
TP
c9
S37
GetGOOSEElementNumber
TP
c9
S38
GetGoCBValues
TP
Yes
S39
SetGoCBValues
TP
Yes
S40
SendGSSEMessage
MC
c8
Yes
S41
GetReference
TP
c9
S42
GetGSSEElementNumber
TP
c9
S43
GetGsCBValues
TP
GSSE-CONTROL-BLOCK (ANNEX C)
C-24
Yes
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
SERVICES
S44
SetGsCBValues
SERVER/
PUBLISHER
UR FAMILY
TP
Yes
SendMSVMessage
MC
c10
S46
GetMSVCBValues
TP
S47
SetMSVCBValues
TP
O
c10
UNICAST SVC
S48
SendUSVMessage
MC
S49
GetUSVCBValues
TP
S50
SetUSVCBValues
TP
Select
S52
SelectWithValue
TP
Yes
S53
Cancel
TP
Yes
S54
Operate
TP
Yes
S55
Command-Termination
TP
S56
TimeActivated-Operate
TP
GetFile
TP
S58
SetFile
TP
S59
DeleteFile
TP
S60
GetFileAttributeValues
TP
Yes
Yes
20
T2
SNTP, IRIG-B
T3
NOTE
20
GE Multilin
C-25
APPENDIX C
C.7LOGICAL NODES
The UR-series of relays supports IEC 61850 logical nodes as indicated in the following table. Note that the actual instantiation of each logical node is determined by the product order code. For example. the logical node PDIS (distance protection) is available only in the D60 Line Distance Relay.
Table C1: IEC 61850 LOGICAL NODES (Sheet 1 of 4)
NODES
UR-FAMILY
Yes
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
CILO: Interlocking
---
---
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
C-26
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
UR-FAMILY
---
---
KFIL: Filter
---
KPMP: Pump
---
KTNK: Tank
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
MMDC: DC measurement
---
---
MMTN: Metering
---
MMTR: Metering
---
Yes
MMXU: Measurement
Yes
Yes
---
Yes
---
PDIS: Distance
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
PTOF: Overfrequency
---
PTOV: Overvoltage
Yes
Yes
---
PTUC: Undercurrent
---
PTUF: Underfrequency
---
PTUV: Undervoltage
GE Multilin
Yes
C-27
APPENDIX C
UR-FAMILY
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
---
Yes
RREC: Autoreclosing
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
TDST: Distance
---
---
TFRQ: Frequency
---
---
THUM: Humidity
---
---
---
---
C-28
GE Multilin
APPENDIX C
UR-FAMILY
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Yes
Yes
---
---
---
---
---
ZBAT: Battery
---
ZBSH: Bushing
---
---
---
ZCON: Converter
---
ZGEN: Generator
---
---
---
ZMOT: Motor
---
ZREA: Reactor
---
ZRES: Resistor
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
GE Multilin
C-29
APPENDIX C
C-30
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
D.1.1 OVERVIEW
IEC 60870-5-103 is defined as a companion standard for the informative element of the protection equipment. IEC 608705-103 defines communication for a serial, unbalanced link only. Communication speeds are defined as either 9600 or
19200 baud.
This manual assumes basic knowledge of the IEC 60870-5-103 protocol and the standard IEC 60870 documents relating to
the protocol.
Standard IEC 60870 documents relating to IEC 60870-5-103:
An IEC 60870-5-103 device is required to provide an interoperability table. Interoperability means that any required application data in the device, which can be coded into an IEC 60870-5-103 data type, can be mapped into the IEC 60870-5-103
address space. This data is recognized by any IEC 60870-5-103 master.
D.1.2 FACTOR AND OFFSET CALCULATION TO TRANSMIT MEASURAND
The general formula for the transmitted value is Xt = a * X + b
where X is the measurand, a is the multiplication factor, b is the offset and Xt is the value transmitted.
The conditions for determining a and b, when the values exceed the range are:
4096 = a*Xmax + b (Xmax is the maximum value for the measurand)
-4095 =a*Xmin + b (Xmin is the minimum value for the measurand)
By solving the above system of equations for a and b, we find that:
a = 8191 / (Xmax - Xmin)
b = -4096 * (Xmax + Xmin) / (Xmax - Xmin)
So
Xt = 8191/(Xmax - Xmin)) * X - 4096 * (Xmax + Xmin) / (Xmax - Xmin)
We may further simplify the above formula for situations where:
1)
Xmin = -Xmax (positive and negative values) :
Xt = (8191/2*Xmax) * X
a = 4096/Xmax
b=0
2)
If Xmin = 0 (only positive values)
Xt = (8191/Xmax) * X - 4096
a = 2 * 4096/Xmax
b = -4096
To calculate Xmax, one needs to know the rated value for the specific type of measurand.
Xmax = 2.4 * Xrated
GE Multilin
D-1
APPENDIX D
D.1.3 INTEROPERABILITY DOCUMENT
The boxes indicate the following: used in standard direction; not used.
1.
PHYSICAL LAYER
Electrical interface
EIA RS-485
32 Number of loads for one protection equipment
Optical interface
Glass fibre
Plastic fibre
F-SMA type connector
BFOC/2.5 type connector
Transmission speed
9600 bits/s
19200 bits/s
2.
LINK LAYER
3.
APPLICATION LAYER
D-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
GE Multilin
D-3
APPENDIX D
D-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX D
OR
2,4
Current L1
Current L2
Current L3
Voltage L1-E
Voltage L2-E
GE Multilin
D-5
APPENDIX D
MEASURAND
Voltage L3-E
Active power P
Reactive power Q
Frequency f
Voltage L1-L2
1,2
OR
2,4
D-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
This document is adapted from the IEC 60870-5-104 standard. For this section the boxes indicate the following: used
in standard direction; not used; cannot be selected in IEC 60870-5-104 standard.
1.
SYSTEM OR DEVICE:
System Definition
Controlling Station Definition (Master)
Controlled Station Definition (Slave)
2.
3.
NETWORK CONFIGURATION:
Point-to-Point
Multipoint
Multiple Point-to-Point
Multipoint Star
PHYSICAL LAYER
Transmission Speed (control direction):
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Standard:
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Recommended
if >1200 bits/s:
100 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
200 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
300 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
600 bits/sec.
19200 bits/sec.
1200 bits/sec.
38400 bits/sec.
56000 bits/sec.
64000 bits/sec.
Transmission Speed (monitor direction):
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Standard:
Unbalanced Interchange
Circuit V.24/V.28 Recommended
if >1200 bits/s:
100 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
2400 bits/sec.
200 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
4800 bits/sec.
300 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
9600 bits/sec.
600 bits/sec.
19200 bits/sec.
1200 bits/sec.
38400 bits/sec.
56000 bits/sec.
64000 bits/sec.
4.
LINK LAYER
Balanced Transmission
Unbalanced Transmission
One Octet
Two Octets
Structured
Unstructured
Frame Length (maximum length, number of octets): Not selectable in companion IEC 60870-5-104 standard
GE Multilin
E-1
APPENDIX E
When using an unbalanced link layer, the following ADSU types are returned in class 2 messages (low priority) with the
indicated causes of transmission:
The standard assignment of ADSUs to class 2 messages is used as follows:
A special assignment of ADSUs to class 2 messages is used as follows:
5.
APPLICATION LAYER
Transmission Mode for Application Data:
Mode 1 (least significant octet first), as defined in Clause 4.10 of IEC 60870-5-4, is used exclusively in this companion
standard.
Common Address of ADSU:
One Octet
Two Octets
Information Object Address:
One Octet
Structured
Two Octets
Unstructured
Three Octets
Cause of Transmission:
One Octet
Two Octets (with originator address). Originator address is set to zero if not used.
Maximum Length of APDU: 253 (the maximum length may be reduced by the system.
Selection of standard ASDUs:
For the following lists, the boxes indicate the following: used in standard direction; not used; cannot be
selected in IEC 60870-5-104 standard.
Process information in monitor direction
E-2
M_SP_NA_1
M_SP_TA_1
M_DP_NA_1
M_DP_TA_1
M_ST_NA_1
M_ST_TA_1
M_BO_NA_1
M_BO_TA_1
M_ME_NA_1
M_NE_TA_1
M_ME_NB_1
M_NE_TB_1
M_ME_NC_1
<14> := Measured value, short floating point value with time tag
M_NE_TC_1
M_IT_NA_1
M_IT_TA_1
M_EP_TA_1
M_EP_TB_1
<19> := Packed output circuit information of protection equipment with time tag
M_EP_TC_1
M_SP_NA_1
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
M_ME_ND_1
M_SP_TB_1
M_DP_TB_1
M_ST_TB_1
M_BO_TB_1
M_ME_TD_1
M_ME_TE_1
<36> := Measured value, short floating point value with time tag CP56Time2a
M_ME_TF_1
M_IT_TB_1
M_EP_TD_1
<39> := Packed start events of protection equipment with time tag CP56Time2a
M_EP_TE_1
<40> := Packed output circuit information of protection equipment with time tag CP56Time2a
M_EP_TF_1
Either the ASDUs of the set <2>, <4>, <6>, <8>, <10>, <12>, <14>, <16>, <17>, <18>, and <19> or of the set
<30> to <40> are used.
Process information in control direction
<45> := Single command
C_SC_NA_1
C_DC_NA_1
C_RC_NA_1
C_SE_NA_1
C_SE_NB_1
C_SE_NC_1
C_BO_NA_1
C_SC_TA_1
C_DC_TA_1
C_RC_TA_1
<61> := Set point command, normalized value with time tag CP56Time2a
C_SE_TA_1
<62> := Set point command, scaled value with time tag CP56Time2a
C_SE_TB_1
<63> := Set point command, short floating point value with time tag CP56Time2a
C_SE_TC_1
C_BO_TA_1
Either the ASDUs of the set <45> to <51> or of the set <58> to <64> are used.
System information in monitor direction
<70> := End of initialization
M_EI_NA_1
C_IC_NA_1
C_CI_NA_1
C_RD_NA_1
C_CS_NA_1
C_TS_NA_1
C_RP_NA_1
C_CD_NA_1
C_TS_TA_1
GE Multilin
E-3
APPENDIX E
PE_ME_NA_1
PE_ME_NB_1
PE_ME_NC_1
PE_AC_NA_1
File transfer
<120> := File Ready
F_FR_NA_1
F_SR_NA_1
F_SC_NA_1
F_LS_NA_1
F_AF_NA_1
<125> := Segment
F_SG_NA_1
C_CD_NA_1
E-4
M_DP_TA_1
<5>
M_ST_NA_1
<6>
M_ST_TA_1
<7>
M_BO_NA_1
<8>
M_BO_TA_1
<9>
M_ME_NA_1
FILE TRANSFER
10
11
12
13
20
to
36
37
to
41
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
DEACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
DEACTIVATION
M_DP_NA_1
<4>
ACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
<3>
ACTIVATION
M_SP_TA_1
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
M_SP_NA_1
<2>
INITIALIZED
<1>
SPONTANEOUS
MNEMONIC
BACKGROUND SCAN
NO.
CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
TYPE IDENTIFICATION
44
45
46
47
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
<10>
M_ME_TA_1
<11>
M_ME_NB_1
<12>
M_ME_TB_1
<13>
M_ME_NC_1
<14>
M_ME_TC_1
<15>
M_IT_NA_1
<16>
M_IT_TA_1
<17>
M_EP_TA_1
<18>
M_EP_TB_1
<19>
M_EP_TC_1
<20>
M_PS_NA_1
<21>
M_ME_ND_1
<30>
M_SP_TB_1
<31>
M_DP_TB_1
<32>
M_ST_TB_1
<33>
M_BO_TB_1
<34>
M_ME_TD_1
<35>
M_ME_TE_1
<36>
M_ME_TF_1
<37>
M_IT_TB_1
<38>
M_EP_TD_1
<39>
M_EP_TE_1
<40>
M_EP_TF_1
<45>
C_SC_NA_1
<46>
C_DC_NA_1
<47>
C_RC_NA_1
<48>
C_SE_NA_1
<49>
C_SE_NB_1
<50>
C_SE_NC_1
<51>
C_BO_NA_1
<58>
C_SC_TA_1
<59>
C_DC_TA_1
<60>
C_RC_TA_1
GE Multilin
ACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
DEACTIVATION
DEACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
FILE TRANSFER
10
11
12
13
20
to
36
37
to
41
ACTIVATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
INITIALIZED
SPONTANEOUS
MNEMONIC
BACKGROUND SCAN
NO.
CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
TYPE IDENTIFICATION
44
45
46
47
E-5
APPENDIX E
6.
<61>
C_SE_TA_1
<62>
C_SE_TB_1
<63>
C_SE_TC_1
ACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
DEACTIVATION
DEACTIVATION CONFIRMATION
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
FILE TRANSFER
10
11
12
13
20
to
36
37
to
41
<64>
C_BO_TA_1
<70>
M_EI_NA_1*)
<100>
C_IC_NA_1
<101>
C_CI_NA_1
<102>
C_RD_NA_1
<103>
C_CS_NA_1
<104>
C_TS_NA_1
<105>
C_RP_NA_1
<106>
C_CD_NA_1
<107>
C_TS_TA_1
<110>
P_ME_NA_1
<111>
P_ME_NB_1
<112>
P_ME_NC_1
<113>
P_AC_NA_1
<120>
F_FR_NA_1
<121>
F_SR_NA_1
<122>
F_SC_NA_1
<123>
F_LS_NA_1
<124>
F_AF_NA_1
<125>
F_SG_NA_1
<126>
F_DR_TA_1*)
ACTIVATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
INITIALIZED
SPONTANEOUS
MNEMONIC
BACKGROUND SCAN
NO.
CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
TYPE IDENTIFICATION
44
45
46
47
X
X
X
X
X
X
E-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
Spontaneous Transmission:
Spontaneous transmission
Double transmission of information objects with cause of transmission spontaneous:
The following type identifications may be transmitted in succession caused by a single status change of an information
object. The particular information object addresses for which double transmission is enabled are defined in a projectspecific list.
Single point information: M_SP_NA_1, M_SP_TA_1, M_SP_TB_1, and M_PS_NA_1
Double point information: M_DP_NA_1, M_DP_TA_1, and M_DP_TB_1
Step position information: M_ST_NA_1, M_ST_TA_1, and M_ST_TB_1
Bitstring of 32 bits: M_BO_NA_1, M_BO_TA_1, and M_BO_TB_1 (if defined for a specific project)
Measured value, normalized value: M_ME_NA_1, M_ME_TA_1, M_ME_ND_1, and M_ME_TD_1
Measured value, scaled value: M_ME_NB_1, M_ME_TB_1, and M_ME_TE_1
Measured value, short floating point number: M_ME_NC_1, M_ME_TC_1, and M_ME_TF_1
Station interrogation:
Global
Group 1
Group 5
Group 9
Group 13
Group 2
Group 6
Group 10
Group 14
Group 3
Group 7
Group 11
Group 15
Group 4
Group 8
Group 12
Group 16
Clock synchronization:
Clock synchronization (optional, see Clause 7.6)
Command transmission:
Direct command transmission
Direct setpoint command transmission
Select and execute command
Select and execute setpoint command
C_SE ACTTERM used
No additional definition
Short pulse duration (duration determined by a system parameter in the outstation)
Long pulse duration (duration determined by a system parameter in the outstation)
Persistent output
Supervision of maximum delay in command direction of commands and setpoint commands
Maximum allowable delay of commands and setpoint commands: 10 s
Transmission of integrated totals:
Mode A: Local freeze with spontaneous transmission
Mode B: Local freeze with counter interrogation
Mode C: Freeze and transmit by counter-interrogation commands
Mode D: Freeze by counter-interrogation command, frozen values reported simultaneously
Counter read
Counter freeze without reset
GE Multilin
E-7
APPENDIX E
DEFAULT
VALUE
REMARKS
SELECTED
VALUE
t0
30 s
120 s
t1
15 s
15 s
t2
10 s
10 s
t3
20 s
20 s
E-8
PARAMETER
DEFAULT
VALUE
REMARKS
SELECTED
VALUE
12 APDUs
12 APDUs
8 APDUs
8 APDUs
GE Multilin
APPENDIX E
Portnumber:
PARAMETER
VALUE
REMARKS
Portnumber
2404
In all cases
GE Multilin
E-9
APPENDIX E
E-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
The following table provides a Device Profile Document in the standard format defined in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions
Document.
Table F1: DNP V3.00 DEVICE PROFILE (Sheet 1 of 3)
(Also see the IMPLEMENTATION TABLE in the following section)
Vendor Name: General Electric Multilin
Device Name: UR Series Relay
Highest DNP Level Supported:
Device Function:
For Requests:
Level 2
For Responses: Level 2
Master
Slave
Notable objects, functions, and/or qualifiers supported in addition to the Highest DNP Levels Supported (the complete
list is described in the attached table):
Binary Inputs (Object 1)
Binary Input Changes (Object 2)
Binary Outputs (Object 10)
Control Relay Output Block (Object 12)
Binary Counters (Object 20)
Frozen Counters (Object 21)
Counter Change Event (Object 22)
Frozen Counter Event (Object 23)
Analog Inputs (Object 30)
Never
Always
Sometimes
Configurable
GE Multilin
F-1
APPENDIX F
Never
Always
When reporting Event Data
When sending multi-fragment responses
Sometimes
Configurable
None
None
None
None
Fixed at ____
Fixed at ____
Fixed at 10 s
Fixed at ____
Variable
Variable
Variable
Variable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Others:
Transmission Delay:
Need Time Interval:
Select/Operate Arm Timeout:
Binary input change scanning period:
Analog input change scanning period:
Counter change scanning period:
Frozen counter event scanning period:
Unsolicited response notification delay:
Unsolicited response retry delay
No intentional delay
Configurable (default = 24 hrs.)
10 s
8 times per power system cycle
500 ms
500 ms
500 ms
100 ms
configurable 0 to 60 sec.
Queue
Clear Queue
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Never
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Always
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Sometimes
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Configurable
Explanation of Sometimes: Object 12 points are mapped to UR Virtual Inputs. The persistence of Virtual Inputs is
determined by the VIRTUAL INPUT X TYPE settings. Both Pulse On and Latch On operations perform the same function in the UR; that is, the appropriate Virtual Input is put into the On state. If the Virtual Input is set to Self-Reset,
it will reset after one pass of FlexLogic. The On/Off times and Count value are ignored. Pulse Off and Latch Off
operations put the appropriate Virtual Input into the Off state. Trip and Close operations both put the appropriate
Virtual Input into the On state.
F-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
Never
Only time-tagged
Only non-time-tagged
Configurable
Never
Configurable
Only certain objects
Sometimes (attach explanation)
ENABLE/DISABLE unsolicited Function
codes supported
Never
Binary Input Change With Time
Binary Input Change With Relative Time
Configurable (attach explanation)
No Counters Reported
Configurable (attach explanation)
16 Bits (Counter 8)
32 Bits (Counters 0 to 7, 9)
Other Value: _____
Point-by-point list attached
GE Multilin
F-3
APPENDIX F
F.1.2 IMPLEMENTATION TABLE
The following table identifies the variations, function codes, and qualifiers supported by the C30 in both request messages
and in response messages. For static (non-change-event) objects, requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be
responded with qualifiers 00 or 01. Static object requests sent with qualifiers 17 or 28 will be responded with qualifiers 17 or
28. For change-event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.
Table F2: IMPLEMENTATION TABLE (Sheet 1 of 4)
OBJECT
OBJECT VARIATION DESCRIPTION
NO.
NO.
1
0
Binary Input (Variation 0 is used to request
default variation)
10
F
12
20
Note 1:
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
Binary Input
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
0
1
1 (read)
1 (read)
1 (read)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
00, 01(start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
RESPONSE
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
129 (response
130 (unsol. resp.)
17, 28 (index)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
129 (response)
echo of request
3 (select)
4 (operate)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
0
Binary Counter
1 (read)
00, 01(start-stop)
7 (freeze)
06(no range, or all)
(Variation 0 is used to request default
8 (freeze noack)
07, 08(limited quantity)
variation)
9 (freeze clear)
17, 28(index)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1
32-Bit Binary Counter
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
7 (freeze)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
8 (freeze noack)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
9 (freeze clear)
17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
A default variation refers to the variation responded when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default variations for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. See the Communications section in Chapter 5 for
details. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
1
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the C30 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
F-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
21
22
23
Note 1:
Frozen Counter
(Variation 0 is used to request default
variation)
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
7 (freeze)
8 (freeze noack)
9 (freeze clear)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
7 (freeze)
8 (freeze noack)
9 (freeze clear)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
7 (freeze)
8 (freeze noack)
9 (freeze clear)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
RESPONSE
QUALIFIER
FUNCTION
CODES (HEX)
CODES (DEC)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
1
32-Bit Frozen Counter
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
2
16-Bit Frozen Counter
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
9
32-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
10
16-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
0
Counter Change Event (Variation 0 is used 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
to request default variation)
1
32-Bit Counter Change Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
2
16-Bit Counter Change Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
5
32-Bit Counter Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
6
16-Bit Counter Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
0
Frozen Counter Event (Variation 0 is used 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
to request default variation)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
1
32-Bit Frozen Counter Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
2
16-Bit Frozen Counter Event
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
A default variation refers to the variation responded when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default variations for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. See the Communications section in Chapter 5 for
details. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the C30 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
GE Multilin
F-5
APPENDIX F
32
34
Note 1:
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
RESPONSE
QUALIFIER
FUNCTION
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
CODES (DEC) CODES (HEX)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
0
Analog Input (Variation 0 is used to request 1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
default variation)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
1
32-Bit Analog Input
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
2
16-Bit Analog Input
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
3
32-Bit Analog Input without Flag
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
4
16-Bit Analog Input without Flag
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
5
short floating point
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
06(no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08(limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28(index)
0
Analog Change Event (Variation 0 is used 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
to request default variation)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
1
32-Bit Analog Change Event without Time 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
2
16-Bit Analog Change Event without Time 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
3
32-Bit Analog Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
4
16-Bit Analog Change Event with Time
1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
5
short floating point Analog Change Event 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
without Time
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
7
short floating point Analog Change Event 1 (read)
06 (no range, or all)
129 (response)
17, 28 (index)
with Time
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
0
Analog Input Reporting Deadband
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
(Variation 0 is used to request default
06 (no range, or all)
variation)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
1
16-bit Analog Input Reporting Deadband
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
17, 28 (index)
(default see Note 1)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
(see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
2 (write)
00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
A default variation refers to the variation responded when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default variations for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. See the Communications section in Chapter 5 for
details. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the C30 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
F-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
REQUEST
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
1 (read)
contd
2 (write)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07 (limited qty=1)
08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
50
52
60
Class 0 Data
2
3
4
Class 1 Data
Class 2 Data
Class 3 Data
2
3
File authentication
File command
File transfer
File descriptor
5b (free format)
Internal Indications
1 (read)
00, 01 (start-stop)
1 (read)
2 (write)
RESPONSE
FUNCTION
CODES (DEC)
129 (response)
QUALIFIER
CODES (HEX)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
00, 01 (start-stop)
17, 28 (index)
(see Note 2)
129 (response)
07 (limited quantity)
(quantity = 1)
70
80
1 (read)
20 (enable unsol)
21 (disable unsol)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
20 (enable unsol)
21 (disable unsol)
22 (assign class)
1 (read)
22 (assign class)
29 (authenticate)
25 (open)
27 (delete)
26 (close)
30 (abort)
1 (read)
2 (write)
5b (free format)
5b (free format)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
5b (free format)
5b (free format)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
5b (free format)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
129 (response)
130 (unsol. resp.)
129 (response)
5b (free format)
5b (free format)
00, 01 (start-stop)
(index =7)
------Note 1:
2 (write)
(see Note 3)
13 (cold restart)
00 (start-stop)
(index =7)
Note 2:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for changeevent objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3:
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts the C30 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
GE Multilin
F-7
APPENDIX F
The DNP binary input data points are configured through the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT
LISTS BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS menu. See the Communications section of Chapter 5 for details. When a freeze function is performed on a binary counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding frozen counter point.
BINARY INPUT POINTS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 1
Change Event Object Number: 2
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 22 (assign class)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Input with status), Configurable
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Input Change with Time), Configurable
Change Event Scan Rate: 8 times per power system cycle
Change Event Buffer Size: 500
Default Class for All Points: 1
F-8
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
Supported Control Relay Output Block fields: Pulse On, Pulse Off, Latch On, Latch Off, Paired Trip, Paired Close.
BINARY OUTPUT STATUS POINTS
Object Number: 10
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Default Variation reported when Variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Output Status)
CONTROL RELAY OUTPUT BLOCKS
Object Number: 12
Request Function Codes supported:
NAME/DESCRIPTION
NAME/DESCRIPTION
Virtual Input 1
32
Virtual Input 33
Virtual Input 2
33
Virtual Input 34
Virtual Input 3
34
Virtual Input 35
Virtual Input 4
35
Virtual Input 36
Virtual Input 5
36
Virtual Input 37
Virtual Input 6
37
Virtual Input 38
Virtual Input 7
38
Virtual Input 39
Virtual Input 8
39
Virtual Input 40
Virtual Input 9
40
Virtual Input 41
Virtual Input 10
41
Virtual Input 42
10
Virtual Input 11
42
Virtual Input 43
11
Virtual Input 12
43
Virtual Input 44
12
Virtual Input 13
44
Virtual Input 45
13
Virtual Input 14
45
Virtual Input 46
14
Virtual Input 15
46
Virtual Input 47
15
Virtual Input 16
47
Virtual Input 48
16
Virtual Input 17
48
Virtual Input 49
17
Virtual Input 18
49
Virtual Input 50
18
Virtual Input 19
50
Virtual Input 51
19
Virtual Input 20
51
Virtual Input 52
20
Virtual Input 21
52
Virtual Input 53
21
Virtual Input 22
53
Virtual Input 54
22
Virtual Input 23
54
Virtual Input 55
23
Virtual Input 24
55
Virtual Input 56
24
Virtual Input 25
56
Virtual Input 57
25
Virtual Input 26
57
Virtual Input 58
26
Virtual Input 27
58
Virtual Input 59
27
Virtual Input 28
59
Virtual Input 60
28
Virtual Input 29
60
Virtual Input 61
29
Virtual Input 30
61
Virtual Input 62
30
Virtual Input 31
62
Virtual Input 63
31
Virtual Input 32
63
Virtual Input 64
GE Multilin
F-9
APPENDIX F
F.2.3 COUNTERS
The following table lists both Binary Counters (Object 20) and Frozen Counters (Object 21). When a freeze function is performed on a Binary Counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding Frozen Counter point.
BINARY COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 20
Change Event Object Number: 22
Request Function Codes supported:
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Binary Counter with Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Counter Change Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
FROZEN COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 21
Change Event Object Number: 23
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
NAME/DESCRIPTION
Digital Counter 1
Digital Counter 2
Digital Counter 3
Digital Counter 4
Digital Counter 5
Digital Counter 6
Digital Counter 7
Digital Counter 8
A counter freeze command has no meaning for counters 8 and 9. C30 Digital Counter values are represented as 32-bit
integers. The DNP 3.0 protocol defines counters to be unsigned integers. Care should be taken when interpreting negative
counter values.
F-10
GE Multilin
APPENDIX F
The DNP analog input data points are configured through the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT
LISTS ANALOG INPUT / MME POINTS menu. See the Communications section of Chapter 5 for details.
It is important to note that 16-bit and 32-bit variations of analog inputs are transmitted through DNP as signed numbers.
Even for analog input points that are not valid as negative values, the maximum positive representation is 32767 for 16-bit
values and 2147483647 for 32-bit values. This is a DNP requirement.
The deadbands for all Analog Input points are in the same units as the Analog Input quantity. For example, an Analog Input
quantity measured in volts has a corresponding deadband in units of volts. This is in conformance with DNP Technical Bulletin 9809-001: Analog Input Reporting Deadband. Relay settings are available to set default deadband values according to
data type. Deadbands for individual Analog Input Points can be set using DNP Object 34.
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 30
Change Event Object Number: 32
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 2 (write, deadbands only), 22 (assign class)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Analog Input)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (Analog Change Event without Time)
Change Event Scan Rate: defaults to 500 ms
Change Event Buffer Size: 256
Default Class for all Points: 2
GE Multilin
F-11
APPENDIX F
F-12
GE Multilin
APPENDIX G
The following procedure is an example of how to set up a simple RADIUS server, where the third-party tool used is also an
example.
1.
2.
In the RADIUSD.CONF file, locate the "bind_address" field and enter your RADIUS server IP address.
3.
In the USERS.CONF file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, add the following text to configure a user "Tester"
with an Administrator role.
Tester:
->User-Password == "Testing1!1"
->GE-UR-Role = Administrator
4.
In the CLIENTS.CONF file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, add the following text to define a RADIUS client,
where the client IP address is 10.0.0.2, the subnet mask is 255.255.255.0, the shared secret specified here is also
configured on the UR device for successful authentication, and the shortname is a short, optional alias that can be
used in place of the IP address.
client 10.0.0.2/24 {
secret = testing123
shortname = private-network-1
}
5.
In the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, create a file called dictionary.ge and add the following content.
# ##########################################################
# GE VSAs
############################################################
VENDOR
GE
2910
# Management authorization
BEGIN-VENDOR
GE
# Role ID
ATTRIBUTE
GE-UR-Role
# GE-UR-ROLE values
VALUE GE-UR-Role
VALUE GE-UR-Role
VALUE GE-UR-Role
VALUE GE-UR-Role
VALUE GE-UR-Role
Administrator
Supervisor
Engineer
Operator
Observer
1
2
3
4
5
integer
END-VENDOR
GE
#############################################################
6.
In the dictionary file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, add the following line.
$INCLUDE dictionary.ge
7.
For the first start, run the RADIUS server in debug mode by entering
<Path_to_Radius>/start_radiusd_debug.bat
8.
Set up the RADIUS client on the UR as follows. Access Device > Settings > Product Setup > Security. Configure the
IP address and ports for the RADIUS server. Leave the GE vendor ID field at the default of 2910. Update the RADIUS
shared secret as specified in the CLIENTS.CONF file.
GE Multilin
G-1
APPENDIX G
G-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX H
REVISION
RELEASE DATE
1601-0088-A1
1.5x
19 February 1999
ECO
N/A
1601-0088-A2
1.6x
10 August 1999
URC-003
1601-0088-A3
1.8x
29 October 1999
URC-004
1601-0088-A4
1.8x
15 November 1999
URC-008
1601-0088-A5
2.0x
17 December 1999
URC-009
1601-0088-A6
2.2x
12 May 2000
URC-011
1601-0088-A7
2.2x
14 June 2000
URC-013
1601-0088-A7a
2.2x
28 June 2000
URC-013a
1601-0088-B1
2.4x
08 September 2000
URC-015
1601-0088-B2
2.4x
03 November 2000
URC-017
1601-0088-B3
2.6x
09 March 2001
URC-019
1601-0088-B4
2.8x
26 September 2001
URC-022
1601-0088-B5
2.9x
03 December 2001
URC-024
1601-0088-B6
2.6x
27 February 2004
URX-120
1601-0088-C1
3.0x
02 July 2002
URC-026
1601-0088-C2
3.1x
30 August 2002
URC-028
1601-0088-C3
3.0x
18 November 2002
URC-030
1601-0088-C4
3.1x
18 November 2002
URC-031
1601-0088-C5
3.0x
11 February 2003
URC-034
1601-0088-C6
3.1x
11 February 2003
URC-035
1601-0088-D1
3.2x
11 February 2003
URC-038
1601-0088-D2
3.2x
02 June 2003
URX-084
1601-0088-E1
3.3x
01 May 2003
URX-080
URX-089
1601-0088-E2
3.3x
29 May 2003
1601-0088-F1
3.4x
10 December 2003
URX-111
1601-0088-F2
3.4x
09 February 2004
URX-115
1601-0088-G1
4.0x
23 March 2004
URX-123
1601-0088-G2
4.0x
17 May 2004
URX-136
1601-0088-H1
4.2x
30 June 2004
URX-145
1601-0088-H2
4.2x
23 July 2004
URX-151
1601-0088-J1
4.4x
15 September 2004
URX-156
1601-0088-K1
4.6x
15 February 2005
URX-176
1601-0088-L1
4.8x
05 August 2005
URX-202
1601-0088-M1
4.9x
15 December 2005
URX-208
1601-0088-M2
4.9x
27 February 2006
URX-214
1601-0088-N1
5.0x
31 March 2006
URX-217
1601-0088-N2
5.0x
26 May 2006
URX-220
1601-0088-P1
5.2x
23 October 2006
URX-230
1601-0088-P2
5.2x
24 January 2007
URX-232
1601-0088-R1
5.4x
26 June 2007
URX-242
1601-0088-R2
5.4x
31 August 2007
URX-246
1601-0088-R3
5.4x
17 October 2007
URX-251
1601-0088-S1
5.5x
7 December 2007
URX-253
1601-0088-S2
5.5x
22 February 2008
URX-258
1601-0088-S3
5.5x
12 March 2008
URX-260
GE Multilin
H-1
APPENDIX H
REVISION
RELEASE DATE
ECO
1601-0088-T1
5.6x
27 June 2008
08-0390
1601-0088-U1
5.7x
29 May 2009
09-0938
1601-0088-U2
5.7x
30 September 2009
09-1165
1601-0088-V1
5.8x
29 May 2010
09-1457
1601-0088-V2
5.8x
04 January 2011
11-2237
1601-0088-W1
5.9x
12 January 2011
11-2227
1601-0088-X1
6.0x
21 December 2011
11-2840
1601-0088-X2
6.0x
5 April 2012
12-3254
1601-0088-Y1
7.0x
30 September 2012
12-3529
1601-0088-Y2
7.0x
11 November 2012
12-3601
1601-0088-Z1
7.1x
30 March 2013
13-0126
1601-0088-AA1
7.2x
1 August 2013
13-0401
PAGE
(AA1)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
---
---
Add
2-
2-
Update
2-
2-
Update
Updated specifications
8-
---
Delete
---
8-
Add
Added Maintenance chapter, moving content from other chapters and adding new instructions to
replace the battery
---
D-
Add
PAGE
(Y3)
PAGE
(Z1)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
---
---
Add
Added CPU options U and V to order code tables in chapter 2, a note above Rear Terminal View
figure in chapter 3, and CPU Module Communications Wiring figure in chapter 3
---
---
Add
Added Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) to order code tables and specifications in chapter 2,
section 5.2.5d Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Network, section 6.3.1 Actual
Values > Status > PRP, and Appendix B Modbus table and F627 and F628 enumeration tables
1-1
1-1
Add
1-5
1-5
Update
Revised section 1.3.1 on system requirements, including addition of support for Windows 7 and
Windows Server 2008
2-8
2-8
Update
5-20
5-20
Add
5-78
5-78
Update
Updated Figures 5-21 and 5-22 Dual Breaker Control Scheme Logic, sheets 1 and 2
5-82
5-82
Update
5-124
5-124
Add
Reinserted section 5.7.5c Remote Devices: ID of Device for Receiving GSSE/GOOSE Messages,
meaning the Settings > Input/Outputs > Remote Devices settings
H-2
GE Multilin
APPENDIX H
PAGE
(Y3)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
--
ix
Add
PAGE
(Y2)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
All
All
Update
All
All
Delete
1-1
1-1
Update
3-8
3-8
Update
PAGE
(Y1)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
All
All
Delete
Title
Title
Update
1-1
1-1
Update
2-
2-
Add
2-
2-
Delete
Deleted E, G, H, J, S from CPU options from order code tables. Deleted 9S, 2S, 2T from
replacement module order code tables.
3-10
3-10
Update
2-12
2-12
Update
3-21
3-21
Update
Deleted references to COM 1 RS485 port in section 3.2.8 CPU Communication Ports. Revised
text and Figure 3-22 CPU Module Communications Wiring to include only modules T, U, V in
section 3.2.8a.
5-1
5-1
Update
Updated the front panel main menu to include the CyberSentry security menu
5-11
5-11
Update
5-11
5-11
Delete
5-12
5-12
Add
5-12
5-12
Update
5-12
5-12
Update
5-36
5-
Delete
Deleted Local Time Offset, Daylight Savings Time, DST (start/stop for month/day/hour) from Real
Time Clock menu
5-
5-35
Add
Added submenus Precision Time Protocol, SNTP Protocol, and Local Time and Synchronizing
Source settings to Real Time Clock menu
5-
5-35
Add
Added new Precision Time Protocol (1588) menu and setting descriptions
5-
5-
Update
Changed Communication to Real Time Clock in SNTP protocol settings path. Moved SNTP
Protocol menu and settings descriptions to Real Time Clock subsection
5-33
5-
Delete
5-
5-39
Add
Added new section for Local Time menu settings and settings description
5-
5-46
Add
Added new PTP Fail menu item to the User-Programmable Self Tests menu
5-
5-
Add
5-
5-90
Update
5-117
5-117
Delete
Deleted section 5.7.5c Remote Devices: ID of Device for Receiving GSSE/GOOSE Messages,
meaning the Settings > Input/Outputs > Remote Devices settings
5-
5-134
Add
Added new CyberSentry security section and main menu, local passwords, session settings,
restore defaults, and supervisory subsections to Chapter 5
6-1
6-1
Update
Update Actual Values main menu to include Real Time Clock Synchronization submenu
GE Multilin
H-3
APPENDIX H
PAGE
(Y1)
CHANGE
DESCRIPTION
6-
6-7
Add
Added new section for Real Time Clock synchronizing consisting of the menu of settings and the
setting descriptions
6-10
6-10
Delete
6-
6-11
Add
7-
7-1
Add
7-
7-3
Add
Added Reboot Relay command and description to the Relay Maintenance menu items
7-
7-5
Add
Added Security menu and submenu commands and descriptions to the Command menu
7-
7-9
Add
8-
8-4
Add
Added new section for CyberSentry software option with overview and security menu subsections
A-
A-
Add
Added FlexAnalog item PTPIRIG-B Delta to Table A-1: FlexAnalog Data Items
B-8
B-8
Update
Updated Modbus memory map table to include port 0 for Modbus slave address, TCP, DNP,
HTTP, TFTP, MMS, and removed references to COM 1 RS485 port
C-23
C-23
Update
Updated tables in sections C.6.3 ACSI Services Conformance Statement and C.7.1 Logical
Nodes Table
H-4
GE Multilin
APPENDIX H
H.2 ABBREVIATIONS
H.2ABBREVIATIONS
A..................... Ampere
AC .................. Alternating Current
A/D ................. Analog to Digital
AE .................. Accidental Energization, Application Entity
AMP ............... Ampere
ANG ............... Angle
ANSI............... American National Standards Institute
AR .................. Automatic Reclosure
ASDU ............. Application-layer Service Data Unit
ASYM ............. Asymmetry
AUTO ............. Automatic
AUX................ Auxiliary
AVG................ Average
FO...................Fiber Optic
FREQ..............Frequency
FSK.................Frequency-Shift Keying
FTP .................File Transfer Protocol
FxE .................FlexElement
FWD................Forward
CAP................ Capacitor
CC .................. Coupling Capacitor
CCVT ............. Coupling Capacitor Voltage Transformer
CFG................ Configure / Configurable
.CFG............... Filename extension for oscillography files
CHK................ Check
CHNL ............. Channel
CLS ................ Close
CLSD.............. Closed
CMND ............ Command
CMPRSN........ Comparison
CO.................. Contact Output
COM............... Communication
COMM............ Communications
COMP ............ Compensated, Comparison
CONN............. Connection
CONT ............. Continuous, Contact
CO-ORD......... Coordination
CPU................ Central Processing Unit
CRC ............... Cyclic Redundancy Code
CRT, CRNT .... Current
CSA................ Canadian Standards Association
CT .................. Current Transformer
CVT ................ Capacitive Voltage Transformer
D/A ................. Digital to Analog
DC (dc)........... Direct Current
DD .................. Disturbance Detector
DFLT .............. Default
DGNST........... Diagnostics
DI.................... Digital Input
DIFF ............... Differential
DIR ................. Directional
DISCREP ....... Discrepancy
DIST ............... Distance
DMD ............... Demand
DNP................ Distributed Network Protocol
DPO ............... Dropout
DSP................ Digital Signal Processor
dt .................... Rate of Change
DTT ................ Direct Transfer Trip
DUTT.............. Direct Under-reaching Transfer Trip
GE Multilin
I.......................Instantaneous
I_0...................Zero Sequence current
I_1...................Positive Sequence current
I_2...................Negative Sequence current
IA ....................Phase A current
IAB ..................Phase A minus B current
IB ....................Phase B current
IBC..................Phase B minus C current
IC ....................Phase C current
ICA..................Phase C minus A current
ID ....................Identification
IED..................Intelligent Electronic Device
IEC..................International Electrotechnical Commission
IEEE................Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers
IG ....................Ground (not residual) current
Igd...................Differential Ground current
IN ....................CT Residual Current (3Io) or Input
INC SEQ .........Incomplete Sequence
INIT .................Initiate
INST................Instantaneous
INV..................Inverse
I/O ...................Input/Output
IOC .................Instantaneous Overcurrent
IOV..................Instantaneous Overvoltage
IRIG ................Inter-Range Instrumentation Group
ISO..................International Standards Organization
IUV..................Instantaneous Undervoltage
K0 ...................Zero Sequence Current Compensation
kA....................kiloAmpere
kV....................kiloVolt
LED.................Light Emitting Diode
LEO.................Line End Open
LFT BLD .........Left Blinder
LOOP..............Loopback
LPU.................Line Pickup
LRA.................Locked-Rotor Current
LTC .................Load Tap-Changer
G .....................Generator
GE...................General Electric
GND................Ground
GNTR..............Generator
GOOSE...........General Object Oriented Substation Event
GPS ................Global Positioning System
M.....................Machine
mA ..................MilliAmpere
MAG................Magnitude
MAN................Manual / Manually
MAX ................Maximum
MIC .................Model Implementation Conformance
MIN .................Minimum, Minutes
MMI.................Man Machine Interface
MMS ...............Manufacturing Message Specification
MRT ................Minimum Response Time
MSG................Message
MTA ................Maximum Torque Angle
MTR ................Motor
MVA ................MegaVolt-Ampere (total 3-phase)
MVA_A............MegaVolt-Ampere (phase A)
MVA_B............MegaVolt-Ampere (phase B)
H-5
H.2 ABBREVIATIONS
APPENDIX H
S .................... Sensitive
SAT ................ CT Saturation
SBO ............... Select Before Operate
SCADA .......... Supervisory Control and Data Acquisition
SEC ............... Secondary
SEL ................ Select / Selector / Selection
SENS ............. Sensitive
SEQ ............... Sequence
SIR................. Source Impedance Ratio
SNTP ............. Simple Network Time Protocol
SRC ............... Source
SSB................ Single Side Band
SSEL.............. Session Selector
STATS............ Statistics
SUPN............. Supervision
SUPV ............. Supervise / Supervision
SV .................. Supervision, Service
SYNC............. Synchrocheck
SYNCHCHK... Synchrocheck
QUAD............. Quadrilateral
R..................... Rate, Reverse
RCA................ Reach Characteristic Angle
REF ................ Reference
REM ............... Remote
REV................ Reverse
RI.................... Reclose Initiate
RIP ................. Reclose In Progress
RGT BLD........ Right Blinder
RMS ............... Root Mean Square
ROD ............... Remote Open Detector
RST ................ Reset
RSTR ............. Restrained
RTD ................ Resistance Temperature Detector
RTU ................ Remote Terminal Unit
RX (Rx) .......... Receive, Receiver
s ..................... second
H-6
GE Multilin
APPENDIX H
H.3 WARRANTY
H.3WARRANTY
GE Multilin
H-7
H.3 WARRANTY
APPENDIX H
H-8
GE Multilin
INDEX
Numerics
10BASE-F
interface ........................................................................ 3-32
settings .................................................................5-25, 5-26
8-BIT SWITCH
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-102
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-33
settings ....................................................................... 5-130
specifications ................................................................ 2-14
A
ABBREVIATIONS ...............................................................H-5
ACTIVATING THE RELAY ........................................1-18, 4-27
ACTUAL VALUES
product information ........................................................ 6-16
ALARM LEDs ................................................................... 5-70
APPLICATION EXAMPLES
breaker trip circuit integrity .......................................... 5-127
contact inputs .............................................................. 5-136
APPROVALS ................................................................... 2-21
ARCHITECTURE ........................................................... 5-100
B
BATTERY
disposal .......................................................................... 8-5
failure ............................................................................. 7-7
replace ............................................................................ 8-3
BATTERY FAILURE ........................................................... 7-7
BINARY INPUT POINTS ..................................................... F-8
BINARY OUTPUT POINTS ................................................. F-9
BLOCK DIAGRAM .............................................................. 1-3
BLOCK SETTING ............................................................... 5-4
BREAKER CONTROL
control of 2 breakers ...................................................... 4-24
description .................................................................... 4-23
dual breaker logic ..................................................5-94, 5-95
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-102
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-28
settings ......................................................................... 5-92
BRIGHTNESS .................................................................. 5-20
C
C37.94 COMMUNICATIONS ............................ 3-33, 3-34, 3-37
C37.94SM COMMUNICATIONS ........................................ 3-36
CAPACITOR CONTROL
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-20
CAUTIONS ........................................................................ 1-1
CE APPROVALS .............................................................. 2-21
CHANGES TO C30 MANUAL ..............................................H-2
CHANNEL TESTS ............................................................ 6-10
CIRCUIT MONITORING APPLICATIONS ........................ 5-125
CLEANING ...................................................................... 2-21
CLEAR RECORDS .................................................... 5-21, 7-2
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-50
settings ......................................................................... 5-21
CLOCK
setting date and time ........................................................ 7-2
settings ......................................................................... 5-60
COMMANDS MENU ............................................................ 7-1
COMMUNICATIONS
10BASE-F ..................................................................... 5-25
connecting to the UR ............................................... 1-8, 1-14
CRC-16 error checking .................................................... B-2
DNP ....................................................................... 5-31, F-1
EGD .............................................................................. 5-53
G.703 ............................................................................ 3-28
half duplex ...................................................................... B-1
HTTP ............................................................................. 5-51
IEC 60870-5-10 ............................................................. 5-55
IEC 60870-5-104 protocol............................................... 5-52
IEC 61850 ................................................................... 5-141
inter-relay communications ............................................. 2-18
Modbus .................................................. 5-30, 5-60, B-1, B-3
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-24
network ................................................................ 5-25, 5-26
overview ........................................................................ 1-17
RS232 ........................................................................... 3-18
RS485 .................................................................. 3-21, 5-23
settings ............ 5-25, 5-26, 5-31, 5-37, 5-52, 5-53, 5-55, 5-60
specifications ................................................................. 2-18
UCA/MMS .................................................................... 5-143
web server ..................................................................... 5-51
COMPATIBILITY ................................................................ 1-3
COMTRADE ............................................................... B-6, B-7
CONDUCTED RFI ............................................................ 2-20
CONTACT INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-3
dry connections ............................................................. 3-16
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-104
Modbus registers ............................... B-14, B-16, B-45, B-47
settings ....................................................................... 5-135
specifications ................................................................. 2-15
thresholds ................................................................... 5-135
wet connections ............................................................. 3-16
CONTACT OUTPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-4
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-104
Modbus registers ........................................ B-14, B-16, B-57
settings ....................................................................... 5-138
CONTROL ELEMENTS ................................................... 5-119
CONTROL POWER
description ..................................................................... 3-10
specifications ................................................................. 2-17
CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-102
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-51
settings ......................................................................... 5-73
specifications ................................................................. 2-14
COUNTERS
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
settings ....................................................................... 5-128
CRC ALARM .................................................................... 5-88
CRC-16 ALGORITHM ........................................................ B-2
CRITICAL FAILURE RELAY ....................................... 2-16, 3-9
CSA APPROVAL .............................................................. 2-21
CURRENT DIFFERENTIAL
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-15
D
DATA FORMATS, MODBUS ............................................. B-60
GE Multilin
INDEX
DATA LOGGER
clearing .................................................................. 5-21, 7-2
Modbus .......................................................................... B-7
Modbus registers ..................................................B-15, B-26
settings ......................................................................... 5-67
specifications................................................................. 2-15
via COMTRADE .............................................................. B-6
DATE ................................................................................. 7-2
DCMA INPUTS ................................................................. 6-12
Modbus registers ..................................................B-18, B-59
settings ....................................................................... 5-153
specifications................................................................. 2-15
DCMA OUTPUTS
description..................................................................... 3-18
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-36
settings ....................................................................... 5-156
specifications................................................................. 2-17
DESIGN ............................................................................. 1-3
DEVICE ID ..................................................................... 5-141
DEVICE PROFILE DOCUMENT ..........................................F-1
DIELECTRIC STRENGTH ................................................... 3-9
DIGITAL COUNTERS
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-102
logic ............................................................................ 5-129
Modbus registers ...................... B-10, B-12, B-13, B-14, B-38
settings ....................................................................... 5-128
DIGITAL ELEMENTS
application example ..................................................... 5-126
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-103
logic ............................................................................ 5-125
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-34
settings ....................................................................... 5-125
DIGITAL OUTPUTS
see entry for CONTACT OUTPUTS
DIMENSIONS .............................................................. 3-1, 3-2
DIRECT DEVICES
actual values ................................................................... 6-8
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-19
settings ....................................................................... 5-145
DIRECT I/O
see also DIRECT INPUTS and DIRECT OUTPUTS
application example ...........................................5-146, 5-147
configuration examples ........................ 5-82, 5-84, 5-88, 5-89
settings ............................................. 5-82, 5-88, 5-89, 5-145
DIRECT INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-8
application example ...........................................5-146, 5-147
clearing counters ............................................................. 7-2
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-104
Modbus registers ...................... B-14, B-15, B-19, B-51, B-52
settings ....................................................................... 5-145
specifications................................................................. 2-15
DIRECT INPUTS/OUTPUTS
error messages ................................................................ 7-7
DIRECT OUTPUTS
application example ...........................................5-146, 5-147
clearing counters ............................................................. 7-2
Modbus registers ............................... B-14, B-15, B-51, B-52
settings ....................................................................... 5-145
DISCONNECT SWITCH
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-103
logic .............................................................................. 5-98
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-32
settings ......................................................................... 5-96
DISPLAY ........................................................1-17, 4-23, 5-20
DNA-1 BIT PAIR ............................................................. 5-143
ii
DNP COMMUNICATIONS
binary counters ............................................................. F-10
binary input points ........................................................... F-8
binary output points ......................................................... F-9
control relay output blocks ............................................... F-9
device profile document ................................................... F-1
frozen counters ............................................................. F-10
implementation table ....................................................... F-4
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-25
settings ..........................................................................5-31
DUPLEX, HALF ................................................................. B-1
DYNAMIC SWITCH
see entry for 8-BIT SWITCH
E
EGD PROTOCOL
actual values ................................................................... 6-9
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-34
settings ................................................................. 5-53, 5-55
EIGHT-BIT SWITCH
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-102
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-33
settings ........................................................................ 5-130
specifications .................................................................2-14
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE ........................................2-20
EMAIL ADDRESS FOR SUPPORT ..................................... 1-2
ENERVISTA UR SETUP
creating a site list ............................................................ 4-1
event recorder ................................................................. 4-2
firmware upgrades ........................................................... 4-2
installation ...................................................................... 1-5
introduction ..................................................................... 4-1
oscillography ................................................................... 4-2
overview ......................................................................... 4-1
requirements ................................................................... 1-5
EQUIPMENT MISMATCH ERROR ...................................... 7-6
ETHERNET
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
configuration ................................................................... 1-8
error messages ............................................................... 7-8
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-15
quick connect .................................................................. 1-9
settings ................................................................. 5-25, 5-26
EVENT CAUSE INDICATORS .................................. 4-15, 4-16
EVENT RECORDER
actual values ..................................................................6-14
clearing ...................................................................5-21, 7-2
Modbus ........................................................................... B-7
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-18
specifications .................................................................2-15
via EnerVista software ..................................................... 4-2
EVENTS SETTING ............................................................ 5-4
EXCEPTION RESPONSES ................................................. B-5
F
F485 ................................................................................1-17
FACEPLATE ............................................................... 3-1, 3-2
FACEPLATE PANELS .............................................. 4-13, 4-23
FACTORY DEFAULT RESET ............................................. 5-5
FAST FORM-C RELAY ......................................................2-17
FAST TRANSIENT TESTING .............................................2-20
FAX NUMBER ................................................................... 1-2
FEATURES ....................................................................... 2-1
GE Multilin
INDEX
FIRMWARE REVISION .................................................... 6-16
FIRMWARE UPGRADES .................................................... 4-2
FLASH MESSAGES ......................................................... 5-20
FLEX STATE PARAMETERS
actual values ............................................................ 6-6, 6-7
Modbus registers .................................................. B-16, B-34
settings ......................................................................... 5-79
specifications ................................................................ 2-14
FLEXCURVES
specifications ................................................................ 2-14
FLEXELEMENTS
actual values ................................................................. 6-12
direction ...................................................................... 5-115
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-103
hysteresis ................................................................... 5-115
Modbus registers .................................................. B-35, B-37
pickup ......................................................................... 5-115
scheme logic ............................................................... 5-114
settings .................................................. 5-113, 5-114, 5-117
specifications ................................................................ 2-14
FLEXLOGIC
editing with EnerVista UR Setup....................................... 4-2
equation editor ............................................................ 5-112
error messages ............................................................... 7-6
evaluation ................................................................... 5-107
example ............................................................ 5-100, 5-107
gate characteristics ..................................................... 5-106
locking equation entries ................................................... 4-8
locking to a serial number ................................................ 4-9
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-30
operands ........................................................... 5-101, 5-102
operators .................................................................... 5-106
rules ........................................................................... 5-106
security ........................................................................... 4-8
specifications ................................................................ 2-14
timers ......................................................................... 5-112
worksheet ................................................................... 5-108
FLEXLOGIC EQUATION EDITOR ................................... 5-112
FLEXLOGIC TIMERS
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-31
settings ....................................................................... 5-112
FORCE CONTACT INPUTS ............................................ 5-159
FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS ........................................ 5-160
FORCE TRIGGER ............................................................ 6-14
FORM-A RELAY
high impedance circuits ................................................. 3-11
outputs ......................................................... 3-10, 3-11, 3-16
specifications ................................................................ 2-16
FORM-C RELAY
outputs ..................................................................3-10, 3-16
specifications ................................................................ 2-16
FREQUENCY RATE OF CHANGE
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-15
FUNCTION SETTING ......................................................... 5-4
FUSE .............................................................................. 2-16
I
IEC 60870-5-103
settings ......................................................................... 5-55
IEC 60870-5-103 PROTOCOL
interoperability document ................................................ D-1
IEC 60870-5-104 PROTOCOL
interoperability document ................................................ E-1
settings ......................................................................... 5-52
IEC 61850 GOOSE ANALOGS
settings ....................................................................... 5-151
IEC 61850 GOOSE UINTEGERS
settings ....................................................................... 5-152
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL
device ID ..................................................................... 5-142
DNA2 assignments ....................................................... 5-144
error messages ................................................................ 7-9
Modbus registers ............. B-40, B-41, B-42, B-43, B-44, B-55
remote inputs ............................................................... 5-142
settings ......................................................................... 5-36
UserSt-1 bit pair .......................................................... 5-144
IEC 870-5-103
explained ......................................................................... 2-6
IED SETUP ........................................................................ 1-5
IEEE C37.94 COMMUNICATIONS ................... 3-33, 3-34, 3-37
IN SERVICE INDICATOR ........................................... 1-18, 7-5
INCOMPATIBLE HARDWARE ERROR ................................ 7-6
INPUTS
contact inputs ........................................... 2-15, 5-135, 5-159
dcmA inputs .......................................................... 2-15, 3-18
direct inputs ................................................................... 2-15
IRIG-B .................................................................. 2-15, 3-22
remote inputs ................................. 2-15, 5-141, 5-142, 5-143
RTD inputs ........................................................... 2-15, 3-18
virtual .......................................................................... 5-137
INSPECTION CHECKLIST .................................................. 1-2
INSTALLATION
communications ............................................................. 3-20
RS485 ........................................................................... 3-21
settings ......................................................................... 5-90
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS .................................. 2-18
INTRODUCTION ................................................................ 1-3
IP ADDRESS ........................................................... 5-25, 5-26
enter on front panel ............................................... 1-18, 4-23
gateway ......................................................................... 5-28
IRIG-B
connection ..................................................................... 3-22
error messages ......................................................... 7-7, 7-8
specifications ................................................................. 2-15
ISO-9000 REGISTRATION ................................................ 2-21
G
G.703 .................................................... 3-27, 3-28, 3-29, 3-32
GATEWAY ADDRESS ...................................................... 5-28
GSSE ................................................ 5-142, 5-143, 5-144, 6-5
H
HALF-DUPLEX .................................................................. B-1
GE Multilin
L
LAMPTEST ........................................................................ 7-3
LANGUAGE ..................................................................... 5-20
LASER MODULE .............................................................. 3-25
iii
INDEX
LATCHING OUTPUTS
application example ...........................................5-139, 5-140
error messages ................................................................ 7-8
settings ....................................................................... 5-138
specifications................................................................. 2-16
LED INDICATORS ................ 4-14, 4-15, 4-16, 4-17, 4-22, 5-70
LED TEST
FlexLogic operand ....................................................... 5-105
settings ......................................................................... 5-68
specifications................................................................. 2-14
LINK POWER BUDGET .................................................... 2-18
LOGIC GATES ............................................................... 5-106
LOST PASSWORD ............................................................. 5-5
M
MAINTENANCE
alert to replace battery ..................................................... 7-7
battery ............................................................................. 8-3
module replacement ......................................................... 8-1
MAINTENANCE COMMANDS ............................................. 7-3
MANUFACTURING DATE ................................................. 6-16
MEMORY MAP DATA FORMATS ......................................B-60
MENU HIERARCHY ................................................ 1-18, 4-25
MENU NAVIGATION .......................................1-18, 4-24, 4-25
MODBUS
data logger .............................................................. B-6, B-7
event recorder ................................................................ B-7
exception responses ....................................................... B-5
execute operation ........................................................... B-4
flex state parameters ..................................................... 5-80
function code 03/04h ....................................................... B-3
function code 05h ........................................................... B-4
function code 06h ........................................................... B-4
function code 10h ........................................................... B-5
introduction .................................................................... B-1
memory map data formats ..............................................B-60
obtaining files ................................................................. B-6
oscillography .................................................................. B-6
passwords ............................................................... B-7, B-8
read/write settings/actual values ...................................... B-3
settings ................................................................ 5-30, 5-60
store multiple settings ..................................................... B-5
store single setting ......................................................... B-4
supported function codes ................................................ B-3
user map ..................................................... 5-60, B-14, B-29
MODEL INFORMATION .................................................... 6-16
MODIFICATION FILE NUMBER ........................................ 6-16
MODULE FAILURE ERROR ................................................ 7-6
MODULES
communications ............................................................. 3-20
direct inputs/outputs ...................................................... 3-25
insertion .......................................................................... 8-1
order codes ................................................................... 2-12
power supply ................................................................... 3-9
transducer I/O ............................................................... 3-18
withdrawal ....................................................................... 8-1
MOUNTING ................................................................. 3-1, 3-2
N
NAMEPLATE ...................................................................... 1-2
iv
NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-103
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-39
settings ........................................................................ 5-118
specifications .................................................................2-14
O
ONE SHOTS ...................................................................5-106
OPERATING TEMPERATURE ...........................................2-20
ORDER CODES .......................... 2-7, 2-8, 2-9, 2-11, 6-16, 7-3
ORDER CODES, UPDATING ............................................. 7-3
ORDERING ................................................. 2-7, 2-8, 2-9, 2-11
OSCILLATORY TRANSIENT TESTING ..............................2-20
OSCILLOGRAPHY
actual values ..................................................................6-14
clearing ...................................................................5-21, 7-2
Modbus ........................................................................... B-6
Modbus registers ......................................... B-16, B-17, B-27
settings ..........................................................................5-65
specifications .................................................................2-15
via COMTRADE .............................................................. B-6
via EnerVista software ..................................................... 4-2
OUTPUTS
contact outputs ............................................................ 5-138
control power .................................................................2-17
critical failure relay .........................................................2-16
Fast Form-C relay ..........................................................2-17
Form-A relay ....................................... 2-16, 3-10, 3-11, 3-16
Form-C relay ................................................ 2-16, 3-10, 3-16
latching outputs ................................................... 2-16, 5-138
remote outputs .................................................. 5-143, 5-144
virtual outputs .............................................................. 5-140
P
PANEL CUTOUT ........................................................ 3-1, 3-2
PARALLEL REDUNDANCY PROTOCOL
actual values ..................................................................6-11
explained .......................................................................5-26
settings ..........................................................................5-25
specifications .................................................................2-18
PARITY ............................................................................5-23
PASSWORD SECURITY
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-105
PASSWORDS
bypass authentication .....................................................5-18
changing ........................................................................4-28
for settings templates ...................................................... 4-5
lost password .................................................................. 5-5
Modbus .................................................................... B-7, B-8
Modbus registers .................................................. B-15, B-24
overview ........................................................................1-19
security ........................................................................... 2-2
settings ........................................................................... 2-2
PC SOFTWARE
see entry for ENERVISTA UR SETUP
PHONE NUMBER FOR SUPPORT ..................................... 1-2
PID REGULATOR
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-103
settings ........................................................................ 5-132
POWER SUPPLY
description ...................................................................... 3-9
low range .......................................................................2-16
specifications .................................................................2-16
GE Multilin
INDEX
PREFERENCES
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-24
PROCESS BUS
overview ....................................................................... 3-10
PRODUCT INFORMATION ........................................ 6-16, B-9
PRODUCT SETUP .................................................... 5-5, 5-16
PRODUCTION TESTS ..................................................... 2-20
PRP
actual values ................................................................. 6-11
explained ...................................................................... 5-26
settings ......................................................................... 5-25
specifications ................................................................ 2-18
PUSHBUTTONS, USER-PROGRAMMABLE
see USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS
R
REAL TIME CLOCK
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-26
settings ......................................................................... 5-60
REAR TERMINAL ASSIGNMENTS ..................................... 3-7
REDUNDANCY
PRP actual values ......................................................... 6-11
PRP explained .............................................................. 5-26
settings ......................................................................... 5-25
specifications ................................................................ 2-18
RELAY ACTIVATION ....................................................... 4-27
RELAY ARCHITECTURE ................................................ 5-100
RELAY MAINTENANCE ..................................................... 7-3
RELAY NAME .................................................................. 5-90
RELAY NOT PROGRAMMED ........................................... 1-18
REMOTE DEVICES
actual values ................................................................... 6-5
device ID ..................................................................... 5-142
error messages ............................................................... 7-9
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-105
Modbus registers ................................ B-14, B-16, B-52, B-57
settings ....................................................................... 5-141
statistics ......................................................................... 6-5
REMOTE DPS INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-4
settings ....................................................................... 5-143
REMOTE INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-3
FlexLogic operands ..................................................... 5-104
Modbus registers ......................................... B-14, B-16, B-53
settings ....................................................................... 5-142
specifications ................................................................ 2-15
REMOTE OUTPUTS
DNA-1 bit pair ............................................................. 5-143
Modbus registers .................................................. B-54, B-55
UserSt-1 bit pair .......................................................... 5-144
REPLACEMENT MODULES .....................................2-12, 2-13
REQUIREMENTS FOR INSTALLATION .............................. 1-5
RESETTING ................................................. 5-5, 5-105, 5-144
REVISION HISTORY ..........................................................H-1
RF IMMUNITY ................................................................. 2-20
RFI, CONDUCTED ........................................................... 2-20
RS232
configuration ................................................................... 1-9
specifications ................................................................ 2-18
wiring ............................................................................ 3-19
RS422
configuration ................................................................. 3-30
timing ............................................................................ 3-31
two-channel application ................................................. 3-30
with fiber interface ......................................................... 3-32
GE Multilin
RS485
description ..................................................................... 3-21
specifications ................................................................. 2-18
RTD INPUTS
actual values ................................................................. 6-13
Modbus registers ................................................. B-18, B-30
settings ....................................................................... 5-154
specifications ................................................................. 2-15
S
SBO ................................................................................. 5-50
SELECT BEFORE OPERATE ............................................ 5-50
SELECTOR SWITCH
actual values ................................................................... 6-6
application example ..................................................... 5-123
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-103
logic ............................................................................ 5-124
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-38
settings ....................................................................... 5-119
specifications ................................................................. 2-14
timing ............................................................... 5-122, 5-123
Self-test errors ................................................................. 7-10
SELF-TESTS
description ....................................................................... 7-5
error messages ................................................................ 7-7
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-105
Modbus registers ............................................................ B-9
SERIAL NUMBER ............................................................. 6-16
SERIAL PORTS
settings ......................................................................... 5-23
SETTINGS TEMPLATES
description ....................................................................... 4-4
editing ............................................................................. 4-4
enabling .......................................................................... 4-4
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-59
password protection ......................................................... 4-5
removing ......................................................................... 4-7
viewing ............................................................................ 4-6
SETTINGS, CHANGING ................................................... 4-26
SIGNAL TYPES .................................................................. 1-3
SITE LIST, CREATING ....................................................... 4-1
SNTP PROTOCOL
accuracy ........................................................................ 2-18
error messages ................................................................ 7-8
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-26
settings ......................................................................... 5-63
SOFTWARE
installation ....................................................................... 1-5
see entry for ENERVISTA UR SETUP
SOFTWARE ARCHITECTURE ............................................ 1-4
SOFTWARE, PC
see entry for EnerVista UR Setup
SPECIFICATIONS ............................................................ 2-14
STANDARD ABBREVIATIONS ........................................... H-5
STATUS INDICATORS ............................................ 4-14, 4-16
STORAGE TEMPERATURE .............................................. 2-20
SUMMATOR
Modbus registers .......................................................... B-33
SUPPORT, TECHNICAL ..................................................... 1-2
SURGE IMMUNITY ........................................................... 2-20
SYNCHROCHECK
actual values .......................................................... 6-9, 6-12
SYNCHROPHASORS
commands ....................................................................... 7-3
SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS ................................................. 1-5
INDEX
T
TARGET MESSAGES ......................................................... 7-5
TARGET SETTING ............................................................. 5-4
TARGETS MENU ............................................................... 7-5
TCP PORT NUMBER ........................................................ 5-51
TECHNICAL SUPPORT ...................................................... 1-2
TELEPROTECTION
actual values ................................................................... 6-4
clearing counters ............................................................. 7-2
FlexLogic operands ............................................5-103, 5-104
logic ............................................................................ 5-150
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-38
overview ...................................................................... 5-149
settings .................................................... 5-89, 5-149, 5-150
specifications................................................................. 2-16
TEMPERATURE MONITOR ..................................... 5-105, 7-9
TERMINALS ....................................................................... 3-7
TESTING
force contact inputs ..................................................... 5-159
force contact outputs ................................................... 5-160
lamp test ......................................................................... 7-3
self-test error messages ................................................... 7-5
TIME ................................................................................. 7-2
TIMERS ......................................................................... 5-112
TRACEABILITY
data ..................................................................... 4-11, 4-12
overview ........................................................................ 4-10
rules .............................................................................. 4-12
TRANSDUCER I/O
actual values ........................................................ 6-12, 6-13
settings .............................................................5-153, 5-154
specifications................................................................. 2-15
wiring ............................................................................ 3-18
TRIP BUS
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-104
Modbus registers ...........................................................B-35
TRIP LEDs ....................................................................... 5-70
TROUBLE INDICATOR .............................................. 1-18, 7-5
U
UL APPROVAL ................................................................. 2-21
UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS
commands ..................................................................... 5-21
resetting .......................................................................... 7-2
UNEXPECTED RESTART ERROR ...................................... 7-9
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED ........................................ 5-90, 7-6
UNPACKING THE RELAY ................................................... 1-2
UNRETURNED MESSAGES ALARM ................................. 5-89
UPDATING ORDER CODE ................................................. 7-3
vi
URPC
see entry for ENERVISTA UR SETUP
USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
example .........................................................................5-82
invoking and scrolling .....................................................5-80
Modbus registers .................................................. B-24, B-29
settings ................................................................. 5-80, 5-82
specifications .................................................................2-14
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDs
custom labeling ..............................................................4-22
defaults..........................................................................4-17
description ............................................................ 4-15, 4-16
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-27
settings ..........................................................................5-70
specifications .................................................................2-14
USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-105
Modbus registers .................................................. B-29, B-33
settings ..........................................................................5-74
specifications .................................................................2-14
USER-PROGRAMMABLE SELF TESTS
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-28
settings ..........................................................................5-71
USERST-1 BIT PAIR ....................................................... 5-144
V
VIBRATION TESTING .......................................................2-20
VIRTUAL INPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-3
commands ...................................................................... 7-1
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-104
logic ............................................................................ 5-137
Modbus registers .................................................... B-9, B-47
settings ........................................................................ 5-137
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
actual values ................................................................... 6-5
FlexLogic operands ...................................................... 5-104
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-48
settings ........................................................................ 5-140
VOLTAGE DEVIATIONS ...................................................2-20
VOLTS PER HERTZ
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-39
W
WARNINGS ....................................................................... 1-1
WARRANTY ...................................................................... H-7
WEB SERVER PROTOCOL ...............................................5-51
WEBSITE .......................................................................... 1-2
GE Multilin